TE X AS I NS TRUM E NTS - P RO DUCTION D ATA ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller D ATA SHE E T D S -LM3S 1G2 1 - 11 4 2 5 C o p yri g h t © 2 0 07-2012 Te xa s In stru me n ts In co rporated Copyright Copyright © 2007-2012 Texas Instruments Incorporated All rights reserved. Stellaris and StellarisWare® are registered trademarks of Texas Instruments Incorporated. ARM and Thumb are registered trademarks and Cortex is a trademark of ARM Limited. Other names and brands may be claimed as the property of others. PRODUCTION DATA information is current as of publication date. Products conform to specifications per the terms of Texas Instruments standard warranty. Production processing does not necessarily include testing of all parameters. Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications of Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet. Texas Instruments Incorporated 108 Wild Basin, Suite 350 Austin, TX 78746 http://www.ti.com/stellaris http://www-k.ext.ti.com/sc/technical-support/product-information-centers.htm 2 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table of Contents Revision History ............................................................................................................................. 28 About This Document .................................................................................................................... 31 Audience .............................................................................................................................................. About This Manual ................................................................................................................................ Related Documents ............................................................................................................................... Documentation Conventions .................................................................................................................. 31 31 31 32 1 Architectural Overview .......................................................................................... 34 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.3.1 1.3.2 1.3.3 1.3.4 1.3.5 1.3.6 1.3.7 1.3.8 1.4 Overview ...................................................................................................................... Target Applications ........................................................................................................ Features ....................................................................................................................... ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core .................................................................................... On-Chip Memory ........................................................................................................... External Peripheral Interface ......................................................................................... Serial Communications Peripherals ................................................................................ System Integration ........................................................................................................ Analog .......................................................................................................................... JTAG and ARM Serial Wire Debug ................................................................................ Packaging and Temperature .......................................................................................... Hardware Details .......................................................................................................... 34 36 36 36 38 39 41 44 49 51 51 52 2 The Cortex-M3 Processor ...................................................................................... 53 2.1 2.2 2.2.1 2.2.2 2.2.3 2.2.4 2.3 2.3.1 2.3.2 2.3.3 2.3.4 2.3.5 2.3.6 2.4 2.4.1 2.4.2 2.4.3 2.4.4 2.4.5 2.4.6 2.4.7 2.5 2.5.1 2.5.2 2.5.3 Block Diagram .............................................................................................................. 54 Overview ...................................................................................................................... 55 System-Level Interface .................................................................................................. 55 Integrated Configurable Debug ...................................................................................... 55 Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) ..................................................................................... 56 Cortex-M3 System Component Details ........................................................................... 56 Programming Model ...................................................................................................... 57 Processor Mode and Privilege Levels for Software Execution ........................................... 57 Stacks .......................................................................................................................... 57 Register Map ................................................................................................................ 58 Register Descriptions .................................................................................................... 59 Exceptions and Interrupts .............................................................................................. 72 Data Types ................................................................................................................... 72 Memory Model .............................................................................................................. 72 Memory Regions, Types and Attributes ........................................................................... 74 Memory System Ordering of Memory Accesses .............................................................. 74 Behavior of Memory Accesses ....................................................................................... 75 Software Ordering of Memory Accesses ......................................................................... 75 Bit-Banding ................................................................................................................... 77 Data Storage ................................................................................................................ 79 Synchronization Primitives ............................................................................................. 79 Exception Model ........................................................................................................... 80 Exception States ........................................................................................................... 81 Exception Types ............................................................................................................ 81 Exception Handlers ....................................................................................................... 84 January 22, 2012 3 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents 2.5.4 2.5.5 2.5.6 2.5.7 2.6 2.6.1 2.6.2 2.6.3 2.6.4 2.7 2.7.1 2.7.2 2.8 Vector Table .................................................................................................................. 84 Exception Priorities ....................................................................................................... 85 Interrupt Priority Grouping .............................................................................................. 86 Exception Entry and Return ........................................................................................... 86 Fault Handling .............................................................................................................. 88 Fault Types ................................................................................................................... 89 Fault Escalation and Hard Faults .................................................................................... 89 Fault Status Registers and Fault Address Registers ........................................................ 90 Lockup ......................................................................................................................... 90 Power Management ...................................................................................................... 90 Entering Sleep Modes ................................................................................................... 91 Wake Up from Sleep Mode ............................................................................................ 91 Instruction Set Summary ............................................................................................... 92 3 Cortex-M3 Peripherals ........................................................................................... 95 3.1 3.1.1 3.1.2 3.1.3 3.1.4 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 Functional Description ................................................................................................... 95 System Timer (SysTick) ................................................................................................. 95 Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) .................................................................... 96 System Control Block (SCB) .......................................................................................... 98 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) ....................................................................................... 98 Register Map .............................................................................................................. 103 System Timer (SysTick) Register Descriptions .............................................................. 105 NVIC Register Descriptions .......................................................................................... 109 System Control Block (SCB) Register Descriptions ........................................................ 122 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) Register Descriptions .................................................... 151 4 JTAG Interface ...................................................................................................... 161 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.3.1 4.3.2 4.3.3 4.3.4 4.4 4.5 4.5.1 4.5.2 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ Signal Description ....................................................................................................... Functional Description ................................................................................................. JTAG Interface Pins ..................................................................................................... JTAG TAP Controller ................................................................................................... Shift Registers ............................................................................................................ Operational Considerations .......................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. Instruction Register (IR) ............................................................................................... Data Registers ............................................................................................................ 162 162 163 163 165 165 166 168 169 169 171 5 System Control ..................................................................................................... 173 5.1 5.2 5.2.1 5.2.2 5.2.3 5.2.4 5.2.5 5.2.6 5.3 5.4 5.5 Signal Description ....................................................................................................... Functional Description ................................................................................................. Device Identification .................................................................................................... Reset Control .............................................................................................................. Non-Maskable Interrupt ............................................................................................... Power Control ............................................................................................................. Clock Control .............................................................................................................. System Control ........................................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... Register Map .............................................................................................................. Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 4 173 173 174 174 179 179 180 187 189 189 191 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 6 Hibernation Module .............................................................................................. 267 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.3.1 6.3.2 6.3.3 6.3.4 6.3.5 6.3.6 6.3.7 6.3.8 6.3.9 6.3.10 6.3.11 6.4 6.4.1 6.4.2 6.4.3 6.4.4 6.4.5 6.5 6.6 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ Signal Description ....................................................................................................... Functional Description ................................................................................................. Register Access Timing ............................................................................................... Hibernation Clock Source ............................................................................................ System Implementation ............................................................................................... Battery Management ................................................................................................... Real-Time Clock .......................................................................................................... Battery-Backed Memory .............................................................................................. Power Control Using HIB ............................................................................................. Power Control Using VDD3ON Mode ........................................................................... Initiating Hibernate ...................................................................................................... Waking from Hibernate ................................................................................................ Interrupts and Status ................................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... Initialization ................................................................................................................. RTC Match Functionality (No Hibernation) .................................................................... RTC Match/Wake-Up from Hibernation ......................................................................... External Wake-Up from Hibernation .............................................................................. RTC or External Wake-Up from Hibernation .................................................................. Register Map .............................................................................................................. Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 268 268 269 269 270 271 272 272 273 273 273 273 273 274 274 274 275 275 276 276 276 277 7 Internal Memory ................................................................................................... 294 7.1 7.2 7.2.1 7.2.2 7.2.3 7.3 7.4 7.5 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ 294 Functional Description ................................................................................................. 294 SRAM ........................................................................................................................ 295 ROM .......................................................................................................................... 295 Flash Memory ............................................................................................................. 297 Register Map .............................................................................................................. 302 Flash Memory Register Descriptions (Flash Control Offset) ............................................ 303 Memory Register Descriptions (System Control Offset) .................................................. 315 8 Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) ................................................................ 339 8.1 8.2 8.2.1 8.2.2 8.2.3 8.2.4 8.2.5 8.2.6 8.2.7 8.2.8 8.2.9 8.2.10 8.3 8.3.1 8.3.2 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ 340 Functional Description ................................................................................................. 340 Channel Assignments .................................................................................................. 341 Priority ........................................................................................................................ 342 Arbitration Size ............................................................................................................ 342 Request Types ............................................................................................................ 342 Channel Configuration ................................................................................................. 343 Transfer Modes ........................................................................................................... 345 Transfer Size and Increment ........................................................................................ 353 Peripheral Interface ..................................................................................................... 353 Software Request ........................................................................................................ 353 Interrupts and Errors .................................................................................................... 354 Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... 354 Module Initialization ..................................................................................................... 354 Configuring a Memory-to-Memory Transfer ................................................................... 355 January 22, 2012 5 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents 8.3.3 8.3.4 8.3.5 8.4 8.5 8.6 Configuring a Peripheral for Simple Transmit ................................................................ Configuring a Peripheral for Ping-Pong Receive ............................................................ Configuring Channel Assignments ................................................................................ Register Map .............................................................................................................. μDMA Channel Control Structure ................................................................................. μDMA Register Descriptions ........................................................................................ 356 358 360 360 362 369 9 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) ........................................................... 399 9.1 9.2 9.2.1 9.2.2 9.2.3 9.2.4 9.2.5 9.2.6 9.3 9.4 9.5 Signal Description ....................................................................................................... 399 Functional Description ................................................................................................. 404 Data Control ............................................................................................................... 405 Interrupt Control .......................................................................................................... 406 Mode Control .............................................................................................................. 407 Commit Control ........................................................................................................... 407 Pad Control ................................................................................................................. 408 Identification ............................................................................................................... 408 Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... 408 Register Map .............................................................................................................. 409 Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 412 10 External Peripheral Interface (EPI) ..................................................................... 455 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.3.1 10.3.2 10.4 10.4.1 10.4.2 10.4.3 10.5 10.6 EPI Block Diagram ...................................................................................................... Signal Description ....................................................................................................... Functional Description ................................................................................................. Non-Blocking Reads .................................................................................................... DMA Operation ........................................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... SDRAM Mode ............................................................................................................. Host Bus Mode ........................................................................................................... General-Purpose Mode ............................................................................................... Register Map .............................................................................................................. Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 456 457 459 460 461 461 462 466 477 485 486 11 General-Purpose Timers ...................................................................................... 530 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.3.1 11.3.2 11.3.3 11.3.4 11.4 11.4.1 11.4.2 11.4.3 11.4.4 11.4.5 11.5 11.6 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ Signal Description ....................................................................................................... Functional Description ................................................................................................. GPTM Reset Conditions .............................................................................................. Timer Modes ............................................................................................................... DMA Operation ........................................................................................................... Accessing Concatenated Register Values ..................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... One-Shot/Periodic Timer Mode .................................................................................... Real-Time Clock (RTC) Mode ...................................................................................... Input Edge-Count Mode ............................................................................................... Input Edge Timing Mode .............................................................................................. PWM Mode ................................................................................................................. Register Map .............................................................................................................. Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 6 530 531 534 535 535 541 542 542 542 543 543 544 545 545 546 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 12 Watchdog Timers ................................................................................................. 577 12.1 12.2 12.2.1 12.3 12.4 12.5 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ Functional Description ................................................................................................. Register Access Timing ............................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... Register Map .............................................................................................................. Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 578 578 579 579 579 580 13 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ..................................................................... 602 13.1 13.2 13.3 13.3.1 13.3.2 13.3.3 13.3.4 13.3.5 13.3.6 13.3.7 13.4 13.4.1 13.4.2 13.5 13.6 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ 603 Signal Description ....................................................................................................... 603 Functional Description ................................................................................................. 604 Sample Sequencers .................................................................................................... 604 Module Control ............................................................................................................ 605 Hardware Sample Averaging Circuit ............................................................................. 607 Analog-to-Digital Converter .......................................................................................... 608 Differential Sampling ................................................................................................... 612 Internal Temperature Sensor ........................................................................................ 614 Digital Comparator Unit ............................................................................................... 615 Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... 619 Module Initialization ..................................................................................................... 619 Sample Sequencer Configuration ................................................................................. 620 Register Map .............................................................................................................. 620 Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 622 14 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) ............................. 678 14.1 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ 14.2 Signal Description ....................................................................................................... 14.3 Functional Description ................................................................................................. 14.3.1 Transmit/Receive Logic ............................................................................................... 14.3.2 Baud-Rate Generation ................................................................................................. 14.3.3 Data Transmission ...................................................................................................... 14.3.4 Serial IR (SIR) ............................................................................................................. 14.3.5 ISO 7816 Support ....................................................................................................... 14.3.6 Modem Handshake Support ......................................................................................... 14.3.7 LIN Support ................................................................................................................ 14.3.8 FIFO Operation ........................................................................................................... 14.3.9 Interrupts .................................................................................................................... 14.3.10 Loopback Operation .................................................................................................... 14.3.11 DMA Operation ........................................................................................................... 14.4 Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... 14.5 Register Map .............................................................................................................. 14.6 Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 679 679 681 681 682 683 683 684 684 686 687 688 689 689 689 690 692 15 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) .................................................................... 742 15.1 15.2 15.3 15.3.1 15.3.2 15.3.3 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ Signal Description ....................................................................................................... Functional Description ................................................................................................. Bit Rate Generation ..................................................................................................... FIFO Operation ........................................................................................................... Interrupts .................................................................................................................... January 22, 2012 743 743 744 745 745 745 7 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents 15.3.4 15.3.5 15.4 15.5 15.6 Frame Formats ........................................................................................................... DMA Operation ........................................................................................................... Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... Register Map .............................................................................................................. Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 16 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface ................................................................ 784 16.1 16.2 16.3 16.3.1 16.3.2 16.3.3 16.3.4 16.3.5 16.4 16.5 16.6 16.7 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ Signal Description ....................................................................................................... Functional Description ................................................................................................. I2C Bus Functional Overview ........................................................................................ Available Speed Modes ............................................................................................... Interrupts .................................................................................................................... Loopback Operation .................................................................................................... Command Sequence Flow Charts ................................................................................ Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... Register Map .............................................................................................................. Register Descriptions (I2C Master) ............................................................................... Register Descriptions (I2C Slave) ................................................................................. 17 Analog Comparators ............................................................................................ 822 17.1 17.2 17.3 17.3.1 17.4 17.5 17.6 Block Diagram ............................................................................................................ Signal Description ....................................................................................................... Functional Description ................................................................................................. Internal Reference Programming .................................................................................. Initialization and Configuration ..................................................................................... Register Map .............................................................................................................. Register Descriptions .................................................................................................. 18 Pin Diagram .......................................................................................................... 835 19 Signal Tables ........................................................................................................ 837 19.1 19.2 19.3 100-Pin LQFP Package Pin Tables ............................................................................... 838 108-Ball BGA Package Pin Tables ................................................................................ 864 Connections for Unused Signals ................................................................................... 891 20 Operating Characteristics ................................................................................... 893 21 Electrical Characteristics .................................................................................... 894 21.1 21.2 21.3 21.4 21.5 21.6 21.7 21.8 21.8.1 21.8.2 21.8.3 21.8.4 21.8.5 21.8.6 Maximum Ratings ....................................................................................................... 894 Recommended Operating Conditions ........................................................................... 894 Load Conditions .......................................................................................................... 895 JTAG and Boundary Scan ............................................................................................ 895 Power and Brown-Out ................................................................................................. 897 Reset ......................................................................................................................... 898 On-Chip Low Drop-Out (LDO) Regulator ....................................................................... 899 Clocks ........................................................................................................................ 899 PLL Specifications ....................................................................................................... 899 PIOSC Specifications .................................................................................................. 900 Internal 30-kHz Oscillator Specifications ....................................................................... 900 Hibernation Clock Source Specifications ....................................................................... 901 Main Oscillator Specifications ....................................................................................... 901 System Clock Specification with ADC Operation ............................................................ 902 8 746 753 754 755 756 785 785 786 786 788 789 790 791 798 799 800 813 822 823 824 824 826 827 827 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 21.9 Sleep Modes ............................................................................................................... 21.10 Hibernation Module ..................................................................................................... 21.11 Flash Memory ............................................................................................................. 21.12 Input/Output Characteristics ......................................................................................... 21.13 External Peripheral Interface (EPI) ............................................................................... 21.14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ................................................................................ 21.15 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) ............................................................................... 21.16 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface ........................................................................... 21.17 Analog Comparator ..................................................................................................... 21.18 Current Consumption .................................................................................................. 21.18.1 Nominal Power Consumption ....................................................................................... 21.18.2 Maximum Current Consumption ................................................................................... A 902 902 904 904 905 910 911 913 914 914 914 915 Register Quick Reference ................................................................................... 917 B Ordering and Contact Information ..................................................................... 944 B.1 B.2 B.3 B.4 Ordering Information .................................................................................................... 944 Part Markings .............................................................................................................. 944 Kits ............................................................................................................................. 945 Support Information ..................................................................................................... 945 C Package Information ............................................................................................ 946 C.1 C.1.1 C.1.2 C.1.3 C.2 C.2.1 C.2.2 C.2.3 100-Pin LQFP Package ............................................................................................... Package Dimensions ................................................................................................... Tray Dimensions ......................................................................................................... Tape and Reel Dimensions .......................................................................................... 108-Ball BGA Package ................................................................................................ Package Dimensions ................................................................................................... Tray Dimensions ......................................................................................................... Tape and Reel Dimensions .......................................................................................... January 22, 2012 946 946 948 948 950 950 952 953 9 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents List of Figures Figure 1-1. Figure 2-1. Figure 2-2. Figure 2-3. Figure 2-4. Figure 2-5. Figure 2-6. Figure 2-7. Figure 3-1. Figure 4-1. Figure 4-2. Figure 4-3. Figure 4-4. Figure 4-5. Figure 5-1. Figure 5-2. Figure 5-3. Figure 5-4. Figure 5-5. Figure 6-1. Figure 6-2. Figure 6-3. Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller High-Level Block Diagram ............................... 35 CPU Block Diagram ............................................................................................. 55 TPIU Block Diagram ............................................................................................ 56 Cortex-M3 Register Set ........................................................................................ 58 Bit-Band Mapping ................................................................................................ 78 Data Storage ....................................................................................................... 79 Vector Table ........................................................................................................ 85 Exception Stack Frame ........................................................................................ 87 SRD Use Example ............................................................................................. 101 JTAG Module Block Diagram .............................................................................. 162 Test Access Port State Machine ......................................................................... 165 IDCODE Register Format ................................................................................... 171 BYPASS Register Format ................................................................................... 171 Boundary Scan Register Format ......................................................................... 172 Basic RST Configuration .................................................................................... 176 External Circuitry to Extend Power-On Reset ....................................................... 176 Reset Circuit Controlled by Switch ...................................................................... 177 Power Architecture ............................................................................................ 180 Main Clock Tree ................................................................................................ 183 Hibernation Module Block Diagram ..................................................................... 268 Using a Crystal as the Hibernation Clock Source ................................................. 271 Using a Dedicated Oscillator as the Hibernation Clock Source with VDD3ON Mode ................................................................................................................ 271 Figure 7-1. Internal Memory Block Diagram .......................................................................... 294 Figure 8-1. μDMA Block Diagram ......................................................................................... 340 Figure 8-2. Example of Ping-Pong μDMA Transaction ........................................................... 346 Figure 8-3. Memory Scatter-Gather, Setup and Configuration ................................................ 348 Figure 8-4. Memory Scatter-Gather, μDMA Copy Sequence .................................................. 349 Figure 8-5. Peripheral Scatter-Gather, Setup and Configuration ............................................. 351 Figure 8-6. Peripheral Scatter-Gather, μDMA Copy Sequence ............................................... 352 Figure 9-1. Digital I/O Pads ................................................................................................. 404 Figure 9-2. Analog/Digital I/O Pads ...................................................................................... 405 Figure 9-3. GPIODATA Write Example ................................................................................. 406 Figure 9-4. GPIODATA Read Example ................................................................................. 406 Figure 10-1. EPI Block Diagram ............................................................................................. 457 Figure 10-2. SDRAM Non-Blocking Read Cycle ...................................................................... 465 Figure 10-3. SDRAM Normal Read Cycle ............................................................................... 465 Figure 10-4. SDRAM Write Cycle ........................................................................................... 466 Figure 10-5. Example Schematic for Muxed Host-Bus 16 Mode ............................................... 472 Figure 10-6. Host-Bus Read Cycle, MODE = 0x1, WRHIGH = 0, RDHIGH = 0 .......................... 474 Figure 10-7. Host-Bus Write Cycle, MODE = 0x1, WRHIGH = 0, RDHIGH = 0 .......................... 475 Figure 10-8. Host-Bus Write Cycle with Multiplexed Address and Data, MODE = 0x0, WRHIGH = 0, RDHIGH = 0 ............................................................................................... 475 Figure 10-9. Host-Bus Write Cycle with Multiplexed Address and Data and ALE with Dual CSn .................................................................................................................. 476 Figure 10-10. Continuous Read Mode Accesses ...................................................................... 476 10 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 10-11. Figure 10-12. Figure 10-13. Figure 10-14. Figure 10-15. Figure 10-16. Figure 10-17. Figure 10-18. Figure 10-19. Figure 10-20. Figure 10-21. Figure 10-22. Figure 10-23. Figure 10-24. Figure 11-1. Figure 11-2. Figure 11-3. Figure 11-4. Figure 11-5. Figure 12-1. Figure 13-1. Figure 13-2. Figure 13-3. Figure 13-4. Figure 13-5. Figure 13-6. Figure 13-7. Figure 13-8. Figure 13-9. Figure 13-10. Figure 13-11. Figure 13-12. Figure 13-13. Figure 13-14. Figure 14-1. Figure 14-2. Figure 14-3. Figure 14-4. Figure 14-5. Figure 15-1. Figure 15-2. Figure 15-3. Figure 15-4. Figure 15-5. Figure 15-6. Figure 15-7. Figure 15-8. Write Followed by Read to External FIFO ............................................................ 477 Two-Entry FIFO ................................................................................................. 477 Single-Cycle Write Access, FRM50=0, FRMCNT=0, WRCYC=0 ........................... 481 Two-Cycle Read, Write Accesses, FRM50=0, FRMCNT=0, RDCYC=1, WRCYC=1 ........................................................................................................ 481 Read Accesses, FRM50=0, FRMCNT=0, RDCYC=1 ............................................ 482 FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=0 and FRMCNT=0 ......................................... 482 FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=0 and FRMCNT=1 ......................................... 482 FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=0 and FRMCNT=2 ......................................... 483 FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=1 and FRMCNT=0 ......................................... 483 FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=1 and FRMCNT=1 ......................................... 483 FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=1 and FRMCNT=2 ......................................... 483 iRDY Signal Operation, FRM50=0, FRMCNT=0, and RD2CYC=1 ......................... 484 EPI Clock Operation, CLKGATE=1, WR2CYC=0 ................................................. 485 EPI Clock Operation, CLKGATE=1, WR2CYC=1 ................................................. 485 GPTM Module Block Diagram ............................................................................ 531 Timer Daisy Chain ............................................................................................. 537 Input Edge-Count Mode Example ....................................................................... 539 16-Bit Input Edge-Time Mode Example ............................................................... 540 16-Bit PWM Mode Example ................................................................................ 541 WDT Module Block Diagram .............................................................................. 578 ADC Module Block Diagram ............................................................................... 603 ADC Sample Phases ......................................................................................... 607 Sample Averaging Example ............................................................................... 608 ADC Input Equivalency Diagram ......................................................................... 609 Internal Voltage Conversion Result ..................................................................... 610 External Voltage Conversion Result with 3.0-V Setting ......................................... 611 External Voltage Conversion Result with 1.0-V Setting ......................................... 611 Differential Sampling Range, VIN_ODD = 1.5 V ...................................................... 613 Differential Sampling Range, VIN_ODD = 0.75 V .................................................... 613 Differential Sampling Range, VIN_ODD = 2.25 V .................................................... 614 Internal Temperature Sensor Characteristic ......................................................... 615 Low-Band Operation (CIC=0x0) .......................................................................... 617 Mid-Band Operation (CIC=0x1) .......................................................................... 618 High-Band Operation (CIC=0x3) ......................................................................... 619 UART Module Block Diagram ............................................................................. 679 UART Character Frame ..................................................................................... 682 IrDA Data Modulation ......................................................................................... 684 LIN Message ..................................................................................................... 686 LIN Synchronization Field ................................................................................... 687 SSI Module Block Diagram ................................................................................. 743 TI Synchronous Serial Frame Format (Single Transfer) ........................................ 747 TI Synchronous Serial Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) ................................ 747 Freescale SPI Format (Single Transfer) with SPO=0 and SPH=0 .......................... 748 Freescale SPI Format (Continuous Transfer) with SPO=0 and SPH=0 .................. 748 Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=0 and SPH=1 ......................................... 749 Freescale SPI Frame Format (Single Transfer) with SPO=1 and SPH=0 ............... 750 Freescale SPI Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) with SPO=1 and SPH=0 ........ 750 January 22, 2012 11 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents Figure 15-9. Figure 15-10. Figure 15-11. Figure 15-12. Figure 16-1. Figure 16-2. Figure 16-3. Figure 16-4. Figure 16-5. Figure 16-6. Figure 16-7. Figure 16-8. Figure 16-9. Figure 16-10. Figure 16-11. Figure 16-12. Figure 16-13. Figure 17-1. Figure 17-2. Figure 17-3. Figure 18-1. Figure 18-2. Figure 21-1. Figure 21-2. Figure 21-3. Figure 21-4. Figure 21-5. Figure 21-6. Figure 21-7. Figure 21-8. Figure 21-9. Figure 21-10. Figure 21-11. Figure 21-12. Figure 21-13. Figure 21-14. Figure 21-15. Figure 21-16. Figure 21-17. Figure 21-18. Figure 21-19. Figure 21-20. Figure 21-21. Figure 21-22. Figure 21-23. Freescale SPI Frame Format with SPO=1 and SPH=1 ......................................... 751 MICROWIRE Frame Format (Single Frame) ........................................................ 752 MICROWIRE Frame Format (Continuous Transfer) ............................................. 753 MICROWIRE Frame Format, SSIFss Input Setup and Hold Requirements ............ 753 I2C Block Diagram ............................................................................................. 785 I2C Bus Configuration ........................................................................................ 786 START and STOP Conditions ............................................................................. 787 Complete Data Transfer with a 7-Bit Address ....................................................... 787 R/S Bit in First Byte ............................................................................................ 788 Data Validity During Bit Transfer on the I2C Bus ................................................... 788 Master Single TRANSMIT .................................................................................. 792 Master Single RECEIVE ..................................................................................... 793 Master TRANSMIT with Repeated START ........................................................... 794 Master RECEIVE with Repeated START ............................................................. 795 Master RECEIVE with Repeated START after TRANSMIT with Repeated START .............................................................................................................. 796 Master TRANSMIT with Repeated START after RECEIVE with Repeated START .............................................................................................................. 797 Slave Command Sequence ................................................................................ 798 Analog Comparator Module Block Diagram ......................................................... 822 Structure of Comparator Unit .............................................................................. 824 Comparator Internal Reference Structure ............................................................ 825 100-Pin LQFP Package Pin Diagram .................................................................. 835 108-Ball BGA Package Pin Diagram (Top View) ................................................... 836 Load Conditions ................................................................................................ 895 JTAG Test Clock Input Timing ............................................................................. 896 JTAG Test Access Port (TAP) Timing .................................................................. 896 Power-On Reset Timing ..................................................................................... 897 Brown-Out Reset Timing .................................................................................... 897 Power-On Reset and Voltage Parameters ........................................................... 898 External Reset Timing (RST) .............................................................................. 898 Software Reset Timing ....................................................................................... 898 Watchdog Reset Timing ..................................................................................... 899 MOSC Failure Reset Timing ............................................................................... 899 Hibernation Module Timing with Internal Oscillator Running in Hibernation ............ 903 Hibernation Module Timing with Internal Oscillator Stopped in Hibernation ............ 904 SDRAM Initialization and Load Mode Register Timing .......................................... 905 SDRAM Read Timing ......................................................................................... 906 SDRAM Write Timing ......................................................................................... 906 Host-Bus 8/16 Mode Read Timing ...................................................................... 907 Host-Bus 8/16 Mode Write Timing ....................................................................... 907 Host-Bus 8/16 Mode Muxed Read Timing ............................................................ 908 Host-Bus 8/16 Mode Muxed Write Timing ............................................................ 908 General-Purpose Mode Read and Write Timing ................................................... 909 General-Purpose Mode iRDY Timing .................................................................. 909 ADC Input Equivalency Diagram ......................................................................... 911 SSI Timing for TI Frame Format (FRF=01), Single Transfer Timing Measurement .................................................................................................... 912 12 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 21-24. Figure 21-25. Figure 21-26. Figure C-1. Figure C-2. Figure C-3. Figure C-4. Figure C-5. Figure C-6. SSI Timing for MICROWIRE Frame Format (FRF=10), Single Transfer ................. 912 SSI Timing for SPI Frame Format (FRF=00), with SPH=1 ..................................... 913 I2C Timing ......................................................................................................... 914 Stellaris LM3S1G21 100-Pin LQFP Package Dimensions ..................................... 946 100-Pin LQFP Tray Dimensions .......................................................................... 948 100-Pin LQFP Tape and Reel Dimensions ........................................................... 949 Stellaris LM3S1G21 108-Ball BGA Package Dimensions ...................................... 950 108-Ball BGA Tray Dimensions ........................................................................... 952 108-Ball BGA Tape and Reel Dimensions ............................................................ 953 January 22, 2012 13 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents List of Tables Table 1. Table 2. Table 2-1. Table 2-2. Table 2-3. Table 2-4. Table 2-5. Table 2-6. Table 2-7. Table 2-8. Table 2-9. Table 2-10. Table 2-11. Table 2-12. Table 2-13. Table 3-1. Table 3-2. Table 3-3. Table 3-4. Table 3-5. Table 3-6. Table 3-7. Table 3-8. Table 3-9. Table 4-1. Table 4-2. Table 4-3. Table 4-4. Table 5-1. Table 5-2. Table 5-3. Table 5-4. Table 5-5. Table 5-6. Table 5-7. Table 5-8. Table 5-9. Table 6-1. Table 6-2. Table 6-3. Table 6-4. Table 7-1. Table 7-2. Table 7-3. Table 8-1. Table 8-2. Revision History .................................................................................................. 28 Documentation Conventions ................................................................................ 32 Summary of Processor Mode, Privilege Level, and Stack Use ................................ 58 Processor Register Map ....................................................................................... 59 PSR Register Combinations ................................................................................. 64 Memory Map ....................................................................................................... 72 Memory Access Behavior ..................................................................................... 75 SRAM Memory Bit-Banding Regions .................................................................... 77 Peripheral Memory Bit-Banding Regions ............................................................... 77 Exception Types .................................................................................................. 83 Interrupts ............................................................................................................ 83 Exception Return Behavior ................................................................................... 88 Faults ................................................................................................................. 89 Fault Status and Fault Address Registers .............................................................. 90 Cortex-M3 Instruction Summary ........................................................................... 92 Core Peripheral Register Regions ......................................................................... 95 Memory Attributes Summary ................................................................................ 98 TEX, S, C, and B Bit Field Encoding ................................................................... 101 Cache Policy for Memory Attribute Encoding ....................................................... 102 AP Bit Field Encoding ........................................................................................ 102 Memory Region Attributes for Stellaris Microcontrollers ........................................ 102 Peripherals Register Map ................................................................................... 103 Interrupt Priority Levels ...................................................................................... 130 Example SIZE Field Values ................................................................................ 158 JTAG_SWD_SWO Signals (100LQFP) ................................................................ 162 JTAG_SWD_SWO Signals (108BGA) ................................................................. 163 JTAG Port Pins State after Power-On Reset or RST assertion .............................. 164 JTAG Instruction Register Commands ................................................................. 169 System Control & Clocks Signals (100LQFP) ...................................................... 173 System Control & Clocks Signals (108BGA) ........................................................ 173 Reset Sources ................................................................................................... 174 Clock Source Options ........................................................................................ 181 Possible System Clock Frequencies Using the SYSDIV Field ............................... 184 Examples of Possible System Clock Frequencies Using the SYSDIV2 Field .......... 184 Examples of Possible System Clock Frequencies with DIV400=1 ......................... 185 System Control Register Map ............................................................................. 189 RCC2 Fields that Override RCC Fields ............................................................... 210 Hibernate Signals (100LQFP) ............................................................................. 268 Hibernate Signals (108BGA) .............................................................................. 269 Hibernation Module Clock Operation ................................................................... 275 Hibernation Module Register Map ....................................................................... 277 Flash Memory Protection Policy Combinations .................................................... 298 User-Programmable Flash Memory Resident Registers ....................................... 302 Flash Register Map ............................................................................................ 302 μDMA Channel Assignments .............................................................................. 341 Request Type Support ....................................................................................... 343 14 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 8-3. Table 8-4. Table 8-5. Table 8-6. Table 8-7. Table 8-8. Table 8-9. Table 8-10. Table 8-11. Table 8-12. Table 8-13. Table 9-1. Table 9-2. Table 9-3. Table 9-4. Table 9-5. Table 9-6. Table 9-7. Table 9-8. Table 9-9. Table 9-10. Table 9-11. Table 9-12. Table 10-1. Table 10-2. Table 10-3. Table 10-4. Table 10-5. Table 10-6. Table 10-7. Table 10-8. Table 11-1. Table 11-2. Table 11-3. Table 11-4. Table 11-5. Table 11-6. Table 11-7. Table 11-8. Table 11-9. Table 11-10. Table 11-11. Table 12-1. Table 13-1. Table 13-2. Table 13-3. Table 13-4. Control Structure Memory Map ........................................................................... 344 Channel Control Structure .................................................................................. 344 μDMA Read Example: 8-Bit Peripheral ................................................................ 353 μDMA Interrupt Assignments .............................................................................. 354 Channel Control Structure Offsets for Channel 30 ................................................ 355 Channel Control Word Configuration for Memory Transfer Example ...................... 355 Channel Control Structure Offsets for Channel 7 .................................................. 356 Channel Control Word Configuration for Peripheral Transmit Example .................. 357 Primary and Alternate Channel Control Structure Offsets for Channel 8 ................. 358 Channel Control Word Configuration for Peripheral Ping-Pong Receive Example ............................................................................................................ 359 μDMA Register Map .......................................................................................... 361 GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values .............................................................. 400 GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions (100LQFP) ................................................... 400 GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions (108BGA) ..................................................... 402 GPIO Pad Configuration Examples ..................................................................... 408 GPIO Interrupt Configuration Example ................................................................ 409 GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values .............................................................. 410 GPIO Register Map ........................................................................................... 410 GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values .............................................................. 423 GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values .............................................................. 429 GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values .............................................................. 431 GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values .............................................................. 434 GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values .............................................................. 441 External Peripheral Interface Signals (100LQFP) ................................................. 457 External Peripheral Interface Signals (108BGA) ................................................... 458 EPI SDRAM Signal Connections ......................................................................... 463 Capabilities of Host Bus 8 and Host Bus 16 Modes .............................................. 467 EPI Host-Bus 8 Signal Connections .................................................................... 468 EPI Host-Bus 16 Signal Connections .................................................................. 470 EPI General Purpose Signal Connections ........................................................... 479 External Peripheral Interface (EPI) Register Map ................................................. 485 Available CCP Pins ............................................................................................ 531 General-Purpose Timers Signals (100LQFP) ....................................................... 532 General-Purpose Timers Signals (108BGA) ......................................................... 533 General-Purpose Timer Capabilities .................................................................... 534 Counter Values When the Timer is Enabled in Periodic or One-Shot Modes .......... 535 16-Bit Timer With Prescaler Configurations ......................................................... 536 Counter Values When the Timer is Enabled in RTC Mode .................................... 537 Counter Values When the Timer is Enabled in Input Edge-Count Mode ................. 538 Counter Values When the Timer is Enabled in Input Event-Count Mode ................ 539 Counter Values When the Timer is Enabled in PWM Mode ................................... 540 Timers Register Map .......................................................................................... 545 Watchdog Timers Register Map .......................................................................... 580 ADC Signals (100LQFP) .................................................................................... 603 ADC Signals (108BGA) ...................................................................................... 604 Samples and FIFO Depth of Sequencers ............................................................ 605 Differential Sampling Pairs ................................................................................. 612 January 22, 2012 15 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents Table 13-5. Table 14-1. Table 14-2. Table 14-3. Table 14-4. Table 15-1. Table 15-2. Table 15-3. Table 16-1. Table 16-2. Table 16-3. Table 16-4. Table 16-5. Table 17-1. Table 17-2. Table 17-3. Table 17-4. Table 19-1. Table 19-2. Table 19-3. Table 19-4. Table 19-5. Table 19-6. Table 19-7. Table 19-8. Table 19-9. Table 19-10. Table 19-11. Table 19-12. Table 19-13. Table 20-1. Table 20-2. Table 20-3. Table 21-1. Table 21-2. Table 21-3. Table 21-4. Table 21-5. Table 21-6. Table 21-7. Table 21-8. Table 21-9. Table 21-10. Table 21-11. Table 21-12. Table 21-13. Table 21-14. Table 21-15. ADC Register Map ............................................................................................. 620 UART Signals (100LQFP) .................................................................................. 680 UART Signals (108BGA) .................................................................................... 680 Flow Control Mode ............................................................................................. 685 UART Register Map ........................................................................................... 691 SSI Signals (100LQFP) ...................................................................................... 744 SSI Signals (108BGA) ........................................................................................ 744 SSI Register Map .............................................................................................. 755 I2C Signals (100LQFP) ...................................................................................... 785 I2C Signals (108BGA) ........................................................................................ 785 Examples of I2C Master Timer Period versus Speed Mode ................................... 789 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface Register Map ............................................. 799 Write Field Decoding for I2CMCS[3:0] Field ......................................................... 805 Analog Comparators Signals (100LQFP) ............................................................. 823 Analog Comparators Signals (108BGA) .............................................................. 823 Internal Reference Voltage and ACREFCTL Field Values ..................................... 825 Analog Comparators Register Map ..................................................................... 827 GPIO Pins With Default Alternate Functions ........................................................ 837 Signals by Pin Number ....................................................................................... 838 Signals by Signal Name ..................................................................................... 846 Signals by Function, Except for GPIO ................................................................. 853 GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions ..................................................................... 859 Possible Pin Assignments for Alternate Functions ................................................ 862 Signals by Pin Number ....................................................................................... 864 Signals by Signal Name ..................................................................................... 872 Signals by Function, Except for GPIO ................................................................. 880 GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions ..................................................................... 886 Possible Pin Assignments for Alternate Functions ................................................ 889 Connections for Unused Signals (100-Pin LQFP) ................................................. 891 Connections for Unused Signals (108-Ball BGA) .................................................. 891 Temperature Characteristics ............................................................................... 893 Thermal Characteristics ..................................................................................... 893 ESD Absolute Maximum Ratings ........................................................................ 893 Maximum Ratings .............................................................................................. 894 Recommended DC Operating Conditions ............................................................ 894 JTAG Characteristics ......................................................................................... 895 Power Characteristics ........................................................................................ 897 Reset Characteristics ......................................................................................... 898 LDO Regulator Characteristics ........................................................................... 899 Phase Locked Loop (PLL) Characteristics ........................................................... 899 Actual PLL Frequency ........................................................................................ 900 PIOSC Clock Characteristics .............................................................................. 900 30-kHz Clock Characteristics .............................................................................. 900 Hibernation Clock Characteristics ....................................................................... 901 HIB Oscillator Input Characteristics ..................................................................... 901 Main Oscillator Clock Characteristics .................................................................. 901 Supported MOSC Crystal Frequencies ................................................................ 901 System Clock Characteristics with ADC Operation ............................................... 902 16 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 21-16. Table 21-17. Table 21-18. Table 21-19. Table 21-20. Table 21-21. Table 21-22. Table 21-23. Table 21-24. Table 21-25. Table 21-26. Table 21-27. Table 21-28. Table 21-29. Table 21-30. Table 21-31. Table 21-32. Table 21-33. Table 21-34. Table B-1. Sleep Modes AC Characteristics ......................................................................... 902 Hibernation Module Battery Characteristics ......................................................... 903 Hibernation Module AC Characteristics ............................................................... 903 Flash Memory Characteristics ............................................................................ 904 GPIO Module Characteristics ............................................................................. 904 EPI SDRAM Characteristics ............................................................................... 905 EPI SDRAM Interface Characteristics ................................................................. 905 EPI Host-Bus 8 and Host-Bus 16 Interface Characteristics ................................... 906 EPI General-Purpose Interface Characteristics .................................................... 908 ADC Characteristics ........................................................................................... 910 ADC Module External Reference Characteristics ................................................. 911 ADC Module Internal Reference Characteristics .................................................. 911 SSI Characteristics ............................................................................................ 911 I2C Characteristics ............................................................................................. 913 Analog Comparator Characteristics ..................................................................... 914 Analog Comparator Voltage Reference Characteristics ........................................ 914 Nominal Power Consumption ............................................................................. 914 Detailed Current Specifications ........................................................................... 915 Hibernation Detailed Current Specifications ......................................................... 916 Part Ordering Information ................................................................................... 944 January 22, 2012 17 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents List of Registers The Cortex-M3 Processor ............................................................................................................. 53 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Cortex General-Purpose Register 0 (R0) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 1 (R1) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 2 (R2) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 3 (R3) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 4 (R4) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 5 (R5) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 6 (R6) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 7 (R7) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 8 (R8) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 9 (R9) ........................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 10 (R10) ....................................................................... 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 11 (R11) ........................................................................ 60 Cortex General-Purpose Register 12 (R12) ....................................................................... 60 Stack Pointer (SP) ........................................................................................................... 61 Link Register (LR) ............................................................................................................ 62 Program Counter (PC) ..................................................................................................... 63 Program Status Register (PSR) ........................................................................................ 64 Priority Mask Register (PRIMASK) .................................................................................... 68 Fault Mask Register (FAULTMASK) .................................................................................. 69 Base Priority Mask Register (BASEPRI) ............................................................................ 70 Control Register (CONTROL) ........................................................................................... 71 Cortex-M3 Peripherals ................................................................................................................... 95 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: SysTick Control and Status Register (STCTRL), offset 0x010 ........................................... 106 SysTick Reload Value Register (STRELOAD), offset 0x014 .............................................. 108 SysTick Current Value Register (STCURRENT), offset 0x018 ........................................... 109 Interrupt 0-31 Set Enable (EN0), offset 0x100 .................................................................. 110 Interrupt 32-54 Set Enable (EN1), offset 0x104 ................................................................ 111 Interrupt 0-31 Clear Enable (DIS0), offset 0x180 .............................................................. 112 Interrupt 32-54 Clear Enable (DIS1), offset 0x184 ............................................................ 113 Interrupt 0-31 Set Pending (PEND0), offset 0x200 ........................................................... 114 Interrupt 32-54 Set Pending (PEND1), offset 0x204 ......................................................... 115 Interrupt 0-31 Clear Pending (UNPEND0), offset 0x280 ................................................... 116 Interrupt 32-54 Clear Pending (UNPEND1), offset 0x284 .................................................. 117 Interrupt 0-31 Active Bit (ACTIVE0), offset 0x300 ............................................................. 118 Interrupt 32-54 Active Bit (ACTIVE1), offset 0x304 ........................................................... 119 Interrupt 0-3 Priority (PRI0), offset 0x400 ......................................................................... 120 Interrupt 4-7 Priority (PRI1), offset 0x404 ......................................................................... 120 Interrupt 8-11 Priority (PRI2), offset 0x408 ....................................................................... 120 Interrupt 12-15 Priority (PRI3), offset 0x40C .................................................................... 120 Interrupt 16-19 Priority (PRI4), offset 0x410 ..................................................................... 120 Interrupt 20-23 Priority (PRI5), offset 0x414 ..................................................................... 120 Interrupt 24-27 Priority (PRI6), offset 0x418 ..................................................................... 120 Interrupt 28-31 Priority (PRI7), offset 0x41C .................................................................... 120 Interrupt 32-35 Priority (PRI8), offset 0x420 ..................................................................... 120 18 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 31: Register 32: Register 33: Register 34: Register 35: Register 36: Register 37: Register 38: Register 39: Register 40: Register 41: Register 42: Register 43: Register 44: Register 45: Register 46: Register 47: Register 48: Register 49: Register 50: Register 51: Register 52: Register 53: Register 54: Interrupt 36-39 Priority (PRI9), offset 0x424 ..................................................................... 120 Interrupt 40-43 Priority (PRI10), offset 0x428 ................................................................... 120 Interrupt 44-47 Priority (PRI11), offset 0x42C ................................................................... 120 Interrupt 48-51 Priority (PRI12), offset 0x430 ................................................................... 120 Interrupt 52-54 Priority (PRI13), offset 0x434 ................................................................... 120 Software Trigger Interrupt (SWTRIG), offset 0xF00 .......................................................... 122 Auxiliary Control (ACTLR), offset 0x008 .......................................................................... 123 CPU ID Base (CPUID), offset 0xD00 ............................................................................... 125 Interrupt Control and State (INTCTRL), offset 0xD04 ........................................................ 126 Vector Table Offset (VTABLE), offset 0xD08 .................................................................... 129 Application Interrupt and Reset Control (APINT), offset 0xD0C ......................................... 130 System Control (SYSCTRL), offset 0xD10 ....................................................................... 132 Configuration and Control (CFGCTRL), offset 0xD14 ....................................................... 134 System Handler Priority 1 (SYSPRI1), offset 0xD18 ......................................................... 136 System Handler Priority 2 (SYSPRI2), offset 0xD1C ........................................................ 137 System Handler Priority 3 (SYSPRI3), offset 0xD20 ......................................................... 138 System Handler Control and State (SYSHNDCTRL), offset 0xD24 .................................... 139 Configurable Fault Status (FAULTSTAT), offset 0xD28 ..................................................... 143 Hard Fault Status (HFAULTSTAT), offset 0xD2C .............................................................. 149 Memory Management Fault Address (MMADDR), offset 0xD34 ........................................ 150 Bus Fault Address (FAULTADDR), offset 0xD38 .............................................................. 151 MPU Type (MPUTYPE), offset 0xD90 ............................................................................. 152 MPU Control (MPUCTRL), offset 0xD94 .......................................................................... 153 MPU Region Number (MPUNUMBER), offset 0xD98 ....................................................... 155 MPU Region Base Address (MPUBASE), offset 0xD9C ................................................... 156 MPU Region Base Address Alias 1 (MPUBASE1), offset 0xDA4 ....................................... 156 MPU Region Base Address Alias 2 (MPUBASE2), offset 0xDAC ...................................... 156 MPU Region Base Address Alias 3 (MPUBASE3), offset 0xDB4 ....................................... 156 MPU Region Attribute and Size (MPUATTR), offset 0xDA0 ............................................... 158 MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 1 (MPUATTR1), offset 0xDA8 .................................. 158 MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 2 (MPUATTR2), offset 0xDB0 .................................. 158 MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 3 (MPUATTR3), offset 0xDB8 .................................. 158 System Control ............................................................................................................................ 173 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Device Identification 0 (DID0), offset 0x000 ..................................................................... 192 Brown-Out Reset Control (PBORCTL), offset 0x030 ........................................................ 194 Raw Interrupt Status (RIS), offset 0x050 .......................................................................... 195 Interrupt Mask Control (IMC), offset 0x054 ...................................................................... 197 Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (MISC), offset 0x058 .................................................. 199 Reset Cause (RESC), offset 0x05C ................................................................................ 201 Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC), offset 0x060 ......................................................... 203 XTAL to PLL Translation (PLLCFG), offset 0x064 ............................................................. 207 GPIO High-Performance Bus Control (GPIOHBCTL), offset 0x06C ................................... 208 Run-Mode Clock Configuration 2 (RCC2), offset 0x070 .................................................... 210 Main Oscillator Control (MOSCCTL), offset 0x07C ........................................................... 213 Deep Sleep Clock Configuration (DSLPCLKCFG), offset 0x144 ........................................ 214 Precision Internal Oscillator Calibration (PIOSCCAL), offset 0x150 ................................... 216 Precision Internal Oscillator Statistics (PIOSCSTAT), offset 0x154 .................................... 218 Device Identification 1 (DID1), offset 0x004 ..................................................................... 219 January 22, 2012 19 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 31: Register 32: Register 33: Register 34: Register 35: Register 36: Register 37: Register 38: Device Capabilities 0 (DC0), offset 0x008 ........................................................................ 221 Device Capabilities 1 (DC1), offset 0x010 ........................................................................ 222 Device Capabilities 2 (DC2), offset 0x014 ........................................................................ 224 Device Capabilities 3 (DC3), offset 0x018 ........................................................................ 226 Device Capabilities 4 (DC4), offset 0x01C ....................................................................... 228 Device Capabilities 5 (DC5), offset 0x020 ........................................................................ 230 Device Capabilities 6 (DC6), offset 0x024 ........................................................................ 231 Device Capabilities 7 (DC7), offset 0x028 ........................................................................ 232 Device Capabilities 8 ADC Channels (DC8), offset 0x02C ................................................ 236 Device Capabilities 9 ADC Digital Comparators (DC9), offset 0x190 ................................. 237 Non-Volatile Memory Information (NVMSTAT), offset 0x1A0 ............................................. 238 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (RCGC0), offset 0x100 ................................... 239 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (SCGC0), offset 0x110 ................................. 241 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (DCGC0), offset 0x120 ....................... 243 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (RCGC1), offset 0x104 ................................... 245 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (SCGC1), offset 0x114 ................................. 248 Deep-Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (DCGC1), offset 0x124 ....................... 251 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (RCGC2), offset 0x108 ................................... 254 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (SCGC2), offset 0x118 ................................. 256 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (DCGC2), offset 0x128 ....................... 258 Software Reset Control 0 (SRCR0), offset 0x040 ............................................................. 260 Software Reset Control 1 (SRCR1), offset 0x044 ............................................................. 262 Software Reset Control 2 (SRCR2), offset 0x048 ............................................................. 265 Hibernation Module ..................................................................................................................... 267 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Hibernation RTC Counter (HIBRTCC), offset 0x000 ......................................................... Hibernation RTC Match 0 (HIBRTCM0), offset 0x004 ....................................................... Hibernation RTC Match 1 (HIBRTCM1), offset 0x008 ....................................................... Hibernation RTC Load (HIBRTCLD), offset 0x00C ........................................................... Hibernation Control (HIBCTL), offset 0x010 ..................................................................... Hibernation Interrupt Mask (HIBIM), offset 0x014 ............................................................. Hibernation Raw Interrupt Status (HIBRIS), offset 0x018 .................................................. Hibernation Masked Interrupt Status (HIBMIS), offset 0x01C ............................................ Hibernation Interrupt Clear (HIBIC), offset 0x020 ............................................................. Hibernation RTC Trim (HIBRTCT), offset 0x024 ............................................................... Hibernation Data (HIBDATA), offset 0x030-0x12C ............................................................ 278 279 280 281 282 285 287 289 291 292 293 Internal Memory ........................................................................................................................... 294 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Flash Memory Address (FMA), offset 0x000 .................................................................... 304 Flash Memory Data (FMD), offset 0x004 ......................................................................... 305 Flash Memory Control (FMC), offset 0x008 ..................................................................... 306 Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status (FCRIS), offset 0x00C ............................................ 309 Flash Controller Interrupt Mask (FCIM), offset 0x010 ........................................................ 310 Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (FCMISC), offset 0x014 ..................... 311 Flash Memory Control 2 (FMC2), offset 0x020 ................................................................. 312 Flash Write Buffer Valid (FWBVAL), offset 0x030 ............................................................. 313 Flash Control (FCTL), offset 0x0F8 ................................................................................. 314 Flash Write Buffer n (FWBn), offset 0x100 - 0x17C .......................................................... 315 ROM Control (RMCTL), offset 0x0F0 .............................................................................. 316 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 0 (FMPRE0), offset 0x130 and 0x200 ................... 317 20 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 31: Register 32: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 0 (FMPPE0), offset 0x134 and 0x400 ............... 318 Boot Configuration (BOOTCFG), offset 0x1D0 ................................................................. 319 User Register 0 (USER_REG0), offset 0x1E0 .................................................................. 321 User Register 1 (USER_REG1), offset 0x1E4 .................................................................. 322 User Register 2 (USER_REG2), offset 0x1E8 .................................................................. 323 User Register 3 (USER_REG3), offset 0x1EC ................................................................. 324 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 1 (FMPRE1), offset 0x204 .................................... 325 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 2 (FMPRE2), offset 0x208 .................................... 326 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 3 (FMPRE3), offset 0x20C ................................... 327 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 4 (FMPRE4), offset 0x210 .................................... 328 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 5 (FMPRE5), offset 0x214 .................................... 329 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 6 (FMPRE6), offset 0x218 .................................... 330 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 7 (FMPRE7), offset 0x21C ................................... 331 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 1 (FMPPE1), offset 0x404 ............................... 332 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 2 (FMPPE2), offset 0x408 ............................... 333 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 3 (FMPPE3), offset 0x40C ............................... 334 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 4 (FMPPE4), offset 0x410 ............................... 335 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 5 (FMPPE5), offset 0x414 ............................... 336 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 6 (FMPPE6), offset 0x418 ............................... 337 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 7 (FMPPE7), offset 0x41C ............................... 338 Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) ........................................................................................ 339 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: DMA Channel Source Address End Pointer (DMASRCENDP), offset 0x000 ...................... 363 DMA Channel Destination Address End Pointer (DMADSTENDP), offset 0x004 ................ 364 DMA Channel Control Word (DMACHCTL), offset 0x008 .................................................. 365 DMA Status (DMASTAT), offset 0x000 ............................................................................ 370 DMA Configuration (DMACFG), offset 0x004 ................................................................... 372 DMA Channel Control Base Pointer (DMACTLBASE), offset 0x008 .................................. 373 DMA Alternate Channel Control Base Pointer (DMAALTBASE), offset 0x00C .................... 374 DMA Channel Wait-on-Request Status (DMAWAITSTAT), offset 0x010 ............................. 375 DMA Channel Software Request (DMASWREQ), offset 0x014 ......................................... 376 DMA Channel Useburst Set (DMAUSEBURSTSET), offset 0x018 .................................... 377 DMA Channel Useburst Clear (DMAUSEBURSTCLR), offset 0x01C ................................. 378 DMA Channel Request Mask Set (DMAREQMASKSET), offset 0x020 .............................. 379 DMA Channel Request Mask Clear (DMAREQMASKCLR), offset 0x024 ........................... 380 DMA Channel Enable Set (DMAENASET), offset 0x028 ................................................... 381 DMA Channel Enable Clear (DMAENACLR), offset 0x02C ............................................... 382 DMA Channel Primary Alternate Set (DMAALTSET), offset 0x030 .................................... 383 DMA Channel Primary Alternate Clear (DMAALTCLR), offset 0x034 ................................. 384 DMA Channel Priority Set (DMAPRIOSET), offset 0x038 ................................................. 385 DMA Channel Priority Clear (DMAPRIOCLR), offset 0x03C .............................................. 386 DMA Bus Error Clear (DMAERRCLR), offset 0x04C ........................................................ 387 DMA Channel Assignment (DMACHASGN), offset 0x500 ................................................. 388 DMA Channel Interrupt Status (DMACHIS), offset 0x504 .................................................. 389 DMA Peripheral Identification 0 (DMAPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ......................................... 390 DMA Peripheral Identification 1 (DMAPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ......................................... 391 DMA Peripheral Identification 2 (DMAPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ......................................... 392 DMA Peripheral Identification 3 (DMAPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ........................................ 393 DMA Peripheral Identification 4 (DMAPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ......................................... 394 January 22, 2012 21 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 31: DMA PrimeCell Identification 0 (DMAPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 ........................................... DMA PrimeCell Identification 1 (DMAPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 ........................................... DMA PrimeCell Identification 2 (DMAPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 ........................................... DMA PrimeCell Identification 3 (DMAPCellID3), offset 0xFFC ........................................... 395 396 397 398 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) ................................................................................... 399 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 31: Register 32: Register 33: Register 34: GPIO Data (GPIODATA), offset 0x000 ............................................................................ 413 GPIO Direction (GPIODIR), offset 0x400 ......................................................................... 414 GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS), offset 0x404 .................................................................. 415 GPIO Interrupt Both Edges (GPIOIBE), offset 0x408 ........................................................ 416 GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV), offset 0x40C ................................................................ 417 GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM), offset 0x410 ................................................................... 418 GPIO Raw Interrupt Status (GPIORIS), offset 0x414 ........................................................ 419 GPIO Masked Interrupt Status (GPIOMIS), offset 0x418 ................................................... 420 GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR), offset 0x41C ................................................................ 422 GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL), offset 0x420 ............................................ 423 GPIO 2-mA Drive Select (GPIODR2R), offset 0x500 ........................................................ 425 GPIO 4-mA Drive Select (GPIODR4R), offset 0x504 ........................................................ 426 GPIO 8-mA Drive Select (GPIODR8R), offset 0x508 ........................................................ 427 GPIO Open Drain Select (GPIOODR), offset 0x50C ......................................................... 428 GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR), offset 0x510 ................................................................ 429 GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR), offset 0x514 ........................................................... 431 GPIO Slew Rate Control Select (GPIOSLR), offset 0x518 ................................................ 433 GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN), offset 0x51C ................................................................ 434 GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK), offset 0x520 ............................................................................ 436 GPIO Commit (GPIOCR), offset 0x524 ............................................................................ 437 GPIO Analog Mode Select (GPIOAMSEL), offset 0x528 ................................................... 439 GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL), offset 0x52C ................................................................. 441 GPIO Peripheral Identification 4 (GPIOPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ....................................... 443 GPIO Peripheral Identification 5 (GPIOPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 ....................................... 444 GPIO Peripheral Identification 6 (GPIOPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 ....................................... 445 GPIO Peripheral Identification 7 (GPIOPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC ...................................... 446 GPIO Peripheral Identification 0 (GPIOPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ....................................... 447 GPIO Peripheral Identification 1 (GPIOPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ....................................... 448 GPIO Peripheral Identification 2 (GPIOPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ....................................... 449 GPIO Peripheral Identification 3 (GPIOPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ...................................... 450 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 0 (GPIOPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 .......................................... 451 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 1 (GPIOPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 .......................................... 452 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 2 (GPIOPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 .......................................... 453 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 3 (GPIOPCellID3), offset 0xFFC ......................................... 454 External Peripheral Interface (EPI) ............................................................................................. 455 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: EPI Configuration (EPICFG), offset 0x000 ....................................................................... 487 EPI Main Baud Rate (EPIBAUD), offset 0x004 ................................................................. 488 EPI SDRAM Configuration (EPISDRAMCFG), offset 0x010 .............................................. 490 EPI Host-Bus 8 Configuration (EPIHB8CFG), offset 0x010 ............................................... 492 EPI Host-Bus 16 Configuration (EPIHB16CFG), offset 0x010 ........................................... 495 EPI General-Purpose Configuration (EPIGPCFG), offset 0x010 ........................................ 499 EPI Host-Bus 8 Configuration 2 (EPIHB8CFG2), offset 0x014 .......................................... 504 EPI Host-Bus 16 Configuration 2 (EPIHB16CFG2), offset 0x014 ....................................... 507 22 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: Register 30: Register 31: Register 32: EPI General-Purpose Configuration 2 (EPIGPCFG2), offset 0x014 ................................... EPI Address Map (EPIADDRMAP), offset 0x01C ............................................................. EPI Read Size 0 (EPIRSIZE0), offset 0x020 .................................................................... EPI Read Size 1 (EPIRSIZE1), offset 0x030 .................................................................... EPI Read Address 0 (EPIRADDR0), offset 0x024 ............................................................ EPI Read Address 1 (EPIRADDR1), offset 0x034 ............................................................ EPI Non-Blocking Read Data 0 (EPIRPSTD0), offset 0x028 ............................................. EPI Non-Blocking Read Data 1 (EPIRPSTD1), offset 0x038 ............................................. EPI Status (EPISTAT), offset 0x060 ................................................................................ EPI Read FIFO Count (EPIRFIFOCNT), offset 0x06C ...................................................... EPI Read FIFO (EPIREADFIFO), offset 0x070 ................................................................ EPI Read FIFO Alias 1 (EPIREADFIFO1), offset 0x074 .................................................... EPI Read FIFO Alias 2 (EPIREADFIFO2), offset 0x078 .................................................... EPI Read FIFO Alias 3 (EPIREADFIFO3), offset 0x07C ................................................... EPI Read FIFO Alias 4 (EPIREADFIFO4), offset 0x080 .................................................... EPI Read FIFO Alias 5 (EPIREADFIFO5), offset 0x084 .................................................... EPI Read FIFO Alias 6 (EPIREADFIFO6), offset 0x088 .................................................... EPI Read FIFO Alias 7 (EPIREADFIFO7), offset 0x08C ................................................... EPI FIFO Level Selects (EPIFIFOLVL), offset 0x200 ........................................................ EPI Write FIFO Count (EPIWFIFOCNT), offset 0x204 ...................................................... EPI Interrupt Mask (EPIIM), offset 0x210 ......................................................................... EPI Raw Interrupt Status (EPIRIS), offset 0x214 .............................................................. EPI Masked Interrupt Status (EPIMIS), offset 0x218 ........................................................ EPI Error and Interrupt Status and Clear (EPIEISC), offset 0x21C .................................... 510 511 513 513 514 514 515 515 517 519 520 520 520 520 520 520 520 520 521 523 524 525 527 528 General-Purpose Timers ............................................................................................................. 530 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: GPTM Configuration (GPTMCFG), offset 0x000 .............................................................. 547 GPTM Timer A Mode (GPTMTAMR), offset 0x004 ........................................................... 548 GPTM Timer B Mode (GPTMTBMR), offset 0x008 ........................................................... 550 GPTM Control (GPTMCTL), offset 0x00C ........................................................................ 552 GPTM Interrupt Mask (GPTMIMR), offset 0x018 .............................................................. 555 GPTM Raw Interrupt Status (GPTMRIS), offset 0x01C ..................................................... 557 GPTM Masked Interrupt Status (GPTMMIS), offset 0x020 ................................................ 560 GPTM Interrupt Clear (GPTMICR), offset 0x024 .............................................................. 563 GPTM Timer A Interval Load (GPTMTAILR), offset 0x028 ................................................ 565 GPTM Timer B Interval Load (GPTMTBILR), offset 0x02C ................................................ 566 GPTM Timer A Match (GPTMTAMATCHR), offset 0x030 .................................................. 567 GPTM Timer B Match (GPTMTBMATCHR), offset 0x034 ................................................. 568 GPTM Timer A Prescale (GPTMTAPR), offset 0x038 ....................................................... 569 GPTM Timer B Prescale (GPTMTBPR), offset 0x03C ...................................................... 570 GPTM TimerA Prescale Match (GPTMTAPMR), offset 0x040 ........................................... 571 GPTM TimerB Prescale Match (GPTMTBPMR), offset 0x044 ........................................... 572 GPTM Timer A (GPTMTAR), offset 0x048 ....................................................................... 573 GPTM Timer B (GPTMTBR), offset 0x04C ....................................................................... 574 GPTM Timer A Value (GPTMTAV), offset 0x050 ............................................................... 575 GPTM Timer B Value (GPTMTBV), offset 0x054 .............................................................. 576 Watchdog Timers ......................................................................................................................... 577 Register 1: Register 2: Watchdog Load (WDTLOAD), offset 0x000 ...................................................................... 581 Watchdog Value (WDTVALUE), offset 0x004 ................................................................... 582 January 22, 2012 23 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Watchdog Control (WDTCTL), offset 0x008 ..................................................................... 583 Watchdog Interrupt Clear (WDTICR), offset 0x00C .......................................................... 585 Watchdog Raw Interrupt Status (WDTRIS), offset 0x010 .................................................. 586 Watchdog Masked Interrupt Status (WDTMIS), offset 0x014 ............................................. 587 Watchdog Test (WDTTEST), offset 0x418 ....................................................................... 588 Watchdog Lock (WDTLOCK), offset 0xC00 ..................................................................... 589 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 4 (WDTPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ................................. 590 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 5 (WDTPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 ................................. 591 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 6 (WDTPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 ................................. 592 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 7 (WDTPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC ................................ 593 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 0 (WDTPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ................................. 594 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 1 (WDTPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ................................. 595 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 2 (WDTPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ................................. 596 Watchdog Peripheral Identification 3 (WDTPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ................................. 597 Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 0 (WDTPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 .................................... 598 Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 1 (WDTPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 .................................... 599 Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 2 (WDTPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 .................................... 600 Watchdog PrimeCell Identification 3 (WDTPCellID3 ), offset 0xFFC .................................. 601 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ............................................................................................. 602 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: ADC Active Sample Sequencer (ADCACTSS), offset 0x000 ............................................. 623 ADC Raw Interrupt Status (ADCRIS), offset 0x004 ........................................................... 624 ADC Interrupt Mask (ADCIM), offset 0x008 ..................................................................... 626 ADC Interrupt Status and Clear (ADCISC), offset 0x00C .................................................. 628 ADC Overflow Status (ADCOSTAT), offset 0x010 ............................................................ 631 ADC Event Multiplexer Select (ADCEMUX), offset 0x014 ................................................. 633 ADC Underflow Status (ADCUSTAT), offset 0x018 ........................................................... 637 ADC Sample Sequencer Priority (ADCSSPRI), offset 0x020 ............................................. 638 ADC Sample Phase Control (ADCSPC), offset 0x024 ...................................................... 640 ADC Processor Sample Sequence Initiate (ADCPSSI), offset 0x028 ................................. 641 ADC Sample Averaging Control (ADCSAC), offset 0x030 ................................................. 643 ADC Digital Comparator Interrupt Status and Clear (ADCDCISC), offset 0x034 ................. 644 ADC Control (ADCCTL), offset 0x038 ............................................................................. 646 ADC Sample Sequence Input Multiplexer Select 0 (ADCSSMUX0), offset 0x040 ............... 647 ADC Sample Sequence Control 0 (ADCSSCTL0), offset 0x044 ........................................ 649 ADC Sample Sequence Result FIFO 0 (ADCSSFIFO0), offset 0x048 ................................ 652 ADC Sample Sequence Result FIFO 1 (ADCSSFIFO1), offset 0x068 ................................ 652 ADC Sample Sequence Result FIFO 2 (ADCSSFIFO2), offset 0x088 ................................ 652 ADC Sample Sequence Result FIFO 3 (ADCSSFIFO3), offset 0x0A8 ............................... 652 ADC Sample Sequence FIFO 0 Status (ADCSSFSTAT0), offset 0x04C ............................. 653 ADC Sample Sequence FIFO 1 Status (ADCSSFSTAT1), offset 0x06C ............................. 653 ADC Sample Sequence FIFO 2 Status (ADCSSFSTAT2), offset 0x08C ............................ 653 ADC Sample Sequence FIFO 3 Status (ADCSSFSTAT3), offset 0x0AC ............................ 653 ADC Sample Sequence 0 Operation (ADCSSOP0), offset 0x050 ...................................... 655 ADC Sample Sequence 0 Digital Comparator Select (ADCSSDC0), offset 0x054 .............. 657 ADC Sample Sequence Input Multiplexer Select 1 (ADCSSMUX1), offset 0x060 ............... 659 ADC Sample Sequence Input Multiplexer Select 2 (ADCSSMUX2), offset 0x080 ............... 659 ADC Sample Sequence Control 1 (ADCSSCTL1), offset 0x064 ........................................ 660 ADC Sample Sequence Control 2 (ADCSSCTL2), offset 0x084 ........................................ 660 24 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 30: Register 31: Register 32: Register 33: Register 34: Register 35: Register 36: Register 37: Register 38: Register 39: Register 40: Register 41: Register 42: Register 43: Register 44: Register 45: Register 46: Register 47: Register 48: Register 49: Register 50: Register 51: Register 52: Register 53: Register 54: ADC Sample Sequence 1 Operation (ADCSSOP1), offset 0x070 ...................................... 662 ADC Sample Sequence 2 Operation (ADCSSOP2), offset 0x090 ..................................... 662 ADC Sample Sequence 1 Digital Comparator Select (ADCSSDC1), offset 0x074 .............. 663 ADC Sample Sequence 2 Digital Comparator Select (ADCSSDC2), offset 0x094 .............. 663 ADC Sample Sequence Input Multiplexer Select 3 (ADCSSMUX3), offset 0x0A0 ............... 665 ADC Sample Sequence Control 3 (ADCSSCTL3), offset 0x0A4 ........................................ 666 ADC Sample Sequence 3 Operation (ADCSSOP3), offset 0x0B0 ..................................... 667 ADC Sample Sequence 3 Digital Comparator Select (ADCSSDC3), offset 0x0B4 .............. 668 ADC Digital Comparator Reset Initial Conditions (ADCDCRIC), offset 0xD00 ..................... 669 ADC Digital Comparator Control 0 (ADCDCCTL0), offset 0xE00 ....................................... 674 ADC Digital Comparator Control 1 (ADCDCCTL1), offset 0xE04 ....................................... 674 ADC Digital Comparator Control 2 (ADCDCCTL2), offset 0xE08 ....................................... 674 ADC Digital Comparator Control 3 (ADCDCCTL3), offset 0xE0C ...................................... 674 ADC Digital Comparator Control 4 (ADCDCCTL4), offset 0xE10 ....................................... 674 ADC Digital Comparator Control 5 (ADCDCCTL5), offset 0xE14 ....................................... 674 ADC Digital Comparator Control 6 (ADCDCCTL6), offset 0xE18 ....................................... 674 ADC Digital Comparator Control 7 (ADCDCCTL7), offset 0xE1C ...................................... 674 ADC Digital Comparator Range 0 (ADCDCCMP0), offset 0xE40 ....................................... 676 ADC Digital Comparator Range 1 (ADCDCCMP1), offset 0xE44 ....................................... 676 ADC Digital Comparator Range 2 (ADCDCCMP2), offset 0xE48 ....................................... 676 ADC Digital Comparator Range 3 (ADCDCCMP3), offset 0xE4C ...................................... 676 ADC Digital Comparator Range 4 (ADCDCCMP4), offset 0xE50 ....................................... 676 ADC Digital Comparator Range 5 (ADCDCCMP5), offset 0xE54 ....................................... 676 ADC Digital Comparator Range 6 (ADCDCCMP6), offset 0xE58 ....................................... 676 ADC Digital Comparator Range 7 (ADCDCCMP7), offset 0xE5C ...................................... 676 Universal Asynchronous Receivers/Transmitters (UARTs) ..................................................... 678 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: UART Data (UARTDR), offset 0x000 ............................................................................... 693 UART Receive Status/Error Clear (UARTRSR/UARTECR), offset 0x004 ........................... 695 UART Flag (UARTFR), offset 0x018 ................................................................................ 698 UART IrDA Low-Power Register (UARTILPR), offset 0x020 ............................................. 701 UART Integer Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTIBRD), offset 0x024 ............................................ 702 UART Fractional Baud-Rate Divisor (UARTFBRD), offset 0x028 ....................................... 703 UART Line Control (UARTLCRH), offset 0x02C ............................................................... 704 UART Control (UARTCTL), offset 0x030 ......................................................................... 706 UART Interrupt FIFO Level Select (UARTIFLS), offset 0x034 ........................................... 710 UART Interrupt Mask (UARTIM), offset 0x038 ................................................................. 712 UART Raw Interrupt Status (UARTRIS), offset 0x03C ...................................................... 716 UART Masked Interrupt Status (UARTMIS), offset 0x040 ................................................. 720 UART Interrupt Clear (UARTICR), offset 0x044 ............................................................... 724 UART DMA Control (UARTDMACTL), offset 0x048 .......................................................... 726 UART LIN Control (UARTLCTL), offset 0x090 ................................................................. 727 UART LIN Snap Shot (UARTLSS), offset 0x094 ............................................................... 728 UART LIN Timer (UARTLTIM), offset 0x098 ..................................................................... 729 UART Peripheral Identification 4 (UARTPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ..................................... 730 UART Peripheral Identification 5 (UARTPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 ..................................... 731 UART Peripheral Identification 6 (UARTPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 ..................................... 732 UART Peripheral Identification 7 (UARTPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC ..................................... 733 UART Peripheral Identification 0 (UARTPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ...................................... 734 January 22, 2012 25 Texas Instruments-Production Data Table of Contents Register 23: Register 24: Register 25: Register 26: Register 27: Register 28: Register 29: UART Peripheral Identification 1 (UARTPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ...................................... UART Peripheral Identification 2 (UARTPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ...................................... UART Peripheral Identification 3 (UARTPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ..................................... UART PrimeCell Identification 0 (UARTPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 ........................................ UART PrimeCell Identification 1 (UARTPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 ........................................ UART PrimeCell Identification 2 (UARTPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 ........................................ UART PrimeCell Identification 3 (UARTPCellID3), offset 0xFFC ........................................ 735 736 737 738 739 740 741 Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) ............................................................................................ 742 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: Register 17: Register 18: Register 19: Register 20: Register 21: Register 22: SSI Control 0 (SSICR0), offset 0x000 .............................................................................. 757 SSI Control 1 (SSICR1), offset 0x004 .............................................................................. 759 SSI Data (SSIDR), offset 0x008 ...................................................................................... 761 SSI Status (SSISR), offset 0x00C ................................................................................... 762 SSI Clock Prescale (SSICPSR), offset 0x010 .................................................................. 764 SSI Interrupt Mask (SSIIM), offset 0x014 ......................................................................... 765 SSI Raw Interrupt Status (SSIRIS), offset 0x018 .............................................................. 766 SSI Masked Interrupt Status (SSIMIS), offset 0x01C ........................................................ 768 SSI Interrupt Clear (SSIICR), offset 0x020 ....................................................................... 770 SSI DMA Control (SSIDMACTL), offset 0x024 ................................................................. 771 SSI Peripheral Identification 4 (SSIPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 ............................................. 772 SSI Peripheral Identification 5 (SSIPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 ............................................. 773 SSI Peripheral Identification 6 (SSIPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 ............................................. 774 SSI Peripheral Identification 7 (SSIPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC ............................................ 775 SSI Peripheral Identification 0 (SSIPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 ............................................. 776 SSI Peripheral Identification 1 (SSIPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 ............................................. 777 SSI Peripheral Identification 2 (SSIPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 ............................................. 778 SSI Peripheral Identification 3 (SSIPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC ............................................ 779 SSI PrimeCell Identification 0 (SSIPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 ............................................... 780 SSI PrimeCell Identification 1 (SSIPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 ............................................... 781 SSI PrimeCell Identification 2 (SSIPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 ............................................... 782 SSI PrimeCell Identification 3 (SSIPCellID3), offset 0xFFC ............................................... 783 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface ........................................................................................ 784 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Register 9: Register 10: Register 11: Register 12: Register 13: Register 14: Register 15: Register 16: I2C Master Slave Address (I2CMSA), offset 0x000 ........................................................... 801 I2C Master Control/Status (I2CMCS), offset 0x004 ........................................................... 802 I2C Master Data (I2CMDR), offset 0x008 ......................................................................... 807 I2C Master Timer Period (I2CMTPR), offset 0x00C ........................................................... 808 I2C Master Interrupt Mask (I2CMIMR), offset 0x010 ......................................................... 809 I2C Master Raw Interrupt Status (I2CMRIS), offset 0x014 ................................................. 810 I2C Master Masked Interrupt Status (I2CMMIS), offset 0x018 ........................................... 811 I2C Master Interrupt Clear (I2CMICR), offset 0x01C ......................................................... 812 I2C Master Configuration (I2CMCR), offset 0x020 ............................................................ 813 I2C Slave Own Address (I2CSOAR), offset 0x800 ............................................................ 814 I2C Slave Control/Status (I2CSCSR), offset 0x804 ........................................................... 815 I2C Slave Data (I2CSDR), offset 0x808 ........................................................................... 817 I2C Slave Interrupt Mask (I2CSIMR), offset 0x80C ........................................................... 818 I2C Slave Raw Interrupt Status (I2CSRIS), offset 0x810 ................................................... 819 I2C Slave Masked Interrupt Status (I2CSMIS), offset 0x814 .............................................. 820 I2C Slave Interrupt Clear (I2CSICR), offset 0x818 ............................................................ 821 26 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Analog Comparators ................................................................................................................... 822 Register 1: Register 2: Register 3: Register 4: Register 5: Register 6: Register 7: Register 8: Analog Comparator Masked Interrupt Status (ACMIS), offset 0x000 .................................. Analog Comparator Raw Interrupt Status (ACRIS), offset 0x004 ....................................... Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable (ACINTEN), offset 0x008 ......................................... Analog Comparator Reference Voltage Control (ACREFCTL), offset 0x010 ....................... Analog Comparator Status 0 (ACSTAT0), offset 0x020 ..................................................... Analog Comparator Status 1 (ACSTAT1), offset 0x040 ..................................................... Analog Comparator Control 0 (ACCTL0), offset 0x024 ..................................................... Analog Comparator Control 1 (ACCTL1), offset 0x044 ..................................................... January 22, 2012 828 829 830 831 832 832 833 833 27 Texas Instruments-Production Data Revision History Revision History The revision history table notes changes made between the indicated revisions of the LM3S1G21 data sheet. Table 1. Revision History Date Revision January 2012 11425 Description ■ ■ In System Control chapter: – Clarified that an external LDO cannot be used. – Clarified system clock requirements when the ADC module is in operation. – Added important note to write the RCC register before the RCC2 register. In Hibernation chapter: – Changed terminology from non-volatile memory to battery-backed memory. – Numerous clarifications, including adding a section "System Implementation". – Clarified Hibernation module register reset conditions. ■ In Internal Memory chapter, clarified programming and use of the non-volatile registers. ■ In GPIO chapter, corrected "GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values" table and added note that if the same signal is assigned to two different GPIO port pins, the signal is assigned to the port with the lowest letter. ■ In EPI chapter: – Clarified table "Capabilities of Host Bus 8 and Host Bus 16 Modes". – Corrected bit and register resets for FREQ (Frequency Range) in EPI SDRAM Configuration (EPISDRAMCFG) register. – Corrected bit and register resets for MAXWAIT (Maximum Wait) in EPI Host-Bus 8 Configuration (EPIHB8CFG) and EPI Host-Bus 16 Configuration (EPIHB16CFG) registers. Also clarified bit descriptions in these registers. – Corrected bit definitions for the EPSZ and ERSZ bits in the EPI Address Map (EPIADDRMAP) register. – Corrected size of COUNT bit field in EPI Read FIFO Count (EPIRFIFOCNT) register. ■ In Timer chapter, clarified timer modes and interrupts. ■ In ADC chapter, added "ADC Input Equivalency Diagram". ■ In UART chapter, clarified interrupt behavior. ■ In SSI chapter, corrected SSIClk in the figure "Synchronous Serial Frame Format (Single Transfer)" and clarified behavior of transmit bits in interrupt registers. ■ In I2C chapter, corrected bit and register reset values for IDLE bit in I2C Master Control/Status (I2CMCS) register. ■ In Analog Comparators chapter, clarified internal reference programming. ■ In Signal Tables chapter, clarified VDDC and LDO pin descriptions. ■ In Electrical Characteristics chapter: 28 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 1. Revision History (continued) Date Revision Description ■ – In Maximum Ratings table, deleted parameter "Input voltage for a GPIO configured as an analog input". – In Recommended DC Operating Conditions table, corrected values for IOH parameter. – In JTAG Characteristics, table, corrected values for parameters "TCK clock Low time" and "TCK clock High time". – In LDO Regulator Characteristics table, added clarifying footnote to CLDO parameter. – In System Clock Characteristics with ADC Operation table, added clarifying footnote to Fsysadc parameter. – In Sleep Modes AC Characteristics table, split parameter "Time to wake from interrupt" into sleep mode and deep-sleep mode parameters. – In SSI Characteristics table, corrected value for parameter "SSIClk cycle time". – Deleted erroneously included Ethernet Controller tables, since this part does not have Ethernet. – In Analog Comparator Characteristics table, added parameter "Input voltage range" and corrected values for parameter "Input common mode voltage range". – In Analog Comparator Voltage Reference Characteristics table, corrected values for absolute accuracy parameters. – Deleted table "USB Controller DC Characteristics". – In Nominal Power Consumption table, added parameter for sleep mode. – In Maximum Current Consumption section, changed reference value for MOSC and temperature in tables that follow. – Deleted table "External VDDC Source Current Specifications". Additional minor data sheet clarifications and corrections. January 22, 2012 29 Texas Instruments-Production Data Revision History Table 1. Revision History (continued) Date Revision July 2011 9970 March 2011 9538 Description ■ Corrected "Reset Sources" table. ■ Added Important Note that RCC register must be written before RCC2 register. ■ Added missing Start Calibration (CAL) bit to the Precision Internal Oscillator Calibration (PIOSCCAL) register. ■ Added missing Precision Internal Oscillator Statistics (PIOSCSTAT) register. ■ In Hibernation Module chapter, deleted section "Special Considerations When Using a 4.194304-MHz Crystal" as this content was added to the errata document. ■ Added a note that all GPIO signals are 5-V tolerant when configured as inputs except for PB0 and PB1, which are limited to 3.6 V. ■ Corrected LIN Mode bit names in UART Interrupt Clear (UARTICR) register. ■ Corrected pin number for RST in table "Connections for Unused Signals" (other pin tables were correct). ■ In the "Operating Characteristics" chapter: – In the "Thermal Characteristics" table, the Thermal resistance value was changed. – In the "ESD Absolute Maximum Ratings" table, the VESDCDM parameter was changed and the VESDMM parameter was deleted. ■ The "Electrical Characteristics" chapter was reorganized by module. In addition, some of the Recommended DC Operating Conditions, LDO Regulator, Clock, GPIO, EPI, Hibernation Module, ADC, and SSI characteristics were finalized. ■ Additional minor data sheet clarifications and corrections. Started tracking revision history. 30 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller About This Document This data sheet provides reference information for the LM3S1G21 microcontroller, describing the functional blocks of the system-on-chip (SoC) device designed around the ARM® Cortex™-M3 core. Audience This manual is intended for system software developers, hardware designers, and application developers. About This Manual This document is organized into sections that correspond to each major feature. Related Documents ® The following related documents are available on the Stellaris web site at www.ti.com/stellaris: ■ Stellaris® Errata ■ ARM® Cortex™-M3 Errata ■ Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual ■ Stellaris® Boot Loader User's Guide ■ Stellaris® Graphics Library User's Guide ■ Stellaris® Peripheral Driver Library User's Guide ■ Stellaris® ROM User’s Guide The following related documents are also referenced: ■ ARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification ■ ARM® Embedded Trace Macrocell Architecture Specification ■ IEEE Standard 1149.1-Test Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture This documentation list was current as of publication date. Please check the web site for additional documentation, including application notes and white papers. January 22, 2012 31 Texas Instruments-Production Data About This Document Documentation Conventions This document uses the conventions shown in Table 2 on page 32. Table 2. Documentation Conventions Notation Meaning General Register Notation REGISTER APB registers are indicated in uppercase bold. For example, PBORCTL is the Power-On and Brown-Out Reset Control register. If a register name contains a lowercase n, it represents more than one register. For example, SRCRn represents any (or all) of the three Software Reset Control registers: SRCR0, SRCR1 , and SRCR2. bit A single bit in a register. bit field Two or more consecutive and related bits. offset 0xnnn A hexadecimal increment to a register's address, relative to that module's base address as specified in Table 2-4 on page 72. Register N Registers are numbered consecutively throughout the document to aid in referencing them. The register number has no meaning to software. reserved Register bits marked reserved are reserved for future use. In most cases, reserved bits are set to 0; however, user software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide software compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. yy:xx The range of register bits inclusive from xx to yy. For example, 31:15 means bits 15 through 31 in that register. Register Bit/Field Types This value in the register bit diagram indicates whether software running on the controller can change the value of the bit field. RC Software can read this field. The bit or field is cleared by hardware after reading the bit/field. RO Software can read this field. Always write the chip reset value. R/W Software can read or write this field. R/WC Software can read or write this field. Writing to it with any value clears the register. R/W1C Software can read or write this field. A write of a 0 to a W1C bit does not affect the bit value in the register. A write of a 1 clears the value of the bit in the register; the remaining bits remain unchanged. This register type is primarily used for clearing interrupt status bits where the read operation provides the interrupt status and the write of the read value clears only the interrupts being reported at the time the register was read. R/W1S Software can read or write a 1 to this field. A write of a 0 to a R/W1S bit does not affect the bit value in the register. W1C Software can write this field. A write of a 0 to a W1C bit does not affect the bit value in the register. A write of a 1 clears the value of the bit in the register; the remaining bits remain unchanged. A read of the register returns no meaningful data. This register is typically used to clear the corresponding bit in an interrupt register. WO Only a write by software is valid; a read of the register returns no meaningful data. Register Bit/Field Reset Value This value in the register bit diagram shows the bit/field value after any reset, unless noted. 0 Bit cleared to 0 on chip reset. 1 Bit set to 1 on chip reset. - Nondeterministic. Pin/Signal Notation [] Pin alternate function; a pin defaults to the signal without the brackets. pin Refers to the physical connection on the package. signal Refers to the electrical signal encoding of a pin. 32 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 2. Documentation Conventions (continued) Notation Meaning assert a signal Change the value of the signal from the logically False state to the logically True state. For active High signals, the asserted signal value is 1 (High); for active Low signals, the asserted signal value is 0 (Low). The active polarity (High or Low) is defined by the signal name (see SIGNAL and SIGNAL below). deassert a signal Change the value of the signal from the logically True state to the logically False state. SIGNAL Signal names are in uppercase and in the Courier font. An overbar on a signal name indicates that it is active Low. To assert SIGNAL is to drive it Low; to deassert SIGNAL is to drive it High. SIGNAL Signal names are in uppercase and in the Courier font. An active High signal has no overbar. To assert SIGNAL is to drive it High; to deassert SIGNAL is to drive it Low. Numbers X An uppercase X indicates any of several values is allowed, where X can be any legal pattern. For example, a binary value of 0X00 can be either 0100 or 0000, a hex value of 0xX is 0x0 or 0x1, and so on. 0x Hexadecimal numbers have a prefix of 0x. For example, 0x00FF is the hexadecimal number FF. All other numbers within register tables are assumed to be binary. Within conceptual information, binary numbers are indicated with a b suffix, for example, 1011b, and decimal numbers are written without a prefix or suffix. January 22, 2012 33 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview 1 Architectural Overview ® Texas Instruments is the industry leader in bringing 32-bit capabilities and the full benefits of ARM Cortex™-M-based microcontrollers to the broadest reach of the microcontroller market. For current ® users of 8- and 16-bit MCUs, Stellaris with Cortex-M offers a direct path to the strongest ecosystem of development tools, software and knowledge in the industry. Designers who migrate to Stellaris benefit from great tools, small code footprint and outstanding performance. Even more important, designers can enter the ARM ecosystem with full confidence in a compatible roadmap from $1 to 1 GHz. For users of current 32-bit MCUs, the Stellaris family offers the industry’s first implementation of Cortex-M3 and the Thumb-2 instruction set. With blazingly-fast responsiveness, Thumb-2 technology combines both 16-bit and 32-bit instructions to deliver the best balance of code density and performance. Thumb-2 uses 26 percent less memory than pure 32-bit code to reduce system cost while delivering 25 percent better performance. The Texas Instruments Stellaris family of microcontrollers—the first ARM Cortex-M3 based controllers— brings high-performance 32-bit computing to cost-sensitive embedded microcontroller applications. 1.1 Overview The Stellaris LM3S1G21 microcontroller combines complex integration and high performance with the following feature highlights: ■ ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core ■ High Performance: 80-MHz operation; 100 DMIPS performance ■ 384 KB single-cycle Flash memory ■ 64 KB single-cycle SRAM ® ■ Internal ROM loaded with StellarisWare software ■ External Peripheral Interface (EPI) ■ Advanced Communication Interfaces: UART, SSI, I2C ■ System Integration: general-purpose timers, watchdog timers, DMA, general-purpose I/Os ■ Analog support: analog and digital comparators, Analog-to-Digital Converters (ADC), on-chip voltage regulator ■ JTAG and ARM Serial Wire Debug (SWD) ■ 100-pin LQFP package ■ 108-ball BGA package ■ Industrial (-40°C to 85°C) temperature range Figure 1-1 on page 35 depicts the features on the Stellaris LM3S1G21 microcontroller. Note that there are two on-chip buses that connect the core to the peripherals. The Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB) bus is the legacy bus. The Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) bus provides better back-to-back access performance than the APB bus. 34 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 1-1. Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller High-Level Block Diagram JTAG/SWD ARM® Cortex™-M3 ROM (80MHz) System Control and Clocks (w/ Precis. Osc.) Flash (384KB) DCode bus NVIC Boot Loader DriverLib AES & CRC MPU ICode bus System Bus LM3S1G21 Bus Matrix SRAM (64KB) SYSTEM PERIPHERALS GeneralPurpose Timer (4) Hibernation Module External Peripheral Interface I2C (2) Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB) Watchdog Timer (2) Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) DMA GPIOs (67) SERIAL PERIPHERALS UART (3) SSI (2) ANALOG PERIPHERALS Analog Comparator (2) 12- Bit ADC Channels (8) January 22, 2012 35 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview For applications requiring extreme conservation of power, the LM3S1G21 microcontroller features a battery-backed Hibernation module to efficiently power down the LM3S1G21 to a low-power state during extended periods of inactivity. With a power-up/power-down sequencer, a continuous time counter (RTC), a pair of match registers, an APB interface to the system bus, and dedicated battery-backed memory, the Hibernation module positions the LM3S1G21 microcontroller perfectly for battery applications. In addition, the LM3S1G21 microcontroller offers the advantages of ARM's widely available development tools, System-on-Chip (SoC) infrastructure IP applications, and a large user community. Additionally, the microcontroller uses ARM's Thumb®-compatible Thumb-2 instruction set to reduce memory requirements and, thereby, cost. Finally, the LM3S1G21 microcontroller is code-compatible to all members of the extensive Stellaris family; providing flexibility to fit precise needs. Texas Instruments offers a complete solution to get to market quickly, with evaluation and development boards, white papers and application notes, an easy-to-use peripheral driver library, and a strong support, sales, and distributor network. 1.2 Target Applications The Stellaris family is positioned for cost-conscious applications requiring significant control processing and connectivity capabilities such as: ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ 1.3 Gaming equipment Home and commercial site monitoring and control Motion control Medical instrumentation Test and measurement equipment Factory automation Fire and security Lighting control Transportation Features The LM3S1G21 microcontroller component features and general function are discussed in more detail in the following section. 1.3.1 ARM Cortex-M3 Processor Core All members of the Stellaris product family, including the LM3S1G21 microcontroller, are designed around an ARM Cortex-M3 processor core. The ARM Cortex-M3 processor provides the core for a high-performance, low-cost platform that meets the needs of minimal memory implementation, reduced pin count, and low power consumption, while delivering outstanding computational performance and exceptional system response to interrupts. 1.3.1.1 Processor Core (see page 53) ■ 32-bit ARM Cortex-M3 architecture optimized for small-footprint embedded applications ■ 80-MHz operation; 100 DMIPS performance ■ Outstanding processing performance combined with fast interrupt handling 36 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller ■ Thumb-2 mixed 16-/32-bit instruction set delivers the high performance expected of a 32-bit ARM core in a compact memory size usually associated with 8- and 16-bit devices, typically in the range of a few kilobytes of memory for microcontroller-class applications – Single-cycle multiply instruction and hardware divide – Atomic bit manipulation (bit-banding), delivering maximum memory utilization and streamlined peripheral control – Unaligned data access, enabling data to be efficiently packed into memory ■ Fast code execution permits slower processor clock or increases sleep mode time ■ Harvard architecture characterized by separate buses for instruction and data ■ Efficient processor core, system and memories ■ Hardware division and fast digital-signal-processing orientated multiply accumulate ■ Saturating arithmetic for signal processing ■ Deterministic, high-performance interrupt handling for time-critical applications ■ Memory protection unit (MPU) to provide a privileged mode for protected operating system functionality ■ Enhanced system debug with extensive breakpoint and trace capabilities ■ Serial Wire Debug and Serial Wire Trace reduce the number of pins required for debugging and tracing ■ Migration from the ARM7 processor family for better performance and power efficiency ■ Optimized for single-cycle Flash memory usage ■ Ultra-low power consumption with integrated sleep modes 1.3.1.2 System Timer (SysTick) (see page 95) ARM Cortex-M3 includes an integrated system timer, SysTick. SysTick provides a simple, 24-bit, clear-on-write, decrementing, wrap-on-zero counter with a flexible control mechanism. The counter can be used in several different ways, for example: ■ An RTOS tick timer that fires at a programmable rate (for example, 100 Hz) and invokes a SysTick routine ■ A high-speed alarm timer using the system clock ■ A variable rate alarm or signal timer—the duration is range-dependent on the reference clock used and the dynamic range of the counter ■ A simple counter used to measure time to completion and time used ■ An internal clock-source control based on missing/meeting durations. January 22, 2012 37 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview 1.3.1.3 Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) (see page 96) The LM3S1G21 controller includes the ARM Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC). The NVIC and Cortex-M3 prioritize and handle all exceptions in Handler Mode. The processor state is automatically stored to the stack on an exception and automatically restored from the stack at the end of the Interrupt Service Routine (ISR). The interrupt vector is fetched in parallel to the state saving, enabling efficient interrupt entry. The processor supports tail-chaining, meaning that back-to-back interrupts can be performed without the overhead of state saving and restoration. Software can set eight priority levels on 7 exceptions (system handlers) and 37 interrupts. ■ Deterministic, fast interrupt processing: always 12 cycles, or just 6 cycles with tail-chaining ■ External non-maskable interrupt signal (NMI) available for immediate execution of NMI handler for safety critical applications ■ Dynamically reprioritizable interrupts ■ Exceptional interrupt handling via hardware implementation of required register manipulations 1.3.1.4 System Control Block (SCB) (see page 98) The SCB provides system implementation information and system control, including configuration, control, and reporting of system exceptions. 1.3.1.5 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) (see page 98) The MPU supports the standard ARM7 Protected Memory System Architecture (PMSA) model. The MPU provides full support for protection regions, overlapping protection regions, access permissions, and exporting memory attributes to the system. 1.3.2 On-Chip Memory The LM3S1G21 microcontroller is integrated with the following set of on-chip memory and features: ■ 64 KB single-cycle SRAM ■ 384 KB single-cycle Flash memory up to 50 MHz; a prefetch buffer improves performance above 50 MHz ■ Internal ROM loaded with StellarisWare software: – Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library – Stellaris Boot Loader – Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) cryptography tables – Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) error detection functionality 1.3.2.1 SRAM (see page 295) The LM3S1G21 microcontroller provides 64 KB of single-cycle on-chip SRAM. The internal SRAM of the Stellaris devices is located at offset 0x2000.0000 of the device memory map. Because read-modify-write (RMW) operations are very time consuming, ARM has introduced bit-banding technology in the Cortex-M3 processor. With a bit-band-enabled processor, certain regions in the memory map (SRAM and peripheral space) can use address aliases to access individual bits in a single, atomic operation. Data can be transferred to and from the SRAM using the Micro Direct Memory Access Controller (µDMA). 38 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 1.3.2.2 Flash Memory (see page 297) The LM3S1G21 microcontroller provides 384 KB of single-cycle on-chip Flash memory (above 50 MHz, the Flash memory can be accessed in a single cycle as long as the code is linear; branches incur a one-cycle stall). The Flash memory is organized as a set of 1-KB blocks that can be individually erased. Erasing a block causes the entire contents of the block to be reset to all 1s. These blocks are paired into a set of 2-KB blocks that can be individually protected. The blocks can be marked as read-only or execute-only, providing different levels of code protection. Read-only blocks cannot be erased or programmed, protecting the contents of those blocks from being modified. Execute-only blocks cannot be erased or programmed, and can only be read by the controller instruction fetch mechanism, protecting the contents of those blocks from being read by either the controller or by a debugger. 1.3.2.3 ROM (see page 295) The LM3S1G21 ROM is preprogrammed with the following software and programs: ■ Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library ■ Stellaris Boot Loader ■ Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) cryptography tables ■ Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) error-detection functionality The Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library is a royalty-free software library for controlling on-chip peripherals with a boot-loader capability. The library performs both peripheral initialization and control functions, with a choice of polled or interrupt-driven peripheral support. In addition, the library is designed to take full advantage of the stellar interrupt performance of the ARM Cortex-M3 core. No special pragmas or custom assembly code prologue/epilogue functions are required. For applications that require in-field programmability, the royalty-free Stellaris Boot Loader can act as an application loader and support in-field firmware updates. The Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) is a publicly defined encryption standard used by the U.S. Government. AES is a strong encryption method with reasonable performance and size. In addition, it is fast in both hardware and software, is fairly easy to implement, and requires little memory. The Texas Instruments encryption package is available with full source code, and is based on lesser general public license (LGPL) source. An LGPL means that the code can be used within an application without any copyleft implications for the application (the code does not automatically become open source). Modifications to the package source, however, must be open source. CRC (Cyclic Redundancy Check) is a technique to validate a span of data has the same contents as when previously checked. This technique can be used to validate correct receipt of messages (nothing lost or modified in transit), to validate data after decompression, to validate that Flash memory contents have not been changed, and for other cases where the data needs to be validated. A CRC is preferred over a simple checksum (e.g. XOR all bits) because it catches changes more readily. 1.3.3 External Peripheral Interface (see page 455) The External Peripheral Interface (EPI) provides access to external devices using a parallel path. Unlike communications peripherals such as SSI, UART, and I2C, the EPI is designed to act like a bus to external peripherals and memory. The EPI has the following features: January 22, 2012 39 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview ■ 8/16/32-bit dedicated parallel bus for external peripherals and memory ■ Memory interface supports contiguous memory access independent of data bus width, thus enabling code execution directly from SDRAM, SRAM and Flash memory ■ Blocking and non-blocking reads ■ Separates processor from timing details through use of an internal write FIFO ■ Efficient transfers using Micro Direct Memory Access Controller (µDMA) – Separate channels for read and write – Read channel request asserted by programmable levels on the internal non-blocking read FIFO (NBRFIFO) – Write channel request asserted by empty on the internal write FIFO (WFIFO) The EPI supports three primary functional modes: Synchronous Dynamic Random Access Memory (SDRAM) mode, Traditional Host-Bus mode, and General-Purpose mode. The EPI module also provides custom GPIOs; however, unlike regular GPIOs, the EPI module uses a FIFO in the same way as a communication mechanism and is speed-controlled using clocking. ■ Synchronous Dynamic Random Access Memory (SDRAM) mode – Supports x16 (single data rate) SDRAM at up to 50 MHz – Supports low-cost SDRAMs up to 64 MB (512 megabits) – Includes automatic refresh and access to all banks/rows – Includes a Sleep/Standby mode to keep contents active with minimal power draw – Multiplexed address/data interface for reduced pin count ■ Host-Bus mode – Traditional x8 and x16 MCU bus interface capabilities – Similar device compatibility options as PIC, ATmega, 8051, and others – Access to SRAM, NOR Flash memory, and other devices, with up to 1 MB of addressing in unmultiplexed mode and 256 MB in multiplexed mode (512 MB in Host-Bus 16 mode with no byte selects) – Support of both muxed and de-muxed address and data – Access to a range of devices supporting the non-address FIFO x8 and x16 interface variant, with support for external FIFO (XFIFO) EMPTY and FULL signals – Speed controlled, with read and write data wait-state counters – Chip select modes include ALE, CSn, Dual CSn and ALE with dual CSn – Manual chip-enable (or use extra address pins) 40 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller ■ General-Purpose mode – Wide parallel interfaces for fast communications with CPLDs and FPGAs – Data widths up to 32 bits – Data rates up to 150 MB/second – Optional "address" sizes from 4 bits to 20 bits – Optional clock output, read/write strobes, framing (with counter-based size), and clock-enable input ■ General parallel GPIO – 1 to 32 bits, FIFOed with speed control – Useful for custom peripherals or for digital data acquisition and actuator controls 1.3.4 Serial Communications Peripherals The LM3S1G21 controller supports both asynchronous and synchronous serial communications with: ■ Three UARTs with IrDA and ISO 7816 support (one UART with modem flow control and status) ■ Two I2C modules ■ Two Synchronous Serial Interface modules (SSI) The following sections provide more detail on each of these communications functions. 1.3.4.1 UART (see page 678) A Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) is an integrated circuit used for RS-232C serial communications, containing a transmitter (parallel-to-serial converter) and a receiver (serial-to-parallel converter), each clocked separately. The LM3S1G21 microcontroller includes three fully programmable 16C550-type UARTs. Although the functionality is similar to a 16C550 UART, this UART design is not register compatible. The UART can generate individually masked interrupts from the Rx, Tx, modem flow control, modem status, and error conditions. The module generates a single combined interrupt when any of the interrupts are asserted and are unmasked. The three UARTs have the following features: ■ Programmable baud-rate generator allowing speeds up to 5 Mbps for regular speed (divide by 16) and 10 Mbps for high speed (divide by 8) ■ Separate 16x8 transmit (TX) and receive (RX) FIFOs to reduce CPU interrupt service loading ■ Programmable FIFO length, including 1-byte deep operation providing conventional double-buffered interface ■ FIFO trigger levels of 1/8, 1/4, 1/2, 3/4, and 7/8 ■ Standard asynchronous communication bits for start, stop, and parity January 22, 2012 41 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview ■ Line-break generation and detection ■ Fully programmable serial interface characteristics – 5, 6, 7, or 8 data bits – Even, odd, stick, or no-parity bit generation/detection – 1 or 2 stop bit generation ■ IrDA serial-IR (SIR) encoder/decoder providing – Programmable use of IrDA Serial Infrared (SIR) or UART input/output – Support of IrDA SIR encoder/decoder functions for data rates up to 115.2 Kbps half-duplex – Support of normal 3/16 and low-power (1.41-2.23 μs) bit durations – Programmable internal clock generator enabling division of reference clock by 1 to 256 for low-power mode bit duration ■ Support for communication with ISO 7816 smart cards ■ Full modem handshake support (on UART1) ■ LIN protocol support ■ Standard FIFO-level and End-of-Transmission interrupts ■ Efficient transfers using Micro Direct Memory Access Controller (µDMA) – Separate channels for transmit and receive – Receive single request asserted when data is in the FIFO; burst request asserted at programmed FIFO level – Transmit single request asserted when there is space in the FIFO; burst request asserted at programmed FIFO level 1.3.4.2 I2C (see page 784) The Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) bus provides bi-directional data transfer through a two-wire design (a serial data line SDA and a serial clock line SCL). The I2C bus interfaces to external I2C devices such as serial memory (RAMs and ROMs), networking devices, LCDs, tone generators, and so on. The I2C bus may also be used for system testing and diagnostic purposes in product development and manufacture. Each device on the I2C bus can be designated as either a master or a slave. Each I2C module supports both sending and receiving data as either a master or a slave and can operate simultaneously as both a master and a slave. Both the I2C master and slave can generate interrupts. The LM3S1G21 microcontroller includes two I2C modules with the following features: ■ Devices on the I2C bus can be designated as either a master or a slave – Supports both transmitting and receiving data as either a master or a slave 42 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller – Supports simultaneous master and slave operation ■ Four I2C modes – Master transmit – Master receive – Slave transmit – Slave receive ■ Two transmission speeds: Standard (100 Kbps) and Fast (400 Kbps) ■ Master and slave interrupt generation – Master generates interrupts when a transmit or receive operation completes (or aborts due to an error) – Slave generates interrupts when data has been transferred or requested by a master or when a START or STOP condition is detected ■ Master with arbitration and clock synchronization, multimaster support, and 7-bit addressing mode 1.3.4.3 SSI (see page 742) Synchronous Serial Interface (SSI) is a four-wire bi-directional communications interface that converts data between parallel and serial. The SSI module performs serial-to-parallel conversion on data received from a peripheral device, and parallel-to-serial conversion on data transmitted to a peripheral device. The SSI module can be configured as either a master or slave device. As a slave device, the SSI module can also be configured to disable its output, which allows a master device to be coupled with multiple slave devices. The TX and RX paths are buffered with separate internal FIFOs. The SSI module also includes a programmable bit rate clock divider and prescaler to generate the output serial clock derived from the SSI module's input clock. Bit rates are generated based on the input clock and the maximum bit rate is determined by the connected peripheral. The LM3S1G21 microcontroller includes two SSI modules with the following features: ■ Programmable interface operation for Freescale SPI, MICROWIRE, or Texas Instruments synchronous serial interfaces ■ Master or slave operation ■ Programmable clock bit rate and prescaler ■ Separate transmit and receive FIFOs, each 16 bits wide and 8 locations deep ■ Programmable data frame size from 4 to 16 bits ■ Internal loopback test mode for diagnostic/debug testing ■ Standard FIFO-based interrupts and End-of-Transmission interrupt ■ Efficient transfers using Micro Direct Memory Access Controller (µDMA) January 22, 2012 43 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview – Separate channels for transmit and receive – Receive single request asserted when data is in the FIFO; burst request asserted when FIFO contains 4 entries – Transmit single request asserted when there is space in the FIFO; burst request asserted when FIFO contains 4 entries 1.3.5 System Integration The LM3S1G21 microcontroller provides a variety of standard system functions integrated into the device, including: ■ Direct Memory Access Controller (DMA) ■ System control and clocks including on-chip precision 16-MHz oscillator ■ Four 32-bit timers (up to eight 16-bit) ■ Eight Capture Compare PWM (CCP) pins ■ Lower-power battery-backed Hibernation module ■ Real-Time Clock in Hibernation module ■ Two Watchdog Timers – One timer runs off the main oscillator – One timer runs off the precision internal oscillator ■ Up to 67 GPIOs, depending on configuration – Highly flexible pin muxing allows use as GPIO or one of several peripheral functions – Independently configurable to 2, 4 or 8 mA drive capability – Up to 4 GPIOs can have 18 mA drive capability The following sections provide more detail on each of these functions. 1.3.5.1 Direct Memory Access (see page 339) The LM3S1G21 microcontroller includes a Direct Memory Access (DMA) controller, known as micro-DMA (μDMA). The μDMA controller provides a way to offload data transfer tasks from the Cortex-M3 processor, allowing for more efficient use of the processor and the available bus bandwidth. The μDMA controller can perform transfers between memory and peripherals. It has dedicated channels for each supported on-chip module and can be programmed to automatically perform transfers between peripherals and memory as the peripheral is ready to transfer more data. The μDMA controller provides the following features: ® ■ ARM PrimeCell 32-channel configurable µDMA controller ■ Support for memory-to-memory, memory-to-peripheral, and peripheral-to-memory in multiple transfer modes – Basic for simple transfer scenarios – Ping-pong for continuous data flow – Scatter-gather for a programmable list of arbitrary transfers initiated from a single request 44 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller ■ Highly flexible and configurable channel operation – Independently configured and operated channels – Dedicated channels for supported on-chip modules – Primary and secondary channel assignments – One channel each for receive and transmit path for bidirectional modules – Dedicated channel for software-initiated transfers – Per-channel configurable priority scheme – Optional software-initiated requests for any channel ■ Two levels of priority ■ Design optimizations for improved bus access performance between µDMA controller and the processor core – µDMA controller access is subordinate to core access – RAM striping – Peripheral bus segmentation ■ Data sizes of 8, 16, and 32 bits ■ Transfer size is programmable in binary steps from 1 to 1024 ■ Source and destination address increment size of byte, half-word, word, or no increment ■ Maskable peripheral requests ■ Interrupt on transfer completion, with a separate interrupt per channel 1.3.5.2 System Control and Clocks (see page 173) System control determines the overall operation of the device. It provides information about the device, controls power-saving features, controls the clocking of the device and individual peripherals, and handles reset detection and reporting. ■ Device identification information: version, part number, SRAM size, Flash memory size, and so on ■ Power control – On-chip fixed Low Drop-Out (LDO) voltage regulator – Hibernation module handles the power-up/down 3.3 V sequencing and control for the core digital logic and analog circuits – Low-power options for microcontroller: Sleep and Deep-sleep modes with clock gating – Low-power options for on-chip modules: software controls shutdown of individual peripherals and memory January 22, 2012 45 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview – 3.3-V supply brown-out detection and reporting via interrupt or reset ■ Multiple clock sources for microcontroller system clock – Precision Oscillator (PIOSC): On-chip resource providing a 16 MHz ±1% frequency at room temperature • 16 MHz ±3% across temperature • Can be recalibrated with 7-bit trim resolution • Software power down control for low power modes – Main Oscillator (MOSC): A frequency-accurate clock source by one of two means: an external single-ended clock source is connected to the OSC0 input pin, or an external crystal is connected across the OSC0 input and OSC1 output pins. • External crystal used with or without on-chip PLL: select supported frequencies from 1 MHz to 16.384 MHz. • External oscillator: from DC to maximum device speed – Internal 30-kHz Oscillator: on chip resource providing a 30 kHz ± 50% frequency, used during power-saving modes – 32.768-kHz external oscillator for the Hibernation Module: eliminates need for additional crystal for main clock source ■ Flexible reset sources – Power-on reset (POR) – Reset pin assertion – Brown-out reset (BOR) detector alerts to system power drops – Software reset – Watchdog timer reset – MOSC failure 1.3.5.3 Programmable Timers (see page 530) Programmable timers can be used to count or time external events that drive the Timer input pins. Each GPTM block provides two 16-bit timers/counters that can be configured to operate independently as timers or event counters, or configured to operate as one 32-bit timer or one 32-bit Real-Time Clock (RTC). Timers can also be used to trigger analog-to-digital (ADC) conversions. The General-Purpose Timer Module (GPTM) contains four GPTM blocks with the following functional options: ■ Operating modes: – 16- or 32-bit programmable one-shot timer – 16- or 32-bit programmable periodic timer – 16-bit general-purpose timer with an 8-bit prescaler – 32-bit Real-Time Clock (RTC) when using an external 32.768-KHz clock as the input 46 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller – 16-bit input-edge count- or time-capture modes – 16-bit PWM mode with software-programmable output inversion of the PWM signal ■ Count up or down ■ Daisy chaining of timer modules to allow a single timer to initiate multiple timing events ■ ADC event trigger ■ User-enabled stalling when the microcontroller asserts CPU Halt flag during debug (excluding RTC mode) ■ Ability to determine the elapsed time between the assertion of the timer interrupt and entry into the interrupt service routine. ■ Efficient transfers using Micro Direct Memory Access Controller (µDMA) – Dedicated channel for each timer – Burst request generated on timer interrupt 1.3.5.4 CCP Pins (see page 538) Capture Compare PWM pins (CCP) can be used by the General-Purpose Timer Module to time/count external events using the CCP pin as an input. Alternatively, the GPTM can generate a simple PWM output on the CCP pin. The LM3S1G21 microcontroller includes eight Capture Compare PWM pins (CCP) that can be programmed to operate in the following modes: ■ Capture: The GP Timer is incremented/decremented by programmed events on the CCP input. The GP Timer captures and stores the current timer value when a programmed event occurs. ■ Compare: The GP Timer is incremented/decremented by programmed events on the CCP input. The GP Timer compares the current value with a stored value and generates an interrupt when a match occurs. ■ PWM: The GP Timer is incremented/decremented by the system clock. A PWM signal is generated based on a match between the counter value and a value stored in a match register and is output on the CCP pin. 1.3.5.5 Hibernation Module (see page 267) The Hibernation module provides logic to switch power off to the main processor and peripherals and to wake on external or time-based events. The Hibernation module includes power-sequencing logic and has the following features: ■ 32-bit real-time counter (RTC) – Two 32-bit RTC match registers for timed wake-up and interrupt generation – RTC predivider trim for making fine adjustments to the clock rate ■ Two mechanisms for power control – System power control using discrete external regulator January 22, 2012 47 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview – On-chip power control using internal switches under register control ■ Dedicated pin for waking using an external signal ■ RTC operational and hibernation memory valid as long as VBAT is valid ■ Low-battery detection, signaling, and interrupt generation ■ Clock source from a 32.768-kHz external oscillator or a 4.194304-MHz crystal; 32.768-kHz external oscillator can be used for main controller clock ■ 64 32-bit words of battery-backed memory to save state during hibernation ■ Programmable interrupts for RTC match, external wake, and low battery events 1.3.5.6 Watchdog Timers (see page 577) A watchdog timer is used to regain control when a system has failed due to a software error or to the failure of an external device to respond in the expected way. The Stellaris Watchdog Timer can generate an interrupt or a reset when a time-out value is reached. In addition, the Watchdog Timer is ARM FiRM-compliant and can be configured to generate an interrupt to the microcontroller on its first time-out, and to generate a reset signal on its second time-out. Once the Watchdog Timer has been configured, the lock register can be written to prevent the timer configuration from being inadvertently altered. The LM3S1G21 microcontroller has two Watchdog Timer modules: Watchdog Timer 0 uses the system clock for its timer clock; Watchdog Timer 1 uses the PIOSC as its timer clock. The Stellaris Watchdog Timer module has the following features: ■ 32-bit down counter with a programmable load register ■ Separate watchdog clock with an enable ■ Programmable interrupt generation logic with interrupt masking ■ Lock register protection from runaway software ■ Reset generation logic with an enable/disable ■ User-enabled stalling when the microcontroller asserts the CPU Halt flag during debug 1.3.5.7 Programmable GPIOs (see page 399) General-purpose input/output (GPIO) pins offer flexibility for a variety of connections. The Stellaris GPIO module is comprised of nine physical GPIO blocks, each corresponding to an individual GPIO port. The GPIO module is FiRM-compliant (compliant to the ARM Foundation IP for Real-Time Microcontrollers specification) and supports 0-67 programmable input/output pins. The number of GPIOs available depends on the peripherals being used (see “Signal Tables” on page 837 for the signals available to each GPIO pin). ■ Up to 67 GPIOs, depending on configuration ■ Highly flexible pin muxing allows use as GPIO or one of several peripheral functions ■ 5-V-tolerant in input configuration 48 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller ■ Two means of port access: either Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) with better back-to-back access performance, or the legacy Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB) for backwards-compatibility with existing code ■ Fast toggle capable of a change every clock cycle for ports on AHB, every two clock cycles for ports on APB ■ Programmable control for GPIO interrupts – Interrupt generation masking – Edge-triggered on rising, falling, or both – Level-sensitive on High or Low values ■ Bit masking in both read and write operations through address lines ■ Can be used to initiate an ADC sample sequence ■ Pins configured as digital inputs are Schmitt-triggered ■ Programmable control for GPIO pad configuration – Weak pull-up or pull-down resistors – 2-mA, 4-mA, and 8-mA pad drive for digital communication; up to four pads can sink 18-mA for high-current applications – Slew rate control for the 8-mA drive – Open drain enables – Digital input enables 1.3.6 Analog The LM3S1G21 microcontroller provides analog functions integrated into the device, including: ■ 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) with eight analog input channels and a sample rate of one million samples/second ■ Two analog comparators ■ Eight digital comparators ■ On-chip voltage regulator The following provides more detail on these analog functions. 1.3.6.1 ADC (see page 602) An analog-to-digital converter (ADC) is a peripheral that converts a continuous analog voltage to a discrete digital number. The Stellaris ADC module features 12-bit conversion resolution and supports eight input channels plus an internal temperature sensor. Four buffered sample sequencers allow rapid sampling of up to eight analog input sources without controller intervention. Each sample sequencer provides flexible programming with fully configurable input source, trigger events, interrupt January 22, 2012 49 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview generation, and sequencer priority. The ADC module has a digital comparator function that allows the conversion value to be diverted to a comparison unit that provides eight digital comparators. The LM3S1G21 microcontroller provides one ADC module with the following features: ■ Eight analog input channels ■ 12-bit precision ADC with an accurate 10-bit data compatibility mode ■ Single-ended and differential-input configurations ■ On-chip internal temperature sensor ■ Maximum sample rate of one million samples/second ■ Optional phase shift in sample time programmable from 22.5º to 337.5º ■ Four programmable sample conversion sequencers from one to eight entries long, with corresponding conversion result FIFOs ■ Flexible trigger control – Controller (software) – Timers – Analog Comparators – GPIO ■ Hardware averaging of up to 64 samples ■ Digital comparison unit providing eight digital comparators ■ Converter uses an internal 3-V reference or an external reference ■ Power and ground for the analog circuitry is separate from the digital power and ground ■ Efficient transfers using Micro Direct Memory Access Controller (µDMA) – Dedicated channel for each sample sequencer – ADC module uses burst requests for DMA 1.3.6.2 Analog Comparators (see page 822) An analog comparator is a peripheral that compares two analog voltages and provides a logical output that signals the comparison result. The LM3S1G21 microcontroller provides two independent integrated analog comparators that can be configured to drive an output or generate an interrupt or ADC event. The comparator can provide its output to a device pin, acting as a replacement for an analog comparator on the board, or it can be used to signal the application via interrupts or triggers to the ADC to cause it to start capturing a sample sequence. The interrupt generation and ADC triggering logic is separate. This means, for example, that an interrupt can be generated on a rising edge and the ADC triggered on a falling edge. 50 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller The LM3S1G21 microcontroller provides two independent integrated analog comparators with the following functions: ■ Compare external pin input to external pin input or to internal programmable voltage reference ■ Compare a test voltage against any one of the following voltages: – An individual external reference voltage – A shared single external reference voltage – A shared internal reference voltage 1.3.7 JTAG and ARM Serial Wire Debug (see page 161) The Joint Test Action Group (JTAG) port is an IEEE standard that defines a Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture for digital integrated circuits and provides a standardized serial interface for controlling the associated test logic. The TAP, Instruction Register (IR), and Data Registers (DR) can be used to test the interconnections of assembled printed circuit boards and obtain manufacturing information on the components. The JTAG Port also provides a means of accessing and controlling design-for-test features such as I/O pin observation and control, scan testing, and debugging. Texas Instruments replaces the ARM SW-DP and JTAG-DP with the ARM Serial Wire JTAG Debug Port (SWJ-DP) interface. The SWJ-DP interface combines the SWD and JTAG debug ports into one module providing all the normal JTAG debug and test functionality plus real-time access to system memory without halting the core or requiring any target resident code. The SWJ-DP interface has the following features: ■ IEEE 1149.1-1990 compatible Test Access Port (TAP) controller ■ Four-bit Instruction Register (IR) chain for storing JTAG instructions ■ IEEE standard instructions: BYPASS, IDCODE, SAMPLE/PRELOAD, EXTEST and INTEST ■ ARM additional instructions: APACC, DPACC and ABORT ■ Integrated ARM Serial Wire Debug (SWD) – Serial Wire JTAG Debug Port (SWJ-DP) – Flash Patch and Breakpoint (FPB) unit for implementing breakpoints – Data Watchpoint and Trace (DWT) unit for implementing watchpoints, trigger resources, and system profiling – Instrumentation Trace Macrocell (ITM) for support of printf style debugging – Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) for bridging to a Trace Port Analyzer 1.3.8 Packaging and Temperature ■ Industrial-range (-40°C to 85°C) 100-pin RoHS-compliant LQFP package ■ Industrial-range (-40°C to 85°C) 108-ball RoHS-compliant BGA package January 22, 2012 51 Texas Instruments-Production Data Architectural Overview 1.4 Hardware Details Details on the pins and package can be found in the following sections: ■ “Pin Diagram” on page 835 ■ “Signal Tables” on page 837 ■ “Operating Characteristics” on page 893 ■ “Electrical Characteristics” on page 894 ■ “Package Information” on page 946 52 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 2 The Cortex-M3 Processor The ARM® Cortex™-M3 processor provides a high-performance, low-cost platform that meets the system requirements of minimal memory implementation, reduced pin count, and low power consumption, while delivering outstanding computational performance and exceptional system response to interrupts. Features include: ® ■ 32-bit ARM Cortex™-M3 architecture optimized for small-footprint embedded applications ■ 80-MHz operation; 100 DMIPS performance ■ Outstanding processing performance combined with fast interrupt handling ■ Thumb-2 mixed 16-/32-bit instruction set delivers the high performance expected of a 32-bit ARM core in a compact memory size usually associated with 8- and 16-bit devices, typically in the range of a few kilobytes of memory for microcontroller-class applications – Single-cycle multiply instruction and hardware divide – Atomic bit manipulation (bit-banding), delivering maximum memory utilization and streamlined peripheral control – Unaligned data access, enabling data to be efficiently packed into memory ■ Fast code execution permits slower processor clock or increases sleep mode time ■ Harvard architecture characterized by separate buses for instruction and data ■ Efficient processor core, system and memories ■ Hardware division and fast digital-signal-processing orientated multiply accumulate ■ Saturating arithmetic for signal processing ■ Deterministic, high-performance interrupt handling for time-critical applications ■ Memory protection unit (MPU) to provide a privileged mode for protected operating system functionality ■ Enhanced system debug with extensive breakpoint and trace capabilities ■ Serial Wire Debug and Serial Wire Trace reduce the number of pins required for debugging and tracing ■ Migration from the ARM7 processor family for better performance and power efficiency ■ Optimized for single-cycle Flash memory usage ■ Ultra-low power consumption with integrated sleep modes ® The Stellaris family of microcontrollers builds on this core to bring high-performance 32-bit computing to cost-sensitive embedded microcontroller applications, such as factory automation and control, industrial control power devices, building and home automation, and stepper motor control. January 22, 2012 53 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor This chapter provides information on the Stellaris implementation of the Cortex-M3 processor, including the programming model, the memory model, the exception model, fault handling, and power management. For technical details on the instruction set, see the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual. 2.1 Block Diagram The Cortex-M3 processor is built on a high-performance processor core, with a 3-stage pipeline Harvard architecture, making it ideal for demanding embedded applications. The processor delivers exceptional power efficiency through an efficient instruction set and extensively optimized design, providing high-end processing hardware including a range of single-cycle and SIMD multiplication and multiply-with-accumulate capabilities, saturating arithmetic and dedicated hardware division. To facilitate the design of cost-sensitive devices, the Cortex-M3 processor implements tightly coupled system components that reduce processor area while significantly improving interrupt handling and system debug capabilities. The Cortex-M3 processor implements a version of the Thumb® instruction set based on Thumb-2 technology, ensuring high code density and reduced program memory requirements. The Cortex-M3 instruction set provides the exceptional performance expected of a modern 32-bit architecture, with the high code density of 8-bit and 16-bit microcontrollers. The Cortex-M3 processor closely integrates a nested interrupt controller (NVIC), to deliver industry-leading interrupt performance. The Stellaris NVIC includes a non-maskable interrupt (NMI) and provides eight interrupt priority levels. The tight integration of the processor core and NVIC provides fast execution of interrupt service routines (ISRs), dramatically reducing interrupt latency. The hardware stacking of registers and the ability to suspend load-multiple and store-multiple operations further reduce interrupt latency. Interrupt handlers do not require any assembler stubs which removes code overhead from the ISRs. Tail-chaining optimization also significantly reduces the overhead when switching from one ISR to another. To optimize low-power designs, the NVIC integrates with the sleep modes, including Deep-sleep mode, which enables the entire device to be rapidly powered down. 54 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 2-1. CPU Block Diagram Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller Interrupts Sleep ARM Cortex-M3 CM3 Core Debug Instructions Data Trace Port Interface Unit Memory Protection Unit Flash Patch and Breakpoint Instrumentation Data Watchpoint Trace Macrocell and Trace ROM Table Private Peripheral Bus (internal) Adv. Peripheral Bus Bus Matrix Serial Wire JTAG Debug Port Debug Access Port 2.2 Overview 2.2.1 System-Level Interface Serial Wire Output Trace Port (SWO) I-code bus D-code bus System bus The Cortex-M3 processor provides multiple interfaces using AMBA® technology to provide high-speed, low-latency memory accesses. The core supports unaligned data accesses and implements atomic bit manipulation that enables faster peripheral controls, system spinlocks, and thread-safe Boolean data handling. The Cortex-M3 processor has a memory protection unit (MPU) that provides fine-grain memory control, enabling applications to implement security privilege levels and separate code, data and stack on a task-by-task basis. 2.2.2 Integrated Configurable Debug The Cortex-M3 processor implements a complete hardware debug solution, providing high system visibility of the processor and memory through either a traditional JTAG port or a 2-pin Serial Wire Debug (SWD) port that is ideal for microcontrollers and other small package devices. The Stellaris implementation replaces the ARM SW-DP and JTAG-DP with the ARM CoreSight™-compliant Serial Wire JTAG Debug Port (SWJ-DP) interface. The SWJ-DP interface combines the SWD and JTAG debug ports into one module. See the ARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification for details on SWJ-DP. For system trace, the processor integrates an Instrumentation Trace Macrocell (ITM) alongside data watchpoints and a profiling unit. To enable simple and cost-effective profiling of the system trace events, a Serial Wire Viewer (SWV) can export a stream of software-generated messages, data trace, and profiling information through a single pin. January 22, 2012 55 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor The Flash Patch and Breakpoint Unit (FPB) provides up to eight hardware breakpoint comparators that debuggers can use. The comparators in the FPB also provide remap functions of up to eight words in the program code in the CODE memory region. This enables applications stored in a read-only area of Flash memory to be patched in another area of on-chip SRAM or Flash memory. If a patch is required, the application programs the FPB to remap a number of addresses. When those addresses are accessed, the accesses are redirected to a remap table specified in the FPB configuration. For more information on the Cortex-M3 debug capabilities, see theARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification. 2.2.3 Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) The TPIU acts as a bridge between the Cortex-M3 trace data from the ITM, and an off-chip Trace Port Analyzer, as shown in Figure 2-2 on page 56. Figure 2-2. TPIU Block Diagram 2.2.4 Debug ATB Slave Port ATB Interface APB Slave Port APB Interface Asynchronous FIFO Trace Out (serializer) Serial Wire Trace Port (SWO) Cortex-M3 System Component Details The Cortex-M3 includes the following system components: ■ SysTick A 24-bit count-down timer that can be used as a Real-Time Operating System (RTOS) tick timer or as a simple counter (see “System Timer (SysTick)” on page 95). ■ Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) An embedded interrupt controller that supports low latency interrupt processing (see “Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC)” on page 96). ■ System Control Block (SCB) 56 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller The programming model interface to the processor. The SCB provides system implementation information and system control, including configuration, control, and reporting of system exceptions (see “System Control Block (SCB)” on page 98). ■ Memory Protection Unit (MPU) Improves system reliability by defining the memory attributes for different memory regions. The MPU provides up to eight different regions and an optional predefined background region (see “Memory Protection Unit (MPU)” on page 98). 2.3 Programming Model This section describes the Cortex-M3 programming model. In addition to the individual core register descriptions, information about the processor modes and privilege levels for software execution and stacks is included. 2.3.1 Processor Mode and Privilege Levels for Software Execution The Cortex-M3 has two modes of operation: ■ Thread mode Used to execute application software. The processor enters Thread mode when it comes out of reset. ■ Handler mode Used to handle exceptions. When the processor has finished exception processing, it returns to Thread mode. In addition, the Cortex-M3 has two privilege levels: ■ Unprivileged In this mode, software has the following restrictions: – Limited access to the MSR and MRS instructions and no use of the CPS instruction – No access to the system timer, NVIC, or system control block – Possibly restricted access to memory or peripherals ■ Privileged In this mode, software can use all the instructions and has access to all resources. In Thread mode, the CONTROL register (see page 71) controls whether software execution is privileged or unprivileged. In Handler mode, software execution is always privileged. Only privileged software can write to the CONTROL register to change the privilege level for software execution in Thread mode. Unprivileged software can use the SVC instruction to make a supervisor call to transfer control to privileged software. 2.3.2 Stacks The processor uses a full descending stack, meaning that the stack pointer indicates the last stacked item on the memory. When the processor pushes a new item onto the stack, it decrements the stack pointer and then writes the item to the new memory location. The processor implements two stacks: January 22, 2012 57 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor the main stack and the process stack, with a pointer for each held in independent registers (see the SP register on page 61). In Thread mode, the CONTROL register (see page 71) controls whether the processor uses the main stack or the process stack. In Handler mode, the processor always uses the main stack. The options for processor operations are shown in Table 2-1 on page 58. Table 2-1. Summary of Processor Mode, Privilege Level, and Stack Use Processor Mode Use Privilege Level Thread Applications Privileged or unprivileged Stack Used Handler Exception handlers Always privileged a Main stack or process stack a Main stack a. See CONTROL (page 71). 2.3.3 Register Map Figure 2-3 on page 58 shows the Cortex-M3 register set. Table 2-2 on page 59 lists the Core registers. The core registers are not memory mapped and are accessed by register name, so the base address is n/a (not applicable) and there is no offset. Figure 2-3. Cortex-M3 Register Set R0 R1 R2 Low registers R3 R4 R5 R6 General-purpose registers R7 R8 R9 High registers R10 R11 R12 Stack Pointer SP (R13) Link Register LR (R14) Program Counter PC (R15) PSR PSP‡ MSP‡ ‡ Banked version of SP Program status register PRIMASK FAULTMASK Exception mask registers Special registers BASEPRI CONTROL CONTROL register 58 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 2-2. Processor Register Map Offset Type Reset - R0 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 0 60 - R1 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 1 60 - R2 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 2 60 - R3 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 3 60 - R4 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 4 60 - R5 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 5 60 - R6 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 6 60 - R7 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 7 60 - R8 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 8 60 - R9 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 9 60 - R10 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 10 60 - R11 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 11 60 - R12 R/W - Cortex General-Purpose Register 12 60 - SP R/W - Stack Pointer 61 - LR R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Link Register 62 - PC R/W - Program Counter 63 - PSR R/W 0x0100.0000 Program Status Register 64 - PRIMASK R/W 0x0000.0000 Priority Mask Register 68 - FAULTMASK R/W 0x0000.0000 Fault Mask Register 69 - BASEPRI R/W 0x0000.0000 Base Priority Mask Register 70 - CONTROL R/W 0x0000.0000 Control Register 71 2.3.4 Description See page Name Register Descriptions This section lists and describes the Cortex-M3 registers, in the order shown in Figure 2-3 on page 58. The core registers are not memory mapped and are accessed by register name rather than offset. Note: The register type shown in the register descriptions refers to type during program execution in Thread mode and Handler mode. Debug access can differ. January 22, 2012 59 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Register 1: Cortex General-Purpose Register 0 (R0) Register 2: Cortex General-Purpose Register 1 (R1) Register 3: Cortex General-Purpose Register 2 (R2) Register 4: Cortex General-Purpose Register 3 (R3) Register 5: Cortex General-Purpose Register 4 (R4) Register 6: Cortex General-Purpose Register 5 (R5) Register 7: Cortex General-Purpose Register 6 (R6) Register 8: Cortex General-Purpose Register 7 (R7) Register 9: Cortex General-Purpose Register 8 (R8) Register 10: Cortex General-Purpose Register 9 (R9) Register 11: Cortex General-Purpose Register 10 (R10) Register 12: Cortex General-Purpose Register 11 (R11) Register 13: Cortex General-Purpose Register 12 (R12) The Rn registers are 32-bit general-purpose registers for data operations and can be accessed from either privileged or unprivileged mode. Cortex General-Purpose Register 0 (R0) Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - DATA Type Reset DATA Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 DATA R/W - Description Register data. 60 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 14: Stack Pointer (SP) The Stack Pointer (SP) is register R13. In Thread mode, the function of this register changes depending on the ASP bit in the Control Register (CONTROL) register. When the ASP bit is clear, this register is the Main Stack Pointer (MSP). When the ASP bit is set, this register is the Process Stack Pointer (PSP). On reset, the ASP bit is clear, and the processor loads the MSP with the value from address 0x0000.0000. The MSP can only be accessed in privileged mode; the PSP can be accessed in either privileged or unprivileged mode. Stack Pointer (SP) Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - SP Type Reset SP Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 SP R/W - Description This field is the address of the stack pointer. January 22, 2012 61 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Register 15: Link Register (LR) The Link Register (LR) is register R14, and it stores the return information for subroutines, function calls, and exceptions. LR can be accessed from either privileged or unprivileged mode. EXC_RETURN is loaded into LR on exception entry. See Table 2-10 on page 88 for the values and description. Link Register (LR) Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 LINK Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 LINK Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 LINK R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 Description 0xFFFF.FFFF This field is the return address. 62 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 16: Program Counter (PC) The Program Counter (PC) is register R15, and it contains the current program address. On reset, the processor loads the PC with the value of the reset vector, which is at address 0x0000.0004. Bit 0 of the reset vector is loaded into the THUMB bit of the EPSR at reset and must be 1. The PC register can be accessed in either privileged or unprivileged mode. Program Counter (PC) Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - PC Type Reset PC Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 PC R/W - Description This field is the current program address. January 22, 2012 63 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Register 17: Program Status Register (PSR) Note: This register is also referred to as xPSR. The Program Status Register (PSR) has three functions, and the register bits are assigned to the different functions: ■ Application Program Status Register (APSR), bits 31:27, ■ Execution Program Status Register (EPSR), bits 26:24, 15:10 ■ Interrupt Program Status Register (IPSR), bits 6:0 The PSR, IPSR, and EPSR registers can only be accessed in privileged mode; the APSR register can be accessed in either privileged or unprivileged mode. APSR contains the current state of the condition flags from previous instruction executions. EPSR contains the Thumb state bit and the execution state bits for the If-Then (IT) instruction or the Interruptible-Continuable Instruction (ICI) field for an interrupted load multiple or store multiple instruction. Attempts to read the EPSR directly through application software using the MSR instruction always return zero. Attempts to write the EPSR using the MSR instruction in application software are always ignored. Fault handlers can examine the EPSR value in the stacked PSR to determine the operation that faulted (see “Exception Entry and Return” on page 86). IPSR contains the exception type number of the current Interrupt Service Routine (ISR). These registers can be accessed individually or as a combination of any two or all three registers, using the register name as an argument to the MSR or MRS instructions. For example, all of the registers can be read using PSR with the MRS instruction, or APSR only can be written to using APSR with the MSR instruction. page 64 shows the possible register combinations for the PSR. See the MRS and MSR instruction descriptions in the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual for more information about how to access the program status registers. Table 2-3. PSR Register Combinations Register Type PSR R/W Combination APSR, EPSR, and IPSR IEPSR RO EPSR and IPSR a, b a APSR and IPSR b APSR and EPSR IAPSR R/W EAPSR R/W a. The processor ignores writes to the IPSR bits. b. Reads of the EPSR bits return zero, and the processor ignores writes to these bits. Program Status Register (PSR) Type R/W, reset 0x0100.0000 Type Reset 31 30 29 28 27 N Z C V Q 26 25 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 ICI / IT ICI / IT Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 24 23 22 21 20 THUMB RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved ISRNUM RO 0 RO 0 64 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31 N R/W 0 Description APSR Negative or Less Flag Value Description 1 The previous operation result was negative or less than. 0 The previous operation result was positive, zero, greater than, or equal. The value of this bit is only meaningful when accessing PSR or APSR. 30 Z R/W 0 APSR Zero Flag Value Description 1 The previous operation result was zero. 0 The previous operation result was non-zero. The value of this bit is only meaningful when accessing PSR or APSR. 29 C R/W 0 APSR Carry or Borrow Flag Value Description 1 The previous add operation resulted in a carry bit or the previous subtract operation did not result in a borrow bit. 0 The previous add operation did not result in a carry bit or the previous subtract operation resulted in a borrow bit. The value of this bit is only meaningful when accessing PSR or APSR. 28 V R/W 0 APSR Overflow Flag Value Description 1 The previous operation resulted in an overflow. 0 The previous operation did not result in an overflow. The value of this bit is only meaningful when accessing PSR or APSR. 27 Q R/W 0 APSR DSP Overflow and Saturation Flag Value Description 1 DSP Overflow or saturation has occurred. 0 DSP overflow or saturation has not occurred since reset or since the bit was last cleared. The value of this bit is only meaningful when accessing PSR or APSR. This bit is cleared by software using an MRS instruction. January 22, 2012 65 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Bit/Field Name Type Reset 26:25 ICI / IT RO 0x0 Description EPSR ICI / IT status These bits, along with bits 15:10, contain the Interruptible-Continuable Instruction (ICI) field for an interrupted load multiple or store multiple instruction or the execution state bits of the IT instruction. When EPSR holds the ICI execution state, bits 26:25 are zero. The If-Then block contains up to four instructions following an IT instruction. Each instruction in the block is conditional. The conditions for the instructions are either all the same, or some can be the inverse of others. See the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual for more information. The value of this field is only meaningful when accessing PSR or EPSR. 24 THUMB RO 1 EPSR Thumb State This bit indicates the Thumb state and should always be set. The following can clear the THUMB bit: ■ The BLX, BX and POP{PC} instructions ■ Restoration from the stacked xPSR value on an exception return ■ Bit 0 of the vector value on an exception entry or reset Attempting to execute instructions when this bit is clear results in a fault or lockup. See “Lockup” on page 90 for more information. The value of this bit is only meaningful when accessing PSR or EPSR. 23:16 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 15:10 ICI / IT RO 0x0 EPSR ICI / IT status These bits, along with bits 26:25, contain the Interruptible-Continuable Instruction (ICI) field for an interrupted load multiple or store multiple instruction or the execution state bits of the IT instruction. When an interrupt occurs during the execution of an LDM, STM, PUSH or POP instruction, the processor stops the load multiple or store multiple instruction operation temporarily and stores the next register operand in the multiple operation to bits 15:12. After servicing the interrupt, the processor returns to the register pointed to by bits 15:12 and resumes execution of the multiple load or store instruction. When EPSR holds the ICI execution state, bits 11:10 are zero. The If-Then block contains up to four instructions following a 16-bit IT instruction. Each instruction in the block is conditional. The conditions for the instructions are either all the same, or some can be the inverse of others. See the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual for more information. The value of this field is only meaningful when accessing PSR or EPSR. 9:7 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 66 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 6:0 ISRNUM RO 0x00 IPSR ISR Number This field contains the exception type number of the current Interrupt Service Routine (ISR). Value Description 0x00 Thread mode 0x01 Reserved 0x02 NMI 0x03 Hard fault 0x04 Memory management fault 0x05 Bus fault 0x06 Usage fault 0x07-0x0A Reserved 0x0B SVCall 0x0C Reserved for Debug 0x0D Reserved 0x0E PendSV 0x0F SysTick 0x10 Interrupt Vector 0 0x11 Interrupt Vector 1 ... ... 0x46 Interrupt Vector 54 0x47-0x7F Reserved See “Exception Types” on page 81 for more information. The value of this field is only meaningful when accessing PSR or IPSR. January 22, 2012 67 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Register 18: Priority Mask Register (PRIMASK) The PRIMASK register prevents activation of all exceptions with programmable priority. Reset, non-maskable interrupt (NMI), and hard fault are the only exceptions with fixed priority. Exceptions should be disabled when they might impact the timing of critical tasks. This register is only accessible in privileged mode. The MSR and MRS instructions are used to access the PRIMASK register, and the CPS instruction may be used to change the value of the PRIMASK register. See the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual for more information on these instructions. For more information on exception priority levels, see “Exception Types” on page 81. Priority Mask Register (PRIMASK) Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:1 reserved RO 0x0000.000 0 PRIMASK R/W 0 RO 0 PRIMASK R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Priority Mask Value Description 1 Prevents the activation of all exceptions with configurable priority. 0 No effect. 68 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 19: Fault Mask Register (FAULTMASK) The FAULTMASK register prevents activation of all exceptions except for the Non-Maskable Interrupt (NMI). Exceptions should be disabled when they might impact the timing of critical tasks. This register is only accessible in privileged mode. The MSR and MRS instructions are used to access the FAULTMASK register, and the CPS instruction may be used to change the value of the FAULTMASK register. See the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual for more information on these instructions. For more information on exception priority levels, see “Exception Types” on page 81. Fault Mask Register (FAULTMASK) Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:1 reserved RO 0x0000.000 0 FAULTMASK R/W 0 RO 0 FAULTMASK R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Fault Mask Value Description 1 Prevents the activation of all exceptions except for NMI. 0 No effect. The processor clears the FAULTMASK bit on exit from any exception handler except the NMI handler. January 22, 2012 69 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Register 20: Base Priority Mask Register (BASEPRI) The BASEPRI register defines the minimum priority for exception processing. When BASEPRI is set to a nonzero value, it prevents the activation of all exceptions with the same or lower priority level as the BASEPRI value. Exceptions should be disabled when they might impact the timing of critical tasks. This register is only accessible in privileged mode. For more information on exception priority levels, see “Exception Types” on page 81. Base Priority Mask Register (BASEPRI) Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset BASEPRI RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:5 BASEPRI R/W 0x0 R/W 0 reserved RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Base Priority Any exception that has a programmable priority level with the same or lower priority as the value of this field is masked. The PRIMASK register can be used to mask all exceptions with programmable priority levels. Higher priority exceptions have lower priority levels. Value Description 4:0 reserved RO 0x0 0x0 All exceptions are unmasked. 0x1 All exceptions with priority level 1-7 are masked. 0x2 All exceptions with priority level 2-7 are masked. 0x3 All exceptions with priority level 3-7 are masked. 0x4 All exceptions with priority level 4-7 are masked. 0x5 All exceptions with priority level 5-7 are masked. 0x6 All exceptions with priority level 6-7 are masked. 0x7 All exceptions with priority level 7 are masked. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 70 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 21: Control Register (CONTROL) The CONTROL register controls the stack used and the privilege level for software execution when the processor is in Thread mode. This register is only accessible in privileged mode. Handler mode always uses MSP, so the processor ignores explicit writes to the ASP bit of the CONTROL register when in Handler mode. The exception entry and return mechanisms automatically update the CONTROL register based on the EXC_RETURN value (see Table 2-10 on page 88). In an OS environment, threads running in Thread mode should use the process stack and the kernel and exception handlers should use the main stack. By default, Thread mode uses MSP. To switch the stack pointer used in Thread mode to PSP, either use the MSR instruction to set the ASP bit, as detailed in the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual, or perform an exception return to Thread mode with the appropriate EXC_RETURN value, as shown in Table 2-10 on page 88. Note: When changing the stack pointer, software must use an ISB instruction immediately after the MSR instruction, ensuring that instructions after the ISB execute use the new stack pointer. See the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual. Control Register (CONTROL) Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ASP TMPL RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:2 reserved RO 0x0000.000 1 ASP R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Active Stack Pointer Value Description 1 PSP is the current stack pointer. 0 MSP is the current stack pointer In Handler mode, this bit reads as zero and ignores writes. The Cortex-M3 updates this bit automatically on exception return. 0 TMPL R/W 0 Thread Mode Privilege Level Value Description 1 Unprivileged software can be executed in Thread mode. 0 Only privileged software can be executed in Thread mode. January 22, 2012 71 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor 2.3.5 Exceptions and Interrupts The Cortex-M3 processor supports interrupts and system exceptions. The processor and the Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) prioritize and handle all exceptions. An exception changes the normal flow of software control. The processor uses Handler mode to handle all exceptions except for reset. See “Exception Entry and Return” on page 86 for more information. The NVIC registers control interrupt handling. See “Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC)” on page 96 for more information. 2.3.6 Data Types The Cortex-M3 supports 32-bit words, 16-bit halfwords, and 8-bit bytes. The processor also supports 64-bit data transfer instructions. All instruction and data memory accesses are little endian. See “Memory Regions, Types and Attributes” on page 74 for more information. 2.4 Memory Model This section describes the processor memory map, the behavior of memory accesses, and the bit-banding features. The processor has a fixed memory map that provides up to 4 GB of addressable memory. The memory map for the LM3S1G21 controller is provided in Table 2-4 on page 72. In this manual, register addresses are given as a hexadecimal increment, relative to the module’s base address as shown in the memory map. The regions for SRAM and peripherals include bit-band regions. Bit-banding provides atomic operations to bit data (see “Bit-Banding” on page 77). The processor reserves regions of the Private peripheral bus (PPB) address range for core peripheral registers (see “Cortex-M3 Peripherals” on page 95). Note: Within the memory map, all reserved space returns a bus fault when read or written. Table 2-4. Memory Map Start End Description For details, see page ... 0x0000.0000 0x0005.FFFF On-chip Flash 297 0x0006.0000 0x00FF.FFFF Reserved - 0x0100.0000 0x1FFF.FFFF Reserved for ROM 295 0x2000.0000 0x2000.FFFF Bit-banded on-chip SRAM 295 0x2001.0000 0x21FF.FFFF Reserved - 0x2200.0000 0x221F.FFFF Bit-band alias of bit-banded on-chip SRAM starting at 0x2000.0000 295 0x2220.0000 0x3FFF.FFFF Reserved - 0x4000.0000 0x4000.0FFF Watchdog timer 0 580 0x4000.1000 0x4000.1FFF Watchdog timer 1 580 0x4000.2000 0x4000.3FFF Reserved - 0x4000.4000 0x4000.4FFF GPIO Port A 412 0x4000.5000 0x4000.5FFF GPIO Port B 412 0x4000.6000 0x4000.6FFF GPIO Port C 412 Memory FiRM Peripherals 72 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 2-4. Memory Map (continued) Start End Description For details, see page ... 0x4000.7000 0x4000.7FFF GPIO Port D 412 0x4000.8000 0x4000.8FFF SSI0 756 0x4000.9000 0x4000.9FFF SSI1 756 0x4000.A000 0x4000.BFFF Reserved - 0x4000.C000 0x4000.CFFF UART0 692 0x4000.D000 0x4000.DFFF UART1 692 0x4000.E000 0x4000.EFFF UART2 692 0x4000.F000 0x4001.FFFF Reserved - 0x4002.0FFF I2C 0 800 0x4002.1000 0x4002.1FFF I2C 800 0x4002.2000 0x4002.3FFF Reserved - 0x4002.4000 0x4002.4FFF GPIO Port E 412 0x4002.5000 0x4002.5FFF GPIO Port F 412 0x4002.6000 0x4002.6FFF GPIO Port G 412 0x4002.7000 0x4002.7FFF GPIO Port H 412 0x4002.8000 0x4002.FFFF Reserved - 0x4003.0000 0x4003.0FFF Timer 0 546 0x4003.1000 0x4003.1FFF Timer 1 546 0x4003.2000 0x4003.2FFF Timer 2 546 0x4003.3000 0x4003.3FFF Timer 3 546 0x4003.4000 0x4003.7FFF Reserved - 0x4003.8000 0x4003.8FFF ADC0 622 0x4003.9000 0x4003.BFFF Reserved - 0x4003.C000 0x4003.CFFF Analog Comparators 822 0x4003.D000 0x4003.DFFF GPIO Port J 412 0x4003.E000 0x4005.7FFF Reserved - 0x4005.8000 0x4005.8FFF GPIO Port A (AHB aperture) 412 0x4005.9000 0x4005.9FFF GPIO Port B (AHB aperture) 412 0x4005.A000 0x4005.AFFF GPIO Port C (AHB aperture) 412 0x4005.B000 0x4005.BFFF GPIO Port D (AHB aperture) 412 0x4005.C000 0x4005.CFFF GPIO Port E (AHB aperture) 412 0x4005.D000 0x4005.DFFF GPIO Port F (AHB aperture) 412 0x4005.E000 0x4005.EFFF GPIO Port G (AHB aperture) 412 0x4005.F000 0x4005.FFFF GPIO Port H (AHB aperture) 412 0x4006.0000 0x4006.0FFF GPIO Port J (AHB aperture) 412 0x4006.1000 0x400C.FFFF Reserved - 0x400D.0000 0x400D.0FFF EPI 0 486 0x400D.1000 0x400F.BFFF Reserved - 0x400F.C000 0x400F.CFFF Hibernation Module 277 0x400F.D000 0x400F.DFFF Flash memory control 303 Peripherals 0x4002.0000 1 January 22, 2012 73 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Table 2-4. Memory Map (continued) Start End Description For details, see page ... 0x400F.E000 0x400F.EFFF System control 191 0x400F.F000 0x400F.FFFF µDMA 360 0x4010.0000 0x41FF.FFFF Reserved - 0x4200.0000 0x43FF.FFFF Bit-banded alias of 0x4000.0000 through 0x400F.FFFF - 0x4400.0000 0x5FFF.FFFF Reserved - 0x6000.0000 0xDFFF.FFFF EPI0 mapped peripheral and RAM - 0xE000.0000 0xE000.0FFF Instrumentation Trace Macrocell (ITM) 55 0xE000.1000 0xE000.1FFF Data Watchpoint and Trace (DWT) 55 0xE000.2000 0xE000.2FFF Flash Patch and Breakpoint (FPB) 55 0xE000.3000 0xE000.DFFF Reserved - 0xE000.E000 0xE000.EFFF Cortex-M3 Peripherals (SysTick, NVIC, MPU and SCB) 103 0xE000.F000 0xE003.FFFF Reserved - 0xE004.0000 0xE004.0FFF Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) 56 0xE004.1000 0xFFFF.FFFF Reserved - Private Peripheral Bus 2.4.1 Memory Regions, Types and Attributes The memory map and the programming of the MPU split the memory map into regions. Each region has a defined memory type, and some regions have additional memory attributes. The memory type and attributes determine the behavior of accesses to the region. The memory types are: ■ Normal: The processor can re-order transactions for efficiency and perform speculative reads. ■ Device: The processor preserves transaction order relative to other transactions to Device or Strongly Ordered memory. ■ Strongly Ordered: The processor preserves transaction order relative to all other transactions. The different ordering requirements for Device and Strongly Ordered memory mean that the memory system can buffer a write to Device memory but must not buffer a write to Strongly Ordered memory. An additional memory attribute is Execute Never (XN), which means the processor prevents instruction accesses. A fault exception is generated only on execution of an instruction executed from an XN region. 2.4.2 Memory System Ordering of Memory Accesses For most memory accesses caused by explicit memory access instructions, the memory system does not guarantee that the order in which the accesses complete matches the program order of the instructions, providing the order does not affect the behavior of the instruction sequence. Normally, if correct program execution depends on two memory accesses completing in program order, software must insert a memory barrier instruction between the memory access instructions (see “Software Ordering of Memory Accesses” on page 75). However, the memory system does guarantee ordering of accesses to Device and Strongly Ordered memory. For two memory access instructions A1 and A2, if both A1 and A2 are accesses to either 74 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Device or Strongly Ordered memory, and if A1 occurs before A2 in program order, A1 is always observed before A2. 2.4.3 Behavior of Memory Accesses Table 2-5 on page 75 shows the behavior of accesses to each region in the memory map. See “Memory Regions, Types and Attributes” on page 74 for more information on memory types and the XN attribute. Stellaris devices may have reserved memory areas within the address ranges shown below (refer to Table 2-4 on page 72 for more information). Table 2-5. Memory Access Behavior Address Range Memory Region Memory Type Execute Never (XN) Description 0x0000.0000 - 0x1FFF.FFFF Code Normal - This executable region is for program code. Data can also be stored here. 0x2000.0000 - 0x3FFF.FFFF SRAM Normal - This executable region is for data. Code can also be stored here. This region includes bit band and bit band alias areas (see Table 2-6 on page 77). 0x4000.0000 - 0x5FFF.FFFF Peripheral Device XN This region includes bit band and bit band alias areas (see Table 2-7 on page 77). 0x6000.0000 - 0x9FFF.FFFF External RAM Normal - This executable region is for data. 0xA000.0000 - 0xDFFF.FFFF External device Device XN This region is for external device memory. 0xE000.0000- 0xE00F.FFFF Private peripheral bus Strongly Ordered XN This region includes the NVIC, system timer, and system control block. 0xE010.0000- 0xFFFF.FFFF Reserved - - - The Code, SRAM, and external RAM regions can hold programs. However, it is recommended that programs always use the Code region because the Cortex-M3 has separate buses that can perform instruction fetches and data accesses simultaneously. The MPU can override the default memory access behavior described in this section. For more information, see “Memory Protection Unit (MPU)” on page 98. The Cortex-M3 prefetches instructions ahead of execution and speculatively prefetches from branch target addresses. 2.4.4 Software Ordering of Memory Accesses The order of instructions in the program flow does not always guarantee the order of the corresponding memory transactions for the following reasons: ■ The processor can reorder some memory accesses to improve efficiency, providing this does not affect the behavior of the instruction sequence. ■ The processor has multiple bus interfaces. ■ Memory or devices in the memory map have different wait states. ■ Some memory accesses are buffered or speculative. “Memory System Ordering of Memory Accesses” on page 74 describes the cases where the memory system guarantees the order of memory accesses. Otherwise, if the order of memory accesses is January 22, 2012 75 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor critical, software must include memory barrier instructions to force that ordering. The Cortex-M3 has the following memory barrier instructions: ■ The Data Memory Barrier (DMB) instruction ensures that outstanding memory transactions complete before subsequent memory transactions. ■ The Data Synchronization Barrier (DSB) instruction ensures that outstanding memory transactions complete before subsequent instructions execute. ■ The Instruction Synchronization Barrier (ISB) instruction ensures that the effect of all completed memory transactions is recognizable by subsequent instructions. Memory barrier instructions can be used in the following situations: ■ MPU programming – If the MPU settings are changed and the change must be effective on the very next instruction, use a DSB instruction to ensure the effect of the MPU takes place immediately at the end of context switching. – Use an ISB instruction to ensure the new MPU setting takes effect immediately after programming the MPU region or regions, if the MPU configuration code was accessed using a branch or call. If the MPU configuration code is entered using exception mechanisms, then an ISB instruction is not required. ■ Vector table If the program changes an entry in the vector table and then enables the corresponding exception, use a DMB instruction between the operations. The DMB instruction ensures that if the exception is taken immediately after being enabled, the processor uses the new exception vector. ■ Self-modifying code If a program contains self-modifying code, use an ISB instruction immediately after the code modification in the program. The ISB instruction ensures subsequent instruction execution uses the updated program. ■ Memory map switching If the system contains a memory map switching mechanism, use a DSB instruction after switching the memory map in the program. The DSB instruction ensures subsequent instruction execution uses the updated memory map. ■ Dynamic exception priority change When an exception priority has to change when the exception is pending or active, use DSB instructions after the change. The change then takes effect on completion of the DSB instruction. Memory accesses to Strongly Ordered memory, such as the System Control Block, do not require the use of DMB instructions. For more information on the memory barrier instructions, see the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual. 76 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 2.4.5 Bit-Banding A bit-band region maps each word in a bit-band alias region to a single bit in the bit-band region. The bit-band regions occupy the lowest 1 MB of the SRAM and peripheral memory regions. Accesses to the 32-MB SRAM alias region map to the 1-MB SRAM bit-band region, as shown in Table 2-6 on page 77. Accesses to the 32-MB peripheral alias region map to the 1-MB peripheral bit-band region, as shown in Table 2-7 on page 77. For the specific address range of the bit-band regions, see Table 2-4 on page 72. Note: A word access to the SRAM or the peripheral bit-band alias region maps to a single bit in the SRAM or peripheral bit-band region. A word access to a bit band address results in a word access to the underlying memory, and similarly for halfword and byte accesses. This allows bit band accesses to match the access requirements of the underlying peripheral. Table 2-6. SRAM Memory Bit-Banding Regions Address Range Memory Region Instruction and Data Accesses 0x2000.0000 - 0x200F.FFFF SRAM bit-band region Direct accesses to this memory range behave as SRAM memory accesses, but this region is also bit addressable through bit-band alias. 0x2200.0000 - 0x23FF.FFFF SRAM bit-band alias Data accesses to this region are remapped to bit band region. A write operation is performed as read-modify-write. Instruction accesses are not remapped. Table 2-7. Peripheral Memory Bit-Banding Regions Address Range Memory Region Instruction and Data Accesses 0x4000.0000 - 0x400F.FFFF Peripheral bit-band region Direct accesses to this memory range behave as peripheral memory accesses, but this region is also bit addressable through bit-band alias. 0x4200.0000 - 0x43FF.FFFF Peripheral bit-band alias Data accesses to this region are remapped to bit band region. A write operation is performed as read-modify-write. Instruction accesses are not permitted. The following formula shows how the alias region maps onto the bit-band region: bit_word_offset = (byte_offset x 32) + (bit_number x 4) bit_word_addr = bit_band_base + bit_word_offset where: bit_word_offset The position of the target bit in the bit-band memory region. bit_word_addr The address of the word in the alias memory region that maps to the targeted bit. bit_band_base The starting address of the alias region. byte_offset The number of the byte in the bit-band region that contains the targeted bit. January 22, 2012 77 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor bit_number The bit position, 0-7, of the targeted bit. Figure 2-4 on page 78 shows examples of bit-band mapping between the SRAM bit-band alias region and the SRAM bit-band region: ■ The alias word at 0x23FF.FFE0 maps to bit 0 of the bit-band byte at 0x200F.FFFF: 0x23FF.FFE0 = 0x2200.0000 + (0x000F.FFFF*32) + (0*4) ■ The alias word at 0x23FF.FFFC maps to bit 7 of the bit-band byte at 0x200F.FFFF: 0x23FF.FFFC = 0x2200.0000 + (0x000F.FFFF*32) + (7*4) ■ The alias word at 0x2200.0000 maps to bit 0 of the bit-band byte at 0x2000.0000: 0x2200.0000 = 0x2200.0000 + (0*32) + (0*4) ■ The alias word at 0x2200.001C maps to bit 7 of the bit-band byte at 0x2000.0000: 0x2200.001C = 0x2200.0000+ (0*32) + (7*4) Figure 2-4. Bit-Band Mapping 32-MB Alias Region 0x23FF.FFFC 0x23FF.FFF8 0x23FF.FFF4 0x23FF.FFF0 0x23FF.FFEC 0x23FF.FFE8 0x23FF.FFE4 0x23FF.FFE0 0x2200.001C 0x2200.0018 0x2200.0014 0x2200.0010 0x2200.000C 0x2200.0008 0x2200.0004 0x2200.0000 7 3 1-MB SRAM Bit-Band Region 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 0x200F.FFFF 7 6 5 4 3 2 0x2000.0003 2.4.5.1 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 0x200F.FFFE 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 5 4 3 2 1 0 6 0x200F.FFFD 1 0x2000.0002 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 0x2000.0001 5 4 2 1 0 1 0 0x200F.FFFC 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 0x2000.0000 Directly Accessing an Alias Region Writing to a word in the alias region updates a single bit in the bit-band region. Bit 0 of the value written to a word in the alias region determines the value written to the targeted bit in the bit-band region. Writing a value with bit 0 set writes a 1 to the bit-band bit, and writing a value with bit 0 clear writes a 0 to the bit-band bit. 78 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bits 31:1 of the alias word have no effect on the bit-band bit. Writing 0x01 has the same effect as writing 0xFF. Writing 0x00 has the same effect as writing 0x0E. When reading a word in the alias region, 0x0000.0000 indicates that the targeted bit in the bit-band region is clear and 0x0000.0001 indicates that the targeted bit in the bit-band region is set. 2.4.5.2 Directly Accessing a Bit-Band Region “Behavior of Memory Accesses” on page 75 describes the behavior of direct byte, halfword, or word accesses to the bit-band regions. 2.4.6 Data Storage The processor views memory as a linear collection of bytes numbered in ascending order from zero. For example, bytes 0-3 hold the first stored word, and bytes 4-7 hold the second stored word. Data is stored in little-endian format, with the least-significant byte (lsbyte) of a word stored at the lowest-numbered byte, and the most-significant byte (msbyte) stored at the highest-numbered byte. Figure 2-5 on page 79 illustrates how data is stored. Figure 2-5. Data Storage Memory 7 Register 0 31 2.4.7 Address A B0 A+1 B1 A+2 B2 A+3 B3 lsbyte 24 23 B3 16 15 B2 8 7 B1 0 B0 msbyte Synchronization Primitives The Cortex-M3 instruction set includes pairs of synchronization primitives which provide a non-blocking mechanism that a thread or process can use to obtain exclusive access to a memory location. Software can use these primitives to perform a guaranteed read-modify-write memory update sequence or for a semaphore mechanism. A pair of synchronization primitives consists of: ■ A Load-Exclusive instruction, which is used to read the value of a memory location and requests exclusive access to that location. ■ A Store-Exclusive instruction, which is used to attempt to write to the same memory location and returns a status bit to a register. If this status bit is clear, it indicates that the thread or process gained exclusive access to the memory and the write succeeds; if this status bit is set, it indicates that the thread or process did not gain exclusive access to the memory and no write was performed. The pairs of Load-Exclusive and Store-Exclusive instructions are: ■ The word instructions LDREX and STREX ■ The halfword instructions LDREXH and STREXH January 22, 2012 79 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor ■ The byte instructions LDREXB and STREXB Software must use a Load-Exclusive instruction with the corresponding Store-Exclusive instruction. To perform an exclusive read-modify-write of a memory location, software must: 1. Use a Load-Exclusive instruction to read the value of the location. 2. Modify the value, as required. 3. Use a Store-Exclusive instruction to attempt to write the new value back to the memory location. 4. Test the returned status bit. If the status bit is clear, the read-modify-write completed successfully. If the status bit is set, no write was performed, which indicates that the value returned at step 1 might be out of date. The software must retry the entire read-modify-write sequence. Software can use the synchronization primitives to implement a semaphore as follows: 1. Use a Load-Exclusive instruction to read from the semaphore address to check whether the semaphore is free. 2. If the semaphore is free, use a Store-Exclusive to write the claim value to the semaphore address. 3. If the returned status bit from step 2 indicates that the Store-Exclusive succeeded, then the software has claimed the semaphore. However, if the Store-Exclusive failed, another process might have claimed the semaphore after the software performed step 1. The Cortex-M3 includes an exclusive access monitor that tags the fact that the processor has executed a Load-Exclusive instruction. The processor removes its exclusive access tag if: ■ It executes a CLREX instruction. ■ It executes a Store-Exclusive instruction, regardless of whether the write succeeds. ■ An exception occurs, which means the processor can resolve semaphore conflicts between different threads. For more information about the synchronization primitive instructions, see the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual. 2.5 Exception Model The ARM Cortex-M3 processor and the Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) prioritize and handle all exceptions in Handler Mode. The processor state is automatically stored to the stack on an exception and automatically restored from the stack at the end of the Interrupt Service Routine (ISR). The vector is fetched in parallel to the state saving, enabling efficient interrupt entry. The processor supports tail-chaining, which enables back-to-back interrupts to be performed without the overhead of state saving and restoration. Table 2-8 on page 83 lists all exception types. Software can set eight priority levels on seven of these exceptions (system handlers) as well as on 37 interrupts (listed in Table 2-9 on page 83). Priorities on the system handlers are set with the NVIC System Handler Priority n (SYSPRIn) registers. Interrupts are enabled through the NVIC Interrupt Set Enable n (ENn) register and 80 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller prioritized with the NVIC Interrupt Priority n (PRIn) registers. Priorities can be grouped by splitting priority levels into preemption priorities and subpriorities. All the interrupt registers are described in “Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC)” on page 96. Internally, the highest user-programmable priority (0) is treated as fourth priority, after a Reset, Non-Maskable Interrupt (NMI), and a Hard Fault, in that order. Note that 0 is the default priority for all the programmable priorities. Important: After a write to clear an interrupt source, it may take several processor cycles for the NVIC to see the interrupt source de-assert. Thus if the interrupt clear is done as the last action in an interrupt handler, it is possible for the interrupt handler to complete while the NVIC sees the interrupt as still asserted, causing the interrupt handler to be re-entered errantly. This situation can be avoided by either clearing the interrupt source at the beginning of the interrupt handler or by performing a read or write after the write to clear the interrupt source (and flush the write buffer). See “Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC)” on page 96 for more information on exceptions and interrupts. 2.5.1 Exception States Each exception is in one of the following states: ■ Inactive. The exception is not active and not pending. ■ Pending. The exception is waiting to be serviced by the processor. An interrupt request from a peripheral or from software can change the state of the corresponding interrupt to pending. ■ Active. An exception that is being serviced by the processor but has not completed. Note: An exception handler can interrupt the execution of another exception handler. In this case, both exceptions are in the active state. ■ Active and Pending. The exception is being serviced by the processor, and there is a pending exception from the same source. 2.5.2 Exception Types The exception types are: ■ Reset. Reset is invoked on power up or a warm reset. The exception model treats reset as a special form of exception. When reset is asserted, the operation of the processor stops, potentially at any point in an instruction. When reset is deasserted, execution restarts from the address provided by the reset entry in the vector table. Execution restarts as privileged execution in Thread mode. ■ NMI. A non-maskable Interrupt (NMI) can be signaled using the NMI signal or triggered by software using the Interrupt Control and State (INTCTRL) register. This exception has the highest priority other than reset. NMI is permanently enabled and has a fixed priority of -2. NMIs cannot be masked or prevented from activation by any other exception or preempted by any exception other than reset. ■ Hard Fault. A hard fault is an exception that occurs because of an error during exception processing, or because an exception cannot be managed by any other exception mechanism. Hard faults have a fixed priority of -1, meaning they have higher priority than any exception with configurable priority. January 22, 2012 81 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor ■ Memory Management Fault. A memory management fault is an exception that occurs because of a memory protection related fault, including access violation and no match. The MPU or the fixed memory protection constraints determine this fault, for both instruction and data memory transactions. This fault is used to abort instruction accesses to Execute Never (XN) memory regions, even if the MPU is disabled. ■ Bus Fault. A bus fault is an exception that occurs because of a memory-related fault for an instruction or data memory transaction such as a prefetch fault or a memory access fault. This fault can be enabled or disabled. ■ Usage Fault. A usage fault is an exception that occurs because of a fault related to instruction execution, such as: – An undefined instruction – An illegal unaligned access – Invalid state on instruction execution – An error on exception return An unaligned address on a word or halfword memory access or division by zero can cause a usage fault when the core is properly configured. ■ SVCall. A supervisor call (SVC) is an exception that is triggered by the SVC instruction. In an OS environment, applications can use SVC instructions to access OS kernel functions and device drivers. ■ Debug Monitor. This exception is caused by the debug monitor (when not halting). This exception is only active when enabled. This exception does not activate if it is a lower priority than the current activation. ■ PendSV. PendSV is a pendable, interrupt-driven request for system-level service. In an OS environment, use PendSV for context switching when no other exception is active. PendSV is triggered using the Interrupt Control and State (INTCTRL) register. ■ SysTick. A SysTick exception is an exception that the system timer generates when it reaches zero when it is enabled to generate an interrupt. Software can also generate a SysTick exception using the Interrupt Control and State (INTCTRL) register. In an OS environment, the processor can use this exception as system tick. ■ Interrupt (IRQ). An interrupt, or IRQ, is an exception signaled by a peripheral or generated by a software request and fed through the NVIC (prioritized). All interrupts are asynchronous to instruction execution. In the system, peripherals use interrupts to communicate with the processor. Table 2-9 on page 83 lists the interrupts on the LM3S1G21 controller. For an asynchronous exception, other than reset, the processor can execute another instruction between when the exception is triggered and when the processor enters the exception handler. Privileged software can disable the exceptions that Table 2-8 on page 83 shows as having configurable priority (see the SYSHNDCTRL register on page 139 and the DIS0 register on page 112). For more information about hard faults, memory management faults, bus faults, and usage faults, see “Fault Handling” on page 88. 82 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 2-8. Exception Types Exception Type a Vector Number Priority Vector Address or b Offset - 0 - 0x0000.0000 Stack top is loaded from the first entry of the vector table on reset. Reset 1 -3 (highest) 0x0000.0004 Asynchronous Non-Maskable Interrupt (NMI) 2 -2 0x0000.0008 Asynchronous Hard Fault 3 -1 0x0000.000C - c 0x0000.0010 Synchronous c 0x0000.0014 Synchronous when precise and asynchronous when imprecise c Synchronous Memory Management 4 programmable Bus Fault 5 programmable Usage Fault 6 programmable 0x0000.0018 7-10 - - - 0x0000.002C Synchronous c 0x0000.0030 Synchronous c 0x0000.0038 Asynchronous c 0x0000.003C Asynchronous SVCall 11 programmable 12 programmable - 13 - PendSV 14 programmable 15 Interrupts - programmable 16 and above Reserved c Debug Monitor SysTick Activation d programmable Reserved 0x0000.0040 and above Asynchronous a. 0 is the default priority for all the programmable priorities. b. See “Vector Table” on page 84. c. See SYSPRI1 on page 136. d. See PRIn registers on page 120. Table 2-9. Interrupts Vector Number Interrupt Number (Bit in Interrupt Registers) Vector Address or Offset Description 0-15 - 0x0000.0000 0x0000.003C 16 0 0x0000.0040 GPIO Port A 17 1 0x0000.0044 GPIO Port B 18 2 0x0000.0048 GPIO Port C 19 3 0x0000.004C GPIO Port D 20 4 0x0000.0050 GPIO Port E 21 5 0x0000.0054 UART0 22 6 0x0000.0058 UART1 23 7 0x0000.005C SSI0 24 8 0x0000.0060 I2C0 25-29 9-13 - 30 14 0x0000.0078 ADC0 Sequence 0 31 15 0x0000.007C ADC0 Sequence 1 32 16 0x0000.0080 ADC0 Sequence 2 33 17 0x0000.0084 ADC0 Sequence 3 34 18 0x0000.0088 Watchdog Timers 0 and 1 35 19 0x0000.008C Timer 0A Processor exceptions Reserved January 22, 2012 83 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Table 2-9. Interrupts (continued) 2.5.3 Vector Number Interrupt Number (Bit in Interrupt Registers) Vector Address or Offset Description 36 20 0x0000.0090 Timer 0B 37 21 0x0000.0094 Timer 1A 38 22 0x0000.0098 Timer 1B 39 23 0x0000.009C Timer 2A 40 24 0x0000.00A0 Timer 2B 41 25 0x0000.00A4 Analog Comparator 0 42 26 0x0000.00A8 Analog Comparator 1 43 27 - 44 28 0x0000.00B0 System Control 45 29 0x0000.00B4 Flash Memory Control 46 30 0x0000.00B8 GPIO Port F 47 31 0x0000.00BC GPIO Port G 48 32 0x0000.00C0 GPIO Port H 49 33 0x0000.00C4 UART2 50 34 0x0000.00C8 SSI1 51 35 0x0000.00CC Timer 3A 52 36 0x0000.00D0 Timer 3B 53 37 0x0000.00D4 I2C1 54-58 38-42 - 59 43 0x0000.00EC 60-61 44-45 - 62 46 0x0000.00F8 µDMA Software µDMA Error Reserved Reserved Hibernation Module Reserved 63 47 0x0000.00FC 64-68 48-52 - 69 53 0x0000.0114 EPI 70 54 0x0000.0118 GPIO Port J Reserved Exception Handlers The processor handles exceptions using: ■ Interrupt Service Routines (ISRs). Interrupts (IRQx) are the exceptions handled by ISRs. ■ Fault Handlers. Hard fault, memory management fault, usage fault, and bus fault are fault exceptions handled by the fault handlers. ■ System Handlers. NMI, PendSV, SVCall, SysTick, and the fault exceptions are all system exceptions that are handled by system handlers. 2.5.4 Vector Table The vector table contains the reset value of the stack pointer and the start addresses, also called exception vectors, for all exception handlers. The vector table is constructed using the vector address or offset shown in Table 2-8 on page 83. Figure 2-6 on page 85 shows the order of the exception 84 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller vectors in the vector table. The least-significant bit of each vector must be 1, indicating that the exception handler is Thumb code Figure 2-6. Vector Table Exception number IRQ number 70 54 . . . 18 2 17 1 16 0 15 -1 14 -2 13 Offset 0x0118 . . . 0x004C 0x0048 0x0044 0x0040 0x003C 0x0038 12 11 Vector IRQ54 . . . IRQ2 IRQ1 IRQ0 Systick PendSV Reserved Reserved for Debug -5 10 0x002C 9 SVCall Reserved 8 7 6 -10 5 -11 4 -12 3 -13 2 -14 1 0x0018 0x0014 0x0010 0x000C 0x0008 0x0004 0x0000 Usage fault Bus fault Memory management fault Hard fault NMI Reset Initial SP value On system reset, the vector table is fixed at address 0x0000.0000. Privileged software can write to the Vector Table Offset (VTABLE) register to relocate the vector table start address to a different memory location, in the range 0x0000.0200 to 0x3FFF.FE00 (see “Vector Table” on page 84). Note that when configuring the VTABLE register, the offset must be aligned on a 512-byte boundary. 2.5.5 Exception Priorities As Table 2-8 on page 83 shows, all exceptions have an associated priority, with a lower priority value indicating a higher priority and configurable priorities for all exceptions except Reset, Hard fault, and NMI. If software does not configure any priorities, then all exceptions with a configurable priority have a priority of 0. For information about configuring exception priorities, see page 136 and page 120. Note: Configurable priority values for the Stellaris implementation are in the range 0-7. This means that the Reset, Hard fault, and NMI exceptions, with fixed negative priority values, always have higher priority than any other exception. January 22, 2012 85 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor For example, assigning a higher priority value to IRQ[0] and a lower priority value to IRQ[1] means that IRQ[1] has higher priority than IRQ[0]. If both IRQ[1] and IRQ[0] are asserted, IRQ[1] is processed before IRQ[0]. If multiple pending exceptions have the same priority, the pending exception with the lowest exception number takes precedence. For example, if both IRQ[0] and IRQ[1] are pending and have the same priority, then IRQ[0] is processed before IRQ[1]. When the processor is executing an exception handler, the exception handler is preempted if a higher priority exception occurs. If an exception occurs with the same priority as the exception being handled, the handler is not preempted, irrespective of the exception number. However, the status of the new interrupt changes to pending. 2.5.6 Interrupt Priority Grouping To increase priority control in systems with interrupts, the NVIC supports priority grouping. This grouping divides each interrupt priority register entry into two fields: ■ An upper field that defines the group priority ■ A lower field that defines a subpriority within the group Only the group priority determines preemption of interrupt exceptions. When the processor is executing an interrupt exception handler, another interrupt with the same group priority as the interrupt being handled does not preempt the handler. If multiple pending interrupts have the same group priority, the subpriority field determines the order in which they are processed. If multiple pending interrupts have the same group priority and subpriority, the interrupt with the lowest IRQ number is processed first. For information about splitting the interrupt priority fields into group priority and subpriority, see page 130. 2.5.7 Exception Entry and Return Descriptions of exception handling use the following terms: ■ Preemption. When the processor is executing an exception handler, an exception can preempt the exception handler if its priority is higher than the priority of the exception being handled. See “Interrupt Priority Grouping” on page 86 for more information about preemption by an interrupt. When one exception preempts another, the exceptions are called nested exceptions. See “Exception Entry” on page 87 more information. ■ Return. Return occurs when the exception handler is completed, and there is no pending exception with sufficient priority to be serviced and the completed exception handler was not handling a late-arriving exception. The processor pops the stack and restores the processor state to the state it had before the interrupt occurred. See “Exception Return” on page 88 for more information. ■ Tail-Chaining. This mechanism speeds up exception servicing. On completion of an exception handler, if there is a pending exception that meets the requirements for exception entry, the stack pop is skipped and control transfers to the new exception handler. ■ Late-Arriving. This mechanism speeds up preemption. If a higher priority exception occurs during state saving for a previous exception, the processor switches to handle the higher priority exception and initiates the vector fetch for that exception. State saving is not affected by late 86 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller arrival because the state saved is the same for both exceptions. Therefore, the state saving continues uninterrupted. The processor can accept a late arriving exception until the first instruction of the exception handler of the original exception enters the execute stage of the processor. On return from the exception handler of the late-arriving exception, the normal tail-chaining rules apply. 2.5.7.1 Exception Entry Exception entry occurs when there is a pending exception with sufficient priority and either the processor is in Thread mode or the new exception is of higher priority than the exception being handled, in which case the new exception preempts the original exception. When one exception preempts another, the exceptions are nested. Sufficient priority means the exception has more priority than any limits set by the mask registers (see PRIMASK on page 68, FAULTMASK on page 69, and BASEPRI on page 70). An exception with less priority than this is pending but is not handled by the processor. When the processor takes an exception, unless the exception is a tail-chained or a late-arriving exception, the processor pushes information onto the current stack. This operation is referred to as stacking and the structure of eight data words is referred to as stack frame. Figure 2-7. Exception Stack Frame ... {aligner} xPSR PC LR R12 R3 R2 R1 R0 Pre-IRQ top of stack IRQ top of stack Immediately after stacking, the stack pointer indicates the lowest address in the stack frame. The stack frame includes the return address, which is the address of the next instruction in the interrupted program. This value is restored to the PC at exception return so that the interrupted program resumes. In parallel to the stacking operation, the processor performs a vector fetch that reads the exception handler start address from the vector table. When stacking is complete, the processor starts executing the exception handler. At the same time, the processor writes an EXC_RETURN value to the LR, indicating which stack pointer corresponds to the stack frame and what operation mode the processor was in before the entry occurred. If no higher-priority exception occurs during exception entry, the processor starts executing the exception handler and automatically changes the status of the corresponding pending interrupt to active. If another higher-priority exception occurs during exception entry, known as late arrival, the processor starts executing the exception handler for this exception and does not change the pending status of the earlier exception. January 22, 2012 87 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor 2.5.7.2 Exception Return Exception return occurs when the processor is in Handler mode and executes one of the following instructions to load the EXC_RETURN value into the PC: ■ An LDM or POP instruction that loads the PC ■ A BX instruction using any register ■ An LDR instruction with the PC as the destination EXC_RETURN is the value loaded into the LR on exception entry. The exception mechanism relies on this value to detect when the processor has completed an exception handler. The lowest four bits of this value provide information on the return stack and processor mode. Table 2-10 on page 88 shows the EXC_RETURN values with a description of the exception return behavior. EXC_RETURN bits 31:4 are all set. When this value is loaded into the PC, it indicates to the processor that the exception is complete, and the processor initiates the appropriate exception return sequence. Table 2-10. Exception Return Behavior EXC_RETURN[31:0] Description 0xFFFF.FFF0 Reserved 0xFFFF.FFF1 Return to Handler mode. Exception return uses state from MSP. Execution uses MSP after return. 0xFFFF.FFF2 - 0xFFFF.FFF8 Reserved 0xFFFF.FFF9 Return to Thread mode. Exception return uses state from MSP. Execution uses MSP after return. 0xFFFF.FFFA - 0xFFFF.FFFC Reserved 0xFFFF.FFFD Return to Thread mode. Exception return uses state from PSP. Execution uses PSP after return. 0xFFFF.FFFE - 0xFFFF.FFFF 2.6 Reserved Fault Handling Faults are a subset of the exceptions (see “Exception Model” on page 80). The following conditions generate a fault: ■ A bus error on an instruction fetch or vector table load or a data access. ■ An internally detected error such as an undefined instruction or an attempt to change state with a BX instruction. ■ Attempting to execute an instruction from a memory region marked as Non-Executable (XN). ■ An MPU fault because of a privilege violation or an attempt to access an unmanaged region. 88 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 2.6.1 Fault Types Table 2-11 on page 89 shows the types of fault, the handler used for the fault, the corresponding fault status register, and the register bit that indicates the fault has occurred. See page 143 for more information about the fault status registers. Table 2-11. Faults Fault Handler Fault Status Register Bit Name Bus error on a vector read Hard fault Hard Fault Status (HFAULTSTAT) VECT Fault escalated to a hard fault Hard fault Hard Fault Status (HFAULTSTAT) FORCED MPU or default memory mismatch on Memory management instruction access fault Memory Management Fault Status (MFAULTSTAT) IERR MPU or default memory mismatch on Memory management data access fault Memory Management Fault Status (MFAULTSTAT) DERR MPU or default memory mismatch on Memory management exception stacking fault Memory Management Fault Status (MFAULTSTAT) MSTKE MPU or default memory mismatch on Memory management exception unstacking fault Memory Management Fault Status (MFAULTSTAT) MUSTKE Bus error during exception stacking Bus fault Bus Fault Status (BFAULTSTAT) BSTKE Bus error during exception unstacking Bus fault Bus Fault Status (BFAULTSTAT) BUSTKE Bus error during instruction prefetch Bus fault Bus Fault Status (BFAULTSTAT) IBUS Precise data bus error Bus fault Bus Fault Status (BFAULTSTAT) PRECISE Imprecise data bus error Bus fault Bus Fault Status (BFAULTSTAT) IMPRE Attempt to access a coprocessor Usage fault Usage Fault Status (UFAULTSTAT) NOCP Undefined instruction Usage fault Usage Fault Status (UFAULTSTAT) UNDEF Attempt to enter an invalid instruction Usage fault b set state Usage Fault Status (UFAULTSTAT) INVSTAT a Invalid EXC_RETURN value Usage fault Usage Fault Status (UFAULTSTAT) INVPC Illegal unaligned load or store Usage fault Usage Fault Status (UFAULTSTAT) UNALIGN Divide by 0 Usage fault Usage Fault Status (UFAULTSTAT) DIV0 a. Occurs on an access to an XN region even if the MPU is disabled. b. Attempting to use an instruction set other than the Thumb instruction set, or returning to a non load-store-multiple instruction with ICI continuation. 2.6.2 Fault Escalation and Hard Faults All fault exceptions except for hard fault have configurable exception priority (see SYSPRI1 on page 136). Software can disable execution of the handlers for these faults (see SYSHNDCTRL on page 139). Usually, the exception priority, together with the values of the exception mask registers, determines whether the processor enters the fault handler, and whether a fault handler can preempt another fault handler as described in “Exception Model” on page 80. In some situations, a fault with configurable priority is treated as a hard fault. This process is called priority escalation, and the fault is described as escalated to hard fault. Escalation to hard fault occurs when: ■ A fault handler causes the same kind of fault as the one it is servicing. This escalation to hard fault occurs because a fault handler cannot preempt itself because it must have the same priority as the current priority level. January 22, 2012 89 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor ■ A fault handler causes a fault with the same or lower priority as the fault it is servicing. This situation happens because the handler for the new fault cannot preempt the currently executing fault handler. ■ An exception handler causes a fault for which the priority is the same as or lower than the currently executing exception. ■ A fault occurs and the handler for that fault is not enabled. If a bus fault occurs during a stack push when entering a bus fault handler, the bus fault does not escalate to a hard fault. Thus if a corrupted stack causes a fault, the fault handler executes even though the stack push for the handler failed. The fault handler operates but the stack contents are corrupted. Note: 2.6.3 Only Reset and NMI can preempt the fixed priority hard fault. A hard fault can preempt any exception other than Reset, NMI, or another hard fault. Fault Status Registers and Fault Address Registers The fault status registers indicate the cause of a fault. For bus faults and memory management faults, the fault address register indicates the address accessed by the operation that caused the fault, as shown in Table 2-12 on page 90. Table 2-12. Fault Status and Fault Address Registers 2.6.4 Handler Status Register Name Address Register Name Register Description Hard fault Hard Fault Status (HFAULTSTAT) - page 149 Memory management Memory Management Fault Status fault (MFAULTSTAT) Memory Management Fault Address (MMADDR) page 143 Bus fault Bus Fault Status (BFAULTSTAT) Bus Fault Address (FAULTADDR) page 143 Usage fault Usage Fault Status (UFAULTSTAT) - page 143 page 150 page 151 Lockup The processor enters a lockup state if a hard fault occurs when executing the NMI or hard fault handlers. When the processor is in the lockup state, it does not execute any instructions. The processor remains in lockup state until it is reset, an NMI occurs, or it is halted by a debugger. Note: 2.7 If the lockup state occurs from the NMI handler, a subsequent NMI does not cause the processor to leave the lockup state. Power Management The Cortex-M3 processor sleep modes reduce power consumption: ■ Sleep mode stops the processor clock. ■ Deep-sleep mode stops the system clock and switches off the PLL and Flash memory. The SLEEPDEEP bit of the System Control (SYSCTRL) register selects which sleep mode is used (see page 132). For more information about the behavior of the sleep modes, see “System Control” on page 187. 90 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller This section describes the mechanisms for entering sleep mode and the conditions for waking up from sleep mode, both of which apply to Sleep mode and Deep-sleep mode. 2.7.1 Entering Sleep Modes This section describes the mechanisms software can use to put the processor into one of the sleep modes. The system can generate spurious wake-up events, for example a debug operation wakes up the processor. Therefore, software must be able to put the processor back into sleep mode after such an event. A program might have an idle loop to put the processor back to sleep mode. 2.7.1.1 Wait for Interrupt The wait for interrupt instruction, WFI, causes immediate entry to sleep mode unless the wake-up condition is true (see “Wake Up from WFI or Sleep-on-Exit” on page 91). When the processor executes a WFI instruction, it stops executing instructions and enters sleep mode. See the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual for more information. 2.7.1.2 Wait for Event The wait for event instruction, WFE, causes entry to sleep mode conditional on the value of a one-bit event register. When the processor executes a WFE instruction, it checks the event register. If the register is 0, the processor stops executing instructions and enters sleep mode. If the register is 1, the processor clears the register and continues executing instructions without entering sleep mode. If the event register is 1, the processor must not enter sleep mode on execution of a WFE instruction. Typically, this situation occurs if an SEV instruction has been executed. Software cannot access this register directly. See the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual for more information. 2.7.1.3 Sleep-on-Exit If the SLEEPEXIT bit of the SYSCTRL register is set, when the processor completes the execution of all exception handlers, it returns to Thread mode and immediately enters sleep mode. This mechanism can be used in applications that only require the processor to run when an exception occurs. 2.7.2 Wake Up from Sleep Mode The conditions for the processor to wake up depend on the mechanism that cause it to enter sleep mode. 2.7.2.1 Wake Up from WFI or Sleep-on-Exit Normally, the processor wakes up only when the NVIC detects an exception with sufficient priority to cause exception entry. Some embedded systems might have to execute system restore tasks after the processor wakes up and before executing an interrupt handler. Entry to the interrupt handler can be delayed by setting the PRIMASK bit and clearing the FAULTMASK bit. If an interrupt arrives that is enabled and has a higher priority than current exception priority, the processor wakes up but does not execute the interrupt handler until the processor clears PRIMASK. For more information about PRIMASK and FAULTMASK, see page 68 and page 69. 2.7.2.2 Wake Up from WFE The processor wakes up if it detects an exception with sufficient priority to cause exception entry. January 22, 2012 91 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor In addition, if the SEVONPEND bit in the SYSCTRL register is set, any new pending interrupt triggers an event and wakes up the processor, even if the interrupt is disabled or has insufficient priority to cause exception entry. For more information about SYSCTRL, see page 132. 2.8 Instruction Set Summary The processor implements a version of the Thumb instruction set. Table 2-13 on page 92 lists the supported instructions. Note: In Table 2-13 on page 92: ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ Angle brackets, <>, enclose alternative forms of the operand Braces, {}, enclose optional operands The Operands column is not exhaustive Op2 is a flexible second operand that can be either a register or a constant Most instructions can use an optional condition code suffix For more information on the instructions and operands, see the instruction descriptions in the Cortex™-M3/M4 Instruction Set Technical User's Manual. Table 2-13. Cortex-M3 Instruction Summary Mnemonic Operands Brief Description Flags ADC, ADCS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Add with carry N,Z,C,V ADD, ADDS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Add N,Z,C,V ADD, ADDW {Rd,} Rn , #imm12 Add N,Z,C,V ADR Rd, label Load PC-relative address - AND, ANDS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Logical AND N,Z,C ASR, ASRS Rd, Rm, <Rs|#n> Arithmetic shift right N,Z,C B label Branch - BFC Rd, #lsb, #width Bit field clear - BFI Rd, Rn, #lsb, #width Bit field insert - BIC, BICS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Bit clear N,Z,C BKPT #imm Breakpoint - BL label Branch with link - BLX Rm Branch indirect with link - BX Rm Branch indirect - CBNZ Rn, label Compare and branch if non-zero - CBZ Rn, label Compare and branch if zero - CLREX - Clear exclusive - CLZ Rd, Rm Count leading zeros - CMN Rn, Op2 Compare negative N,Z,C,V CMP Rn, Op2 Compare N,Z,C,V CPSID i Change processor state, disable interrupts - CPSIE i Change processor state, enable interrupts - DMB - Data memory barrier - DSB - Data synchronization barrier - 92 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 2-13. Cortex-M3 Instruction Summary (continued) Mnemonic Operands Brief Description Flags EOR, EORS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Exclusive OR N,Z,C ISB - Instruction synchronization barrier - IT - If-Then condition block - LDM Rn{!}, reglist Load multiple registers, increment after - LDMDB, LDMEA Rn{!}, reglist Load multiple registers, decrement before LDMFD, LDMIA Rn{!}, reglist Load multiple registers, increment after - LDR Rt, [Rn, #offset] Load register with word - LDRB, LDRBT Rt, [Rn, #offset] Load register with byte - LDRD Rt, Rt2, [Rn, #offset] Load register with two bytes - LDREX Rt, [Rn, #offset] Load register exclusive - LDREXB Rt, [Rn] Load register exclusive with byte - LDREXH Rt, [Rn] Load register exclusive with halfword - LDRH, LDRHT Rt, [Rn, #offset] Load register with halfword - LDRSB, LDRSBT Rt, [Rn, #offset] Load register with signed byte - LDRSH, LDRSHT Rt, [Rn, #offset] Load register with signed halfword - LDRT Rt, [Rn, #offset] Load register with word - LSL, LSLS Rd, Rm, <Rs|#n> Logical shift left N,Z,C LSR, LSRS Rd, Rm, <Rs|#n> Logical shift right N,Z,C MLA Rd, Rn, Rm, Ra Multiply with accumulate, 32-bit result - MLS Rd, Rn, Rm, Ra Multiply and subtract, 32-bit result - MOV, MOVS Rd, Op2 Move N,Z,C MOV, MOVW Rd, #imm16 Move 16-bit constant N,Z,C MOVT Rd, #imm16 Move top - MRS Rd, spec_reg Move from special register to general register - MSR spec_reg, Rm Move from general register to special register N,Z,C,V MUL, MULS {Rd,} Rn, Rm Multiply, 32-bit result N,Z MVN, MVNS Rd, Op2 Move NOT N,Z,C NOP - No operation - ORN, ORNS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Logical OR NOT N,Z,C ORR, ORRS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Logical OR N,Z,C POP reglist Pop registers from stack - PUSH reglist Push registers onto stack - RBIT Rd, Rn Reverse bits - REV Rd, Rn Reverse byte order in a word - REV16 Rd, Rn Reverse byte order in each halfword - REVSH Rd, Rn Reverse byte order in bottom halfword and sign extend - ROR, RORS Rd, Rm, <Rs|#n> Rotate right N,Z,C RRX, RRXS Rd, Rm Rotate right with extend N,Z,C January 22, 2012 - 93 Texas Instruments-Production Data The Cortex-M3 Processor Table 2-13. Cortex-M3 Instruction Summary (continued) Mnemonic Operands Brief Description Flags RSB, RSBS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Reverse subtract N,Z,C,V SBC, SBCS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Subtract with carry N,Z,C,V SBFX Rd, Rn, #lsb, #width Signed bit field extract - SDIV {Rd,} Rn, Rm Signed divide - SEV - Send event - SMLAL RdLo, RdHi, Rn, Rm Signed multiply with accumulate (32x32+64), 64-bit result - SMULL RdLo, RdHi, Rn, Rm Signed multiply (32x32), 64-bit result - SSAT Rd, #n, Rm {,shift #s} Signed saturate Q STM Rn{!}, reglist Store multiple registers, increment after - STMDB, STMEA Rn{!}, reglist Store multiple registers, decrement before STMFD, STMIA Rn{!}, reglist Store multiple registers, increment after - STR Rt, [Rn {, #offset}] Store register word - STRB, STRBT Rt, [Rn {, #offset}] Store register byte - STRD Rt, Rt2, [Rn {, #offset}] Store register two words - STREX Rt, Rt, [Rn {, #offset}] Store register exclusive - STREXB Rd, Rt, [Rn] Store register exclusive byte - STREXH Rd, Rt, [Rn] Store register exclusive halfword - STRH, STRHT Rt, [Rn {, #offset}] Store register halfword - STRSB, STRSBT Rt, [Rn {, #offset}] Store register signed byte - STRSH, STRSHT Rt, [Rn {, #offset}] Store register signed halfword - STRT Rt, [Rn {, #offset}] Store register word - SUB, SUBS {Rd,} Rn, Op2 Subtract N,Z,C,V SUB, SUBW {Rd,} Rn, #imm12 Subtract 12-bit constant N,Z,C,V SVC #imm Supervisor call - SXTB {Rd,} Rm {,ROR #n} Sign extend a byte - SXTH {Rd,} Rm {,ROR #n} Sign extend a halfword - TBB [Rn, Rm] Table branch byte - TBH [Rn, Rm, LSL #1] Table branch halfword - TEQ Rn, Op2 Test equivalence N,Z,C TST Rn, Op2 Test N,Z,C UBFX Rd, Rn, #lsb, #width Unsigned bit field extract - UDIV {Rd,} Rn, Rm Unsigned divide - UMLAL RdLo, RdHi, Rn, Rm Unsigned multiply with accumulate (32x32+32+32), 64-bit result - UMULL RdLo, RdHi, Rn, Rm Unsigned multiply (32x 2), 64-bit result - USAT Rd, #n, Rm {,shift #s} Unsigned Saturate Q UXTB {Rd,} Rm, {,ROR #n} Zero extend a Byte - UXTH {Rd,} Rm, {,ROR #n} Zero extend a Halfword - WFE - Wait for event - WFI - Wait for interrupt - 94 - January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 3 Cortex-M3 Peripherals ® This chapter provides information on the Stellaris implementation of the Cortex-M3 processor peripherals, including: ■ SysTick (see page 95) Provides a simple, 24-bit clear-on-write, decrementing, wrap-on-zero counter with a flexible control mechanism. ■ Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) (see page 96) – Facilitates low-latency exception and interrupt handling – Controls power management – Implements system control registers ■ System Control Block (SCB) (see page 98) Provides system implementation information and system control, including configuration, control, and reporting of system exceptions. ■ Memory Protection Unit (MPU) (see page 98) Supports the standard ARMv7 Protected Memory System Architecture (PMSA) model. The MPU provides full support for protection regions, overlapping protection regions, access permissions, and exporting memory attributes to the system. Table 3-1 on page 95 shows the address map of the Private Peripheral Bus (PPB). Some peripheral register regions are split into two address regions, as indicated by two addresses listed. Table 3-1. Core Peripheral Register Regions Address Core Peripheral Description (see page ...) 0xE000.E010-0xE000.E01F System Timer 95 0xE000.E100-0xE000.E4EF Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller 96 System Control Block 98 Memory Protection Unit 98 0xE000.EF00-0xE000.EF03 0xE000.E008-0xE000.E00F 0xE000.ED00-0xE000.ED3F 0xE000.ED90-0xE000.EDB8 3.1 Functional Description This chapter provides information on the Stellaris implementation of the Cortex-M3 processor peripherals: SysTick, NVIC, SCB and MPU. 3.1.1 System Timer (SysTick) Cortex-M3 includes an integrated system timer, SysTick, which provides a simple, 24-bit clear-on-write, decrementing, wrap-on-zero counter with a flexible control mechanism. The counter can be used in several different ways, for example as: ■ An RTOS tick timer that fires at a programmable rate (for example, 100 Hz) and invokes a SysTick routine. ■ A high-speed alarm timer using the system clock. January 22, 2012 95 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals ■ A variable rate alarm or signal timer—the duration is range-dependent on the reference clock used and the dynamic range of the counter. ■ A simple counter used to measure time to completion and time used. ■ An internal clock source control based on missing/meeting durations. The COUNT bit in the STCTRL control and status register can be used to determine if an action completed within a set duration, as part of a dynamic clock management control loop. The timer consists of three registers: ■ SysTick Control and Status (STCTRL): A control and status counter to configure its clock, enable the counter, enable the SysTick interrupt, and determine counter status. ■ SysTick Reload Value (STRELOAD): The reload value for the counter, used to provide the counter's wrap value. ■ SysTick Current Value (STCURRENT): The current value of the counter. When enabled, the timer counts down on each clock from the reload value to zero, reloads (wraps) to the value in the STRELOAD register on the next clock edge, then decrements on subsequent clocks. Clearing the STRELOAD register disables the counter on the next wrap. When the counter reaches zero, the COUNT status bit is set. The COUNT bit clears on reads. Writing to the STCURRENT register clears the register and the COUNT status bit. The write does not trigger the SysTick exception logic. On a read, the current value is the value of the register at the time the register is accessed. The SysTick counter runs on the system clock. If this clock signal is stopped for low power mode, the SysTick counter stops. Ensure software uses aligned word accesses to access the SysTick registers. Note: 3.1.2 When the processor is halted for debugging, the counter does not decrement. Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) This section describes the Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) and the registers it uses. The NVIC supports: ■ 37 interrupts. ■ A programmable priority level of 0-7 for each interrupt. A higher level corresponds to a lower priority, so level 0 is the highest interrupt priority. ■ Low-latency exception and interrupt handling. ■ Level and pulse detection of interrupt signals. ■ Dynamic reprioritization of interrupts. ■ Grouping of priority values into group priority and subpriority fields. ■ Interrupt tail-chaining. ■ An external Non-maskable interrupt (NMI). 96 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller The processor automatically stacks its state on exception entry and unstacks this state on exception exit, with no instruction overhead, providing low latency exception handling. 3.1.2.1 Level-Sensitive and Pulse Interrupts The processor supports both level-sensitive and pulse interrupts. Pulse interrupts are also described as edge-triggered interrupts. A level-sensitive interrupt is held asserted until the peripheral deasserts the interrupt signal. Typically this happens because the ISR accesses the peripheral, causing it to clear the interrupt request. A pulse interrupt is an interrupt signal sampled synchronously on the rising edge of the processor clock. To ensure the NVIC detects the interrupt, the peripheral must assert the interrupt signal for at least one clock cycle, during which the NVIC detects the pulse and latches the interrupt. When the processor enters the ISR, it automatically removes the pending state from the interrupt (see “Hardware and Software Control of Interrupts” on page 97 for more information). For a level-sensitive interrupt, if the signal is not deasserted before the processor returns from the ISR, the interrupt becomes pending again, and the processor must execute its ISR again. As a result, the peripheral can hold the interrupt signal asserted until it no longer needs servicing. 3.1.2.2 Hardware and Software Control of Interrupts The Cortex-M3 latches all interrupts. A peripheral interrupt becomes pending for one of the following reasons: ■ The NVIC detects that the interrupt signal is High and the interrupt is not active. ■ The NVIC detects a rising edge on the interrupt signal. ■ Software writes to the corresponding interrupt set-pending register bit, or to the Software Trigger Interrupt (SWTRIG) register to make a Software-Generated Interrupt pending. See the INT bit in the PEND0 register on page 114 or SWTRIG on page 122. A pending interrupt remains pending until one of the following: ■ The processor enters the ISR for the interrupt, changing the state of the interrupt from pending to active. Then: – For a level-sensitive interrupt, when the processor returns from the ISR, the NVIC samples the interrupt signal. If the signal is asserted, the state of the interrupt changes to pending, which might cause the processor to immediately re-enter the ISR. Otherwise, the state of the interrupt changes to inactive. – For a pulse interrupt, the NVIC continues to monitor the interrupt signal, and if this is pulsed the state of the interrupt changes to pending and active. In this case, when the processor returns from the ISR the state of the interrupt changes to pending, which might cause the processor to immediately re-enter the ISR. If the interrupt signal is not pulsed while the processor is in the ISR, when the processor returns from the ISR the state of the interrupt changes to inactive. ■ Software writes to the corresponding interrupt clear-pending register bit – For a level-sensitive interrupt, if the interrupt signal is still asserted, the state of the interrupt does not change. Otherwise, the state of the interrupt changes to inactive. January 22, 2012 97 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals – For a pulse interrupt, the state of the interrupt changes to inactive, if the state was pending or to active, if the state was active and pending. 3.1.3 System Control Block (SCB) The System Control Block (SCB) provides system implementation information and system control, including configuration, control, and reporting of the system exceptions. 3.1.4 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) This section describes the Memory protection unit (MPU). The MPU divides the memory map into a number of regions and defines the location, size, access permissions, and memory attributes of each region. The MPU supports independent attribute settings for each region, overlapping regions, and export of memory attributes to the system. The memory attributes affect the behavior of memory accesses to the region. The Cortex-M3 MPU defines eight separate memory regions, 0-7, and a background region. When memory regions overlap, a memory access is affected by the attributes of the region with the highest number. For example, the attributes for region 7 take precedence over the attributes of any region that overlaps region 7. The background region has the same memory access attributes as the default memory map, but is accessible from privileged software only. The Cortex-M3 MPU memory map is unified, meaning that instruction accesses and data accesses have the same region settings. If a program accesses a memory location that is prohibited by the MPU, the processor generates a memory management fault, causing a fault exception and possibly causing termination of the process in an OS environment. In an OS environment, the kernel can update the MPU region setting dynamically based on the process to be executed. Typically, an embedded OS uses the MPU for memory protection. Configuration of MPU regions is based on memory types (see “Memory Regions, Types and Attributes” on page 74 for more information). Table 3-2 on page 98 shows the possible MPU region attributes. See the section called “MPU Configuration for a Stellaris Microcontroller” on page 102 for guidelines for programming a microcontroller implementation. Table 3-2. Memory Attributes Summary Memory Type Description Strongly Ordered All accesses to Strongly Ordered memory occur in program order. Device Memory-mapped peripherals Normal Normal memory To avoid unexpected behavior, disable the interrupts before updating the attributes of a region that the interrupt handlers might access. Ensure software uses aligned accesses of the correct size to access MPU registers: ■ Except for the MPU Region Attribute and Size (MPUATTR) register, all MPU registers must be accessed with aligned word accesses. ■ The MPUATTR register can be accessed with byte or aligned halfword or word accesses. 98 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller The processor does not support unaligned accesses to MPU registers. When setting up the MPU, and if the MPU has previously been programmed, disable unused regions to prevent any previous region settings from affecting the new MPU setup. 3.1.4.1 Updating an MPU Region To update the attributes for an MPU region, the MPU Region Number (MPUNUMBER), MPU Region Base Address (MPUBASE) and MPUATTR registers must be updated. Each register can be programmed separately or with a multiple-word write to program all of these registers. You can use the MPUBASEx and MPUATTRx aliases to program up to four regions simultaneously using an STM instruction. Updating an MPU Region Using Separate Words This example simple code configures one region: ; R1 = region number ; R2 = size/enable ; R3 = attributes ; R4 = address LDR R0,=MPUNUMBER STR R1, [R0, #0x0] STR R4, [R0, #0x4] STRH R2, [R0, #0x8] STRH R3, [R0, #0xA] ; ; ; ; ; 0xE000ED98, MPU region number register Region Number Region Base Address Region Size and Enable Region Attribute Disable a region before writing new region settings to the MPU if you have previously enabled the region being changed. For example: ; R1 = region number ; R2 = size/enable ; R3 = attributes ; R4 = address LDR R0,=MPUNUMBER STR R1, [R0, #0x0] BIC R2, R2, #1 STRH R2, [R0, #0x8] STR R4, [R0, #0x4] STRH R3, [R0, #0xA] ORR R2, #1 STRH R2, [R0, #0x8] ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; 0xE000ED98, MPU region number register Region Number Disable Region Size and Enable Region Base Address Region Attribute Enable Region Size and Enable Software must use memory barrier instructions: ■ Before MPU setup, if there might be outstanding memory transfers, such as buffered writes, that might be affected by the change in MPU settings. ■ After MPU setup, if it includes memory transfers that must use the new MPU settings. However, memory barrier instructions are not required if the MPU setup process starts by entering an exception handler, or is followed by an exception return, because the exception entry and exception return mechanism cause memory barrier behavior. Software does not need any memory barrier instructions during MPU setup, because it accesses the MPU through the Private Peripheral Bus (PPB), which is a Strongly Ordered memory region. January 22, 2012 99 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals For example, if all of the memory access behavior is intended to take effect immediately after the programming sequence, then a DSB instruction and an ISB instruction should be used. A DSB is required after changing MPU settings, such as at the end of context switch. An ISB is required if the code that programs the MPU region or regions is entered using a branch or call. If the programming sequence is entered using a return from exception, or by taking an exception, then an ISB is not required. Updating an MPU Region Using Multi-Word Writes The MPU can be programmed directly using multi-word writes, depending how the information is divided. Consider the following reprogramming: ; R1 = region number ; R2 = address ; R3 = size, attributes in one LDR R0, =MPUNUMBER ; 0xE000ED98, MPU region number register STR R1, [R0, #0x0] ; Region Number STR R2, [R0, #0x4] ; Region Base Address STR R3, [R0, #0x8] ; Region Attribute, Size and Enable An STM instruction can be used to optimize this: ; R1 = region number ; R2 = address ; R3 = size, attributes in one LDR R0, =MPUNUMBER ; 0xE000ED98, MPU region number register STM R0, {R1-R3} ; Region number, address, attribute, size and enable This operation can be done in two words for pre-packed information, meaning that the MPU Region Base Address (MPUBASE) register (see page 156) contains the required region number and has the VALID bit set. This method can be used when the data is statically packed, for example in a boot loader: ; R1 = address and region number in one ; R2 = size and attributes in one LDR R0, =MPUBASE ; 0xE000ED9C, MPU Region Base register STR R1, [R0, #0x0] ; Region base address and region number combined ; with VALID (bit 4) set STR R2, [R0, #0x4] ; Region Attribute, Size and Enable Subregions Regions of 256 bytes or more are divided into eight equal-sized subregions. Set the corresponding bit in the SRD field of the MPU Region Attribute and Size (MPUATTR) register (see page 158) to disable a subregion. The least-significant bit of the SRD field controls the first subregion, and the most-significant bit controls the last subregion. Disabling a subregion means another region overlapping the disabled range matches instead. If no other enabled region overlaps the disabled subregion, the MPU issues a fault. Regions of 32, 64, and 128 bytes do not support subregions. With regions of these sizes, the SRD field must be configured to 0x00, otherwise the MPU behavior is unpredictable. 100 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Example of SRD Use Two regions with the same base address overlap. Region one is 128 KB, and region two is 512 KB. To ensure the attributes from region one apply to the first 128 KB region, configure the SRD field for region two to 0x03 to disable the first two subregions, as Figure 3-1 on page 101 shows. Figure 3-1. SRD Use Example Region 2, with subregions Region 1 Base address of both regions 3.1.4.2 Offset from base address 512KB 448KB 384KB 320KB 256KB 192KB 128KB Disabled subregion 64KB Disabled subregion 0 MPU Access Permission Attributes The access permission bits, TEX, S, C, B, AP, and XN of the MPUATTR register, control access to the corresponding memory region. If an access is made to an area of memory without the required permissions, then the MPU generates a permission fault. Table 3-3 on page 101 shows the encodings for the TEX, C, B, and S access permission bits. All encodings are shown for completeness, however the current implementation of the Cortex-M3 does not support the concept of cacheability or shareability. Refer to the section called “MPU Configuration for a Stellaris Microcontroller” on page 102 for information on programming the MPU for Stellaris implementations. Table 3-3. TEX, S, C, and B Bit Field Encoding TEX S 000b x C B Memory Type Shareability Other Attributes a 0 0 Strongly Ordered Shareable - a - 000 x 0 1 Device Shareable 000 0 1 0 Normal Not shareable 000 1 1 0 Normal Shareable 000 0 1 1 Normal Not shareable 000 1 1 1 Normal Shareable 001 0 0 0 Normal Not shareable 001 1 0 0 Normal Shareable Outer and inner noncacheable. 001 x a 0 1 Reserved encoding - - a Outer and inner write-through. No write allocate. 001 x 1 0 Reserved encoding - - 001 0 1 1 Normal Not shareable 001 1 1 1 Normal Shareable Outer and inner write-back. Write and read allocate. 010 x a 0 0 Device Not shareable Nonshared Device. a 0 1 Reserved encoding - - a 1 x Reserved encoding - - 010 x 010 x a January 22, 2012 101 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Table 3-3. TEX, S, C, and B Bit Field Encoding (continued) TEX S C B Memory Type Shareability Other Attributes 1BB 0 A A Normal Not shareable 1BB 1 A A Normal Shareable Cached memory (BB = outer policy, AA = inner policy). See Table 3-4 for the encoding of the AA and BB bits. a. The MPU ignores the value of this bit. Table 3-4 on page 102 shows the cache policy for memory attribute encodings with a TEX value in the range of 0x4-0x7. Table 3-4. Cache Policy for Memory Attribute Encoding Encoding, AA or BB Corresponding Cache Policy 00 Non-cacheable 01 Write back, write and read allocate 10 Write through, no write allocate 11 Write back, no write allocate Table 3-5 on page 102 shows the AP encodings in the MPUATTR register that define the access permissions for privileged and unprivileged software. Table 3-5. AP Bit Field Encoding AP Bit Field Privileged Permissions Unprivileged Permissions Description 000 No access No access All accesses generate a permission fault. 001 R/W No access Access from privileged software only. 010 R/W RO Writes by unprivileged software generate a permission fault. 011 R/W R/W Full access. 100 Unpredictable Unpredictable Reserved. 101 RO No access Reads by privileged software only. 110 RO RO Read-only, by privileged or unprivileged software. 111 RO RO Read-only, by privileged or unprivileged software. MPU Configuration for a Stellaris Microcontroller Stellaris microcontrollers have only a single processor and no caches. As a result, the MPU should be programmed as shown in Table 3-6 on page 102. Table 3-6. Memory Region Attributes for Stellaris Microcontrollers Memory Region TEX S C B Memory Type and Attributes Flash memory 000b 0 1 0 Normal memory, non-shareable, write-through Internal SRAM 000b 1 1 0 Normal memory, shareable, write-through External SRAM 000b 1 1 1 Normal memory, shareable, write-back, write-allocate Peripherals 000b 1 0 1 Device memory, shareable 102 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller In current Stellaris microcontroller implementations, the shareability and cache policy attributes do not affect the system behavior. However, using these settings for the MPU regions can make the application code more portable. The values given are for typical situations. 3.1.4.3 MPU Mismatch When an access violates the MPU permissions, the processor generates a memory management fault (see “Exceptions and Interrupts” on page 72 for more information). The MFAULTSTAT register indicates the cause of the fault. See page 143 for more information. 3.2 Register Map Table 3-7 on page 103 lists the Cortex-M3 Peripheral SysTick, NVIC, MPU and SCB registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register's address, relative to the Core Peripherals base address of 0xE000.E000. Note: Register spaces that are not used are reserved for future or internal use. Software should not modify any reserved memory address. Table 3-7. Peripherals Register Map Offset Name Type Reset Description See page System Timer (SysTick) Registers 0x010 STCTRL R/W 0x0000.0004 SysTick Control and Status Register 106 0x014 STRELOAD R/W 0x0000.0000 SysTick Reload Value Register 108 0x018 STCURRENT R/WC 0x0000.0000 SysTick Current Value Register 109 Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) Registers 0x100 EN0 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 0-31 Set Enable 110 0x104 EN1 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 32-54 Set Enable 111 0x180 DIS0 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 0-31 Clear Enable 112 0x184 DIS1 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 32-54 Clear Enable 113 0x200 PEND0 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 0-31 Set Pending 114 0x204 PEND1 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 32-54 Set Pending 115 0x280 UNPEND0 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 0-31 Clear Pending 116 0x284 UNPEND1 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 32-54 Clear Pending 117 0x300 ACTIVE0 RO 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 0-31 Active Bit 118 0x304 ACTIVE1 RO 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 32-54 Active Bit 119 0x400 PRI0 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 0-3 Priority 120 0x404 PRI1 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 4-7 Priority 120 0x408 PRI2 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 8-11 Priority 120 0x40C PRI3 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 12-15 Priority 120 0x410 PRI4 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 16-19 Priority 120 January 22, 2012 103 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Table 3-7. Peripherals Register Map (continued) Description See page Offset Name Type Reset 0x414 PRI5 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 20-23 Priority 120 0x418 PRI6 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 24-27 Priority 120 0x41C PRI7 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 28-31 Priority 120 0x420 PRI8 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 32-35 Priority 120 0x424 PRI9 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 36-39 Priority 120 0x428 PRI10 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 40-43 Priority 120 0x42C PRI11 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 44-47 Priority 120 0x430 PRI12 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 48-51 Priority 120 0x434 PRI13 R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt 52-54 Priority 120 0xF00 SWTRIG WO 0x0000.0000 Software Trigger Interrupt 122 System Control Block (SCB) Registers 0x008 ACTLR R/W 0x0000.0000 Auxiliary Control 123 0xD00 CPUID RO 0x412F.C230 CPU ID Base 125 0xD04 INTCTRL R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt Control and State 126 0xD08 VTABLE R/W 0x0000.0000 Vector Table Offset 129 0xD0C APINT R/W 0xFA05.0000 Application Interrupt and Reset Control 130 0xD10 SYSCTRL R/W 0x0000.0000 System Control 132 0xD14 CFGCTRL R/W 0x0000.0200 Configuration and Control 134 0xD18 SYSPRI1 R/W 0x0000.0000 System Handler Priority 1 136 0xD1C SYSPRI2 R/W 0x0000.0000 System Handler Priority 2 137 0xD20 SYSPRI3 R/W 0x0000.0000 System Handler Priority 3 138 0xD24 SYSHNDCTRL R/W 0x0000.0000 System Handler Control and State 139 0xD28 FAULTSTAT R/W1C 0x0000.0000 Configurable Fault Status 143 0xD2C HFAULTSTAT R/W1C 0x0000.0000 Hard Fault Status 149 0xD34 MMADDR R/W - Memory Management Fault Address 150 0xD38 FAULTADDR R/W - Bus Fault Address 151 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) Registers 0xD90 MPUTYPE RO 0x0000.0800 MPU Type 152 0xD94 MPUCTRL R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Control 153 0xD98 MPUNUMBER R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Number 155 0xD9C MPUBASE R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Base Address 156 0xDA0 MPUATTR R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Attribute and Size 158 104 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 3-7. Peripherals Register Map (continued) Name Type Reset 0xDA4 MPUBASE1 R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Base Address Alias 1 156 0xDA8 MPUATTR1 R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 1 158 0xDAC MPUBASE2 R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Base Address Alias 2 156 0xDB0 MPUATTR2 R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 2 158 0xDB4 MPUBASE3 R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Base Address Alias 3 156 0xDB8 MPUATTR3 R/W 0x0000.0000 MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 3 158 3.3 Description See page Offset System Timer (SysTick) Register Descriptions This section lists and describes the System Timer registers, in numerical order by address offset. January 22, 2012 105 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 1: SysTick Control and Status Register (STCTRL), offset 0x010 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The SysTick STCTRL register enables the SysTick features. SysTick Control and Status Register (STCTRL) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x010 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0004 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 16 COUNT RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 2 1 0 CLK_SRC INTEN ENABLE R/W 1 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:17 reserved RO 0x000 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 16 COUNT RO 0 Count Flag Value Description 0 The SysTick timer has not counted to 0 since the last time this bit was read. 1 The SysTick timer has counted to 0 since the last time this bit was read. This bit is cleared by a read of the register or if the STCURRENT register is written with any value. If read by the debugger using the DAP, this bit is cleared only if the MasterType bit in the AHB-AP Control Register is clear. Otherwise, the COUNT bit is not changed by the debugger read. See the ARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification for more information on MasterType. 15:3 reserved RO 0x000 2 CLK_SRC R/W 1 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Clock Source Value Description 0 External reference clock. (Not implemented for most Stellaris microcontrollers.) 1 System clock Because an external reference clock is not implemented, this bit must be set in order for SysTick to operate. 106 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 1 INTEN R/W 0 0 ENABLE R/W 0 Description Interrupt Enable Value Description 0 Interrupt generation is disabled. Software can use the COUNT bit to determine if the counter has ever reached 0. 1 An interrupt is generated to the NVIC when SysTick counts to 0. Enable Value Description 0 The counter is disabled. 1 Enables SysTick to operate in a multi-shot way. That is, the counter loads the RELOAD value and begins counting down. On reaching 0, the COUNT bit is set and an interrupt is generated if enabled by INTEN. The counter then loads the RELOAD value again and begins counting. January 22, 2012 107 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 2: SysTick Reload Value Register (STRELOAD), offset 0x014 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The STRELOAD register specifies the start value to load into the SysTick Current Value (STCURRENT) register when the counter reaches 0. The start value can be between 0x1 and 0x00FF.FFFF. A start value of 0 is possible but has no effect because the SysTick interrupt and the COUNT bit are activated when counting from 1 to 0. SysTick can be configured as a multi-shot timer, repeated over and over, firing every N+1 clock pulses, where N is any value from 1 to 0x00FF.FFFF. For example, if a tick interrupt is required every 100 clock pulses, 99 must be written into the RELOAD field. SysTick Reload Value Register (STRELOAD) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x014 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset 19 RELOAD RELOAD Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:24 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 23:0 RELOAD R/W 0x00.0000 Reload Value Value to load into the SysTick Current Value (STCURRENT) register when the counter reaches 0. 108 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 3: SysTick Current Value Register (STCURRENT), offset 0x018 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The STCURRENT register contains the current value of the SysTick counter. SysTick Current Value Register (STCURRENT) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x018 Type R/WC, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 reserved Type Reset 20 19 18 17 16 CURRENT RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 CURRENT Type Reset R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 R/WC 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:24 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 23:0 CURRENT R/WC 0x00.0000 Current Value This field contains the current value at the time the register is accessed. No read-modify-write protection is provided, so change with care. This register is write-clear. Writing to it with any value clears the register. Clearing this register also clears the COUNT bit of the STCTRL register. 3.4 NVIC Register Descriptions This section lists and describes the NVIC registers, in numerical order by address offset. The NVIC registers can only be fully accessed from privileged mode, but interrupts can be pended while in unprivileged mode by enabling the Configuration and Control (CFGCTRL) register. Any other unprivileged mode access causes a bus fault. Ensure software uses correctly aligned register accesses. The processor does not support unaligned accesses to NVIC registers. An interrupt can enter the pending state even if it is disabled. Before programming the VTABLE register to relocate the vector table, ensure the vector table entries of the new vector table are set up for fault handlers, NMI, and all enabled exceptions such as interrupts. For more information, see page 129. January 22, 2012 109 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 4: Interrupt 0-31 Set Enable (EN0), offset 0x100 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. If a pending interrupt is enabled, the NVIC activates the interrupt based on its priority. If an interrupt is not enabled, asserting its interrupt signal changes the interrupt state to pending, but the NVIC never activates the interrupt, regardless of its priority. Interrupt 0-31 Set Enable (EN0) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x100 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 INT Type Reset INT Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 INT R/W Reset Description 0x0000.0000 Interrupt Enable Value Description 0 On a read, indicates the interrupt is disabled. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates the interrupt is enabled. On a write, enables the interrupt. A bit can only be cleared by setting the corresponding INT[n] bit in the DISn register. 110 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 5: Interrupt 32-54 Set Enable (EN1), offset 0x104 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The EN1 register enables interrupts and shows which interrupts are enabled. Bit 0 corresponds to Interrupt 32; bit 22 corresponds to Interrupt 54. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. If a pending interrupt is enabled, the NVIC activates the interrupt based on its priority. If an interrupt is not enabled, asserting its interrupt signal changes the interrupt state to pending, but the NVIC never activates the interrupt, regardless of its priority. Interrupt 32-54 Set Enable (EN1) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x104 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset INT INT Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:23 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 22:0 INT R/W 0x00.0000 Interrupt Enable Value Description 0 On a read, indicates the interrupt is disabled. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates the interrupt is enabled. On a write, enables the interrupt. A bit can only be cleared by setting the corresponding INT[n] bit in the DIS1 register. January 22, 2012 111 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 6: Interrupt 0-31 Clear Enable (DIS0), offset 0x180 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Interrupt 0-31 Clear Enable (DIS0) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x180 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 INT R/W R/W 0 Reset R/W 0 Description 0x0000.0000 Interrupt Disable Value Description 0 On a read, indicates the interrupt is disabled. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates the interrupt is enabled. On a write, clears the corresponding INT[n] bit in the EN0 register, disabling interrupt [n]. 112 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 7: Interrupt 32-54 Clear Enable (DIS1), offset 0x184 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The DIS1 register disables interrupts. Bit 0 corresponds to Interrupt 32; bit 22 corresponds to Interrupt 54. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Interrupt 32-54 Clear Enable (DIS1) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x184 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 reserved Type Reset 19 18 17 16 INT RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:23 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 22:0 INT R/W 0x00.0000 Interrupt Disable Value Description 0 On a read, indicates the interrupt is disabled. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates the interrupt is enabled. On a write, clears the corresponding INT[n] bit in the EN1 register, disabling interrupt [n]. January 22, 2012 113 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 8: Interrupt 0-31 Set Pending (PEND0), offset 0x200 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Interrupt 0-31 Set Pending (PEND0) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x200 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 INT R/W R/W 0 Reset R/W 0 Description 0x0000.0000 Interrupt Set Pending Value Description 0 On a read, indicates that the interrupt is not pending. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates that the interrupt is pending. On a write, the corresponding interrupt is set to pending even if it is disabled. If the corresponding interrupt is already pending, setting a bit has no effect. A bit can only be cleared by setting the corresponding INT[n] bit in the UNPEND0 register. 114 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 9: Interrupt 32-54 Set Pending (PEND1), offset 0x204 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The PEND1 register forces interrupts into the pending state and shows which interrupts are pending. Bit 0 corresponds to Interrupt 32; bit 22 corresponds to Interrupt 54. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Interrupt 32-54 Set Pending (PEND1) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x204 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 reserved Type Reset 19 18 17 16 INT RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:23 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 22:0 INT R/W 0x00.0000 Interrupt Set Pending Value Description 0 On a read, indicates that the interrupt is not pending. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates that the interrupt is pending. On a write, the corresponding interrupt is set to pending even if it is disabled. If the corresponding interrupt is already pending, setting a bit has no effect. A bit can only be cleared by setting the corresponding INT[n] bit in the UNPEND1 register. January 22, 2012 115 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 10: Interrupt 0-31 Clear Pending (UNPEND0), offset 0x280 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Interrupt 0-31 Clear Pending (UNPEND0) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x280 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 INT R/W R/W 0 Reset R/W 0 Description 0x0000.0000 Interrupt Clear Pending Value Description 0 On a read, indicates that the interrupt is not pending. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates that the interrupt is pending. On a write, clears the corresponding INT[n] bit in the PEND0 register, so that interrupt [n] is no longer pending. Setting a bit does not affect the active state of the corresponding interrupt. 116 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 11: Interrupt 32-54 Clear Pending (UNPEND1), offset 0x284 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The UNPEND1 register shows which interrupts are pending and removes the pending state from interrupts. Bit 0 corresponds to Interrupt 32; bit 22 corresponds to Interrupt 54. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Interrupt 32-54 Clear Pending (UNPEND1) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x284 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 reserved Type Reset 19 18 17 16 INT RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 INT Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:23 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 22:0 INT R/W 0x00.0000 Interrupt Clear Pending Value Description 0 On a read, indicates that the interrupt is not pending. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates that the interrupt is pending. On a write, clears the corresponding INT[n] bit in the PEND1 register, so that interrupt [n] is no longer pending. Setting a bit does not affect the active state of the corresponding interrupt. January 22, 2012 117 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 12: Interrupt 0-31 Active Bit (ACTIVE0), offset 0x300 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Caution – Do not manually set or clear the bits in this register. Interrupt 0-31 Active Bit (ACTIVE0) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x300 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 INT Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 INT Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 INT RO RO 0 Reset RO 0 Description 0x0000.0000 Interrupt Active Value Description 0 The corresponding interrupt is not active. 1 The corresponding interrupt is active, or active and pending. 118 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 13: Interrupt 32-54 Active Bit (ACTIVE1), offset 0x304 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The ACTIVE1 register indicates which interrupts are active. Bit 0 corresponds to Interrupt 32; bit 22 corresponds to Interrupt 54. See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Caution – Do not manually set or clear the bits in this register. Interrupt 32-54 Active Bit (ACTIVE1) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x304 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 reserved Type Reset 19 18 17 16 INT RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 INT Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:23 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 22:0 INT RO 0x00.0000 Interrupt Active Value Description 0 The corresponding interrupt is not active. 1 The corresponding interrupt is active, or active and pending. January 22, 2012 119 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 14: Interrupt 0-3 Priority (PRI0), offset 0x400 Register 15: Interrupt 4-7 Priority (PRI1), offset 0x404 Register 16: Interrupt 8-11 Priority (PRI2), offset 0x408 Register 17: Interrupt 12-15 Priority (PRI3), offset 0x40C Register 18: Interrupt 16-19 Priority (PRI4), offset 0x410 Register 19: Interrupt 20-23 Priority (PRI5), offset 0x414 Register 20: Interrupt 24-27 Priority (PRI6), offset 0x418 Register 21: Interrupt 28-31 Priority (PRI7), offset 0x41C Register 22: Interrupt 32-35 Priority (PRI8), offset 0x420 Register 23: Interrupt 36-39 Priority (PRI9), offset 0x424 Register 24: Interrupt 40-43 Priority (PRI10), offset 0x428 Register 25: Interrupt 44-47 Priority (PRI11), offset 0x42C Register 26: Interrupt 48-51 Priority (PRI12), offset 0x430 Register 27: Interrupt 52-54 Priority (PRI13), offset 0x434 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The PRIn registers provide 3-bit priority fields for each interrupt. These registers are byte accessible. Each register holds four priority fields that are assigned to interrupts as follows: PRIn Register Bit Field Interrupt Bits 31:29 Interrupt [4n+3] Bits 23:21 Interrupt [4n+2] Bits 15:13 Interrupt [4n+1] Bits 7:5 Interrupt [4n] See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. Each priority level can be split into separate group priority and subpriority fields. The PRIGROUP field in the Application Interrupt and Reset Control (APINT) register (see page 130) indicates the position of the binary point that splits the priority and subpriority fields. These registers can only be accessed from privileged mode. 120 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Interrupt 0-3 Priority (PRI0) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x400 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 INTD Type Reset 25 24 23 reserved 22 21 20 19 INTC 18 17 16 reserved R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 INTB Type Reset 26 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved RO 0 INTA Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:29 INTD R/W 0x0 R/W 0 reserved RO 0 Description Interrupt Priority for Interrupt [4n+3] This field holds a priority value, 0-7, for the interrupt with the number [4n+3], where n is the number of the Interrupt Priority register (n=0 for PRI0, and so on). The lower the value, the greater the priority of the corresponding interrupt. 28:24 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 23:21 INTC R/W 0x0 Interrupt Priority for Interrupt [4n+2] This field holds a priority value, 0-7, for the interrupt with the number [4n+2], where n is the number of the Interrupt Priority register (n=0 for PRI0, and so on). The lower the value, the greater the priority of the corresponding interrupt. 20:16 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 15:13 INTB R/W 0x0 Interrupt Priority for Interrupt [4n+1] This field holds a priority value, 0-7, for the interrupt with the number [4n+1], where n is the number of the Interrupt Priority register (n=0 for PRI0, and so on). The lower the value, the greater the priority of the corresponding interrupt. 12:8 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 7:5 INTA R/W 0x0 Interrupt Priority for Interrupt [4n] This field holds a priority value, 0-7, for the interrupt with the number [4n], where n is the number of the Interrupt Priority register (n=0 for PRI0, and so on). The lower the value, the greater the priority of the corresponding interrupt. 4:0 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 121 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 28: Software Trigger Interrupt (SWTRIG), offset 0xF00 Note: Only privileged software can enable unprivileged access to the SWTRIG register. Writing an interrupt number to the SWTRIG register generates a Software Generated Interrupt (SGI). See Table 2-9 on page 83 for interrupt assignments. When the MAINPEND bit in the Configuration and Control (CFGCTRL) register (see page 134) is set, unprivileged software can access the SWTRIG register. Software Trigger Interrupt (SWTRIG) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xF00 Type WO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 INTID Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:6 reserved RO 0x0000.00 5:0 INTID WO 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Interrupt ID This field holds the interrupt ID of the required SGI. For example, a value of 0x3 generates an interrupt on IRQ3. 3.5 System Control Block (SCB) Register Descriptions This section lists and describes the System Control Block (SCB) registers, in numerical order by address offset. The SCB registers can only be accessed from privileged mode. All registers must be accessed with aligned word accesses except for the FAULTSTAT and SYSPRI1-SYSPRI3 registers, which can be accessed with byte or aligned halfword or word accesses. The processor does not support unaligned accesses to system control block registers. 122 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 29: Auxiliary Control (ACTLR), offset 0x008 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The ACTLR register provides disable bits for IT folding, write buffer use for accesses to the default memory map, and interruption of multi-cycle instructions. By default, this register is set to provide optimum performance from the Cortex-M3 processor and does not normally require modification. Auxiliary Control (ACTLR) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 2 1 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 DISFOLD DISWBUF DISMCYC RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:3 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 2 DISFOLD R/W 0 Disable IT Folding Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Disables IT folding. In some situations, the processor can start executing the first instruction in an IT block while it is still executing the IT instruction. This behavior is called IT folding, and improves performance, However, IT folding can cause jitter in looping. If a task must avoid jitter, set the DISFOLD bit before executing the task, to disable IT folding. 1 DISWBUF R/W 0 Disable Write Buffer Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Disables write buffer use during default memory map accesses. In this situation, all bus faults are precise bus faults but performance is decreased because any store to memory must complete before the processor can execute the next instruction. Note: This bit only affects write buffers implemented in the Cortex-M3 processor. January 22, 2012 123 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 DISMCYC R/W 0 Description Disable Interrupts of Multiple Cycle Instructions Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Disables interruption of load multiple and store multiple instructions. In this situation, the interrupt latency of the processor is increased because any LDM or STM must complete before the processor can stack the current state and enter the interrupt handler. 124 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 30: CPU ID Base (CPUID), offset 0xD00 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The CPUID register contains the ARM® Cortex™-M3 processor part number, version, and implementation information. CPU ID Base (CPUID) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD00 Type RO, reset 0x412F.C230 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 IMP Type Reset 21 20 19 18 VAR RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 PARTNO Type Reset RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 17 16 RO 1 RO 1 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 CON REV RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:24 IMP RO 0x41 Implementer Code RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 Value Description 0x41 ARM 23:20 VAR RO 0x2 Variant Number Value Description 0x2 19:16 CON RO 0xF The rn value in the rnpn product revision identifier, for example, the 2 in r2p0. Constant Value Description 0xF 15:4 PARTNO RO 0xC23 Always reads as 0xF. Part Number Value Description 0xC23 Cortex-M3 processor. 3:0 REV RO 0x0 Revision Number Value Description 0x0 The pn value in the rnpn product revision identifier, for example, the 0 in r2p0. January 22, 2012 125 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 31: Interrupt Control and State (INTCTRL), offset 0xD04 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The INCTRL register provides a set-pending bit for the NMI exception, and set-pending and clear-pending bits for the PendSV and SysTick exceptions. In addition, bits in this register indicate the exception number of the exception being processed, whether there are preempted active exceptions, the exception number of the highest priority pending exception, and whether any interrupts are pending. When writing to INCTRL, the effect is unpredictable when writing a 1 to both the PENDSV and UNPENDSV bits, or writing a 1 to both the PENDSTSET and PENDSTCLR bits. Interrupt Control and State (INTCTRL) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD04 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 NMISET Type Reset 30 29 reserved 28 26 25 24 PENDSV UNPENDSV PENDSTSET PENDSTCLR reserved 23 22 21 ISRPRE ISRPEND 20 19 18 reserved 17 16 VECPEND R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 WO 0 R/W 0 WO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 VECPEND Type Reset 27 RO 0 RETBASE RO 0 reserved RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31 NMISET R/W 0 VECACT RO 0 Description NMI Set Pending Value Description 0 On a read, indicates an NMI exception is not pending. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates an NMI exception is pending. On a write, changes the NMI exception state to pending. Because NMI is the highest-priority exception, normally the processor enters the NMI exception handler as soon as it registers the setting of this bit, and clears this bit on entering the interrupt handler. A read of this bit by the NMI exception handler returns 1 only if the NMI signal is reasserted while the processor is executing that handler. 30:29 reserved RO 0x0 28 PENDSV R/W 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PendSV Set Pending Value Description 0 On a read, indicates a PendSV exception is not pending. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates a PendSV exception is pending. On a write, changes the PendSV exception state to pending. Setting this bit is the only way to set the PendSV exception state to pending. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the UNPENDSV bit. 126 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 27 UNPENDSV WO 0 Description PendSV Clear Pending Value Description 0 On a write, no effect. 1 On a write, removes the pending state from the PendSV exception. This bit is write only; on a register read, its value is unknown. 26 PENDSTSET R/W 0 SysTick Set Pending Value Description 0 On a read, indicates a SysTick exception is not pending. On a write, no effect. 1 On a read, indicates a SysTick exception is pending. On a write, changes the SysTick exception state to pending. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the PENDSTCLR bit. 25 PENDSTCLR WO 0 SysTick Clear Pending Value Description 0 On a write, no effect. 1 On a write, removes the pending state from the SysTick exception. This bit is write only; on a register read, its value is unknown. 24 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 23 ISRPRE RO 0 Debug Interrupt Handling Value Description 0 The release from halt does not take an interrupt. 1 The release from halt takes an interrupt. This bit is only meaningful in Debug mode and reads as zero when the processor is not in Debug mode. 22 ISRPEND RO 0 Interrupt Pending Value Description 0 No interrupt is pending. 1 An interrupt is pending. This bit provides status for all interrupts excluding NMI and Faults. 21:19 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 127 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 18:12 VECPEND RO 0x00 Interrupt Pending Vector Number This field contains the exception number of the highest priority pending enabled exception. The value indicated by this field includes the effect of the BASEPRI and FAULTMASK registers, but not any effect of the PRIMASK register. Value Description 0x00 No exceptions are pending 0x01 Reserved 0x02 NMI 0x03 Hard fault 0x04 Memory management fault 0x05 Bus fault 0x06 Usage fault 0x07-0x0A Reserved 0x0B SVCall 0x0C Reserved for Debug 0x0D Reserved 0x0E PendSV 0x0F SysTick 0x10 Interrupt Vector 0 0x11 Interrupt Vector 1 ... ... 0x46 Interrupt Vector 54 0x47-0x7F Reserved 11 RETBASE RO 0 Return to Base Value Description 0 There are preempted active exceptions to execute. 1 There are no active exceptions, or the currently executing exception is the only active exception. This bit provides status for all interrupts excluding NMI and Faults. This bit only has meaning if the processor is currently executing an ISR (the Interrupt Program Status (IPSR) register is non-zero). 10:7 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 6:0 VECACT RO 0x00 Interrupt Pending Vector Number This field contains the active exception number. The exception numbers can be found in the description for the VECPEND field. If this field is clear, the processor is in Thread mode. This field contains the same value as the ISRNUM field in the IPSR register. Subtract 16 from this value to obtain the IRQ number required to index into the Interrupt Set Enable (ENn), Interrupt Clear Enable (DISn), Interrupt Set Pending (PENDn), Interrupt Clear Pending (UNPENDn), and Interrupt Priority (PRIn) registers (see page 64). 128 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 32: Vector Table Offset (VTABLE), offset 0xD08 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The VTABLE register indicates the offset of the vector table base address from memory address 0x0000.0000. Vector Table Offset (VTABLE) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD08 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 reserved Type Reset 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 BASE RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 OFFSET R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 OFFSET Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:30 reserved RO 0x0 29 BASE R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Vector Table Base Value Description 28:9 OFFSET R/W 0x000.00 0 The vector table is in the code memory region. 1 The vector table is in the SRAM memory region. Vector Table Offset When configuring the OFFSET field, the offset must be aligned to the number of exception entries in the vector table. Because there are 54 interrupts, the offset must be aligned on a 512-byte boundary. 8:0 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 129 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 33: Application Interrupt and Reset Control (APINT), offset 0xD0C Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The APINT register provides priority grouping control for the exception model, endian status for data accesses, and reset control of the system. To write to this register, 0x05FA must be written to the VECTKEY field, otherwise the write is ignored. The PRIGROUP field indicates the position of the binary point that splits the INTx fields in the Interrupt Priority (PRIx) registers into separate group priority and subpriority fields. Table 3-8 on page 130 shows how the PRIGROUP value controls this split. The bit numbers in the Group Priority Field and Subpriority Field columns in the table refer to the bits in the INTA field. For the INTB field, the corresponding bits are 15:13; for INTC, 23:21; and for INTD, 31:29. Note: Determining preemption of an exception uses only the group priority field. Table 3-8. Interrupt Priority Levels a PRIGROUP Bit Field Binary Point Group Priority Field Subpriority Field Group Priorities Subpriorities 0x0 - 0x4 bxxx. [7:5] None 8 1 0x5 bxx.y [7:6] [5] 4 2 0x6 bx.yy [7] [6:5] 2 4 0x7 b.yyy None [7:5] 1 8 a. INTx field showing the binary point. An x denotes a group priority field bit, and a y denotes a subpriority field bit. Application Interrupt and Reset Control (APINT) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD0C Type R/W, reset 0xFA05.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 0 R/W 1 5 4 3 2 1 0 VECTKEY Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 reserved ENDIANESS Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 1 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 9 8 7 6 PRIGROUP RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:16 VECTKEY R/W 0xFA05 reserved R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 SYSRESREQ VECTCLRACT VECTRESET RO 0 RO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 Description Register Key This field is used to guard against accidental writes to this register. 0x05FA must be written to this field in order to change the bits in this register. On a read, 0xFA05 is returned. 15 ENDIANESS RO 0 Data Endianess The Stellaris implementation uses only little-endian mode so this is cleared to 0. 14:11 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 130 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 10:8 PRIGROUP R/W 0x0 Description Interrupt Priority Grouping This field determines the split of group priority from subpriority (see Table 3-8 on page 130 for more information). 7:3 reserved RO 0x0 2 SYSRESREQ WO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. System Reset Request Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Resets the core and all on-chip peripherals except the Debug interface. This bit is automatically cleared during the reset of the core and reads as 0. 1 VECTCLRACT WO 0 Clear Active NMI / Fault This bit is reserved for Debug use and reads as 0. This bit must be written as a 0, otherwise behavior is unpredictable. 0 VECTRESET WO 0 System Reset This bit is reserved for Debug use and reads as 0. This bit must be written as a 0, otherwise behavior is unpredictable. January 22, 2012 131 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 34: System Control (SYSCTRL), offset 0xD10 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The SYSCTRL register controls features of entry to and exit from low-power state. System Control (SYSCTRL) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD10 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 2 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 10 9 8 7 6 5 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:5 reserved RO 0x0000.00 4 SEVONPEND R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 4 3 SEVONPEND reserved R/W 0 RO 0 SLEEPDEEP SLEEPEXIT R/W 0 R/W 0 0 reserved RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Wake Up on Pending Value Description 0 Only enabled interrupts or events can wake up the processor; disabled interrupts are excluded. 1 Enabled events and all interrupts, including disabled interrupts, can wake up the processor. When an event or interrupt enters the pending state, the event signal wakes up the processor from WFE. If the processor is not waiting for an event, the event is registered and affects the next WFE. The processor also wakes up on execution of a SEV instruction or an external event. 3 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 2 SLEEPDEEP R/W 0 Deep Sleep Enable Value Description 0 Use Sleep mode as the low power mode. 1 Use Deep-sleep mode as the low power mode. 132 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 1 SLEEPEXIT R/W 0 Description Sleep on ISR Exit Value Description 0 When returning from Handler mode to Thread mode, do not sleep when returning to Thread mode. 1 When returning from Handler mode to Thread mode, enter sleep or deep sleep on return from an ISR. Setting this bit enables an interrupt-driven application to avoid returning to an empty main application. 0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 133 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 35: Configuration and Control (CFGCTRL), offset 0xD14 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The CFGCTRL register controls entry to Thread mode and enables: the handlers for NMI, hard fault and faults escalated by the FAULTMASK register to ignore bus faults; trapping of divide by zero and unaligned accesses; and access to the SWTRIG register by unprivileged software (see page 122). Configuration and Control (CFGCTRL) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD14 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0200 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 6 5 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 8 7 reserved STKALIGN BFHFNMIGN RO 0 RO 0 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:10 reserved RO 0x0000.00 9 STKALIGN R/W 1 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 4 3 2 1 0 DIV0 UNALIGNED reserved MAINPEND BASETHR R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Stack Alignment on Exception Entry Value Description 0 The stack is 4-byte aligned. 1 The stack is 8-byte aligned. On exception entry, the processor uses bit 9 of the stacked PSR to indicate the stack alignment. On return from the exception, it uses this stacked bit to restore the correct stack alignment. 8 BFHFNMIGN R/W 0 Ignore Bus Fault in NMI and Fault This bit enables handlers with priority -1 or -2 to ignore data bus faults caused by load and store instructions. The setting of this bit applies to the hard fault, NMI, and FAULTMASK escalated handlers. Value Description 0 Data bus faults caused by load and store instructions cause a lock-up. 1 Handlers running at priority -1 and -2 ignore data bus faults caused by load and store instructions. Set this bit only when the handler and its data are in absolutely safe memory. The normal use of this bit is to probe system devices and bridges to detect control path problems and fix them. 7:5 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 134 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 4 DIV0 R/W 0 Description Trap on Divide by 0 This bit enables faulting or halting when the processor executes an SDIV or UDIV instruction with a divisor of 0. Value Description 3 UNALIGNED R/W 0 0 Do not trap on divide by 0. A divide by zero returns a quotient of 0. 1 Trap on divide by 0. Trap on Unaligned Access Value Description 0 Do not trap on unaligned halfword and word accesses. 1 Trap on unaligned halfword and word accesses. An unaligned access generates a usage fault. Unaligned LDM, STM, LDRD, and STRD instructions always fault regardless of whether UNALIGNED is set. 2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 1 MAINPEND R/W 0 Allow Main Interrupt Trigger Value Description 0 BASETHR R/W 0 0 Disables unprivileged software access to the SWTRIG register. 1 Enables unprivileged software access to the SWTRIG register (see page 122). Thread State Control Value Description 0 The processor can enter Thread mode only when no exception is active. 1 The processor can enter Thread mode from any level under the control of an EXC_RETURN value (see “Exception Return” on page 88 for more information). January 22, 2012 135 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 36: System Handler Priority 1 (SYSPRI1), offset 0xD18 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The SYSPRI1 register configures the priority level, 0 to 7 of the usage fault, bus fault, and memory management fault exception handlers. This register is byte-accessible. System Handler Priority 1 (SYSPRI1) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD18 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 reserved Type Reset RO 0 15 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 14 13 12 11 BUS Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 10 9 8 7 reserved R/W 0 RO 0 22 21 20 19 USAGE RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 6 5 4 3 MEM RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved reserved R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:24 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 23:21 USAGE R/W 0x0 Usage Fault Priority This field configures the priority level of the usage fault. Configurable priority values are in the range 0-7, with lower values having higher priority. 20:16 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 15:13 BUS R/W 0x0 Bus Fault Priority This field configures the priority level of the bus fault. Configurable priority values are in the range 0-7, with lower values having higher priority. 12:8 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 7:5 MEM R/W 0x0 Memory Management Fault Priority This field configures the priority level of the memory management fault. Configurable priority values are in the range 0-7, with lower values having higher priority. 4:0 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 136 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 37: System Handler Priority 2 (SYSPRI2), offset 0xD1C Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The SYSPRI2 register configures the priority level, 0 to 7 of the SVCall handler. This register is byte-accessible. System Handler Priority 2 (SYSPRI2) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD1C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 SVC Type Reset 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 reserved R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:29 SVC R/W 0x0 RO 0 Description SVCall Priority This field configures the priority level of SVCall. Configurable priority values are in the range 0-7, with lower values having higher priority. 28:0 reserved RO 0x000.0000 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 137 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 38: System Handler Priority 3 (SYSPRI3), offset 0xD20 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The SYSPRI3 register configures the priority level, 0 to 7 of the SysTick exception and PendSV handlers. This register is byte-accessible. System Handler Priority 3 (SYSPRI3) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD20 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 TICK Type Reset 26 25 24 23 reserved R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 22 21 20 19 PENDSV R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 6 5 4 3 DEBUG RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:29 TICK R/W 0x0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved reserved R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description SysTick Exception Priority This field configures the priority level of the SysTick exception. Configurable priority values are in the range 0-7, with lower values having higher priority. 28:24 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 23:21 PENDSV R/W 0x0 PendSV Priority This field configures the priority level of PendSV. Configurable priority values are in the range 0-7, with lower values having higher priority. 20:8 reserved RO 0x000 7:5 DEBUG R/W 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Debug Priority This field configures the priority level of Debug. Configurable priority values are in the range 0-7, with lower values having higher priority. 4:0 reserved RO 0x0.0000 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 138 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 39: System Handler Control and State (SYSHNDCTRL), offset 0xD24 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The SYSHNDCTRL register enables the system handlers, and indicates the pending status of the usage fault, bus fault, memory management fault, and SVC exceptions as well as the active status of the system handlers. If a system handler is disabled and the corresponding fault occurs, the processor treats the fault as a hard fault. This register can be modified to change the pending or active status of system exceptions. An OS kernel can write to the active bits to perform a context switch that changes the current exception type. Caution – Software that changes the value of an active bit in this register without correct adjustment to the stacked content can cause the processor to generate a fault exception. Ensure software that writes to this register retains and subsequently restores the current active status. If the value of a bit in this register must be modified after enabling the system handlers, a read-modify-write procedure must be used to ensure that only the required bit is modified. System Handler Control and State (SYSHNDCTRL) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD24 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 SVC BUSP MEMP USAGEP R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 USAGE BUS MEM R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TICK PNDSV reserved MON SVCA R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 USGA reserved BUSA MEMA R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset Type Reset reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:19 reserved RO 0x000 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 18 USAGE R/W 0 Usage Fault Enable Value Description 17 BUS R/W 0 0 Disables the usage fault exception. 1 Enables the usage fault exception. Bus Fault Enable Value Description 0 Disables the bus fault exception. 1 Enables the bus fault exception. January 22, 2012 139 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset 16 MEM R/W 0 Description Memory Management Fault Enable Value Description 15 SVC R/W 0 0 Disables the memory management fault exception. 1 Enables the memory management fault exception. SVC Call Pending Value Description 0 An SVC call exception is not pending. 1 An SVC call exception is pending. This bit can be modified to change the pending status of the SVC call exception. 14 BUSP R/W 0 Bus Fault Pending Value Description 0 A bus fault exception is not pending. 1 A bus fault exception is pending. This bit can be modified to change the pending status of the bus fault exception. 13 MEMP R/W 0 Memory Management Fault Pending Value Description 0 A memory management fault exception is not pending. 1 A memory management fault exception is pending. This bit can be modified to change the pending status of the memory management fault exception. 12 USAGEP R/W 0 Usage Fault Pending Value Description 0 A usage fault exception is not pending. 1 A usage fault exception is pending. This bit can be modified to change the pending status of the usage fault exception. 11 TICK R/W 0 SysTick Exception Active Value Description 0 A SysTick exception is not active. 1 A SysTick exception is active. This bit can be modified to change the active status of the SysTick exception, however, see the Caution above before setting this bit. 140 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 10 PNDSV R/W 0 Description PendSV Exception Active Value Description 0 A PendSV exception is not active. 1 A PendSV exception is active. This bit can be modified to change the active status of the PendSV exception, however, see the Caution above before setting this bit. 9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 8 MON R/W 0 Debug Monitor Active Value Description 7 SVCA R/W 0 0 The Debug monitor is not active. 1 The Debug monitor is active. SVC Call Active Value Description 0 SVC call is not active. 1 SVC call is active. This bit can be modified to change the active status of the SVC call exception, however, see the Caution above before setting this bit. 6:4 reserved RO 0x0 3 USGA R/W 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Usage Fault Active Value Description 0 Usage fault is not active. 1 Usage fault is active. This bit can be modified to change the active status of the usage fault exception, however, see the Caution above before setting this bit. 2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 1 BUSA R/W 0 Bus Fault Active Value Description 0 Bus fault is not active. 1 Bus fault is active. This bit can be modified to change the active status of the bus fault exception, however, see the Caution above before setting this bit. January 22, 2012 141 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 MEMA R/W 0 Description Memory Management Fault Active Value Description 0 Memory management fault is not active. 1 Memory management fault is active. This bit can be modified to change the active status of the memory management fault exception, however, see the Caution above before setting this bit. 142 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 40: Configurable Fault Status (FAULTSTAT), offset 0xD28 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The FAULTSTAT register indicates the cause of a memory management fault, bus fault, or usage fault. Each of these functions is assigned to a subregister as follows: ■ Usage Fault Status (UFAULTSTAT), bits 31:16 ■ Bus Fault Status (BFAULTSTAT), bits 15:8 ■ Memory Management Fault Status (MFAULTSTAT), bits 7:0 FAULTSTAT is byte accessible. FAULTSTAT or its subregisters can be accessed as follows: ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ The complete FAULTSTAT register, with a word access to offset 0xD28 The MFAULTSTAT, with a byte access to offset 0xD28 The MFAULTSTAT and BFAULTSTAT, with a halfword access to offset 0xD28 The BFAULTSTAT, with a byte access to offset 0xD29 The UFAULTSTAT, with a halfword access to offset 0xD2A Bits are cleared by writing a 1 to them. In a fault handler, the true faulting address can be determined by: 1. Read and save the Memory Management Fault Address (MMADDR) or Bus Fault Address (FAULTADDR) value. 2. Read the MMARV bit in MFAULTSTAT, or the BFARV bit in BFAULTSTAT to determine if the MMADDR or FAULTADDR contents are valid. Software must follow this sequence because another higher priority exception might change the MMADDR or FAULTADDR value. For example, if a higher priority handler preempts the current fault handler, the other fault might change the MMADDR or FAULTADDR value. Configurable Fault Status (FAULTSTAT) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD28 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 BFARV Type Reset R/W1C 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 25 24 DIV0 UNALIGN R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 23 22 21 20 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 6 5 12 11 10 9 8 7 BSTKE BUSTKE IMPRE PRECISE IBUS MMARV R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 NOCP INVPC INVSTAT UNDEF R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 4 3 2 1 0 MSTKE MUSTKE reserved DERR IERR R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 RO 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:26 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 143 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset 25 DIV0 R/W1C 0 Description Divide-by-Zero Usage Fault Value Description 0 No divide-by-zero fault has occurred, or divide-by-zero trapping is not enabled. 1 The processor has executed an SDIV or UDIV instruction with a divisor of 0. When this bit is set, the PC value stacked for the exception return points to the instruction that performed the divide by zero. Trapping on divide-by-zero is enabled by setting the DIV0 bit in the Configuration and Control (CFGCTRL) register (see page 134). This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 24 UNALIGN R/W1C 0 Unaligned Access Usage Fault Value Description 0 No unaligned access fault has occurred, or unaligned access trapping is not enabled. 1 The processor has made an unaligned memory access. Unaligned LDM, STM, LDRD, and STRD instructions always fault regardless of the configuration of this bit. Trapping on unaligned access is enabled by setting the UNALIGNED bit in the CFGCTRL register (see page 134). This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 23:20 reserved RO 0x00 19 NOCP R/W1C 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. No Coprocessor Usage Fault Value Description 0 A usage fault has not been caused by attempting to access a coprocessor. 1 The processor has attempted to access a coprocessor. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 18 INVPC R/W1C 0 Invalid PC Load Usage Fault Value Description 0 A usage fault has not been caused by attempting to load an invalid PC value. 1 The processor has attempted an illegal load of EXC_RETURN to the PC as a result of an invalid context or an invalid EXC_RETURN value. When this bit is set, the PC value stacked for the exception return points to the instruction that tried to perform the illegal load of the PC. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 144 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 17 INVSTAT R/W1C 0 Description Invalid State Usage Fault Value Description 0 A usage fault has not been caused by an invalid state. 1 The processor has attempted to execute an instruction that makes illegal use of the EPSR register. When this bit is set, the PC value stacked for the exception return points to the instruction that attempted the illegal use of the Execution Program Status Register (EPSR) register. This bit is not set if an undefined instruction uses the EPSR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 16 UNDEF R/W1C 0 Undefined Instruction Usage Fault Value Description 0 A usage fault has not been caused by an undefined instruction. 1 The processor has attempted to execute an undefined instruction. When this bit is set, the PC value stacked for the exception return points to the undefined instruction. An undefined instruction is an instruction that the processor cannot decode. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 15 BFARV R/W1C 0 Bus Fault Address Register Valid Value Description 0 The value in the Bus Fault Address (FAULTADDR) register is not a valid fault address. 1 The FAULTADDR register is holding a valid fault address. This bit is set after a bus fault, where the address is known. Other faults can clear this bit, such as a memory management fault occurring later. If a bus fault occurs and is escalated to a hard fault because of priority, the hard fault handler must clear this bit. This action prevents problems if returning to a stacked active bus fault handler whose FAULTADDR register value has been overwritten. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 14:13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 145 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset 12 BSTKE R/W1C 0 Description Stack Bus Fault Value Description 0 No bus fault has occurred on stacking for exception entry. 1 Stacking for an exception entry has caused one or more bus faults. When this bit is set, the SP is still adjusted but the values in the context area on the stack might be incorrect. A fault address is not written to the FAULTADDR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 11 BUSTKE R/W1C 0 Unstack Bus Fault Value Description 0 No bus fault has occurred on unstacking for a return from exception. 1 Unstacking for a return from exception has caused one or more bus faults. This fault is chained to the handler. Thus, when this bit is set, the original return stack is still present. The SP is not adjusted from the failing return, a new save is not performed, and a fault address is not written to the FAULTADDR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 10 IMPRE R/W1C 0 Imprecise Data Bus Error Value Description 0 An imprecise data bus error has not occurred. 1 A data bus error has occurred, but the return address in the stack frame is not related to the instruction that caused the error. When this bit is set, a fault address is not written to the FAULTADDR register. This fault is asynchronous. Therefore, if the fault is detected when the priority of the current process is higher than the bus fault priority, the bus fault becomes pending and becomes active only when the processor returns from all higher-priority processes. If a precise fault occurs before the processor enters the handler for the imprecise bus fault, the handler detects that both the IMPRE bit is set and one of the precise fault status bits is set. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 9 PRECISE R/W1C 0 Precise Data Bus Error Value Description 0 A precise data bus error has not occurred. 1 A data bus error has occurred, and the PC value stacked for the exception return points to the instruction that caused the fault. When this bit is set, the fault address is written to the FAULTADDR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 146 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 8 IBUS R/W1C 0 Description Instruction Bus Error Value Description 0 An instruction bus error has not occurred. 1 An instruction bus error has occurred. The processor detects the instruction bus error on prefetching an instruction, but sets this bit only if it attempts to issue the faulting instruction. When this bit is set, a fault address is not written to the FAULTADDR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 7 MMARV R/W1C 0 Memory Management Fault Address Register Valid Value Description 0 The value in the Memory Management Fault Address (MMADDR) register is not a valid fault address. 1 The MMADDR register is holding a valid fault address. If a memory management fault occurs and is escalated to a hard fault because of priority, the hard fault handler must clear this bit. This action prevents problems if returning to a stacked active memory management fault handler whose MMADDR register value has been overwritten. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 6:5 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 4 MSTKE R/W1C 0 Stack Access Violation Value Description 0 No memory management fault has occurred on stacking for exception entry. 1 Stacking for an exception entry has caused one or more access violations. When this bit is set, the SP is still adjusted but the values in the context area on the stack might be incorrect. A fault address is not written to the MMADDR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. January 22, 2012 147 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset 3 MUSTKE R/W1C 0 Description Unstack Access Violation Value Description 0 No memory management fault has occurred on unstacking for a return from exception. 1 Unstacking for a return from exception has caused one or more access violations. This fault is chained to the handler. Thus, when this bit is set, the original return stack is still present. The SP is not adjusted from the failing return, a new save is not performed, and a fault address is not written to the MMADDR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 1 DERR R/W1C 0 Data Access Violation Value Description 0 A data access violation has not occurred. 1 The processor attempted a load or store at a location that does not permit the operation. When this bit is set, the PC value stacked for the exception return points to the faulting instruction and the address of the attempted access is written to the MMADDR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 0 IERR R/W1C 0 Instruction Access Violation Value Description 0 An instruction access violation has not occurred. 1 The processor attempted an instruction fetch from a location that does not permit execution. This fault occurs on any access to an XN region, even when the MPU is disabled or not present. When this bit is set, the PC value stacked for the exception return points to the faulting instruction and the address of the attempted access is not written to the MMADDR register. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 148 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 41: Hard Fault Status (HFAULTSTAT), offset 0xD2C Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The HFAULTSTAT register gives information about events that activate the hard fault handler. Bits are cleared by writing a 1 to them. Hard Fault Status (HFAULTSTAT) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD2C Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 Type Reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 DBG FORCED R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 VECT reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W1C 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31 DBG R/W1C 0 Description Debug Event This bit is reserved for Debug use. This bit must be written as a 0, otherwise behavior is unpredictable. 30 FORCED R/W1C 0 Forced Hard Fault Value Description 0 No forced hard fault has occurred. 1 A forced hard fault has been generated by escalation of a fault with configurable priority that cannot be handled, either because of priority or because it is disabled. When this bit is set, the hard fault handler must read the other fault status registers to find the cause of the fault. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 29:2 reserved RO 0x00 1 VECT R/W1C 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Vector Table Read Fault Value Description 0 No bus fault has occurred on a vector table read. 1 A bus fault occurred on a vector table read. This error is always handled by the hard fault handler. When this bit is set, the PC value stacked for the exception return points to the instruction that was preempted by the exception. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. 0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 149 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 42: Memory Management Fault Address (MMADDR), offset 0xD34 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The MMADDR register contains the address of the location that generated a memory management fault. When an unaligned access faults, the address in the MMADDR register is the actual address that faulted. Because a single read or write instruction can be split into multiple aligned accesses, the fault address can be any address in the range of the requested access size. Bits in the Memory Management Fault Status (MFAULTSTAT) register indicate the cause of the fault and whether the value in the MMADDR register is valid (see page 143). Memory Management Fault Address (MMADDR) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD34 Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - ADDR Type Reset R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ADDR Type Reset R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 ADDR R/W - R/W - Description Fault Address When the MMARV bit of MFAULTSTAT is set, this field holds the address of the location that generated the memory management fault. 150 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 43: Bus Fault Address (FAULTADDR), offset 0xD38 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The FAULTADDR register contains the address of the location that generated a bus fault. When an unaligned access faults, the address in the FAULTADDR register is the one requested by the instruction, even if it is not the address of the fault. Bits in the Bus Fault Status (BFAULTSTAT) register indicate the cause of the fault and whether the value in the FAULTADDR register is valid (see page 143). Bus Fault Address (FAULTADDR) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD38 Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - ADDR Type Reset R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ADDR Type Reset R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 ADDR R/W - R/W - Description Fault Address When the FAULTADDRV bit of BFAULTSTAT is set, this field holds the address of the location that generated the bus fault. 3.6 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) Register Descriptions This section lists and describes the Memory Protection Unit (MPU) registers, in numerical order by address offset. The MPU registers can only be accessed from privileged mode. January 22, 2012 151 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 44: MPU Type (MPUTYPE), offset 0xD90 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The MPUTYPE register indicates whether the MPU is present, and if so, how many regions it supports. MPU Type (MPUTYPE) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD90 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0800 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 DREGION Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 RO 0 IREGION RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 4 3 2 1 reserved RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 0 SEPARATE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:24 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 23:16 IREGION RO 0x00 Number of I Regions This field indicates the number of supported MPU instruction regions. This field always contains 0x00. The MPU memory map is unified and is described by the DREGION field. 15:8 DREGION RO 0x08 Number of D Regions Value Description 0x08 Indicates there are eight supported MPU data regions. 7:1 reserved RO 0x00 0 SEPARATE RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Separate or Unified MPU Value Description 0 Indicates the MPU is unified. 152 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 45: MPU Control (MPUCTRL), offset 0xD94 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The MPUCTRL register enables the MPU, enables the default memory map background region, and enables use of the MPU when in the hard fault, Non-maskable Interrupt (NMI), and Fault Mask Register (FAULTMASK) escalated handlers. When the ENABLE and PRIVDEFEN bits are both set: ■ For privileged accesses, the default memory map is as described in “Memory Model” on page 72. Any access by privileged software that does not address an enabled memory region behaves as defined by the default memory map. ■ Any access by unprivileged software that does not address an enabled memory region causes a memory management fault. Execute Never (XN) and Strongly Ordered rules always apply to the System Control Space regardless of the value of the ENABLE bit. When the ENABLE bit is set, at least one region of the memory map must be enabled for the system to function unless the PRIVDEFEN bit is set. If the PRIVDEFEN bit is set and no regions are enabled, then only privileged software can operate. When the ENABLE bit is clear, the system uses the default memory map, which has the same memory attributes as if the MPU is not implemented (see Table 2-5 on page 75 for more information). The default memory map applies to accesses from both privileged and unprivileged software. When the MPU is enabled, accesses to the System Control Space and vector table are always permitted. Other areas are accessible based on regions and whether PRIVDEFEN is set. Unless HFNMIENA is set, the MPU is not enabled when the processor is executing the handler for an exception with priority –1 or –2. These priorities are only possible when handling a hard fault or NMI exception or when FAULTMASK is enabled. Setting the HFNMIENA bit enables the MPU when operating with these two priorities. MPU Control (MPUCTRL) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD94 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:3 reserved RO 0x0000.000 PRIVDEFEN HFNMIENA R/W 0 R/W 0 ENABLE R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 153 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset 2 PRIVDEFEN R/W 0 Description MPU Default Region This bit enables privileged software access to the default memory map. Value Description 0 If the MPU is enabled, this bit disables use of the default memory map. Any memory access to a location not covered by any enabled region causes a fault. 1 If the MPU is enabled, this bit enables use of the default memory map as a background region for privileged software accesses. When this bit is set, the background region acts as if it is region number -1. Any region that is defined and enabled has priority over this default map. If the MPU is disabled, the processor ignores this bit. 1 HFNMIENA R/W 0 MPU Enabled During Faults This bit controls the operation of the MPU during hard fault, NMI, and FAULTMASK handlers. Value Description 0 The MPU is disabled during hard fault, NMI, and FAULTMASK handlers, regardless of the value of the ENABLE bit. 1 The MPU is enabled during hard fault, NMI, and FAULTMASK handlers. When the MPU is disabled and this bit is set, the resulting behavior is unpredictable. 0 ENABLE R/W 0 MPU Enable Value Description 0 The MPU is disabled. 1 The MPU is enabled. When the MPU is disabled and the HFNMIENA bit is set, the resulting behavior is unpredictable. 154 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 46: MPU Region Number (MPUNUMBER), offset 0xD98 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The MPUNUMBER register selects which memory region is referenced by the MPU Region Base Address (MPUBASE) and MPU Region Attribute and Size (MPUATTR) registers. Normally, the required region number should be written to this register before accessing the MPUBASE or the MPUATTR register. However, the region number can be changed by writing to the MPUBASE register with the VALID bit set (see page 156). This write updates the value of the REGION field. MPU Region Number (MPUNUMBER) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD98 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 1 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:3 reserved RO 0x0000.000 2:0 NUMBER R/W 0x0 NUMBER RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. MPU Region to Access This field indicates the MPU region referenced by the MPUBASE and MPUATTR registers. The MPU supports eight memory regions. January 22, 2012 155 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 47: MPU Region Base Address (MPUBASE), offset 0xD9C Register 48: MPU Region Base Address Alias 1 (MPUBASE1), offset 0xDA4 Register 49: MPU Region Base Address Alias 2 (MPUBASE2), offset 0xDAC Register 50: MPU Region Base Address Alias 3 (MPUBASE3), offset 0xDB4 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The MPUBASE register defines the base address of the MPU region selected by the MPU Region Number (MPUNUMBER) register and can update the value of the MPUNUMBER register. To change the current region number and update the MPUNUMBER register, write the MPUBASE register with the VALID bit set. The ADDR field is bits 31:N of the MPUBASE register. Bits (N-1):5 are reserved. The region size, as specified by the SIZE field in the MPU Region Attribute and Size (MPUATTR) register, defines the value of N where: N = Log2(Region size in bytes) If the region size is configured to 4 GB in the MPUATTR register, there is no valid ADDR field. In this case, the region occupies the complete memory map, and the base address is 0x0000.0000. The base address is aligned to the size of the region. For example, a 64-KB region must be aligned on a multiple of 64 KB, for example, at 0x0001.0000 or 0x0002.0000. MPU Region Base Address (MPUBASE) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xD9C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 VALID reserved WO 0 RO 0 ADDR Type Reset ADDR Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:5 ADDR R/W 0x0000.000 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 REGION R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Base Address Mask Bits 31:N in this field contain the region base address. The value of N depends on the region size, as shown above. The remaining bits (N-1):5 are reserved. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 156 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 4 VALID WO 0 Description Region Number Valid Value Description 0 The MPUNUMBER register is not changed and the processor updates the base address for the region specified in the MPUNUMBER register and ignores the value of the REGION field. 1 The MPUNUMBER register is updated with the value of the REGION field and the base address is updated for the region specified in the REGION field. This bit is always read as 0. 3 reserved RO 0 2:0 REGION R/W 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Region Number On a write, contains the value to be written to the MPUNUMBER register. On a read, returns the current region number in the MPUNUMBER register. January 22, 2012 157 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Register 51: MPU Region Attribute and Size (MPUATTR), offset 0xDA0 Register 52: MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 1 (MPUATTR1), offset 0xDA8 Register 53: MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 2 (MPUATTR2), offset 0xDB0 Register 54: MPU Region Attribute and Size Alias 3 (MPUATTR3), offset 0xDB8 Note: This register can only be accessed from privileged mode. The MPUATTR register defines the region size and memory attributes of the MPU region specified by the MPU Region Number (MPUNUMBER) register and enables that region and any subregions. The MPUATTR register is accessible using word or halfword accesses with the most-significant halfword holding the region attributes and the least-significant halfword holds the region size and the region and subregion enable bits. The MPU access permission attribute bits, XN, AP, TEX, S, C, and B, control access to the corresponding memory region. If an access is made to an area of memory without the required permissions, then the MPU generates a permission fault. The SIZE field defines the size of the MPU memory region specified by the MPUNUMBER register as follows: (Region size in bytes) = 2(SIZE+1) The smallest permitted region size is 32 bytes, corresponding to a SIZE value of 4. Table 3-9 on page 158 gives example SIZE values with the corresponding region size and value of N in the MPU Region Base Address (MPUBASE) register. Table 3-9. Example SIZE Field Values a SIZE Encoding Region Size Value of N Note 00100b (0x4) 32 B 5 Minimum permitted size 01001b (0x9) 1 KB 10 - 10011b (0x13) 1 MB 20 - 11101b (0x1D) 1 GB 30 - 11111b (0x1F) 4 GB No valid ADDR field in MPUBASE; the Maximum possible size region occupies the complete memory map. a. Refers to the N parameter in the MPUBASE register (see page 156). MPU Region Attribute and Size (MPUATTR) Base 0xE000.E000 Offset 0xDA0 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 reserved Type Reset 26 25 24 23 AP 21 reserved 20 19 18 TEX 17 16 XN reserved S C B RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 SRD Type Reset 22 reserved SIZE 158 R/W 0 ENABLE R/W 0 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:29 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 28 XN R/W 0 Instruction Access Disable Value Description 0 Instruction fetches are enabled. 1 Instruction fetches are disabled. 27 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 26:24 AP R/W 0 Access Privilege For information on using this bit field, see Table 3-5 on page 102. 23:22 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 21:19 TEX R/W 0x0 Type Extension Mask For information on using this bit field, see Table 3-3 on page 101. 18 S R/W 0 Shareable For information on using this bit, see Table 3-3 on page 101. 17 C R/W 0 Cacheable For information on using this bit, see Table 3-3 on page 101. 16 B R/W 0 Bufferable For information on using this bit, see Table 3-3 on page 101. 15:8 SRD R/W 0x00 Subregion Disable Bits Value Description 0 The corresponding subregion is enabled. 1 The corresponding subregion is disabled. Region sizes of 128 bytes and less do not support subregions. When writing the attributes for such a region, configure the SRD field as 0x00. See the section called “Subregions” on page 100 for more information. 7:6 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 5:1 SIZE R/W 0x0 Region Size Mask The SIZE field defines the size of the MPU memory region specified by the MPUNUMBER register. Refer to Table 3-9 on page 158 for more information. January 22, 2012 159 Texas Instruments-Production Data Cortex-M3 Peripherals Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 ENABLE R/W 0 Description Region Enable Value Description 0 The region is disabled. 1 The region is enabled. 160 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 4 JTAG Interface The Joint Test Action Group (JTAG) port is an IEEE standard that defines a Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture for digital integrated circuits and provides a standardized serial interface for controlling the associated test logic. The TAP, Instruction Register (IR), and Data Registers (DR) can be used to test the interconnections of assembled printed circuit boards and obtain manufacturing information on the components. The JTAG Port also provides a means of accessing and controlling design-for-test features such as I/O pin observation and control, scan testing, and debugging. The JTAG port is comprised of four pins: TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO. Data is transmitted serially into the controller on TDI and out of the controller on TDO. The interpretation of this data is dependent on the current state of the TAP controller. For detailed information on the operation of the JTAG port and TAP controller, please refer to the IEEE Standard 1149.1-Test Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture. ® The Stellaris JTAG controller works with the ARM JTAG controller built into the Cortex-M3 core by multiplexing the TDO outputs from both JTAG controllers. ARM JTAG instructions select the ARM TDO output while Stellaris JTAG instructions select the Stellaris TDO output. The multiplexer is controlled by the Stellaris JTAG controller, which has comprehensive programming for the ARM, Stellaris, and unimplemented JTAG instructions. The Stellaris JTAG module has the following features: ■ IEEE 1149.1-1990 compatible Test Access Port (TAP) controller ■ Four-bit Instruction Register (IR) chain for storing JTAG instructions ■ IEEE standard instructions: BYPASS, IDCODE, SAMPLE/PRELOAD, EXTEST and INTEST ■ ARM additional instructions: APACC, DPACC and ABORT ■ Integrated ARM Serial Wire Debug (SWD) – Serial Wire JTAG Debug Port (SWJ-DP) – Flash Patch and Breakpoint (FPB) unit for implementing breakpoints – Data Watchpoint and Trace (DWT) unit for implementing watchpoints, trigger resources, and system profiling – Instrumentation Trace Macrocell (ITM) for support of printf style debugging – Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) for bridging to a Trace Port Analyzer See the ARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification for more information on the ARM JTAG controller. January 22, 2012 161 Texas Instruments-Production Data JTAG Interface 4.1 Block Diagram Figure 4-1. JTAG Module Block Diagram TCK TMS TAP Controller TDI Instruction Register (IR) BYPASS Data Register TDO Boundary Scan Data Register IDCODE Data Register ABORT Data Register DPACC Data Register APACC Data Register Cortex-M3 Debug Port 4.2 Signal Description The following table lists the external signals of the JTAG/SWD controller and describes the function of each. The JTAG/SWD controller signals are alternate functions for some GPIO signals, however note that the reset state of the pins is for the JTAG/SWD function. The JTAG/SWD controller signals are under commit protection and require a special process to be configured as GPIOs, see “Commit Control” on page 407. The column in the table below titled "Pin Mux/Pin Assignment" lists the GPIO pin placement for the JTAG/SWD controller signals. The AFSEL bit in the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (page 423) is set to choose the JTAG/SWD function. The number in parentheses is the encoding that must be programmed into the PMCn field in the GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL) register (page 441) to assign the JTAG/SWD controller signals to the specified GPIO port pin. For more information on configuring GPIOs, see “General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs)” on page 399. Table 4-1. JTAG_SWD_SWO Signals (100LQFP) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment a Pin Type Buffer Type Description SWCLK 80 PC0 (3) I TTL JTAG/SWD CLK. SWDIO 79 PC1 (3) I/O TTL JTAG TMS and SWDIO. SWO 77 PC3 (3) O TTL JTAG TDO and SWO. TCK 80 PC0 (3) I TTL JTAG/SWD CLK. TDI 78 PC2 (3) I TTL JTAG TDI. TDO 77 PC3 (3) O TTL JTAG TDO and SWO. 162 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 4-1. JTAG_SWD_SWO Signals (100LQFP) (continued) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment 79 TMS a Pin Type Buffer Type I TTL PC1 (3) Description JTAG TMS and SWDIO. a. The TTL designation indicates the pin has TTL-compatible voltage levels. Table 4-2. JTAG_SWD_SWO Signals (108BGA) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment a Pin Type Buffer Type Description A9 PC0 (3) I TTL JTAG/SWD CLK. SWDIO B9 PC1 (3) I/O TTL JTAG TMS and SWDIO. SWO A10 PC3 (3) O TTL JTAG TDO and SWO. TCK A9 PC0 (3) I TTL JTAG/SWD CLK. SWCLK TDI B8 PC2 (3) I TTL JTAG TDI. TDO A10 PC3 (3) O TTL JTAG TDO and SWO. TMS B9 PC1 (3) I TTL JTAG TMS and SWDIO. a. The TTL designation indicates the pin has TTL-compatible voltage levels. 4.3 Functional Description A high-level conceptual drawing of the JTAG module is shown in Figure 4-1 on page 162. The JTAG module is composed of the Test Access Port (TAP) controller and serial shift chains with parallel update registers. The TAP controller is a simple state machine controlled by the TCK and TMS inputs. The current state of the TAP controller depends on the sequence of values captured on TMS at the rising edge of TCK. The TAP controller determines when the serial shift chains capture new data, shift data from TDI towards TDO, and update the parallel load registers. The current state of the TAP controller also determines whether the Instruction Register (IR) chain or one of the Data Register (DR) chains is being accessed. The serial shift chains with parallel load registers are comprised of a single Instruction Register (IR) chain and multiple Data Register (DR) chains. The current instruction loaded in the parallel load register determines which DR chain is captured, shifted, or updated during the sequencing of the TAP controller. Some instructions, like EXTEST and INTEST, operate on data currently in a DR chain and do not capture, shift, or update any of the chains. Instructions that are not implemented decode to the BYPASS instruction to ensure that the serial path between TDI and TDO is always connected (see Table 4-4 on page 169 for a list of implemented instructions). See “JTAG and Boundary Scan” on page 895 for JTAG timing diagrams. Note: 4.3.1 Of all the possible reset sources, only Power-On reset (POR) and the assertion of the RST input have any effect on the JTAG module. The pin configurations are reset by both the RST input and POR, whereas the internal JTAG logic is only reset with POR. See “Reset Sources” on page 174 for more information on reset. JTAG Interface Pins The JTAG interface consists of four standard pins: TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO. These pins and their associated state after a power-on reset or reset caused by the RST input are given in Table 4-3. Detailed information on each pin follows. Refer to “General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs)” on page 399 for information on how to reprogram the configuration of these pins. January 22, 2012 163 Texas Instruments-Production Data JTAG Interface Table 4-3. JTAG Port Pins State after Power-On Reset or RST assertion 4.3.1.1 Pin Name Data Direction Internal Pull-Up Internal Pull-Down Drive Strength Drive Value TCK Input Enabled Disabled N/A N/A TMS Input Enabled Disabled N/A N/A TDI Input Enabled Disabled N/A N/A TDO Output Enabled Disabled 2-mA driver High-Z Test Clock Input (TCK) The TCK pin is the clock for the JTAG module. This clock is provided so the test logic can operate independently of any other system clocks and to ensure that multiple JTAG TAP controllers that are daisy-chained together can synchronously communicate serial test data between components. During normal operation, TCK is driven by a free-running clock with a nominal 50% duty cycle. When necessary, TCK can be stopped at 0 or 1 for extended periods of time. While TCK is stopped at 0 or 1, the state of the TAP controller does not change and data in the JTAG Instruction and Data Registers is not lost. By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TCK pin is enabled after reset, assuring that no clocking occurs if the pin is not driven from an external source. The internal pull-up and pull-down resistors can be turned off to save internal power as long as the TCK pin is constantly being driven by an external source (see page 429 and page 431). 4.3.1.2 Test Mode Select (TMS) The TMS pin selects the next state of the JTAG TAP controller. TMS is sampled on the rising edge of TCK. Depending on the current TAP state and the sampled value of TMS, the next state may be entered. Because the TMS pin is sampled on the rising edge of TCK, the IEEE Standard 1149.1 expects the value on TMS to change on the falling edge of TCK. Holding TMS high for five consecutive TCK cycles drives the TAP controller state machine to the Test-Logic-Reset state. When the TAP controller enters the Test-Logic-Reset state, the JTAG module and associated registers are reset to their default values. This procedure should be performed to initialize the JTAG controller. The JTAG Test Access Port state machine can be seen in its entirety in Figure 4-2 on page 165. By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TMS pin is enabled after reset. Changes to the pull-up resistor settings on GPIO Port C should ensure that the internal pull-up resistor remains enabled on PC1/TMS; otherwise JTAG communication could be lost (see page 429). 4.3.1.3 Test Data Input (TDI) The TDI pin provides a stream of serial information to the IR chain and the DR chains. TDI is sampled on the rising edge of TCK and, depending on the current TAP state and the current instruction, may present this data to the proper shift register chain. Because the TDI pin is sampled on the rising edge of TCK, the IEEE Standard 1149.1 expects the value on TDI to change on the falling edge of TCK. By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TDI pin is enabled after reset. Changes to the pull-up resistor settings on GPIO Port C should ensure that the internal pull-up resistor remains enabled on PC2/TDI; otherwise JTAG communication could be lost (see page 429). 4.3.1.4 Test Data Output (TDO) The TDO pin provides an output stream of serial information from the IR chain or the DR chains. The value of TDO depends on the current TAP state, the current instruction, and the data in the 164 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller chain being accessed. In order to save power when the JTAG port is not being used, the TDO pin is placed in an inactive drive state when not actively shifting out data. Because TDO can be connected to the TDI of another controller in a daisy-chain configuration, the IEEE Standard 1149.1 expects the value on TDO to change on the falling edge of TCK. By default, the internal pull-up resistor on the TDO pin is enabled after reset, assuring that the pin remains at a constant logic level when the JTAG port is not being used. The internal pull-up and pull-down resistors can be turned off to save internal power if a High-Z output value is acceptable during certain TAP controller states (see page 429 and page 431). 4.3.2 JTAG TAP Controller The JTAG TAP controller state machine is shown in Figure 4-2. The TAP controller state machine is reset to the Test-Logic-Reset state on the assertion of a Power-On-Reset (POR). In order to reset the JTAG module after the microcontroller has been powered on, the TMS input must be held HIGH for five TCK clock cycles, resetting the TAP controller and all associated JTAG chains. Asserting the correct sequence on the TMS pin allows the JTAG module to shift in new instructions, shift in data, or idle during extended testing sequences. For detailed information on the function of the TAP controller and the operations that occur in each state, please refer to IEEE Standard 1149.1. Figure 4-2. Test Access Port State Machine Test Logic Reset 1 0 Run Test Idle 0 Select DR Scan 1 Select IR Scan 1 0 1 Capture DR 1 Capture IR 0 0 Shift DR Shift IR 0 1 Exit 1 DR Exit 1 IR 1 Pause IR 0 1 Exit 2 DR 0 1 0 Exit 2 IR 1 1 Update DR 4.3.3 1 0 Pause DR 1 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 Update IR 1 0 Shift Registers The Shift Registers consist of a serial shift register chain and a parallel load register. The serial shift register chain samples specific information during the TAP controller’s CAPTURE states and allows January 22, 2012 165 Texas Instruments-Production Data JTAG Interface this information to be shifted out on TDO during the TAP controller’s SHIFT states. While the sampled data is being shifted out of the chain on TDO, new data is being shifted into the serial shift register on TDI. This new data is stored in the parallel load register during the TAP controller’s UPDATE states. Each of the shift registers is discussed in detail in “Register Descriptions” on page 169. 4.3.4 Operational Considerations Certain operational parameters must be considered when using the JTAG module. Because the JTAG pins can be programmed to be GPIOs, board configuration and reset conditions on these pins must be considered. In addition, because the JTAG module has integrated ARM Serial Wire Debug, the method for switching between these two operational modes is described below. 4.3.4.1 GPIO Functionality When the microcontroller is reset with either a POR or RST, the JTAG/SWD port pins default to their JTAG/SWD configurations. The default configuration includes enabling digital functionality (DEN[3:0] set in the Port C GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register), enabling the pull-up resistors (PUE[3:0] set in the Port C GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR) register), disabling the pull-down resistors (PDE[3:0] cleared in the Port C GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register) and enabling the alternate hardware function (AFSEL[3:0] set in the Port C GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register) on the JTAG/SWD pins. See page 423, page 429, page 431, and page 434. It is possible for software to configure these pins as GPIOs after reset by clearing AFSEL[3:0] in the Port C GPIOAFSEL register. If the user does not require the JTAG/SWD port for debugging or board-level testing, this provides four more GPIOs for use in the design. Caution – It is possible to create a software sequence that prevents the debugger from connecting to the Stellaris microcontroller. If the program code loaded into flash immediately changes the JTAG pins to their GPIO functionality, the debugger may not have enough time to connect and halt the controller before the JTAG pin functionality switches. As a result, the debugger may be locked out of the part. This issue can be avoided with a software routine that restores JTAG functionality based on an external or software trigger. The GPIO commit control registers provide a layer of protection against accidental programming of critical hardware peripherals. Protection is provided for the NMI pin (PB7) and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PC[3:0]). Writes to protected bits of the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (see page 423), GPIO Pull Up Select (GPIOPUR) register (see page 429), GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register (see page 431), and GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register (see page 434) are not committed to storage unless the GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK) register (see page 436) has been unlocked and the appropriate bits of the GPIO Commit (GPIOCR) register (see page 437) have been set. 4.3.4.2 Communication with JTAG/SWD Because the debug clock and the system clock can be running at different frequencies, care must be taken to maintain reliable communication with the JTAG/SWD interface. In the Capture-DR state, the result of the previous transaction, if any, is returned, together with a 3-bit ACK response. Software should check the ACK response to see if the previous operation has completed before initiating a new transaction. Alternatively, if the system clock is at least 8 times faster than the debug clock (TCK or SWCLK), the previous operation has enough time to complete and the ACK bits do not have to be checked. 166 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 4.3.4.3 Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller Note: Performing the sequence below restores the non-volatile registers discussed in “Non-Volatile Register Programming” on page 301 to their factory default values. The mass erase of the Flash memory caused by the sequence below occurs prior to the non-volatile registers being restored. If software configures any of the JTAG/SWD pins as GPIO and loses the ability to communicate with the debugger, there is a debug port unlock sequence that can be used to recover the microcontroller. Performing a total of ten JTAG-to-SWD and SWD-to-JTAG switch sequences while holding the microcontroller in reset mass erases the Flash memory. The debug port unlock sequence is: 1. Assert and hold the RST signal. 2. Apply power to the device. 3. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the JTAG-to-SWD switch sequence on the section called “JTAG-to-SWD Switching” on page 168. 4. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the SWD-to-JTAG switch sequence on the section called “SWD-to-JTAG Switching” on page 168. 5. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the JTAG-to-SWD switch sequence. 6. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the SWD-to-JTAG switch sequence. 7. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the JTAG-to-SWD switch sequence. 8. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the SWD-to-JTAG switch sequence. 9. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the JTAG-to-SWD switch sequence. 10. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the SWD-to-JTAG switch sequence. 11. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the JTAG-to-SWD switch sequence. 12. Perform steps 1 and 2 of the SWD-to-JTAG switch sequence. 13. Release the RST signal. 14. Wait 400 ms. 15. Power-cycle the microcontroller. 4.3.4.4 ARM Serial Wire Debug (SWD) In order to seamlessly integrate the ARM Serial Wire Debug (SWD) functionality, a serial-wire debugger must be able to connect to the Cortex-M3 core without having to perform, or have any knowledge of, JTAG cycles. This integration is accomplished with a SWD preamble that is issued before the SWD session begins. The switching preamble used to enable the SWD interface of the SWJ-DP module starts with the TAP controller in the Test-Logic-Reset state. From here, the preamble sequences the TAP controller through the following states: Run Test Idle, Select DR, Select IR, Test Logic Reset, Test Logic Reset, Run Test Idle, Run Test Idle, Select DR, Select IR, Test Logic Reset, Test Logic Reset, Run Test Idle, Run Test Idle, Select DR, Select IR, and Test Logic Reset states. January 22, 2012 167 Texas Instruments-Production Data JTAG Interface Stepping through this sequence of the TAP state machine enables the SWD interface and disables the JTAG interface. For more information on this operation and the SWD interface, see the ARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification. Because this sequence is a valid series of JTAG operations that could be issued, the ARM JTAG TAP controller is not fully compliant to the IEEE Standard 1149.1. This instance is the only one where the ARM JTAG TAP controller does not meet full compliance with the specification. Due to the low probability of this sequence occurring during normal operation of the TAP controller, it should not affect normal performance of the JTAG interface. JTAG-to-SWD Switching To switch the operating mode of the Debug Access Port (DAP) from JTAG to SWD mode, the external debug hardware must send the switching preamble to the microcontroller. The 16-bit TMS command for switching to SWD mode is defined as b1110.0111.1001.1110, transmitted LSB first. This command can also be represented as 0xE79E when transmitted LSB first. The complete switch sequence should consist of the following transactions on the TCK/SWCLK and TMS/SWDIO signals: 1. Send at least 50 TCK/SWCLK cycles with TMS/SWDIO High to ensure that both JTAG and SWD are in their reset/idle states. 2. Send the 16-bit JTAG-to-SWD switch command, 0xE79E, on TMS. 3. Send at least 50 TCK/SWCLK cycles with TMS/SWDIO High to ensure that if SWJ-DP was already in SWD mode, the SWD goes into the line reset state before sending the switch sequence. SWD-to-JTAG Switching To switch the operating mode of the Debug Access Port (DAP) from SWD to JTAG mode, the external debug hardware must send a switch command to the microcontroller. The 16-bit TMS command for switching to JTAG mode is defined as b1110.0111.0011.1100, transmitted LSB first. This command can also be represented as 0xE73C when transmitted LSB first. The complete switch sequence should consist of the following transactions on the TCK/SWCLK and TMS/SWDIO signals: 1. Send at least 50 TCK/SWCLK cycles with TMS/SWDIO High to ensure that both JTAG and SWD are in their reset/idle states. 2. Send the 16-bit SWD-to-JTAG switch command, 0xE73C, on TMS. 3. Send at least 50 TCK/SWCLK cycles with TMS/SWDIO High to ensure that if SWJ-DP was already in JTAG mode, the JTAG goes into the Test Logic Reset state before sending the switch sequence. 4.4 Initialization and Configuration After a Power-On-Reset or an external reset (RST), the JTAG pins are automatically configured for JTAG communication. No user-defined initialization or configuration is needed. However, if the user application changes these pins to their GPIO function, they must be configured back to their JTAG functionality before JTAG communication can be restored. To return the pins to their JTAG functions, enable the four JTAG pins (PC[3:0]) for their alternate function using the GPIOAFSEL register. In addition to enabling the alternate functions, any other changes to the GPIO pad configurations on the four JTAG pins (PC[3:0]) should be returned to their default settings. 168 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 4.5 Register Descriptions The registers in the JTAG TAP Controller or Shift Register chains are not memory mapped and are not accessible through the on-chip Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). Instead, the registers within the JTAG controller are all accessed serially through the TAP Controller. These registers include the Instruction Register and the six Data Registers. 4.5.1 Instruction Register (IR) The JTAG TAP Instruction Register (IR) is a four-bit serial scan chain connected between the JTAG TDI and TDO pins with a parallel load register. When the TAP Controller is placed in the correct states, bits can be shifted into the IR. Once these bits have been shifted into the chain and updated, they are interpreted as the current instruction. The decode of the IR bits is shown in Table 4-4. A detailed explanation of each instruction, along with its associated Data Register, follows. Table 4-4. JTAG Instruction Register Commands 4.5.1.1 IR[3:0] Instruction Description 0x0 EXTEST Drives the values preloaded into the Boundary Scan Chain by the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction onto the pads. 0x1 INTEST Drives the values preloaded into the Boundary Scan Chain by the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction into the controller. 0x2 SAMPLE / PRELOAD 0x8 ABORT Shifts data into the ARM Debug Port Abort Register. 0xA DPACC Shifts data into and out of the ARM DP Access Register. 0xB APACC Shifts data into and out of the ARM AC Access Register. 0xE IDCODE Loads manufacturing information defined by the IEEE Standard 1149.1 into the IDCODE chain and shifts it out. 0xF BYPASS Connects TDI to TDO through a single Shift Register chain. All Others Reserved Defaults to the BYPASS instruction to ensure that TDI is always connected to TDO. Captures the current I/O values and shifts the sampled values out of the Boundary Scan Chain while new preload data is shifted in. EXTEST Instruction The EXTEST instruction is not associated with its own Data Register chain. Instead, the EXTEST instruction uses the data that has been preloaded into the Boundary Scan Data Register using the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction. When the EXTEST instruction is present in the Instruction Register, the preloaded data in the Boundary Scan Data Register associated with the outputs and output enables are used to drive the GPIO pads rather than the signals coming from the core. With tests that drive known values out of the controller, this instruction can be used to verify connectivity. While the EXTEST instruction is present in the Instruction Register, the Boundary Scan Data Register can be accessed to sample and shift out the current data and load new data into the Boundary Scan Data Register. 4.5.1.2 INTEST Instruction The INTEST instruction is not associated with its own Data Register chain. Instead, the INTEST instruction uses the data that has been preloaded into the Boundary Scan Data Register using the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction. When the INTEST instruction is present in the Instruction Register, the preloaded data in the Boundary Scan Data Register associated with the inputs are used to drive the signals going into the core rather than the signals coming from the GPIO pads. With tests that drive known values into the controller, this instruction can be used for testing. It is important to note that although the RST input pin is on the Boundary Scan Data Register chain, it is only observable. January 22, 2012 169 Texas Instruments-Production Data JTAG Interface While the INTEST instruction is present in the Instruction Register, the Boundary Scan Data Register can be accessed to sample and shift out the current data and load new data into the Boundary Scan Data Register. 4.5.1.3 SAMPLE/PRELOAD Instruction The SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction connects the Boundary Scan Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction samples the current state of the pad pins for observation and preloads new test data. Each GPIO pad has an associated input, output, and output enable signal. When the TAP controller enters the Capture DR state during this instruction, the input, output, and output-enable signals to each of the GPIO pads are captured. These samples are serially shifted out on TDO while the TAP controller is in the Shift DR state and can be used for observation or comparison in various tests. While these samples of the inputs, outputs, and output enables are being shifted out of the Boundary Scan Data Register, new data is being shifted into the Boundary Scan Data Register from TDI. Once the new data has been shifted into the Boundary Scan Data Register, the data is saved in the parallel load registers when the TAP controller enters the Update DR state. This update of the parallel load register preloads data into the Boundary Scan Data Register that is associated with each input, output, and output enable. This preloaded data can be used with the EXTEST and INTEST instructions to drive data into or out of the controller. See “Boundary Scan Data Register” on page 171 for more information. 4.5.1.4 ABORT Instruction The ABORT instruction connects the associated ABORT Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction provides read and write access to the ABORT Register of the ARM Debug Access Port (DAP). Shifting the proper data into this Data Register clears various error bits or initiates a DAP abort of a previous request. See the “ABORT Data Register” on page 172 for more information. 4.5.1.5 DPACC Instruction The DPACC instruction connects the associated DPACC Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction provides read and write access to the DPACC Register of the ARM Debug Access Port (DAP). Shifting the proper data into this register and reading the data output from this register allows read and write access to the ARM debug and status registers. See “DPACC Data Register” on page 172 for more information. 4.5.1.6 APACC Instruction The APACC instruction connects the associated APACC Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction provides read and write access to the APACC Register of the ARM Debug Access Port (DAP). Shifting the proper data into this register and reading the data output from this register allows read and write access to internal components and buses through the Debug Port. See “APACC Data Register” on page 172 for more information. 4.5.1.7 IDCODE Instruction The IDCODE instruction connects the associated IDCODE Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction provides information on the manufacturer, part number, and version of the ARM core. This information can be used by testing equipment and debuggers to automatically configure input and output data streams. IDCODE is the default instruction loaded into the JTAG Instruction Register when a Power-On-Reset (POR) is asserted, or the Test-Logic-Reset state is entered. See “IDCODE Data Register” on page 171 for more information. 170 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 4.5.1.8 BYPASS Instruction The BYPASS instruction connects the associated BYPASS Data Register chain between TDI and TDO. This instruction is used to create a minimum length serial path between the TDI and TDO ports. The BYPASS Data Register is a single-bit shift register. This instruction improves test efficiency by allowing components that are not needed for a specific test to be bypassed in the JTAG scan chain by loading them with the BYPASS instruction. See “BYPASS Data Register” on page 171 for more information. 4.5.2 Data Registers The JTAG module contains six Data Registers. These serial Data Register chains include: IDCODE, BYPASS, Boundary Scan, APACC, DPACC, and ABORT and are discussed in the following sections. 4.5.2.1 IDCODE Data Register The format for the 32-bit IDCODE Data Register defined by the IEEE Standard 1149.1 is shown in Figure 4-3. The standard requires that every JTAG-compliant microcontroller implement either the IDCODE instruction or the BYPASS instruction as the default instruction. The LSB of the IDCODE Data Register is defined to be a 1 to distinguish it from the BYPASS instruction, which has an LSB of 0. This definition allows auto-configuration test tools to determine which instruction is the default instruction. The major uses of the JTAG port are for manufacturer testing of component assembly and program development and debug. To facilitate the use of auto-configuration debug tools, the IDCODE instruction outputs a value of 0x4BA0.0477. This value allows the debuggers to automatically configure themselves to work correctly with the Cortex-M3 during debug. Figure 4-3. IDCODE Register Format 31 TDI 4.5.2.2 28 27 12 11 Version Part Number 1 0 Manufacturer ID 1 TDO BYPASS Data Register The format for the 1-bit BYPASS Data Register defined by the IEEE Standard 1149.1 is shown in Figure 4-4. The standard requires that every JTAG-compliant microcontroller implement either the BYPASS instruction or the IDCODE instruction as the default instruction. The LSB of the BYPASS Data Register is defined to be a 0 to distinguish it from the IDCODE instruction, which has an LSB of 1. This definition allows auto-configuration test tools to determine which instruction is the default instruction. Figure 4-4. BYPASS Register Format 0 TDI 4.5.2.3 0 TDO Boundary Scan Data Register The format of the Boundary Scan Data Register is shown in Figure 4-5. Each GPIO pin, starting with a GPIO pin next to the JTAG port pins, is included in the Boundary Scan Data Register. Each January 22, 2012 171 Texas Instruments-Production Data JTAG Interface GPIO pin has three associated digital signals that are included in the chain. These signals are input, output, and output enable, and are arranged in that order as shown in the figure. When the Boundary Scan Data Register is accessed with the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction, the input, output, and output enable from each digital pad are sampled and then shifted out of the chain to be verified. The sampling of these values occurs on the rising edge of TCK in the Capture DR state of the TAP controller. While the sampled data is being shifted out of the Boundary Scan chain in the Shift DR state of the TAP controller, new data can be preloaded into the chain for use with the EXTEST and INTEST instructions. The EXTEST instruction forces data out of the controller, and the INTEST instruction forces data into the controller. Figure 4-5. Boundary Scan Register Format TDI I N O U T O E ... 1st GPIO 4.5.2.4 I N O U T mth GPIO O E I N O U T (m+1)th GPIO O E ... I N O U T O E TDO GPIO nth APACC Data Register The format for the 35-bit APACC Data Register defined by ARM is described in the ARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification. 4.5.2.5 DPACC Data Register The format for the 35-bit DPACC Data Register defined by ARM is described in the ARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification. 4.5.2.6 ABORT Data Register The format for the 35-bit ABORT Data Register defined by ARM is described in the ARM® Debug Interface V5 Architecture Specification. 172 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 5 System Control System control configures the overall operation of the device and provides information about the device. Configurable features include reset control, NMI operation, power control, clock control, and low-power modes. 5.1 Signal Description The following table lists the external signals of the System Control module and describes the function of each. The NMI signal is the alternate function for the GPIO PB7 signal and functions as a GPIO after reset. PB7 is under commit protection and requires a special process to be configured as any alternate function or to subsequently return to the GPIO function, see “Commit Control” on page 407. The column in the table below titled "Pin Mux/Pin Assignment" lists the GPIO pin placement for the NMI signal. The AFSEL bit in the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (page 423) should be set to choose the NMI function. The number in parentheses is the encoding that must be programmed into the PMCn field in the GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL) register (page 441) to assign the NMI signal to the specified GPIO port pin. For more information on configuring GPIOs, see “General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs)” on page 399. The remaining signals (with the word "fixed" in the Pin Mux/Pin Assignment column) have a fixed pin assignment and function. Table 5-1. System Control & Clocks Signals (100LQFP) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment a Pin Type Buffer Type Description NMI 89 PB7 (4) I TTL Non-maskable interrupt. OSC0 48 fixed I Analog Main oscillator crystal input or an external clock reference input. OSC1 49 fixed O Analog Main oscillator crystal output. Leave unconnected when using a single-ended clock source. RST 64 fixed I TTL System reset input. a. The TTL designation indicates the pin has TTL-compatible voltage levels. Table 5-2. System Control & Clocks Signals (108BGA) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment a Pin Type Buffer Type Description NMI A8 PB7 (4) I TTL Non-maskable interrupt. OSC0 L11 fixed I Analog Main oscillator crystal input or an external clock reference input. OSC1 M11 fixed O Analog Main oscillator crystal output. Leave unconnected when using a single-ended clock source. RST H11 fixed I TTL System reset input. a. The TTL designation indicates the pin has TTL-compatible voltage levels. 5.2 Functional Description The System Control module provides the following capabilities: ■ Device identification, see “Device Identification” on page 174 ■ Local control, such as reset (see “Reset Control” on page 174), power (see “Power Control” on page 179) and clock control (see “Clock Control” on page 180) January 22, 2012 173 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control ■ System control (Run, Sleep, and Deep-Sleep modes), see “System Control” on page 187 5.2.1 Device Identification Several read-only registers provide software with information on the microcontroller, such as version, part number, SRAM size, Flash memory size, and other features. See the DID0 (page 192), DID1 (page 219), DC0-DC9 (page 221) and NVMSTAT (page 238) registers. 5.2.2 Reset Control This section discusses aspects of hardware functions during reset as well as system software requirements following the reset sequence. 5.2.2.1 Reset Sources The LM3S1G21 microcontroller has six sources of reset: 1. Power-on reset (POR) (see page 175). 2. External reset input pin (RST) assertion (see page 175). 3. Internal brown-out (BOR) detector (see page 177). 4. Software-initiated reset (with the software reset registers) (see page 177). 5. A watchdog timer reset condition violation (see page 178). 6. MOSC failure (see page 179). Table 5-3 provides a summary of results of the various reset operations. Table 5-3. Reset Sources Core Reset? JTAG Reset? On-Chip Peripherals Reset? Power-On Reset Reset Source Yes Yes Yes RST Yes Yes Yes Brown-Out Reset Yes Yes Yes Software System Request Reset using the SYSRESREQ bit in the APINT register. Yes Yes Yes Software System Request Reset using the VECTRESET bit in the APINT register. Yes No No Software Peripheral Reset No Yes Yes Watchdog Reset Yes Yes Yes MOSC Failure Reset Yes Yes Yes a a. Programmable on a module-by-module basis using the Software Reset Control Registers. After a reset, the Reset Cause (RESC) register is set with the reset cause. The bits in this register are sticky and maintain their state across multiple reset sequences, except when an internal POR is the cause, in which case, all the bits in the RESC register are cleared except for the POR indicator. A bit in the RESC register can be cleared by writing a 0. 174 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller At any reset that resets the core, the user has the opportunity to direct the core to execute the ROM Boot Loader or the application in Flash memory by using any GPIO signal as configured in the Boot Configuration (BOOTCFG) register. At reset, the ROM is mapped over the Flash memory so that the ROM boot sequence is always executed. The boot sequence executed from ROM is as follows: 1. The BA bit (below) is cleared such that ROM is mapped to 0x01xx.xxxx and Flash memory is mapped to address 0x0. 2. The BOOTCFG register is read. If the EN bit is clear, the status of the specified GPIO pin is compared with the specified polarity. If the status matches the specified polarity, the ROM is mapped to address 0x0000.0000 and execution continues out of the ROM Boot Loader. 3. If the status doesn't match the specified polarity, the data at address 0x0000.0004 is read, and if the data at this address is 0xFFFF.FFFF, the ROM is mapped to address 0x0000.0000 and execution continues out of the ROM Boot Loader. 4. If there is valid data at address 0x0000.0004, the stack pointer (SP) is loaded from Flash memory at address 0x0000.0000 and the program counter (PC) is loaded from address 0x0000.0004. The user application begins executing. For example, if the BOOTCFG register is written and committed with the value of 0x0000.3C01, then PB7 is examined at reset to determine if the ROM Boot Loader should be executed. If PB7 is Low, the core unconditionally begins executing the ROM boot loader. If PB7 is High, then the application in Flash memory is executed if the reset vector at location 0x0000.0004 is not 0xFFFF.FFFF. Otherwise, the ROM boot loader is executed. 5.2.2.2 Power-On Reset (POR) The internal Power-On Reset (POR) circuit monitors the power supply voltage (VDD) and generates a reset signal to all of the internal logic including JTAG when the power supply ramp reaches a threshold value (VTH). The microcontroller must be operating within the specified operating parameters when the on-chip power-on reset pulse is complete (see “Power and Brown-Out” on page 897). For applications that require the use of an external reset signal to hold the microcontroller in reset longer than the internal POR, the RST input may be used as discussed in “External RST Pin” on page 175. The Power-On Reset sequence is as follows: 1. The microcontroller waits for internal POR to go inactive. 2. The internal reset is released and the core loads from memory the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, and the first instruction designated by the program counter, and then begins execution. The internal POR is only active on the initial power-up of the microcontroller and when the microcontroller wakes from hibernation. The Power-On Reset timing is shown in Figure 21-4 on page 897. 5.2.2.3 External RST Pin Note: It is recommended that the trace for the RST signal must be kept as short as possible. Be sure to place any components connected to the RST signal as close to the microcontroller as possible. January 22, 2012 175 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control If the application only uses the internal POR circuit, the RST input must be connected to the power supply (VDD) through an optional pull-up resistor (0 to 100K Ω) as shown in Figure 5-1 on page 176. Figure 5-1. Basic RST Configuration VDD Stellaris® RPU RST RPU = 0 to 100 kΩ The external reset pin (RST) resets the microcontroller including the core and all the on-chip peripherals except the JTAG TAP controller (see “JTAG Interface” on page 161). The external reset sequence is as follows: 1. The external reset pin (RST) is asserted for the duration specified by TMIN and then de-asserted (see “Reset” on page 898). 2. The internal reset is released and the core loads from memory the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, and the first instruction designated by the program counter, and then begins execution. To improve noise immunity and/or to delay reset at power up, the RST input may be connected to an RC network as shown in Figure 5-2 on page 176. Figure 5-2. External Circuitry to Extend Power-On Reset VDD Stellaris® RPU RST C1 RPU = 1 kΩ to 100 kΩ C1 = 1 nF to 10 µF If the application requires the use of an external reset switch, Figure 5-3 on page 177 shows the proper circuitry to use. 176 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 5-3. Reset Circuit Controlled by Switch VDD Stellaris® RPU RST C1 RS Typical RPU = 10 kΩ Typical RS = 470 Ω C1 = 10 nF The RPU and C1 components define the power-on delay. The external reset timing is shown in Figure 21-7 on page 898. 5.2.2.4 Brown-Out Reset (BOR) The microcontroller provides a brown-out detection circuit that triggers if the power supply (VDD) drops below a brown-out threshold voltage (VBTH). If a brown-out condition is detected, the system may generate an interrupt or a system reset. The default condition is to reset the microcontroller. Brown-out resets are controlled with the Power-On and Brown-Out Reset Control (PBORCTL) register. The BORIOR bit in the PBORCTL register must be set for a brown-out condition to trigger a reset; if BORIOR is clear, an interrupt is generated. When a Brown-out condition occurs during a Flash PROGRAM or ERASE operation, a full system reset is always triggered without regard to the setting in the PBORCTL register. The brown-out reset sequence is as follows: 1. When VDD drops below VBTH, an internal BOR condition is set. 2. If the BOR condition exists, an internal reset is asserted. 3. The internal reset is released and the microcontroller fetches and loads the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, the first instruction designated by the program counter, and begins execution. 4. The internal BOR condition is reset after 500 µs to prevent another BOR condition from being set before software has a chance to investigate the original cause. The result of a brown-out reset is equivalent to that of an assertion of the external RST input, and the reset is held active until the proper VDD level is restored. The RESC register can be examined in the reset interrupt handler to determine if a Brown-Out condition was the cause of the reset, thus allowing software to determine what actions are required to recover. The internal Brown-Out Reset timing is shown in Figure 21-5 on page 897. 5.2.2.5 Software Reset Software can reset a specific peripheral or generate a reset to the entire microcontroller. January 22, 2012 177 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Peripherals can be individually reset by software via three registers that control reset signals to each on-chip peripheral (see the SRCRn registers, page 260). If the bit position corresponding to a peripheral is set and subsequently cleared, the peripheral is reset. The encoding of the reset registers is consistent with the encoding of the clock gating control for peripherals and on-chip functions (see “System Control” on page 187). The entire microcontroller, including the core, can be reset by software by setting the SYSRESREQ bit in the Application Interrupt and Reset Control (APINT) register. The software-initiated system reset sequence is as follows: 1. A software microcontroller reset is initiated by setting the SYSRESREQ bit. 2. An internal reset is asserted. 3. The internal reset is deasserted and the microcontroller loads from memory the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, and the first instruction designated by the program counter, and then begins execution. The core only can be reset by software by setting the VECTRESET bit in the APINT register. The software-initiated core reset sequence is as follows: 1. A core reset is initiated by setting the VECTRESET bit. 2. An internal reset is asserted. 3. The internal reset is deasserted and the microcontroller loads from memory the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, and the first instruction designated by the program counter, and then begins execution. The software-initiated system reset timing is shown in Figure 21-8 on page 898. 5.2.2.6 Watchdog Timer Reset The Watchdog Timer module's function is to prevent system hangs. The LM3S1G21 microcontroller has two Watchdog Timer modules in case one watchdog clock source fails. One watchdog is run off the system clock and the other is run off the Precision Internal Oscillator (PIOSC). Each module operates in the same manner except that because the PIOSC watchdog timer module is in a different clock domain, register accesses must have a time delay between them. The watchdog timer can be configured to generate an interrupt to the microcontroller on its first time-out and to generate a reset on its second time-out. After the watchdog's first time-out event, the 32-bit watchdog counter is reloaded with the value of the Watchdog Timer Load (WDTLOAD) register and resumes counting down from that value. If the timer counts down to zero again before the first time-out interrupt is cleared, and the reset signal has been enabled, the watchdog timer asserts its reset signal to the microcontroller. The watchdog timer reset sequence is as follows: 1. The watchdog timer times out for the second time without being serviced. 2. An internal reset is asserted. 3. The internal reset is released and the microcontroller loads from memory the initial stack pointer, the initial program counter, and the first instruction designated by the program counter, and then begins execution. For more information on the Watchdog Timer module, see “Watchdog Timers” on page 577. 178 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller The watchdog reset timing is shown in Figure 21-9 on page 899. 5.2.3 Non-Maskable Interrupt The microcontroller has three sources of non-maskable interrupt (NMI): ■ The assertion of the NMI signal ■ A main oscillator verification error ■ The NMISET bit in the Interrupt Control and State (INTCTRL) register in the Cortex™-M3 (see page 126). Software must check the cause of the interrupt in order to distinguish among the sources. 5.2.3.1 NMI Pin The NMI signal is the alternate function for GPIO port pin PB7. The alternate function must be enabled in the GPIO for the signal to be used as an interrupt, as described in “General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs)” on page 399. Note that enabling the NMI alternate function requires the use of the GPIO lock and commit function just like the GPIO port pins associated with JTAG/SWD functionality, see page 437. The active sense of the NMI signal is High; asserting the enabled NMI signal above VIH initiates the NMI interrupt sequence. 5.2.3.2 Main Oscillator Verification Failure The LM3S1G21 microcontroller provides a main oscillator verification circuit that generates an error condition if the oscillator is running too fast or too slow. If the main oscillator verification circuit is enabled and a failure occurs, a power-on reset is generated and control is transferred to the NMI handler. The NMI handler is used to address the main oscillator verification failure because the necessary code can be removed from the general reset handler, speeding up reset processing. The detection circuit is enabled by setting the CVAL bit in the Main Oscillator Control (MOSCCTL) register. The main oscillator verification error is indicated in the main oscillator fail status (MOSCFAIL) bit in the Reset Cause (RESC) register. The main oscillator verification circuit action is described in more detail in “Main Oscillator Verification Circuit” on page 187. 5.2.4 Power Control ® The Stellaris microcontroller provides an integrated LDO regulator that is used to provide power to the majority of the microcontroller's internal logic. Figure 5-4 shows the power architecture. An external LDO may not be used. Note: VDDA must be supplied with a voltage that meets the specification in Table 21-2 on page 894, or the microcontroller does not function properly. VDDA is the supply for all of the analog circuitry on the device, including the clock circuitry. January 22, 2012 179 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Figure 5-4. Power Architecture VDDC Internal Logic and PLL VDDC GND GND LDO Low-Noise LDO +3.3V VDD GND I/O Buffers VDD GND VDDA GNDA Analog Circuits VDDA 5.2.5 GNDA Clock Control System control determines the control of clocks in this part. 5.2.5.1 Fundamental Clock Sources There are multiple clock sources for use in the microcontroller: ■ Precision Internal Oscillator (PIOSC). The precision internal oscillator is an on-chip clock source that is the clock source the microcontroller uses during and following POR. It does not require the use of any external components and provides a clock that is 16 MHz ±1% at room temperature and ±3% across temperature. The PIOSC allows for a reduced system cost in applications that require an accurate clock source. If the main oscillator is required, software must enable the main oscillator following reset and allow the main oscillator to stabilize before changing the clock reference. If the Hibernation Module clock source is a 32.768-kHz oscillator, the precision internal oscillator can be trimmed by software based on a reference clock for increased accuracy. ■ Main Oscillator (MOSC). The main oscillator provides a frequency-accurate clock source by one of two means: an external single-ended clock source is connected to the OSC0 input pin, or an external crystal is connected across the OSC0 input and OSC1 output pins. If the PLL is being used, the crystal value must be one of the supported frequencies between 3.579545 MHz to 180 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 16.384 MHz (inclusive). If the PLL is not being used, the crystal may be any one of the supported frequencies between 1 MHz to 16.384 MHz. The single-ended clock source range is from DC through the specified speed of the microcontroller. The supported crystals are listed in the XTAL bit field in the RCC register (see page 203). ■ Internal 30-kHz Oscillator. The internal 30-kHz oscillator provides an operational frequency of 30 kHz ± 50%. It is intended for use during Deep-Sleep power-saving modes. This power-savings mode benefits from reduced internal switching and also allows the MOSC to be powered down. ■ Hibernation Module Clock Source. The Hibernation module can be clocked in one of two ways. The first way is a 4.194304-MHz crystal connected to the XOSC0 and XOSC1 pins. This clock signal is divided by 128 internally to produce the 32.768-kHz clock reference. The second way is a 32.768-kHz oscillator connected to the XOSC0 pin. The 32.768-kHz oscillator can be used for the system clock, thus eliminating the need for an additional crystal or oscillator. The Hibernation module clock source is intended to provide the system with a real-time clock source and may also provide an accurate source of Deep-Sleep or Hibernate mode power savings. The internal system clock (SysClk), is derived from any of the above sources plus two others: the output of the main internal PLL and the precision internal oscillator divided by four (4 MHz ± 1%). The frequency of the PLL clock reference must be in the range of 3.579545 MHz to 16.384 MHz (inclusive). Table 5-4 on page 181 shows how the various clock sources can be used in a system. Table 5-4. Clock Source Options 5.2.5.2 Clock Source Drive PLL? Precision Internal Oscillator Yes Used as SysClk? BYPASS = 0, OSCSRC = 0x1 Yes BYPASS = 1, OSCSRC = 0x1 Precision Internal Oscillator divide by 4 No (4 MHz ± 1%) - Yes BYPASS = 1, OSCSRC = 0x2 Main Oscillator BYPASS = 0, OSCSRC = 0x0 Yes BYPASS = 1, OSCSRC = 0x0 Yes Internal 30-kHz Oscillator No - Yes BYPASS = 1, OSCSRC = 0x3 Hibernation Module 32.768-kHz Oscillator No - Yes BYPASS = 1, OSCSRC2 = 0x7 Hibernation Module 4.194304-MHz Crystal No - No - Clock Configuration The Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) and Run-Mode Clock Configuration 2 (RCC2) registers provide control for the system clock. The RCC2 register is provided to extend fields that offer additional encodings over the RCC register. When used, the RCC2 register field values are used by the logic over the corresponding field in the RCC register. In particular, RCC2 provides for a larger assortment of clock configuration options. These registers control the following clock functionality: ■ Source of clocks in sleep and deep-sleep modes ■ System clock derived from PLL or other clock source ■ Enabling/disabling of oscillators and PLL ■ Clock divisors January 22, 2012 181 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control ■ Crystal input selection Important: Write the RCC register prior to writing the RCC2 register. If a subsequent write to the RCC register is required, include another register access after writing the RCC register and before writing the RCC2 register. Figure 5-5 shows the logic for the main clock tree. The peripheral blocks are driven by the system clock signal and can be individually enabled/disabled. When the PLL is enabled, the ADC clock signal is automatically divided down to 16 MHz from the PLL output for proper ADC operation. Note: When the ADC module is in operation, the system clock must be at least 16 MHz. 182 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 5-5. Main Clock Tree XTALa USBPWRDN c USB PLL (480 MHz) ÷4 USB Clock RXINT RXFRAC I2S Receive MCLK TXINT TXFRAC I2S Transmit MCLK USEPWMDIV a PWMDW a PWM Clock XTALa PWRDN b MOSCDIS a PLL (400 MHz) Main OSC USESYSDIV a,d DIV400 c ÷2 IOSCDIS a System Clock Precision Internal OSC (16 MHz) SYSDIV e ÷4 BYPASS b,d Internal OSC (30 kHz) Hibernation OSC (32.768 kHz) PWRDN ADC Clock OSCSRC b,d ÷ 25 a. Control provided by RCC register bit/field. b. Control provided by RCC register bit/field or RCC2 register bit/field, if overridden with RCC2 register bit USERCC2. c. Control provided by RCC2 register bit/field. d. Also may be controlled by DSLPCLKCFG when in deep sleep mode. e. Control provided by RCC register SYSDIV field, RCC2 register SYSDIV2 field if overridden with USERCC2 bit, or [SYSDIV2,SYSDIV2LSB] if both USERCC2 and DIV400 bits are set. Note: The figure above shows all features available on all Stellaris® Firestorm-class microcontrollers. Not all peripherals may be available on this device. Using the SYSDIV and SYSDIV2 Fields In the RCC register, the SYSDIV field specifies which divisor is used to generate the system clock from either the PLL output or the oscillator source (depending on how the BYPASS bit in this register January 22, 2012 183 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control is configured). When using the PLL, the VCO frequency of 400 MHz is predivided by 2 before the divisor is applied. Table 5-5 shows how the SYSDIV encoding affects the system clock frequency, depending on whether the PLL is used (BYPASS=0) or another clock source is used (BYPASS=1). The divisor is equivalent to the SYSDIV encoding plus 1. For a list of possible clock sources, see Table 5-4 on page 181. Table 5-5. Possible System Clock Frequencies Using the SYSDIV Field SYSDIV Divisor a ® Frequency (BYPASS=0) Frequency (BYPASS=1) StellarisWare Parameter b 0x0 /1 reserved Clock source frequency/2 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_1 0x1 /2 reserved Clock source frequency/2 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_2 0x2 /3 66.67 MHz Clock source frequency/3 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_3 0x3 /4 50 MHz Clock source frequency/4 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_4 0x4 /5 40 MHz Clock source frequency/5 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_5 0x5 /6 33.33 MHz Clock source frequency/6 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_6 0x6 /7 28.57 MHz Clock source frequency/7 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_7 0x7 /8 25 MHz Clock source frequency/8 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_8 0x8 /9 22.22 MHz Clock source frequency/9 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_9 0x9 /10 20 MHz Clock source frequency/10 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_10 0xA /11 18.18 MHz Clock source frequency/11 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_11 0xB /12 16.67 MHz Clock source frequency/12 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_12 0xC /13 15.38 MHz Clock source frequency/13 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_13 0xD /14 14.29 MHz Clock source frequency/14 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_14 0xE /15 13.33 MHz Clock source frequency/15 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_15 0xF /16 12.5 MHz (default) Clock source frequency/16 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_16 a. This parameter is used in functions such as SysCtlClockSet() in the Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library. b. SYSCTL_SYSDIV_1 does not set the USESYSDIV bit. As a result, using this parameter without enabling the PLL results in the system clock having the same frequency as the clock source. The SYSDIV2 field in the RCC2 register is 2 bits wider than the SYSDIV field in the RCC register so that additional larger divisors up to /64 are possible, allowing a lower system clock frequency for improved Deep Sleep power consumption. When using the PLL, the VCO frequency of 400 MHz is predivided by 2 before the divisor is applied. The divisor is equivalent to the SYSDIV2 encoding plus 1. Table 5-6 shows how the SYSDIV2 encoding affects the system clock frequency, depending on whether the PLL is used (BYPASS2=0) or another clock source is used (BYPASS2=1). For a list of possible clock sources, see Table 5-4 on page 181. Table 5-6. Examples of Possible System Clock Frequencies Using the SYSDIV2 Field SYSDIV2 Divisor a Frequency (BYPASS2=0) Frequency (BYPASS2=1) StellarisWare Parameter b 0x00 /1 reserved Clock source frequency/2 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_1 0x01 /2 reserved Clock source frequency/2 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_2 0x02 /3 66.67 MHz Clock source frequency/3 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_3 0x03 /4 50 MHz Clock source frequency/4 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_4 0x04 /5 40 MHz Clock source frequency/5 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_5 ... ... ... ... ... 0x09 /10 20 MHz Clock source frequency/10 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_10 ... ... ... ... ... 184 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 5-6. Examples of Possible System Clock Frequencies Using the SYSDIV2 Field (continued) Divisor SYSDIV2 0x3F /64 a Frequency (BYPASS2=0) Frequency (BYPASS2=1) StellarisWare Parameter 3.125 MHz Clock source frequency/64 SYSCTL_SYSDIV_64 a. This parameter is used in functions such as SysCtlClockSet() in the Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library. b. SYSCTL_SYSDIV_1 does not set the USESYSDIV bit. As a result, using this parameter without enabling the PLL results in the system clock having the same frequency as the clock source. To allow for additional frequency choices when using the PLL, the DIV400 bit is provided along with the SYSDIV2LSB bit. When the DIV400 bit is set, bit 22 becomes the LSB for SYSDIV2. In this situation, the divisor is equivalent to the (SYSDIV2 encoding with SYSDIV2LSB appended) plus one. Table 5-7 shows the frequency choices when DIV400 is set. When the DIV400 bit is clear, SYSDIV2LSB is ignored, and the system clock frequency is determined as shown in Table 5-6 on page 184. Table 5-7. Examples of Possible System Clock Frequencies with DIV400=1 /2 reserved - 0 /3 reserved - 1 /4 reserved - 0 /5 80 MHz SYSCTL_SYSDIV_2_5 1 /6 66.67 MHz SYSCTL_SYSDIV_3 0 /7 reserved - 1 /8 50 MHz SYSCTL_SYSDIV_4 0 /9 44.44 MHz SYSCTL_SYSDIV_4_5 1 /10 40 MHz SYSCTL_SYSDIV_5 ... ... ... ... 0 /127 3.15 MHz SYSCTL_SYSDIV_63_5 1 /128 3.125 MHz SYSCTL_SYSDIV_64 0x00 reserved 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 ... 0x3F b StellarisWare Parameter SYSDIV2LSB Divisor a Frequency (BYPASS2=0) SYSDIV2 a. Note that DIV400 and SYSDIV2LSB are only valid when BYPASS2=0. b. This parameter is used in functions such as SysCtlClockSet() in the Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library. 5.2.5.3 Precision Internal Oscillator Operation (PIOSC) The microcontroller powers up with the PIOSC running. If another clock source is desired, the PIOSC must remain enabled as it is used for internal functions. The PIOSC can only be disabled during Deep-Sleep mode. It can be powered down by setting the IOSCDIS bit in the RCC register. The PIOSC generates a 16-MHz clock with a ±1% accuracy at room temperatures. Across the extended temperature range, the accuracy is ±3%. At the factory, the PIOSC is set to 16 MHz at room temperature, however, the frequency can be trimmed for other voltage or temperature conditions using software in one of three ways: ■ Default calibration: clear the UTEN bit and set the UPDATE bit in the Precision Internal Oscillator Calibration (PIOSCCAL) register. ■ User-defined calibration: The user can program the UT value to adjust the PIOSC frequency. As the UT value increases, the generated period increases. To commit a new UT value, first set the January 22, 2012 185 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control UTEN bit, then program the UT field, and then set the UPDATE bit. The adjustment finishes within a few clock periods and is glitch free. ■ Automatic calibration using the Hibernation module with a functioning 32.768-kHz clock source: Set the CAL bit in the PIOSCCAL register; the results of the calibration are shown in the RESULT field in the Precision Internal Oscillator Statistic (PIOSCSTAT) register. After calibration is complete, the PIOSC is trimmed using the trimmed value returned in the CT field. 5.2.5.4 Crystal Configuration for the Main Oscillator (MOSC) The main oscillator supports the use of a select number of crystals. If the main oscillator is used by the PLL as a reference clock, the supported range of crystals is 3.579545 to 16.384 MHz, otherwise, the range of supported crystals is 1 to 16.384 MHz. The XTAL bit in the RCC register (see page 203) describes the available crystal choices and default programming values. Software configures the RCC register XTAL field with the crystal number. If the PLL is used in the design, the XTAL field value is internally translated to the PLL settings. 5.2.5.5 Main PLL Frequency Configuration The main PLL is disabled by default during power-on reset and is enabled later by software if required. Software specifies the output divisor to set the system clock frequency and enables the main PLL to drive the output. The PLL operates at 400 MHz, but is divided by two prior to the application of the output divisor, unless the DIV400 bit in the RCC2 register is set. To configure the PIOSC to be the clock source for the main PLL, program the OSCRC2 field in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration 2 (RCC2) register to be 0x1. If the main oscillator provides the clock reference to the main PLL, the translation provided by hardware and used to program the PLL is available for software in the XTAL to PLL Translation (PLLCFG) register (see page 207). The internal translation provides a translation within ± 1% of the targeted PLL VCO frequency. Table 21-8 on page 900 shows the actual PLL frequency and error for a given crystal choice. The Crystal Value field (XTAL) in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register (see page 203) describes the available crystal choices and default programming of the PLLCFG register. Any time the XTAL field changes, the new settings are translated and the internal PLL settings are updated. 5.2.5.6 PLL Modes ■ Normal: The PLL multiplies the input clock reference and drives the output. ■ Power-Down: Most of the PLL internal circuitry is disabled and the PLL does not drive the output. The modes are programmed using the RCC/RCC2 register fields (see page 203 and page 210). 5.2.5.7 PLL Operation If a PLL configuration is changed, the PLL output frequency is unstable until it reconverges (relocks) to the new setting. The time between the configuration change and relock is TREADY (see Table 21-7 on page 899). During the relock time, the affected PLL is not usable as a clock reference. The PLL is changed by one of the following: ■ Change to the XTAL value in the RCC register—writes of the same value do not cause a relock. 186 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller ■ Change in the PLL from Power-Down to Normal mode. A counter clocked by the system clock is used to measure the TREADY requirement. If the system clock is the main oscillator and it is running off an 8.192 MHz or slower external oscillator clock, the down counter is set to 0x1200 (that is, ~600 μs at an 8.192 MHz). If the system clock is running off the PIOSC or an external oscillator clock that is faster than 8.192 MHz, the down counter is set to 0x2400. Hardware is provided to keep the PLL from being used as a system clock until the TREADY condition is met after one of the two changes above. It is the user's responsibility to have a stable clock source (like the main oscillator) before the RCC/RCC2 register is switched to use the PLL. If the main PLL is enabled and the system clock is switched to use the PLL in one step, the system control hardware continues to clock the microcontroller from the oscillator selected by the RCC/RCC2 register until the main PLL is stable (TREADY time met), after which it changes to the PLL. Software can use many methods to ensure that the system is clocked from the main PLL, including periodically polling the PLLLRIS bit in the Raw Interrupt Status (RIS) register, and enabling the PLL Lock interrupt. 5.2.5.8 Main Oscillator Verification Circuit The clock control includes circuitry to ensure that the main oscillator is running at the appropriate frequency. The circuit monitors the main oscillator frequency and signals if the frequency is outside of the allowable band of attached crystals. The detection circuit is enabled using the CVAL bit in the Main Oscillator Control (MOSCCTL) register. If this circuit is enabled and detects an error, the following sequence is performed by the hardware: 1. The MOSCFAIL bit in the Reset Cause (RESC) register is set. 2. If the internal oscillator (PIOSC) is disabled, it is enabled. 3. The system clock is switched from the main oscillator to the PIOSC. 4. An internal power-on reset is initiated that lasts for 32 PIOSC periods. 5. Reset is de-asserted and the processor is directed to the NMI handler during the reset sequence. 5.2.6 System Control For power-savings purposes, the RCGCn, SCGCn, and DCGCn registers control the clock gating logic for each peripheral or block in the system while the microcontroller is in Run, Sleep, and Deep-Sleep mode, respectively. These registers are located in the System Control register map starting at offsets 0x600, 0x700, and 0x800, respectively. There must be a delay of 3 system clocks after a peripheral module clock is enabled in the RCGC register before any module registers are accessed. There are four levels of operation for the microcontroller defined as: ■ Run mode ■ Sleep mode ■ Deep-Sleep mode ■ Hibernate mode The following sections describe the different modes in detail. January 22, 2012 187 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Caution – If the Cortex-M3 Debug Access Port (DAP) has been enabled, and the device wakes from a low power sleep or deep-sleep mode, the core may start executing code before all clocks to peripherals have been restored to their Run mode configuration. The DAP is usually enabled by software tools accessing the JTAG or SWD interface when debugging or flash programming. If this condition occurs, a Hard Fault is triggered when software accesses a peripheral with an invalid clock. A software delay loop can be used at the beginning of the interrupt routine that is used to wake up a system from a WFI (Wait For Interrupt) instruction. This stalls the execution of any code that accesses a peripheral register that might cause a fault. This loop can be removed for production software as the DAP is most likely not enabled during normal execution. Because the DAP is disabled by default (power on reset), the user can also power cycle the device. The DAP is not enabled unless it is enabled through the JTAG or SWD interface. 5.2.6.1 Run Mode In Run mode, the microcontroller actively executes code. Run mode provides normal operation of the processor and all of the peripherals that are currently enabled by the RCGCn registers. The system clock can be any of the available clock sources including the PLL. 5.2.6.2 Sleep Mode In Sleep mode, the clock frequency of the active peripherals is unchanged, but the processor and the memory subsystem are not clocked and therefore no longer execute code. Sleep mode is entered by the Cortex-M3 core executing a WFI (Wait for Interrupt) instruction. Any properly configured interrupt event in the system brings the processor back into Run mode. See “Power Management” on page 90 for more details. Peripherals are clocked that are enabled in the SCGCn registers when auto-clock gating is enabled (see the RCC register) or the RCGCn registers when the auto-clock gating is disabled. The system clock has the same source and frequency as that during Run mode. 5.2.6.3 Deep-Sleep Mode In Deep-Sleep mode, the clock frequency of the active peripherals may change (depending on the Run mode clock configuration) in addition to the processor clock being stopped. An interrupt returns the microcontroller to Run mode from one of the sleep modes; the sleep modes are entered on request from the code. Deep-Sleep mode is entered by first setting the SLEEPDEEP bit in the System Control (SYSCTRL) register (see page 132) and then executing a WFI instruction. Any properly configured interrupt event in the system brings the processor back into Run mode. See “Power Management” on page 90 for more details. The Cortex-M3 processor core and the memory subsystem are not clocked in Deep-Sleep mode. Peripherals are clocked that are enabled in the DCGCn registers when auto-clock gating is enabled (see the RCC register) or the RCGCn registers when auto-clock gating is disabled. The system clock source is specified in the DSLPCLKCFG register. When the DSLPCLKCFG register is used, the internal oscillator source is powered up, if necessary, and other clocks are powered down. If the PLL is running at the time of the WFI instruction, hardware powers the PLL down and overrides the SYSDIV field of the active RCC/RCC2 register, to be determined by the DSDIVORIDE setting in the DSLPCLKCFG register, up to /16 or /64 respectively. When the Deep-Sleep exit event occurs, hardware brings the system clock back to the source and frequency it had at the onset of Deep-Sleep mode before enabling the clocks that had been stopped during the Deep-Sleep duration. If the PIOSC is used as the PLL reference clock source, it may continue to provide the clock during Deep-Sleep. See page 214. 188 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 5.2.6.4 Hibernate Mode In this mode, the power supplies are turned off to the main part of the microcontroller and only the Hibernation module's circuitry is active. An external wake event or RTC event is required to bring the microcontroller back to Run mode. The Cortex-M3 processor and peripherals outside of the Hibernation module see a normal "power on" sequence and the processor starts running code. Software can determine if the microcontroller has been restarted from Hibernate mode by inspecting the Hibernation module registers. For more information on the operation of Hibernate mode, see “Hibernation Module” on page 267. 5.3 Initialization and Configuration The PLL is configured using direct register writes to the RCC/RCC2 register. If the RCC2 register is being used, the USERCC2 bit must be set and the appropriate RCC2 bit/field is used. The steps required to successfully change the PLL-based system clock are: 1. Bypass the PLL and system clock divider by setting the BYPASS bit and clearing the USESYS bit in the RCC register, thereby configuring the microcontroller to run off a "raw" clock source and allowing for the new PLL configuration to be validated before switching the system clock to the PLL. 2. Select the crystal value (XTAL) and oscillator source (OSCSRC), and clear the PWRDN bit in RCC/RCC2. Setting the XTAL field automatically pulls valid PLL configuration data for the appropriate crystal, and clearing the PWRDN bit powers and enables the PLL and its output. 3. Select the desired system divider (SYSDIV) in RCC/RCC2 and set the USESYS bit in RCC. The SYSDIV field determines the system frequency for the microcontroller. 4. Wait for the PLL to lock by polling the PLLLRIS bit in the Raw Interrupt Status (RIS) register. 5. Enable use of the PLL by clearing the BYPASS bit in RCC/RCC2. 5.4 Register Map Table 5-8 on page 189 lists the System Control registers, grouped by function. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register's address, relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. Note: Spaces in the System Control register space that are not used are reserved for future or internal use. Software should not modify any reserved memory address. Additional Flash and ROM registers defined in the System Control register space are described in the “Internal Memory” on page 294. Table 5-8. System Control Register Map Description See page Offset Name Type Reset 0x000 DID0 RO - Device Identification 0 192 0x004 DID1 RO - Device Identification 1 219 0x008 DC0 RO 0x00FF.00BF Device Capabilities 0 221 0x010 DC1 RO - Device Capabilities 1 222 0x014 DC2 RO 0x430F.5037 Device Capabilities 2 224 January 22, 2012 189 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Table 5-8. System Control Register Map (continued) Offset Name 0x018 See page Type Reset Description DC3 RO 0xBFFF.0FC0 Device Capabilities 3 226 0x01C DC4 RO 0x0004.F1FF Device Capabilities 4 228 0x020 DC5 RO 0x0000.0000 Device Capabilities 5 230 0x024 DC6 RO 0x0000.0000 Device Capabilities 6 231 0x028 DC7 RO 0xFFFF.FFFF Device Capabilities 7 232 0x02C DC8 RO 0x0000.00FF Device Capabilities 8 ADC Channels 236 0x030 PBORCTL R/W 0x0000.0002 Brown-Out Reset Control 194 0x040 SRCR0 R/W 0x00000000 Software Reset Control 0 260 0x044 SRCR1 R/W 0x00000000 Software Reset Control 1 262 0x048 SRCR2 R/W 0x00000000 Software Reset Control 2 265 0x050 RIS RO 0x0000.0000 Raw Interrupt Status 195 0x054 IMC R/W 0x0000.0000 Interrupt Mask Control 197 0x058 MISC R/W1C 0x0000.0000 Masked Interrupt Status and Clear 199 0x05C RESC R/W - Reset Cause 201 0x060 RCC R/W 0x0780.3AD1 Run-Mode Clock Configuration 203 0x064 PLLCFG RO - XTAL to PLL Translation 207 0x06C GPIOHBCTL R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO High-Performance Bus Control 208 0x070 RCC2 R/W 0x07C0.6810 Run-Mode Clock Configuration 2 210 0x07C MOSCCTL R/W 0x0000.0000 Main Oscillator Control 213 0x100 RCGC0 R/W 0x00000040 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 239 0x104 RCGC1 R/W 0x00000000 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 245 0x108 RCGC2 R/W 0x00000000 Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 254 0x110 SCGC0 R/W 0x00000040 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 241 0x114 SCGC1 R/W 0x00000000 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 248 0x118 SCGC2 R/W 0x00000000 Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 256 0x120 DCGC0 R/W 0x00000040 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 243 0x124 DCGC1 R/W 0x00000000 Deep-Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 251 0x128 DCGC2 R/W 0x00000000 Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 258 0x144 DSLPCLKCFG R/W 0x0780.0000 Deep Sleep Clock Configuration 214 0x150 PIOSCCAL R/W 0x0000.0000 Precision Internal Oscillator Calibration 216 0x154 PIOSCSTAT RO 0x0000.0040 Precision Internal Oscillator Statistics 218 0x190 DC9 RO 0x0000.00FF Device Capabilities 9 ADC Digital Comparators 237 190 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 5-8. System Control Register Map (continued) Offset Name 0x1A0 NVMSTAT 5.5 Type Reset RO 0x0000.0001 Description Non-Volatile Memory Information See page 238 Register Descriptions All addresses given are relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. January 22, 2012 191 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 1: Device Identification 0 (DID0), offset 0x000 This register identifies the version of the microcontroller. Each microcontroller is uniquely identified by the combined values of the CLASS field in the DID0 register and the PARTNO field in the DID1 register. Device Identification 0 (DID0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x000 Type RO, reset 31 30 28 27 26 VER reserved Type Reset 29 25 24 23 22 21 20 reserved 18 17 16 CLASS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - MAJOR Type Reset 19 MINOR Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31 reserved RO 0 30:28 VER RO 0x1 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. DID0 Version This field defines the DID0 register format version. The version number is numeric. The value of the VER field is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x1 Second version of the DID0 register format. 27:24 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 23:16 CLASS RO 0x06 Device Class The CLASS field value identifies the internal design from which all mask sets are generated for all microcontrollers in a particular product line. The CLASS field value is changed for new product lines, for changes in fab process (for example, a remap or shrink), or any case where the MAJOR or MINOR fields require differentiation from prior microcontrollers. The value of the CLASS field is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x06 Stellaris® Firestorm-class microcontrollers 192 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 15:8 MAJOR RO - Description Major Revision This field specifies the major revision number of the microcontroller. The major revision reflects changes to base layers of the design. The major revision number is indicated in the part number as a letter (A for first revision, B for second, and so on). This field is encoded as follows: Value Description 0x0 Revision A (initial device) 0x1 Revision B (first base layer revision) 0x2 Revision C (second base layer revision) and so on. 7:0 MINOR RO - Minor Revision This field specifies the minor revision number of the microcontroller. The minor revision reflects changes to the metal layers of the design. The MINOR field value is reset when the MAJOR field is changed. This field is numeric and is encoded as follows: Value Description 0x0 Initial device, or a major revision update. 0x1 First metal layer change. 0x2 Second metal layer change. and so on. January 22, 2012 193 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 2: Brown-Out Reset Control (PBORCTL), offset 0x030 This register is responsible for controlling reset conditions after initial power-on reset. Brown-Out Reset Control (PBORCTL) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x030 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0002 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 BORIOR reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 1 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:2 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 1 BORIOR R/W 1 BOR Interrupt or Reset Value Description 0 reserved RO 0 0 A Brown Out Event causes an interrupt to be generated to the interrupt controller. 1 A Brown Out Event causes a reset of the microcontroller. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 194 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 3: Raw Interrupt Status (RIS), offset 0x050 This register indicates the status for system control raw interrupts. An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller if the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Mask Control (IMC) register is set. Writing a 1 to the corresponding bit in the Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (MISC) register clears an interrupt status bit. Raw Interrupt Status (RIS) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x050 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MOSCPUPRIS reserved PLLLRIS BORRIS reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:9 reserved RO 0x0000.00 8 MOSCPUPRIS RO 0 reserved Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. MOSC Power Up Raw Interrupt Status Value Description 1 Sufficient time has passed for the MOSC to reach the expected frequency. The value for this power-up time is indicated by TMOSC_START. 0 Sufficient time has not passed for the MOSC to reach the expected frequency. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the MOSCPUPMIS bit in the MISC register. 7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 6 PLLLRIS RO 0 PLL Lock Raw Interrupt Status Value Description 1 The PLL timer has reached TREADY indicating that sufficient time has passed for the PLL to lock. 0 The PLL timer has not reached TREADY. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the PLLLMIS bit in the MISC register. 5:2 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 195 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 1 BORRIS RO 0 Description Brown-Out Reset Raw Interrupt Status Value Description 1 A brown-out condition is currently active. 0 A brown-out condition is not currently active. Note the BORIOR bit in the PBORCTL register must be cleared to cause an interrupt due to a Brown Out Event. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the BORMIS bit in the MISC register. 0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 196 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 4: Interrupt Mask Control (IMC), offset 0x054 This register contains the mask bits for system control raw interrupts. A raw interrupt, indicated by a bit being set in the Raw Interrupt Status (RIS) register, is sent to the interrupt controller if the corresponding bit in this register is set. Interrupt Mask Control (IMC) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x054 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MOSCPUPIM reserved PLLLIM BORIM reserved R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:9 reserved RO 0x0000.00 8 MOSCPUPIM R/W 0 reserved Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. MOSC Power Up Interrupt Mask Value Description 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the MOSCPUPRIS bit in the RIS register is set. 0 The MOSCPUPRIS interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. 7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 6 PLLLIM R/W 0 PLL Lock Interrupt Mask Value Description 5:2 reserved RO 0x0 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the PLLLRIS bit in the RIS register is set. 0 The PLLLRIS interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 197 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 1 BORIM R/W 0 Description Brown-Out Reset Interrupt Mask Value Description 0 reserved RO 0 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the BORRIS bit in the RIS register is set. 0 The BORRIS interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 198 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 5: Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (MISC), offset 0x058 On a read, this register gives the current masked status value of the corresponding interrupt in the Raw Interrupt Status (RIS) register. All of the bits are R/W1C, thus writing a 1 to a bit clears the corresponding raw interrupt bit in the RIS register (see page 195). Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (MISC) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x058 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MOSCPUPMIS reserved PLLLMIS BORMIS reserved R/W1C 0 RO 0 R/W1C 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W1C 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:9 reserved RO 0x0000.00 8 MOSCPUPMIS R/W1C 0 reserved Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. MOSC Power Up Masked Interrupt Status Value Description 1 When read, a 1 indicates that an unmasked interrupt was signaled because sufficient time has passed for the MOSC PLL to lock. Writing a 1 to this bit clears it and also the MOSCPUPRIS bit in the RIS register. 0 When read, a 0 indicates that sufficient time has not passed for the MOSC PLL to lock. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. 7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 6 PLLLMIS R/W1C 0 PLL Lock Masked Interrupt Status Value Description 1 When read, a 1 indicates that an unmasked interrupt was signaled because sufficient time has passed for the PLL to lock. Writing a 1 to this bit clears it and also the PLLLRIS bit in the RIS register. 0 When read, a 0 indicates that sufficient time has not passed for the PLL to lock. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. January 22, 2012 199 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 5:2 reserved RO 0x0 1 BORMIS R/W1C 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. BOR Masked Interrupt Status Value Description 1 When read, a 1 indicates that an unmasked interrupt was signaled because of a brown-out condition. Writing a 1 to this bit clears it and also the BORRIS bit in the RIS register. 0 When read, a 0 indicates that a brown-out condition has not occurred. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. 0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 200 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 6: Reset Cause (RESC), offset 0x05C This register is set with the reset cause after reset. The bits in this register are sticky and maintain their state across multiple reset sequences, except when an power-on reset is the cause, in which case, all bits other than POR in the RESC register are cleared. Reset Cause (RESC) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x05C Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W - 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WDT1 SW WDT0 BOR POR EXT RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - reserved Type Reset MOSCFAIL reserved Type Reset RO 0 16 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:17 reserved RO 0x000 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 16 MOSCFAIL R/W - MOSC Failure Reset Value Description 1 When read, this bit indicates that the MOSC circuit was enabled for clock validation and failed, generating a reset event. 0 When read, this bit indicates that a MOSC failure has not generated a reset since the previous power-on reset. Writing a 0 to this bit clears it. 15:6 reserved RO 0x00 5 WDT1 R/W - Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Watchdog Timer 1 Reset Value Description 1 When read, this bit indicates that Watchdog Timer 1 timed out and generated a reset. 0 When read, this bit indicates that Watchdog Timer 1 has not generated a reset since the previous power-on reset. Writing a 0 to this bit clears it. January 22, 2012 201 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 4 SW R/W - Description Software Reset Value Description 1 When read, this bit indicates that a software reset has caused a reset event. 0 When read, this bit indicates that a software reset has not generated a reset since the previous power-on reset. Writing a 0 to this bit clears it. 3 WDT0 R/W - Watchdog Timer 0 Reset Value Description 1 When read, this bit indicates that Watchdog Timer 0 timed out and generated a reset. 0 When read, this bit indicates that Watchdog Timer 0 has not generated a reset since the previous power-on reset. Writing a 0 to this bit clears it. 2 BOR R/W - Brown-Out Reset Value Description 1 When read, this bit indicates that a brown-out reset has caused a reset event. 0 When read, this bit indicates that a brown-out reset has not generated a reset since the previous power-on reset. Writing a 0 to this bit clears it. 1 POR R/W - Power-On Reset Value Description 1 When read, this bit indicates that a power-on reset has caused a reset event. 0 When read, this bit indicates that a power-on reset has not generated a reset. Writing a 0 to this bit clears it. 0 EXT R/W - External Reset Value Description 1 When read, this bit indicates that an external reset (RST assertion) has caused a reset event. 0 When read, this bit indicates that an external reset (RST assertion) has not caused a reset event since the previous power-on reset. Writing a 0 to this bit clears it. 202 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 7: Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC), offset 0x060 The bits in this register configure the system clock and oscillators. Important: Write the RCC register prior to writing the RCC2 register. If a subsequent write to the RCC register is required, include another register access after writing the RCC register and before writing the RCC2 register. Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x060 Type R/W, reset 0x0780.3AD1 31 30 29 28 26 25 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 PWRDN reserved BYPASS R/W 1 RO 1 R/W 1 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 27 24 23 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 1 ACG 21 20 19 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 0 R/W 1 RO 0 SYSDIV 22 XTAL Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:28 reserved RO 0x0 27 ACG R/W 0 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 2 1 0 reserved USESYSDIV R/W 0 18 OSCSRC reserved RO 0 IOSCDIS MOSCDIS R/W 0 R/W 1 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Auto Clock Gating This bit specifies whether the system uses the Sleep-Mode Clock Gating Control (SCGCn) registers and Deep-Sleep-Mode Clock Gating Control (DCGCn) registers if the microcontroller enters a Sleep or Deep-Sleep mode (respectively). Value Description 1 The SCGCn or DCGCn registers are used to control the clocks distributed to the peripherals when the microcontroller is in a sleep mode. The SCGCn and DCGCn registers allow unused peripherals to consume less power when the microcontroller is in a sleep mode. 0 The Run-Mode Clock Gating Control (RCGCn) registers are used when the microcontroller enters a sleep mode. The RCGCn registers are always used to control the clocks in Run mode. 26:23 SYSDIV R/W 0xF System Clock Divisor Specifies which divisor is used to generate the system clock from either the PLL output or the oscillator source (depending on how the BYPASS bit in this register is configured). See Table 5-5 on page 184 for bit encodings. If the SYSDIV value is less than MINSYSDIV (see page 222), and the PLL is being used, then the MINSYSDIV value is used as the divisor. If the PLL is not being used, the SYSDIV value can be less than MINSYSDIV. January 22, 2012 203 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 22 USESYSDIV R/W 0 Description Enable System Clock Divider Value Description 1 The system clock divider is the source for the system clock. The system clock divider is forced to be used when the PLL is selected as the source. If the USERCC2 bit in the RCC2 register is set, then the SYSDIV2 field in the RCC2 register is used as the system clock divider rather than the SYSDIV field in this register. 0 The system clock is used undivided. 21:14 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 13 PWRDN R/W 1 PLL Power Down Value Description 1 The PLL is powered down. Care must be taken to ensure that another clock source is functioning and that the BYPASS bit is set before setting this bit. 0 The PLL is operating normally. 12 reserved RO 1 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 11 BYPASS R/W 1 PLL Bypass Value Description 1 The system clock is derived from the OSC source and divided by the divisor specified by SYSDIV. 0 The system clock is the PLL output clock divided by the divisor specified by SYSDIV. See Table 5-5 on page 184 for programming guidelines. Note: The ADC must be clocked from the PLL or directly from a 16-MHz clock source to operate properly. 204 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 10:6 XTAL R/W 0x0B Crystal Value This field specifies the crystal value attached to the main oscillator. The encoding for this field is provided below. Depending on the crystal used, the PLL frequency may not be exactly 400 MHz, see Table 21-8 on page 900 for more information. Value Crystal Frequency (MHz) Not Crystal Frequency (MHz) Using Using the PLL the PLL 0x00 1.000 MHz reserved 0x01 1.8432 MHz reserved 0x02 2.000 MHz reserved 0x03 2.4576 MHz reserved 0x04 3.579545 MHz 0x05 3.6864 MHz 0x06 4 MHz 0x07 4.096 MHz 0x08 4.9152 MHz 0x09 5 MHz 0x0A 5.12 MHz 0x0B 6 MHz (reset value) 0x0C 6.144 MHz 0x0D 7.3728 MHz 0x0E 8 MHz 0x0F 8.192 MHz 0x10 10.0 MHz 0x11 12.0 MHz 0x12 12.288 MHz 0x13 13.56 MHz 0x14 14.31818 MHz 0x15 16.0 MHz 0x16 16.384 MHz January 22, 2012 205 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 5:4 OSCSRC R/W 0x1 Description Oscillator Source Selects the input source for the OSC. The values are: Value Input Source 0x0 MOSC Main oscillator 0x1 PIOSC Precision internal oscillator (default) 0x2 PIOSC/4 Precision internal oscillator / 4 0x3 30 kHz 30-kHz internal oscillator For additional oscillator sources, see the RCC2 register. 3:2 reserved RO 0x0 1 IOSCDIS R/W 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Precision Internal Oscillator Disable Value Description 0 MOSCDIS R/W 1 1 The precision internal oscillator (PIOSC) is disabled. 0 The precision internal oscillator is enabled. Main Oscillator Disable Value Description 1 The main oscillator is disabled (default). 0 The main oscillator is enabled. 206 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 8: XTAL to PLL Translation (PLLCFG), offset 0x064 This register provides a means of translating external crystal frequencies into the appropriate PLL settings. This register is initialized during the reset sequence and updated anytime that the XTAL field changes in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register (see page 203). The PLL frequency is calculated using the PLLCFG field values, as follows: PLLFreq = OSCFreq * F / (R + 1) XTAL to PLL Translation (PLLCFG) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x064 Type RO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 F Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:14 reserved RO 0x0000.0 13:5 F RO - R Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. PLL F Value This field specifies the value supplied to the PLL’s F input. 4:0 R RO - PLL R Value This field specifies the value supplied to the PLL’s R input. January 22, 2012 207 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 9: GPIO High-Performance Bus Control (GPIOHBCTL), offset 0x06C This register controls which internal bus is used to access each GPIO port. When a bit is clear, the corresponding GPIO port is accessed across the legacy Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB) bus and through the APB memory aperture. When a bit is set, the corresponding port is accessed across the Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) bus and through the AHB memory aperture. Each GPIO port can be individually configured to use AHB or APB, but may be accessed only through one aperture. The AHB bus provides better back-to-back access performance than the APB bus. The address aperture in the memory map changes for the ports that are enabled for AHB access (see Table 9-7 on page 410). GPIO High-Performance Bus Control (GPIOHBCTL) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x06C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PORTJ PORTH PORTG PORTF PORTE PORTD PORTC PORTB PORTA R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:9 reserved RO 0x0000.0 8 PORTJ R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Port J Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port J. Value Description 7 PORTH R/W 0 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. Port H Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port H. Value Description 6 PORTG R/W 0 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. Port G Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port G. Value Description 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. 208 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 5 PORTF R/W 0 Description Port F Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port F. Value Description 4 PORTE R/W 0 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. Port E Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port E. Value Description 3 PORTD R/W 0 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. Port D Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port D. Value Description 2 PORTC R/W 0 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. Port C Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port C. Value Description 1 PORTB R/W 0 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. Port B Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port B. Value Description 0 PORTA R/W 0 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. Port A Advanced High-Performance Bus This bit defines the memory aperture for Port A. Value Description 1 Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) 0 Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB). This bus is the legacy bus. January 22, 2012 209 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 10: Run-Mode Clock Configuration 2 (RCC2), offset 0x070 This register overrides the RCC equivalent register fields, as shown in Table 5-9, when the USERCC2 bit is set, allowing the extended capabilities of the RCC2 register to be used while also providing a means to be backward-compatible to previous parts. Each RCC2 field that supersedes an RCC field is located at the same LSB bit position; however, some RCC2 fields are larger than the corresponding RCC field. Table 5-9. RCC2 Fields that Override RCC Fields RCC2 Field... Overrides RCC Field SYSDIV2, bits[28:23] SYSDIV, bits[26:23] PWRDN2, bit[13] PWRDN, bit[13] BYPASS2, bit[11] BYPASS, bit[11] OSCSRC2, bits[6:4] OSCSRC, bits[5:4] Important: Write the RCC register prior to writing the RCC2 register. If a subsequent write to the RCC register is required, include another register access after writing the RCC register and before writing the RCC2 register. Run-Mode Clock Configuration 2 (RCC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x070 Type R/W, reset 0x07C0.6810 31 30 USERCC2 DIV400 Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 SYSDIV2 reserved RO 0 R/W 0 22 R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 10 9 8 7 6 13 12 11 PWRDN2 reserved BYPASS2 R/W 1 RO 0 R/W 1 reserved RO 0 21 20 19 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 USERCC2 R/W 0 Use RCC2 R/W 0 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 OSCSRC2 RO 0 18 reserved SYSDIV2LSB R/W 0 reserved R/W 1 RO 0 RO 0 Value Description 30 DIV400 R/W 0 1 The RCC2 register fields override the RCC register fields. 0 The RCC register fields are used, and the fields in RCC2 are ignored. Divide PLL as 400 MHz vs. 200 MHz This bit, along with the SYSDIV2LSB bit, allows additional frequency choices. Value Description 1 Append the SYSDIV2LSB bit to the SYSDIV2 field to create a 7 bit divisor using the 400 MHz PLL output, see Table 5-7 on page 185. 0 Use SYSDIV2 as is and apply to 200 MHz predivided PLL output. See Table 5-6 on page 184 for programming guidelines. 210 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 29 reserved RO 0x0 28:23 SYSDIV2 R/W 0x0F Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. System Clock Divisor 2 Specifies which divisor is used to generate the system clock from either the PLL output or the oscillator source (depending on how the BYPASS2 bit is configured). SYSDIV2 is used for the divisor when both the USESYSDIV bit in the RCC register and the USERCC2 bit in this register are set. See Table 5-6 on page 184 for programming guidelines. 22 SYSDIV2LSB R/W 1 Additional LSB for SYSDIV2 When DIV400 is set, this bit becomes the LSB of SYSDIV2. If DIV400 is clear, this bit is not used. See Table 5-6 on page 184 for programming guidelines. This bit can only be set or cleared when DIV400 is set. 21:14 reserved RO 0x0 13 PWRDN2 R/W 1 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Power-Down PLL 2 Value Description 1 The PLL is powered down. 0 The PLL operates normally. 12 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 11 BYPASS2 R/W 1 PLL Bypass 2 Value Description 1 The system clock is derived from the OSC source and divided by the divisor specified by SYSDIV2. 0 The system clock is the PLL output clock divided by the divisor specified by SYSDIV2. See Table 5-6 on page 184 for programming guidelines. Note: 10:7 reserved RO 0x0 The ADC must be clocked from the PLL or directly from a 16-MHz clock source to operate properly. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 211 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 6:4 OSCSRC2 R/W 0x1 Description Oscillator Source 2 Selects the input source for the OSC. The values are: Value Description 0x0 MOSC Main oscillator 0x1 PIOSC Precision internal oscillator 0x2 PIOSC/4 Precision internal oscillator / 4 0x3 30 kHz 30-kHz internal oscillator 0x4-0x6 Reserved 0x7 32.768 kHz 32.768-kHz external oscillator 3:0 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 212 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 11: Main Oscillator Control (MOSCCTL), offset 0x07C This register provides the ability to enable the MOSC clock verification circuit. When enabled, this circuit monitors the frequency of the MOSC to verify that the oscillator is operating within specified limits. If the clock goes invalid after being enabled, the microcontroller issues a power-on reset and reboots to the NMI handler. Main Oscillator Control (MOSCCTL) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x07C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:1 reserved RO 0x0000.000 0 CVAL R/W 0 RO 0 CVAL R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Clock Validation for MOSC Value Description 1 The MOSC monitor circuit is enabled. 0 The MOSC monitor circuit is disabled. January 22, 2012 213 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 12: Deep Sleep Clock Configuration (DSLPCLKCFG), offset 0x144 This register provides configuration information for the hardware control of Deep Sleep Mode. Deep Sleep Clock Configuration (DSLPCLKCFG) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x144 Type R/W, reset 0x0780.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 reserved Type Reset 25 24 23 22 21 20 DSDIVORIDE 18 17 16 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset 19 DSOSCSRC RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:29 reserved RO 0x0 28:23 DSDIVORIDE R/W 0x0F R/W 0 reserved Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Divider Field Override If Deep-Sleep mode is enabled when the PLL is running, the PLL is disabled. This 6-bit field contains a system divider field that overrides the SYSDIV field in the RCC register or the SYSDIV2 field in the RCC2 register during Deep Sleep. This divider is applied to the source selected by the DSOSCSRC field. Value Description 0x0 /1 0x1 /2 0x2 /3 0x3 /4 ... ... 0x3F /64 22:7 reserved RO 0x000 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 214 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 6:4 DSOSCSRC R/W 0x0 Description Clock Source Specifies the clock source during Deep-Sleep mode. Value Description 0x0 MOSC Use the main oscillator as the source. Note: 0x1 If the PIOSC is being used as the clock reference for the PLL, the PIOSC is the clock source instead of MOSC in Deep-Sleep mode. PIOSC Use the precision internal 16-MHz oscillator as the source. 0x2 Reserved 0x3 30 kHz Use the 30-kHz internal oscillator as the source. 0x4-0x6 Reserved 0x7 32.768 kHz Use the Hibernation module 32.768-kHz external oscillator as the source. 3:0 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 215 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 13: Precision Internal Oscillator Calibration (PIOSCCAL), offset 0x150 This register provides the ability to update or recalibrate the precision internal oscillator. Note that a 32.768-kHz oscillator must be used as the Hibernation module clock source for the user to be able to calibrate the PIOSC. Precision Internal Oscillator Calibration (PIOSCCAL) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x150 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 CAL UPDATE reserved R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 UTEN Type Reset reserved reserved Type Reset 23 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31 UTEN R/W 0 UT Description Use User Trim Value Value Description 30:10 reserved RO 0x0000 9 CAL R/W 0 1 The trim value in bits[6:0] of this register are used for any update trim operation. 0 The factory calibration value is used for an update trim operation. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Start Calibration Value Description 1 Starts a new calibration of the PIOSC. Results are in the PIOSCSTAT register. The resulting trim value from the operation is active in the PIOSC after the calibration completes. The result overrides any previous update trim operation whether the calibration passes or fails. 0 No action. This bit is auto-cleared after it is set. 8 UPDATE R/W 0 Update Trim Value Description 1 Updates the PIOSC trim value with the UT bit or the DT bit in the PIOSCSTAT register. Used with UTEN. 0 No action. This bit is auto-cleared after the update. 7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 216 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 6:0 UT R/W 0x0 Description User Trim Value User trim value that can be loaded into the PIOSC. Refer to “Main PLL Frequency Configuration” on page 186 for more information on calibrating the PIOSC. January 22, 2012 217 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 14: Precision Internal Oscillator Statistics (PIOSCSTAT), offset 0x154 This register provides the user information on the PIOSC calibration. Note that a 32.768-kHz oscillator must be used as the Hibernation module clock source for the user to be able to calibrate the PIOSC. Precision Internal Oscillator Statistics (PIOSCSTAT) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x154 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0040 31 30 29 28 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - RO - 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset DT reserved Type Reset RO 0 RESULT CT reserved RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:23 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 22:16 DT RO - Default Trim Value This field contains the default trim value. This value is loaded into the PIOSC after every full power-up. 15:10 reserved RO 0x0 9:8 RESULT RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Calibration Result Value Description 7 reserved RO 0 6:0 CT RO 0x40 0x0 Calibration has not been attempted. 0x1 The last calibration operation completed to meet 1% accuracy. 0x2 The last calibration operation failed to meet 1% accuracy. 0x3 Reserved Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Calibration Trim Value This field contains the trim value from the last calibration operation. After factory calibration CT and DT are the same. 218 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 15: Device Identification 1 (DID1), offset 0x004 This register identifies the device family, part number, temperature range, pin count, and package type. Each microcontroller is uniquely identified by the combined values of the CLASS field in the DID0 register and the PARTNO field in the DID1 register. Device Identification 1 (DID1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x004 Type RO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 RO 0 15 25 24 23 22 21 20 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO - RO - RO - VER Type Reset FAM PINCOUNT Type Reset RO 0 RO 1 18 17 16 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 3 2 1 0 PARTNO reserved RO 0 19 TEMP Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:28 VER RO 0x1 RO - PKG ROHS RO - RO 1 QUAL RO - RO - Description DID1 Version This field defines the DID1 register format version. The version number is numeric. The value of the VER field is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x1 27:24 FAM RO 0x0 Second version of the DID1 register format. Family This field provides the family identification of the device within the Luminary Micro product portfolio. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x0 23:16 PARTNO RO 0xAF Stellaris family of microcontollers, that is, all devices with external part numbers starting with LM3S. Part Number This field provides the part number of the device within the family. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0xAF LM3S1G21 15:13 PINCOUNT RO 0x2 Package Pin Count This field specifies the number of pins on the device package. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x2 100-pin package January 22, 2012 219 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 12:8 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 7:5 TEMP RO - Temperature Range This field specifies the temperature rating of the device. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 4:3 PKG RO - 0x0 Commercial temperature range (0°C to 70°C) 0x1 Industrial temperature range (-40°C to 85°C) 0x2 Extended temperature range (-40°C to 105°C) Package Type This field specifies the package type. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 2 ROHS RO 1 0x0 SOIC package 0x1 LQFP package 0x2 BGA package RoHS-Compliance This bit specifies whether the device is RoHS-compliant. A 1 indicates the part is RoHS-compliant. 1:0 QUAL RO - Qualification Status This field specifies the qualification status of the device. The value is encoded as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x0 Engineering Sample (unqualified) 0x1 Pilot Production (unqualified) 0x2 Fully Qualified 220 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 16: Device Capabilities 0 (DC0), offset 0x008 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. Device Capabilities 0 (DC0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x008 Type RO, reset 0x00FF.00BF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 SRAMSZ Type Reset FLASHSZ Type Reset RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:16 SRAMSZ RO 0x00FF SRAM Size Indicates the size of the on-chip SRAM memory. Value Description 0x00FF 64 KB of SRAM 15:0 FLASHSZ RO 0x00BF Flash Size Indicates the size of the on-chip flash memory. Value Description 0x00BF 384 KB of Flash January 22, 2012 221 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 17: Device Capabilities 1 (DC1), offset 0x010 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. If any bit is clear in this register, the module is not present. The corresponding bit in the RCGC0, SCGC0, and DCGC0 registers cannot be set. Device Capabilities 1 (DC1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x010 Type RO, reset 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset 28 26 25 24 23 WDT1 22 21 20 19 18 17 reserved 16 ADC0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MPU HIB TEMPSNS PLL WDT0 SWO SWD JTAG RO - RO - RO - RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 MINSYSDIV Type Reset 27 RO - reserved RO 0 MAXADC0SPD RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:29 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 28 WDT1 RO 1 Watchdog Timer 1 Present When set, indicates that watchdog timer 1 is present. 27:17 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 16 ADC0 RO 1 ADC Module 0 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 is present 15:12 MINSYSDIV RO - System Clock Divider Minimum 4-bit divider value for system clock. The reset value is hardware-dependent. See the RCC register for how to change the system clock divisor using the SYSDIV bit. Value Description 11:10 reserved RO 0 0x1 Specifies an 80-MHz CPU clock with a PLL divider of 2.5. 0x2 Specifies a 66.67-MHz CPU clock with a PLL divider of 3. 0x3 Specifies a 50-MHz CPU clock with a PLL divider of 4. 0x7 Specifies a 25-MHz clock with a PLL divider of 8. 0x9 Specifies a 20-MHz clock with a PLL divider of 10. Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 222 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 9:8 MAXADC0SPD RO 0x3 Description Max ADC0 Speed This field indicates the maximum rate at which the ADC samples data. Value Description 0x3 7 MPU RO 1 1M samples/second MPU Present When set, indicates that the Cortex-M3 Memory Protection Unit (MPU) module is present. See the "Cortex-M3 Peripherals" chapter for details on the MPU. 6 HIB RO 1 Hibernation Module Present When set, indicates that the Hibernation module is present. 5 TEMPSNS RO 1 Temp Sensor Present When set, indicates that the on-chip temperature sensor is present. 4 PLL RO 1 PLL Present When set, indicates that the on-chip Phase Locked Loop (PLL) is present. 3 WDT0 RO 1 Watchdog Timer 0 Present When set, indicates that watchdog timer 0 is present. 2 SWO RO 1 SWO Trace Port Present When set, indicates that the Serial Wire Output (SWO) trace port is present. 1 SWD RO 1 SWD Present When set, indicates that the Serial Wire Debugger (SWD) is present. 0 JTAG RO 1 JTAG Present When set, indicates that the JTAG debugger interface is present. January 22, 2012 223 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 18: Device Capabilities 2 (DC2), offset 0x014 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. If any bit is clear in this register, the module is not present. The corresponding bit in the RCGC0, SCGC0, and DCGC0 registers cannot be set. Device Capabilities 2 (DC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x014 Type RO, reset 0x430F.5037 Type Reset Type Reset 31 30 29 28 reserved EPI0 RO 0 27 26 25 24 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 COMP1 COMP0 RO 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 reserved I2C1 reserved I2C0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 TIMER3 TIMER2 TIMER1 TIMER0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 SSI1 SSI0 reserved UART2 UART1 UART0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 reserved reserved Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 30 EPI0 RO 1 EPI Module 0 Present When set, indicates that EPI module 0 is present. 29:26 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 25 COMP1 RO 1 Analog Comparator 1 Present When set, indicates that analog comparator 1 is present. 24 COMP0 RO 1 Analog Comparator 0 Present When set, indicates that analog comparator 0 is present. 23:20 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 19 TIMER3 RO 1 Timer Module 3 Present When set, indicates that General-Purpose Timer module 3 is present. 18 TIMER2 RO 1 Timer Module 2 Present When set, indicates that General-Purpose Timer module 2 is present. 17 TIMER1 RO 1 Timer Module 1 Present When set, indicates that General-Purpose Timer module 1 is present. 16 TIMER0 RO 1 Timer Module 0 Present When set, indicates that General-Purpose Timer module 0 is present. 15 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 224 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 14 I2C1 RO 1 Description I2C Module 1 Present When set, indicates that I2C module 1 is present. 13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 12 I2C0 RO 1 I2C Module 0 Present When set, indicates that I2C module 0 is present. 11:6 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 5 SSI1 RO 1 SSI Module 1 Present When set, indicates that SSI module 1 is present. 4 SSI0 RO 1 SSI Module 0 Present When set, indicates that SSI module 0 is present. 3 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 2 UART2 RO 1 UART Module 2 Present When set, indicates that UART module 2 is present. 1 UART1 RO 1 UART Module 1 Present When set, indicates that UART module 1 is present. 0 UART0 RO 1 UART Module 0 Present When set, indicates that UART module 0 is present. January 22, 2012 225 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 19: Device Capabilities 3 (DC3), offset 0x018 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. If any bit is clear in this register, the module is not present. The corresponding bit in the RCGC0, SCGC0, and DCGC0 registers cannot be set. Device Capabilities 3 (DC3) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x018 Type RO, reset 0xBFFF.0FC0 Type Reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 32KHZ reserved CCP5 CCP4 CCP3 CCP2 CCP1 CCP0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset C1O RO 0 RO 0 C1PLUS C1MINUS RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31 32KHZ RO 1 C0O RO 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 ADC0AIN7 ADC0AIN6 ADC0AIN5 ADC0AIN4 ADC0AIN3 ADC0AIN2 ADC0AIN1 ADC0AIN0 C0PLUS C0MINUS RO 1 RO 1 reserved Description 32KHz Input Clock Available When set, indicates an even CCP pin is present and can be used as a 32-KHz input clock. 30 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 29 CCP5 RO 1 CCP5 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 5 is present. 28 CCP4 RO 1 CCP4 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 4 is present. 27 CCP3 RO 1 CCP3 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 3 is present. 26 CCP2 RO 1 CCP2 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 2 is present. 25 CCP1 RO 1 CCP1 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 1 is present. 24 CCP0 RO 1 CCP0 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 0 is present. 23 ADC0AIN7 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN7 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 7 is present. 22 ADC0AIN6 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN6 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 6 is present. 21 ADC0AIN5 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN5 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 5 is present. 226 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 20 ADC0AIN4 RO 1 Description ADC Module 0 AIN4 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 4 is present. 19 ADC0AIN3 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN3 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 3 is present. 18 ADC0AIN2 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN2 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 2 is present. 17 ADC0AIN1 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN1 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 1 is present. 16 ADC0AIN0 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN0 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 0 is present. 15:12 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 11 C1O RO 1 C1o Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 1 output pin is present. 10 C1PLUS RO 1 C1+ Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 1 (+) input pin is present. 9 C1MINUS RO 1 C1- Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 1 (-) input pin is present. 8 C0O RO 1 C0o Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 0 output pin is present. 7 C0PLUS RO 1 C0+ Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 0 (+) input pin is present. 6 C0MINUS RO 1 C0- Pin Present When set, indicates that the analog comparator 0 (-) input pin is present. 5:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 227 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 20: Device Capabilities 4 (DC4), offset 0x01C This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. If any bit is clear in this register, the module is not present. The corresponding bit in the RCGC0, SCGC0, and DCGC0 registers cannot be set. Device Capabilities 4 (DC4) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x01C Type RO, reset 0x0004.F1FF 31 30 29 28 27 26 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 CCP7 CCP6 UDMA ROM RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOJ GPIOH GPIOG GPIOF GPIOE GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 reserved Type Reset Type Reset reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 18 17 PICAL 16 reserved Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:19 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 18 PICAL RO 1 PIOSC Calibrate When set, indicates that the PIOSC can be calibrated. 17:16 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 15 CCP7 RO 1 CCP7 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 7 is present. 14 CCP6 RO 1 CCP6 Pin Present When set, indicates that Capture/Compare/PWM pin 6 is present. 13 UDMA RO 1 Micro-DMA Module Present When set, indicates that the micro-DMA module present. 12 ROM RO 1 Internal Code ROM Present When set, indicates that internal code ROM is present. 11:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 8 GPIOJ RO 1 GPIO Port J Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port J is present. 7 GPIOH RO 1 GPIO Port H Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port H is present. 6 GPIOG RO 1 GPIO Port G Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port G is present. 228 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 5 GPIOF RO 1 Description GPIO Port F Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port F is present. 4 GPIOE RO 1 GPIO Port E Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port E is present. 3 GPIOD RO 1 GPIO Port D Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port D is present. 2 GPIOC RO 1 GPIO Port C Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port C is present. 1 GPIOB RO 1 GPIO Port B Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port B is present. 0 GPIOA RO 1 GPIO Port A Present When set, indicates that GPIO Port A is present. January 22, 2012 229 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 21: Device Capabilities 5 (DC5), offset 0x020 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. If any bit is clear in this register, the module is not present. The corresponding bit in the RCGC0, SCGC0, and DCGC0 registers cannot be set. Device Capabilities 5 (DC5) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x020 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 reserved RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 230 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 22: Device Capabilities 6 (DC6), offset 0x024 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. If any bit is clear in this register, the module is not present. The corresponding bit in the RCGC0, SCGC0, and DCGC0 registers cannot be set. Device Capabilities 6 (DC6) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x024 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 reserved RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 231 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 23: Device Capabilities 7 (DC7), offset 0x028 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify uDMA channel features. A 1 indicates the channel is available on this device; a 0 that the channel is only available on other devices in the family. Most channels have primary and secondary assignments. If the primary function is not available on this microcontroller, the secondary function becomes the primary function. If the secondary function is not available, the primary function is the only option. Device Capabilities 7 (DC7) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x028 Type RO, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 reserved Type Reset 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 DMACH30 DMACH29 DMACH28 DMACH27 DMACH26 DMACH25 DMACH24 DMACH23 DMACH22 DMACH21 DMACH20 DMACH19 DMACH18 DMACH17 DMACH16 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DMACH15 DMACH14 DMACH13 DMACH12 DMACH11 DMACH10 DMACH9 DMACH8 DMACH7 DMACH6 DMACH5 DMACH4 DMACH3 DMACH2 DMACH1 DMACH0 Type Reset RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31 reserved RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Description Reserved Reserved for uDMA channel 31. 30 DMACH30 RO 1 SW When set, indicates uDMA channel 30 is available for software transfers. 29 DMACH29 RO 1 I2S0_TX / CAN1_TX When set, indicates uDMA channel 29 is available and connected to the transmit path of I2S module 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of CAN module 1 transmit. 28 DMACH28 RO 1 I2S0_RX / CAN1_RX When set, indicates uDMA channel 28 is available and connected to the receive path of I2S module 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of CAN module 1 receive. 27 DMACH27 RO 1 CAN1_TX / ADC1_SS3 When set, indicates uDMA channel 27 is available and connected to the transmit path of CAN module 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of ADC module 1 Sample Sequencer 3. 26 DMACH26 RO 1 CAN1_RX / ADC1_SS2 When set, indicates uDMA channel 26 is available and connected to the receive path of CAN module 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of ADC module 1 Sample Sequencer 2. 232 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 25 DMACH25 RO 1 Description SSI1_TX / ADC1_SS1 When set, indicates uDMA channel 25 is available and connected to the transmit path of SSI module 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of ADC module 1 Sample Sequencer 1. 24 DMACH24 RO 1 SSI1_RX / ADC1_SS0 When set, indicates uDMA channel 24 is available and connected to the receive path of SSI module 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of ADC module 1 Sample Sequencer 0. 23 DMACH23 RO 1 UART1_TX / CAN2_TX When set, indicates uDMA channel 23 is available and connected to the transmit path of UART module 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of CAN module 2 transmit. 22 DMACH22 RO 1 UART1_RX / CAN2_RX When set, indicates uDMA channel 22 is available and connected to the receive path of UART module 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of CAN module 2 receive. 21 DMACH21 RO 1 Timer1B / EPI0_WFIFO When set, indicates uDMA channel 21 is available and connected to Timer 1B. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of EPI module 0 write FIFO (WRIFO). 20 DMACH20 RO 1 Timer1A / EPI0_NBRFIFO When set, indicates uDMA channel 20 is available and connected to Timer 1A. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of EPI module 0 non-blocking read FIFO (NBRFIFO). 19 DMACH19 RO 1 Timer0B / Timer1B When set, indicates uDMA channel 19 is available and connected to Timer 0B. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 1B. 18 DMACH18 RO 1 Timer0A / Timer1A When set, indicates uDMA channel 18 is available and connected to Timer 0A. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 1A. 17 DMACH17 RO 1 ADC0_SS3 When set, indicates uDMA channel 17 is available and connected to ADC module 0 Sample Sequencer 3. 16 DMACH16 RO 1 ADC0_SS2 When set, indicates uDMA channel 16 is available and connected to ADC module 0 Sample Sequencer 2. January 22, 2012 233 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 15 DMACH15 RO 1 Description ADC0_SS1 / Timer2B When set, indicates uDMA channel 15 is available and connected to ADC module 0 Sample Sequencer 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 2B. 14 DMACH14 RO 1 ADC0_SS0 / Timer2A When set, indicates uDMA channel 14 is available and connected to ADC module 0 Sample Sequencer 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 2A. 13 DMACH13 RO 1 CAN0_TX / UART2_TX When set, indicates uDMA channel 13 is available and connected to the transmit path of CAN module 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of UART module 2 transmit. 12 DMACH12 RO 1 CAN0_RX / UART2_RX When set, indicates uDMA channel 12 is available and connected to the receive path of CAN module 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of UART module 2 receive. 11 DMACH11 RO 1 SSI0_TX / SSI1_TX When set, indicates uDMA channel 11 is available and connected to the transmit path of SSI module 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of SSI module 1 transmit. 10 DMACH10 RO 1 SSI0_RX / SSI1_RX When set, indicates uDMA channel 10 is available and connected to the receive path of SSI module 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of SSI module 1 receive. 9 DMACH9 RO 1 UART0_TX / UART1_TX When set, indicates uDMA channel 9 is available and connected to the transmit path of UART module 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of UART module 1 transmit. 8 DMACH8 RO 1 UART0_RX / UART1_RX When set, indicates uDMA channel 8 is available and connected to the receive path of UART module 0. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of UART module 1 receive. 7 DMACH7 RO 1 ETH_TX / Timer2B When set, indicates uDMA channel 7 is available and connected to the transmit path of the Ethernet module. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 2B. 234 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 6 DMACH6 RO 1 Description ETH_RX / Timer2A When set, indicates uDMA channel 6 is available and connected to the receive path of the Ethernet module. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 2A. 5 DMACH5 RO 1 USB_EP3_TX / Timer2B When set, indicates uDMA channel 5 is available and connected to the transmit path of USB endpoint 3. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 2B. 4 DMACH4 RO 1 USB_EP3_RX / Timer2A When set, indicates uDMA channel 4 is available and connected to the receive path of USB endpoint 3. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 2A. 3 DMACH3 RO 1 USB_EP2_TX / Timer3B When set, indicates uDMA channel 3 is available and connected to the transmit path of USB endpoint 2. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 3B. 2 DMACH2 RO 1 USB_EP2_RX / Timer3A When set, indicates uDMA channel 2 is available and connected to the receive path of USB endpoint 2. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of Timer 3A. 1 DMACH1 RO 1 USB_EP1_TX / UART2_TX When set, indicates uDMA channel 1 is available and connected to the transmit path of USB endpoint 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of UART module 2 transmit. 0 DMACH0 RO 1 USB_EP1_RX / UART2_RX When set, indicates uDMA channel 0 is available and connected to the receive path of USB endpoint 1. If the corresponding bit in the DMACHASGN register is set, the channel is connected instead to the secondary channel assignment of UART module 2 receive. January 22, 2012 235 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 24: Device Capabilities 8 ADC Channels (DC8), offset 0x02C This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. Device Capabilities 8 ADC Channels (DC8) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x02C Type RO, reset 0x0000.00FF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset ADC0AIN7 ADC0AIN6 ADC0AIN5 ADC0AIN4 ADC0AIN3 ADC0AIN2 ADC0AIN1 ADC0AIN0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:8 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 7 ADC0AIN7 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN7 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 7 is present. 6 ADC0AIN6 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN6 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 6 is present. 5 ADC0AIN5 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN5 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 5 is present. 4 ADC0AIN4 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN4 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 4 is present. 3 ADC0AIN3 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN3 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 3 is present. 2 ADC0AIN2 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN2 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 2 is present. 1 ADC0AIN1 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN1 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 1 is present. 0 ADC0AIN0 RO 1 ADC Module 0 AIN0 Pin Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 input pin 0 is present. 236 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 25: Device Capabilities 9 ADC Digital Comparators (DC9), offset 0x190 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. Device Capabilities 9 ADC Digital Comparators (DC9) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x190 Type RO, reset 0x0000.00FF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 ADC0DC7 ADC0DC6 ADC0DC5 ADC0DC4 ADC0DC3 ADC0DC2 ADC0DC1 ADC0DC0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:8 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 7 ADC0DC7 RO 1 ADC0 DC7 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 Digital Comparator 7 is present. 6 ADC0DC6 RO 1 ADC0 DC6 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 Digital Comparator 6 is present. 5 ADC0DC5 RO 1 ADC0 DC5 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 Digital Comparator 5 is present. 4 ADC0DC4 RO 1 ADC0 DC4 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 Digital Comparator 4 is present. 3 ADC0DC3 RO 1 ADC0 DC3 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 Digital Comparator 3 is present. 2 ADC0DC2 RO 1 ADC0 DC2 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 Digital Comparator 2 is present. 1 ADC0DC1 RO 1 ADC0 DC1 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 Digital Comparator 1 is present. 0 ADC0DC0 RO 1 ADC0 DC0 Present When set, indicates that ADC module 0 Digital Comparator 0 is present. January 22, 2012 237 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 26: Non-Volatile Memory Information (NVMSTAT), offset 0x1A0 This register is predefined by the part and can be used to verify features. Non-Volatile Memory Information (NVMSTAT) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x1A0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0001 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 FWB RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:1 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 0 FWB RO 1 32 Word Flash Write Buffer Active When set, indicates that the 32 word Flash memory write buffer feature is active. 238 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 27: Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (RCGC0), offset 0x100 This register controls the clock gating logic in normal Run mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC0 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC0 for Sleep operation, and DCGC0 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (RCGC0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x100 Type R/W, reset 0x00000040 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset 28 27 26 25 24 23 WDT1 21 20 19 18 17 reserved 16 ADC0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset 22 RO 0 MAXADC0SPD R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved HIB RO 0 R/W 1 reserved RO 0 RO 0 WDT0 R/W 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:29 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 28 WDT1 R/W 0 WDT1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the Watchdog Timer module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 27:17 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 16 ADC0 R/W 0 ADC0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for ADC module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 15:10 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 239 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 9:8 MAXADC0SPD R/W 0 Description ADC0 Sample Speed This field sets the rate at which ADC0 samples data. You cannot set the rate higher than the maximum rate. You can set the sample rate by setting the MAXADC0SPD bit as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x3 1M samples/second 0x2 500K samples/second 0x1 250K samples/second 0x0 125K samples/second 7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 6 HIB R/W 1 HIB Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the Hibernation module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 5:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 3 WDT0 R/W 0 WDT0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the Watchdog Timer module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 2:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 240 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 28: Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (SCGC0), offset 0x110 This register controls the clock gating logic in Sleep mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC0 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC0 for Sleep operation, and DCGC0 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (SCGC0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x110 Type R/W, reset 0x00000040 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset 28 27 26 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 RO 0 RO 0 24 23 RO 0 RO 0 22 21 20 19 18 17 reserved reserved Type Reset 25 WDT1 RO 0 RO 0 9 8 MAXADC0SPD RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 5 4 7 6 reserved HIB RO 0 R/W 1 16 ADC0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 WDT0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 1 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:29 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 28 WDT1 R/W 0 WDT1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Watchdog Timer module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 27:17 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 16 ADC0 R/W 0 ADC0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for ADC module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 15:10 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 241 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 9:8 MAXADC0SPD R/W 0 Description ADC0 Sample Speed This field sets the rate at which ADC module 0 samples data. You cannot set the rate higher than the maximum rate. You can set the sample rate by setting the MAXADC0SPD bit as follows (all other encodings are reserved): Value Description 0x3 1M samples/second 0x2 500K samples/second 0x1 250K samples/second 0x0 125K samples/second 7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 6 HIB R/W 1 HIB Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the Hibernation module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 5:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 3 WDT0 R/W 0 WDT0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the Watchdog Timer module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 2:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 242 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 29: Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (DCGC0), offset 0x120 This register controls the clock gating logic in Deep-Sleep mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC0 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC0 for Sleep operation, and DCGC0 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (DCGC0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x120 Type R/W, reset 0x00000040 31 30 29 reserved Type Reset 28 27 26 25 24 23 WDT1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 11 10 9 8 7 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 22 21 20 19 18 17 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 6 5 4 HIB RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 1 16 ADC0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 WDT0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 1 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:29 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 28 WDT1 R/W 0 WDT1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the Watchdog Timer module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 27:17 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 16 ADC0 R/W 0 ADC0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for ADC module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 15:7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 243 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 6 HIB R/W 1 Description HIB Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the Hibernation module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 5:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 3 WDT0 R/W 0 WDT0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for the Watchdog Timer module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 2:0 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 244 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 30: Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (RCGC1), offset 0x104 This register controls the clock gating logic in normal Run mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC1 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC1 for Sleep operation, and DCGC1 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (RCGC1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x104 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 Type Reset Type Reset 31 30 29 28 reserved EPI0 RO 0 27 26 25 24 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 COMP1 COMP0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 reserved I2C1 reserved I2C0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 TIMER3 TIMER2 TIMER1 TIMER0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 SSI1 SSI0 reserved UART2 UART1 UART0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved reserved Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 30 EPI0 R/W 0 EPI0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for EPI module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 29:26 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 25 COMP1 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 1 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 24 COMP0 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. January 22, 2012 245 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 23:20 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 19 TIMER3 R/W 0 Timer 3 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 3. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 Timer 2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 2. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 Timer 1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 Timer 0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 15 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 14 I2C1 R/W 0 I2C1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 12 I2C0 R/W 0 I2C0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 11:6 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 5 SSI1 R/W 0 SSI1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 246 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 4 SSI0 R/W 0 Description SSI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 3 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 2 UART2 R/W 0 UART2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 2. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 1 UART1 R/W 0 UART1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 0 UART0 R/W 0 UART0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. January 22, 2012 247 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 31: Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (SCGC1), offset 0x114 This register controls the clock gating logic in Sleep mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC1 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC1 for Sleep operation, and DCGC1 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (SCGC1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x114 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 Type Reset Type Reset 31 30 reserved EPI0 RO 0 R/W 0 29 28 27 26 reserved RO 0 25 24 COMP1 COMP0 23 22 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 11 10 9 8 7 6 15 14 13 12 reserved I2C1 reserved I2C0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 21 20 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 TIMER3 TIMER2 TIMER1 TIMER0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSI1 SSI0 reserved UART2 UART1 UART0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 30 EPI0 R/W 0 EPI0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for EPI module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 29:26 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 25 COMP1 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 1 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 24 COMP0 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 248 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 23:20 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 19 TIMER3 R/W 0 Timer 3 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 3. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 Timer 2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 2. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 Timer 1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 Timer 0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 15 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 14 I2C1 R/W 0 I2C1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 12 I2C0 R/W 0 I2C0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 11:6 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 5 SSI1 R/W 0 SSI1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. January 22, 2012 249 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 4 SSI0 R/W 0 Description SSI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 3 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 2 UART2 R/W 0 UART2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 2. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 1 UART1 R/W 0 UART1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 0 UART0 R/W 0 UART0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 250 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 32: Deep-Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (DCGC1), offset 0x124 This register controls the clock gating logic in Deep-Sleep mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC1 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC1 for Sleep operation, and DCGC1 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Deep-Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 1 (DCGC1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x124 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 Type Reset Type Reset 31 30 reserved EPI0 RO 0 R/W 0 29 28 27 26 reserved RO 0 25 24 COMP1 COMP0 23 22 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 11 10 9 8 7 6 15 14 13 12 reserved I2C1 reserved I2C0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 21 20 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 19 18 17 16 TIMER3 TIMER2 TIMER1 TIMER0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 SSI1 SSI0 reserved UART2 UART1 UART0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 30 EPI0 R/W 0 EPI0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for EPI module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 29:26 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 25 COMP1 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 1 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 24 COMP0 R/W 0 Analog Comparator 0 Clock Gating This bit controls the clock gating for analog comparator 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. January 22, 2012 251 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 23:20 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 19 TIMER3 R/W 0 Timer 3 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 3. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 Timer 2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 2. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 Timer 1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 Timer 0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for General-Purpose Timer module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 15 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 14 I2C1 R/W 0 I2C1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 12 I2C0 R/W 0 I2C0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for I2C module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 11:6 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 5 SSI1 R/W 0 SSI1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 252 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 4 SSI0 R/W 0 Description SSI0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for SSI module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 3 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 2 UART2 R/W 0 UART2 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 2. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 1 UART1 R/W 0 UART1 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 1. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 0 UART0 R/W 0 UART0 Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for UART module 0. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. January 22, 2012 253 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 33: Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (RCGC2), offset 0x108 This register controls the clock gating logic in normal Run mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC2 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC2 for Sleep operation, and DCGC2 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (RCGC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x108 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOJ GPIOH GPIOG GPIOF GPIOE GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 UDMA R/W 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:14 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 13 UDMA R/W 0 Micro-DMA Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for micro-DMA. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 12:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 8 GPIOJ R/W 0 Port J Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port J. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 7 GPIOH R/W 0 Port H Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port H. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 254 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 6 GPIOG R/W 0 Description Port G Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port G. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 5 GPIOF R/W 0 Port F Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port F. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 4 GPIOE R/W 0 Port E Clock Gating Control Port E Clock Gating Control. This bit controls the clock gating for Port E. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 3 GPIOD R/W 0 Port D Clock Gating Control Port D Clock Gating Control. This bit controls the clock gating for Port D. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 2 GPIOC R/W 0 Port C Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port C. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 1 GPIOB R/W 0 Port B Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port B. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Port A Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port A. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. January 22, 2012 255 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 34: Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (SCGC2), offset 0x118 This register controls the clock gating logic in Sleep mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC2 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC2 for Sleep operation, and DCGC2 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (SCGC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x118 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 15 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 13 12 11 10 9 UDMA R/W 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOJ GPIOH GPIOG GPIOF GPIOE GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:14 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 13 UDMA R/W 0 Micro-DMA Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for micro-DMA. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 12:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 8 GPIOJ R/W 0 Port J Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port J. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 7 GPIOH R/W 0 Port H Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port H. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 256 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 6 GPIOG R/W 0 Description Port G Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port G. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 5 GPIOF R/W 0 Port F Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port F. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 4 GPIOE R/W 0 Port E Clock Gating Control Port E Clock Gating Control. This bit controls the clock gating for Port E. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 3 GPIOD R/W 0 Port D Clock Gating Control Port D Clock Gating Control. This bit controls the clock gating for Port D. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 2 GPIOC R/W 0 Port C Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port C. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 1 GPIOB R/W 0 Port B Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port B. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Port A Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port A. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. January 22, 2012 257 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 35: Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (DCGC2), offset 0x128 This register controls the clock gating logic in Deep-Sleep mode. Each bit controls a clock enable for a given interface, function, or module. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled (saving power). If the module is unclocked, reads or writes to the module generate a bus fault. The reset state of these bits is 0 (unclocked) unless otherwise noted, so that all functional modules are disabled. It is the responsibility of software to enable the ports necessary for the application. Note that these registers may contain more bits than there are interfaces, functions, or modules to control. This configuration is implemented to assure reasonable code compatibility with other family and future parts. RCGC2 is the clock configuration register for running operation, SCGC2 for Sleep operation, and DCGC2 for Deep-Sleep operation. Setting the ACG bit in the Run-Mode Clock Configuration (RCC) register specifies that the system uses sleep modes. Deep Sleep Mode Clock Gating Control Register 2 (DCGC2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x128 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 15 14 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 13 12 11 10 9 UDMA R/W 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOJ GPIOH GPIOG GPIOF GPIOE GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:14 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 13 UDMA R/W 0 Micro-DMA Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for micro-DMA. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 12:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 8 GPIOJ R/W 0 Port J Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port J. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 7 GPIOH R/W 0 Port H Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port H. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 258 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 6 GPIOG R/W 0 Description Port G Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port G. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 5 GPIOF R/W 0 Port F Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port F. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 4 GPIOE R/W 0 Port E Clock Gating Control Port E Clock Gating Control. This bit controls the clock gating for Port E. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 3 GPIOD R/W 0 Port D Clock Gating Control Port D Clock Gating Control. This bit controls the clock gating for Port D. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 2 GPIOC R/W 0 Port C Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port C. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 1 GPIOB R/W 0 Port B Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port B. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Port A Clock Gating Control This bit controls the clock gating for Port A. If set, the module receives a clock and functions. Otherwise, the module is unclocked and disabled. If the module is unclocked, a read or write to the module generates a bus fault. January 22, 2012 259 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 36: Software Reset Control 0 (SRCR0), offset 0x040 This register allows individual modules to be reset. Writes to this register are masked by the bits in the Device Capabilities 1 (DC1) register. Software Reset Control 0 (SRCR0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x040 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 reserved Type Reset 27 26 25 24 23 WDT1 21 20 19 18 17 reserved 16 ADC0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset 22 HIB RO 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 WDT0 R/W 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:29 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 28 WDT1 R/W 0 WDT1 Reset Control When this bit is set, Watchdog Timer module 1 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 27:17 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 16 ADC0 R/W 0 ADC0 Reset Control When this bit is set, ADC module 0 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 15:7 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 6 HIB R/W 0 HIB Reset Control When this bit is set, the Hibernation module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states.This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 5:4 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 3 WDT0 R/W 0 WDT0 Reset Control When this bit is set, Watchdog Timer module 0 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 260 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 2:0 reserved RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 261 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Register 37: Software Reset Control 1 (SRCR1), offset 0x044 This register allows individual modules to be reset. Writes to this register are masked by the bits in the Device Capabilities 2 (DC2) register. Software Reset Control 1 (SRCR1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x044 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 Type Reset Type Reset 31 30 29 28 reserved EPI0 RO 0 27 26 25 24 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 COMP1 COMP0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 reserved I2C1 reserved I2C0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 TIMER3 TIMER2 TIMER1 TIMER0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 SSI1 SSI0 reserved UART2 UART1 UART0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved reserved Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 30 EPI0 R/W 0 EPI0 Reset Control When this bit is set, EPI module 0 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 29:26 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 25 COMP1 R/W 0 Analog Comp 1 Reset Control When this bit is set, Analog Comparator module 1 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 24 COMP0 R/W 0 Analog Comp 0 Reset Control When this bit is set, Analog Comparator module 0 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 23:20 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 19 TIMER3 R/W 0 Timer 3 Reset Control Timer 3 Reset Control. When this bit is set, General-Purpose Timer module 3 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 18 TIMER2 R/W 0 Timer 2 Reset Control When this bit is set, General-Purpose Timer module 2 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 262 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 17 TIMER1 R/W 0 Description Timer 1 Reset Control When this bit is set, General-Purpose Timer module 1 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 16 TIMER0 R/W 0 Timer 0 Reset Control When this bit is set, General-Purpose Timer module 0 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 15 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 14 I2C1 R/W 0 I2C1 Reset Control When this bit is set, I2C module 1 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 13 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 12 I2C0 R/W 0 I2C0 Reset Control When this bit is set, I2C module 0 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 11:6 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 5 SSI1 R/W 0 SSI1 Reset Control When this bit is set, SSI module 1 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 4 SSI0 R/W 0 SSI0 Reset Control When this bit is set, SSI module 0 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 3 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 2 UART2 R/W 0 UART2 Reset Control When this bit is set, UART module 2 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 1 UART1 R/W 0 UART1 Reset Control When this bit is set, UART module 1 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. January 22, 2012 263 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 UART0 R/W 0 Description UART0 Reset Control When this bit is set, UART module 0 is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 264 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 38: Software Reset Control 2 (SRCR2), offset 0x048 This register allows individual modules to be reset. Writes to this register are masked by the bits in the Device Capabilities 4 (DC4) register. Software Reset Control 2 (SRCR2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x048 Type R/W, reset 0x00000000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GPIOJ GPIOH GPIOG GPIOF GPIOE GPIOD GPIOC GPIOB GPIOA R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 UDMA R/W 0 reserved RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:14 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 13 UDMA R/W 0 Micro-DMA Reset Control When this bit is set, uDMA module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 12:9 reserved RO 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 8 GPIOJ R/W 0 Port J Reset Control When this bit is set, Port J module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 7 GPIOH R/W 0 Port H Reset Control When this bit is set, Port H module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 6 GPIOG R/W 0 Port G Reset Control When this bit is set, Port G module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 5 GPIOF R/W 0 Port F Reset Control When this bit is set, Port F module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 4 GPIOE R/W 0 Port E Reset Control When this bit is set, Port E module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. January 22, 2012 265 Texas Instruments-Production Data System Control Bit/Field Name Type Reset 3 GPIOD R/W 0 Description Port D Reset Control When this bit is set, Port D module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 2 GPIOC R/W 0 Port C Reset Control When this bit is set, Port C module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 1 GPIOB R/W 0 Port B Reset Control When this bit is set, Port B module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 0 GPIOA R/W 0 Port A Reset Control When this bit is set, Port A module is reset. All internal data is lost and the registers are returned to their reset states. This bit must be manually cleared after being set. 266 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 6 Hibernation Module The Hibernation Module manages removal and restoration of power to provide a means for reducing power consumption. When the processor and peripherals are idle, power can be completely removed with only the Hibernation module remaining powered. Power can be restored based on an external signal or at a certain time using the built-in Real-Time Clock (RTC). The Hibernation module can be independently supplied from a battery or an auxiliary power supply. The Hibernation module has the following features: ■ 32-bit real-time counter (RTC) – Two 32-bit RTC match registers for timed wake-up and interrupt generation – RTC predivider trim for making fine adjustments to the clock rate ■ Two mechanisms for power control – System power control using discrete external regulator – On-chip power control using internal switches under register control ■ Dedicated pin for waking using an external signal ■ RTC operational and hibernation memory valid as long as VBAT is valid ■ Low-battery detection, signaling, and interrupt generation ■ Clock source from a 32.768-kHz external oscillator or a 4.194304-MHz crystal; 32.768-kHz external oscillator can be used for main controller clock ■ 64 32-bit words of battery-backed memory to save state during hibernation ■ Programmable interrupts for RTC match, external wake, and low battery events January 22, 2012 267 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module 6.1 Block Diagram Figure 6-1. Hibernation Module Block Diagram HIBCTL.CLK32EN XOSC0 Interrupts HIBIM HIBRIS HIBMIS HIBIC Pre-Divider XOSC1 HIBRTCT /128 HIBCTL.CLKSEL Battery-Backed Memory 64 words HIBDATA RTC HIBRTCC HIBRTCLD HIBRTCM0 HIBRTCM1 Clock Source for System Clock Interrupts to CPU MATCH0/1 HIBCTL.RTCEN WAKE LOWBAT Power Sequence Logic Low Battery Detect VBAT HIBCTL.LOWBATEN HIB HIBCTL.PWRCUT HIBCTL.RTCWEN HIBCTL.EXTWEN HIBCTL.VABORT HIBCTL.HIBREQ 6.2 Signal Description The following table lists the external signals of the Hibernation module and describes the function of each. These signals have dedicated functions and are not alternate functions for any GPIO signals. Table 6-1. Hibernate Signals (100LQFP) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment a Pin Type Buffer Type Description HIB 51 fixed O OD An output that indicates the processor is in Hibernate mode. VBAT 55 fixed - Power Power source for the Hibernation module. It is normally connected to the positive terminal of a battery and serves as the battery backup/Hibernation module power-source supply. WAKE 50 fixed I TTL An external input that brings the processor out of Hibernate mode when asserted. XOSC0 52 fixed I Analog Hibernation module oscillator crystal input or an external clock reference input. Note that this is either a 4.194304-MHz crystal or a 32.768-kHz oscillator for the Hibernation module RTC. See the CLKSEL bit in the HIBCTL register. XOSC1 53 fixed O Analog Hibernation module oscillator crystal output. Leave unconnected when using a single-ended clock source. a. The TTL designation indicates the pin has TTL-compatible voltage levels. 268 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 6-2. Hibernate Signals (108BGA) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment a Pin Type Buffer Type Description HIB M12 fixed O OD An output that indicates the processor is in Hibernate mode. VBAT L12 fixed - Power Power source for the Hibernation module. It is normally connected to the positive terminal of a battery and serves as the battery backup/Hibernation module power-source supply. WAKE M10 fixed I TTL An external input that brings the processor out of Hibernate mode when asserted. XOSC0 K11 fixed I Analog Hibernation module oscillator crystal input or an external clock reference input. Note that this is either a 4.194304-MHz crystal or a 32.768-kHz oscillator for the Hibernation module RTC. See the CLKSEL bit in the HIBCTL register. XOSC1 K12 fixed O Analog Hibernation module oscillator crystal output. Leave unconnected when using a single-ended clock source. a. The TTL designation indicates the pin has TTL-compatible voltage levels. 6.3 Functional Description The Hibernation module provides two mechanisms for power control: ■ The first mechanism controls the power to the microcontroller with a control signal (HIB) that signals an external voltage regulator to turn on or off. ■ The second mechanism uses internal switches to control power to the Cortex-M3 as well as to most analog and digital functions while retaining I/O pin power (VDD3ON mode). The Hibernation module power source is determined dynamically. The supply voltage of the Hibernation module is the larger of the main voltage source (VDD) or the battery/auxilliary voltage source (VBAT). The Hibernation module also has an independent clock source to maintain a real-time clock (RTC) when the system clock is powered down. Once in hibernation, the module signals an external voltage regulator to turn the power back on when an external pin (WAKE) is asserted or when the internal RTC reaches a certain value. The Hibernation module can also detect when the battery voltage is low and optionally prevent hibernation when this occurs. When waking from hibernation, the HIB signal is deasserted. The return of VDD causes a POR to be executed. The time from when the WAKE signal is asserted to when code begins execution is equal to the wake-up time (tWAKE_TO_HIB) plus the power-on reset time (TIRPOR). 6.3.1 Register Access Timing Because the Hibernation module has an independent clocking domain, certain registers must be written only with a timing gap between accesses. The delay time is tHIB_REG_ACCESS, therefore software must guarantee that this delay is inserted between back-to-back writes to certain Hibernation registers or between a write followed by a read to those same registers. Software may make use of the WRC bit in the Hibernation Control (HIBCTL) register to ensure that the required timing gap has elapsed. This bit is cleared on a write operation and set once the write completes, indicating to software that another write or read may be started safely. Software should poll HIBCTL for WRC=1 prior to accessing any affected register. The following registers are subject to this timing restriction: January 22, 2012 269 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module ■ Hibernation RTC Counter (HIBRTCC) ■ Hibernation RTC Match 0 (HIBRTCM0) ■ Hibernation RTC Match 1 (HIBRTCM1) ■ Hibernation RTC Load (HIBRTCLD) ■ Hibernation RTC Trim (HIBRTCT) ■ Hibernation Data (HIBDATA) Back-to-back reads from Hibernation module registers have no timing restrictions. Reads are performed at the full peripheral clock rate. 6.3.2 Hibernation Clock Source In systems where the Hibernation module is used to put the microcontroller into hibernation, the module must be clocked by an external source that is independent from the main system clock, even if the RTC feature is not used. An external oscillator or crystal is used for this purpose. To use a crystal, a 4.194304-MHz crystal is connected to the XOSC0 and XOSC1 pins. This clock signal is divided by 128 internally to produce a 32.768-kHz Hibernation clock reference. Alternatively, a 32.768-kHz oscillator can be connected to the XOSC0 pin, leaving XOSC1 unconnected. Care must be taken that the voltage amplitude of the 32.768-kHz oscillator is less than VBAT, otherwise, the Hibernation module may draw power from the oscillator and not VBAT during hibernation. See Figure 6-2 on page 271 and Figure 6-3 on page 271. The Hibernation clock source is enabled by setting the CLK32EN bit of the HIBCTL register. The type of clock source is selected by clearing the CLKSEL bit for a 4.194304-MHz crystal and setting the CLKSEL bit for a 32.768-kHz oscillator. If a crystal is used for the clock source, the software must leave a delay of tHIBOSC_START after writing to the CLK32EN bit and before any other accesses to the Hibernation module registers. The delay allows the crystal to power up and stabilize. If an oscillator is used for the clock source, no delay is needed. 270 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 6-2. Using a Crystal as the Hibernation Clock Source Stellaris® Microcontroller Regulator or Switch Input Voltage IN OUT VDD EN XOSC0 X1 RL XOSC1 C1 C2 HIB WAKE RPU1 Open drain external wake up circuit Note: VBAT GND 3V Battery RPU2 X1 = Crystal frequency is fXOSC_XTAL. C1,2 = Capacitor value derived from crystal vendor load capacitance specifications. RL = Load resistor is RXOSC_LOAD. RPU1 = Pull-up resistor 1 (value and voltage source (VBAT or Input Voltage) determined by regulator or switch enable input characteristics). RPU2 = Pull-up resistor 2 is 200 kΩ See “Hibernation Clock Source Specifications” on page 901 for specific parameter values. Figure 6-3. Using a Dedicated Oscillator as the Hibernation Clock Source with VDD3ON Mode Stellaris® Microcontroller Regulator Input Voltage IN OUT VDD Clock Source XOSC0 (fEXT_OSC) N.C. XOSC1 HIB WAKE Open drain external wake up circuit Note: 6.3.3 VBAT GND RPU 3V Battery RPU = Pull-up resistor is 1 MΩ System Implementation Several different system configurations are possible when using the Hibernation module: ■ Using a single battery source, where the battery provides both VDD and VBAT. January 22, 2012 271 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module ■ Using the VDD3ON mode, where VDD continues to be powered in hibernation, allowing the GPIO pins to retain their states, as shown in Figure 6-3 on page 271. In this mode, VDDC is powered off internally. ■ Using separate sources for VDD and VBAT, as shown in Figure 6-2 on page 271. ■ Using a regulator to provide both VDD and VBAT with a switch enabled by HIB to remove VDD during hibernation. Adding external capacitance to the VBAT supply reduces the accuracy of the low-battery measurement and should be avoided if possible. The diagrams referenced in this section only show the connection to the Hibernation pins and not to the full system. If the application does not require the use of the Hibernation module, refer to “Connections for Unused Signals” on page 891. In this situation, the HIB bit in the Run Mode Clock Gating Control Register 0 (RCGC0) register must be cleared, disabling the system clock to the Hibernation module and Hibernation module registers are not accessible. 6.3.4 Battery Management Important: System-level factors may affect the accuracy of the low battery detect circuit. The designer should consider battery type, discharge characteristics, and a test load during battery voltage measurements. The Hibernation module can be independently powered by a battery or an auxiliary power source using the VBAT pin. The module can monitor the voltage level of the battery and detect when the voltage drops below VLOWBAT. The module can also be configured so that it does not go into Hibernate mode if the battery voltage drops below this threshold. Battery voltage is not measured while in Hibernate mode. The Hibernation module can be configured to detect a low battery condition by setting the LOWBATEN bit of the HIBCTL register. In this configuration, the LOWBAT bit of the Hibernation Raw Interrupt Status (HIBRIS) register is set when the battery level is low. If the VABORT bit in the HIBCTL register is also set, then the module is prevented from entering Hibernate mode when a low battery is detected. The module can also be configured to generate an interrupt for the low-battery condition (see “Interrupts and Status” on page 274). Note that the Hibernation module draws power from whichever source (VBAT or VDD) has the higher voltage. Therefore, it is important to design the circuit to ensure that VDD is higher that VBAT under nominal conditions or else the Hibernation module draws power from the battery even when VDD is available. 6.3.5 Real-Time Clock The Hibernation module includes a 32-bit counter that increments once per second with the proper configuration (see “Hibernation Clock Source” on page 270). The 32.768-kHz clock signal, either directly from the 32.768-kHz oscillator or from the 4.194304-MHz crystal divided by 128, is fed into a predivider register that counts down the 32.768-kHz clock ticks to achieve a once per second clock rate for the RTC. The rate can be adjusted to compensate for inaccuracies in the clock source by using the predivider trim register, HIBRTCT. This register has a nominal value of 0x7FFF, and is used for one second out of every 64 seconds to divide the input clock. This configuration allows the software to make fine corrections to the clock rate by adjusting the predivider trim register up or down from 0x7FFF. The predivider trim should be adjusted up from 0x7FFF in order to slow down the RTC rate and down from 0x7FFF in order to speed up the RTC rate. 272 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller The Hibernation module includes two 32-bit match registers that are compared to the value of the RTC counter. The match registers can be used to wake the processor from Hibernate mode or to generate an interrupt to the processor if it is not in hibernation. The RTC must be enabled with the RTCEN bit of the HIBCTL register. The value of the RTC can be set at any time by writing to the HIBRTCLD register. The predivider trim can be adjusted by reading and writing the HIBRTCT register. The predivider uses this register once every 64 seconds to adjust the clock rate. The two match registers can be set by writing to the HIBRTCM0 and HIBRTCM1 registers. The RTC can be configured to generate interrupts by using the interrupt registers (see “Interrupts and Status” on page 274). As long as the RTC is enabled and a valid VBAT is present, the RTC continues counting, regardless of whether VDD is present or if the part is in hibernation. 6.3.6 Battery-Backed Memory The Hibernation module contains 64 32-bit words of memory that are powered from the battery or auxiliary power supply and therefore retained during hibernation. The processor software can save state information in this memory prior to hibernation and recover the state upon waking. The battery-backed memory can be accessed through the HIBDATA registers. If both VDD and VBAT are removed, the contents of the HIBDATA registers are not retained. 6.3.7 Power Control Using HIB Important: The Hibernation Module requires special system implementation considerations when using HIB to control power, as it is intended to power-down all other sections of the microcontroller. All system signals and power supplies that connect to the chip must be driven to 0 VDC or powered down with the same regulator controlled by HIB. The Hibernation module controls power to the microcontroller through the use of the HIB pin which is intended to be connected to the enable signal of the external regulator(s) providing 3.3 V to the microcontroller and other circuits. When the HIB signal is asserted by the Hibernation module, the external regulator is turned off and no longer powers the microcontroller and any parts of the system that are powered by the regulator. The Hibernation module remains powered from the VBAT supply (which could be a battery or an auxiliary power source) until a Wake event. Power to the microcontroller is restored by deasserting the HIB signal, which causes the external regulator to turn power back on to the chip. 6.3.8 Power Control Using VDD3ON Mode The Hibernation module may also be configured to cut power to all internal modules. While in this state, all pins are configured as inputs. In the VDD3ON mode, the regulator should maintain 3.3 V power to the microcontroller during Hibernate. This power control mode is enabled by setting the VDD3ON bit in HIBCTL. 6.3.9 Initiating Hibernate Hibernate mode is initiated when the HIBREQ bit of the HIBCTL register is set. If a wake-up condition has not been configured using the PINWEN or RTCWEN bits in the HIBCTL register, the hibernation request is ignored. If a Flash memory write operation is in progress when the HIBREQ bit is set, an interlock feature holds off the transition into Hibernate mode until the write has completed. 6.3.10 Waking from Hibernate The Hibernation module is configured to wake from the external WAKE pin by setting the PINWEN bit of the HIBCTL register. It is configured to wake from RTC match by setting the RTCWEN bit. Note that the WAKE pin uses the Hibernation module's internal power supply as the logic 1 reference. January 22, 2012 273 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Upon either external wake-up or RTC match, the Hibernation module delays coming out of hibernation until VDD is above the minimum specified voltage, see Table 21-2 on page 894. When the Hibernation module wakes, the microcontroller performs a normal power-on reset. Note that this reset does not reset the Hibernation module, but does reset the rest of the microcontroller. Software can detect that the power-on was due to a wake from hibernation by examining the raw interrupt status register (see “Interrupts and Status” on page 274) and by looking for state data in the battery-backed memory (see “Battery-Backed Memory” on page 273). 6.3.11 Interrupts and Status The Hibernation module can generate interrupts when the following conditions occur: ■ Assertion of WAKE pin ■ RTC match ■ Low battery detected All of the interrupts are ORed together before being sent to the interrupt controller, so the Hibernate module can only generate a single interrupt request to the controller at any given time. The software interrupt handler can service multiple interrupt events by reading the Hibernation Masked Interrupt Status (HIBMIS) register. Software can also read the status of the Hibernation module at any time by reading the HIBRIS register which shows all of the pending events. This register can be used after waking from hibernation to see if the wake condition was caused by the WAKE signal or the RTC match. The events that can trigger an interrupt are configured by setting the appropriate bits in the Hibernation Interrupt Mask (HIBIM) register. Pending interrupts can be cleared by writing the corresponding bit in the Hibernation Interrupt Clear (HIBIC) register. 6.4 Initialization and Configuration The Hibernation module has several different configurations. The following sections show the recommended programming sequence for various scenarios. The examples below assume that a 32.768-kHz oscillator is used, and thus always set the CLKSEL bit of the HIBCTL register. If a 4.194304-MHz crystal is used instead, then the CLKSEL bit remains cleared. Because the Hibernation module runs at 32.768 kHz and is asynchronous to the rest of the microcontroller, which is run off the system clock, software must allow a delay of tHIB_REG_ACCESS after writes to certain registers (see “Register Access Timing” on page 269). The registers that require a delay are listed in a note in “Register Map” on page 276 as well as in each register description. 6.4.1 Initialization The Hibernation module comes out of reset with the system clock enabled to the module, but if the system clock to the module has been disabled, then it must be re-enabled, even if the RTC feature is not used. See page 239. If a 4.194304-MHz crystal is used as the Hibernation module clock source, perform the following step: 1. Write 0x40 to the HIBCTL register at offset 0x10 to enable the crystal and select the divide-by-128 input path. If a 32.678-kHz single-ended oscillator is used as the Hibernation module clock source, then perform the following steps: 274 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 1. Write 0x44 to the HIBCTL register at offset 0x10 to enable the oscillator input and bypass the on-chip oscillator. 2. No delay is necessary. The above steps are only necessary when the entire system is initialized for the first time. If the microcontroller has been in hibernation, then the Hibernation module has already been powered up and the above steps are not necessary. The software can detect that the Hibernation module and clock are already powered by examining the CLK32EN bit of the HIBCTL register. Table 6-3 on page 275 illustrates how the clocks function with various bit setting both in normal operation and in hibernation. Table 6-3. Hibernation Module Clock Operation CLK32EN PINWEN RTCWEN CLKSEL RTCEN Result Normal Operation 6.4.2 Result Hibernation 0 X X X X Hibernation module disabled Hibernation module disabled 1 0 0 0 1 RTC match capability enabled. Module clocked from 4.184304-MHz crystal. No hibernation 1 0 0 1 1 RTC match capability enabled. Module clocked from 32.768-kHz oscillator. No hibernation 1 0 1 X 1 Module clocked from selected source RTC match for wake-up event 1 1 0 X 0 Module clocked from selected source Clock is powered down during hibernation and powered up again on external wake-up event. 1 1 0 X 1 Module clocked from selected source Clock is powered up during hibernation for RTC. Wake up on external event. 1 1 1 X 1 Module clocked from selected source RTC match or external wake-up event, whichever occurs first. RTC Match Functionality (No Hibernation) Use the following steps to implement the RTC match functionality of the Hibernation module: 1. Write the required RTC match value to one of the HIBRTCMn registers at offset 0x004 or 0x008. 2. Write the required RTC load value to the HIBRTCLD register at offset 0x00C. 3. Set the required RTC match interrupt mask in the RTCALT0 and RTCALT1 bits (bits 1:0) in the HIBIM register at offset 0x014. 4. Write 0x0000.0041 to the HIBCTL register at offset 0x010 to enable the RTC to begin counting. 6.4.3 RTC Match/Wake-Up from Hibernation Use the following steps to implement the RTC match and wake-up functionality of the Hibernation module: 1. Write the required RTC match value to the HIBRTCMn registers at offset 0x004 or 0x008. 2. Write the required RTC load value to the HIBRTCLD register at offset 0x00C. January 22, 2012 275 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module 3. Write any data to be retained during power cut to the HIBDATA register at offsets 0x030-0x12C. 4. Set the RTC Match Wake-Up and start the hibernation sequence by writing 0x0000.004F to the HIBCTL register at offset 0x010. 6.4.4 External Wake-Up from Hibernation Use the following steps to implement the Hibernation module with the external WAKE pin as the wake-up source for the microcontroller: 1. Write any data to be retained during power cut to the HIBDATA register at offsets 0x030-0x12C. 2. Enable the external wake and start the hibernation sequence by writing 0x0000.0056 to the HIBCTL register at offset 0x010. Note that in this mode, if the RTC is disabled, then the Hibernation clock source is powered down during Hibernate mode and is powered up again on the external wake event to save power during hibernation. If the RTC is enabled before hibernation, it continues to operate during hibernation. 6.4.5 RTC or External Wake-Up from Hibernation 1. Write the required RTC match value to the HIBRTCMn registers at offset 0x004 or 0x008. 2. Write the required RTC load value to the HIBRTCLD register at offset 0x00C. 3. Write any data to be retained during power cut to the HIBDATA register at offsets 0x030-0x12C. 4. Set the RTC Match/External Wake-Up and start the hibernation sequence by writing 0x0000.005F to the HIBCTL register at offset 0x010. 6.5 Register Map Table 6-4 on page 277 lists the Hibernation registers. All addresses given are relative to the Hibernation Module base address at 0x400F.C000. Note that the system clock to the Hibernation module must be enabled before the registers can be programmed (see page 239). There must be a delay of 3 system clocks after the Hibernation module clock is enabled before any Hibernation module registers are accessed. Note: HIBRTCC, HIBRTCM0, HIBRTCM1, HIBRTCLD, HIBRTCT, and HIBDATA are on the Hibernation module clock domain and have special timing requirements. Software should make use of the WRC bit in the HIBCTL register to ensure that the required timing gap has elapsed. If the WRC bit is clear, any attempted write access is ignored. See “Register Access Timing” on page 269. Important: The Hibernation module registers are reset under two conditions: 1. A system reset when the RTCEN and the PINWEN bits in the HIBCTL register are both cleared. 2. A cold POR, when both the VDD and VBAT supplies are removed. Any other reset condition is ignored by the Hibernation module. 276 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 6-4. Hibernation Module Register Map Offset Name 0x000 Reset HIBRTCC RO 0x0000.0000 Hibernation RTC Counter 278 0x004 HIBRTCM0 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Hibernation RTC Match 0 279 0x008 HIBRTCM1 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Hibernation RTC Match 1 280 0x00C HIBRTCLD R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Hibernation RTC Load 281 0x010 HIBCTL R/W 0x8000.0000 Hibernation Control 282 0x014 HIBIM R/W 0x0000.0000 Hibernation Interrupt Mask 285 0x018 HIBRIS RO 0x0000.0000 Hibernation Raw Interrupt Status 287 0x01C HIBMIS RO 0x0000.0000 Hibernation Masked Interrupt Status 289 0x020 HIBIC R/W1C 0x0000.0000 Hibernation Interrupt Clear 291 0x024 HIBRTCT R/W 0x0000.7FFF Hibernation RTC Trim 292 0x0300x12C HIBDATA R/W - Hibernation Data 293 6.6 Description See page Type Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the Hibernation module registers, in numerical order by address offset. January 22, 2012 277 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Register 1: Hibernation RTC Counter (HIBRTCC), offset 0x000 This register is the current 32-bit value of the RTC counter. Note: HIBRTCC, HIBRTCM0, HIBRTCM1, HIBRTCLD, HIBRTCT, and HIBDATA are on the Hibernation module clock domain and have special timing requirements. Software should make use of the WRC bit in the HIBCTL register to ensure that the required timing gap has elapsed. If the WRC bit is clear, any attempted write access is ignored. See “Register Access Timing” on page 269. Hibernation RTC Counter (HIBRTCC) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x000 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RTCC Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RTCC Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 RTCC RO RO 0 Reset RO 0 Description 0x0000.0000 RTC Counter A read returns the 32-bit counter value, which represents the seconds elapsed since the RTC was enabled. This register is read-only. To change the value, use the HIBRTCLD register. 278 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 2: Hibernation RTC Match 0 (HIBRTCM0), offset 0x004 This register is the 32-bit match 0 register for the RTC counter. Note: HIBRTCC, HIBRTCM0, HIBRTCM1, HIBRTCLD, HIBRTCT, and HIBDATA are on the Hibernation module clock domain and have special timing requirements. Software should make use of the WRC bit in the HIBCTL register to ensure that the required timing gap has elapsed. If the WRC bit is clear, any attempted write access is ignored. See “Register Access Timing” on page 269. Hibernation RTC Match 0 (HIBRTCM0) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x004 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RTCM0 Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RTCM0 Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 RTCM0 R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 Description 0xFFFF.FFFF RTC Match 0 A write loads the value into the RTC match register. A read returns the current match value. January 22, 2012 279 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Register 3: Hibernation RTC Match 1 (HIBRTCM1), offset 0x008 This register is the 32-bit match 1 register for the RTC counter. Note: HIBRTCC, HIBRTCM0, HIBRTCM1, HIBRTCLD, HIBRTCT, and HIBDATA are on the Hibernation module clock domain and have special timing requirements. Software should make use of the WRC bit in the HIBCTL register to ensure that the required timing gap has elapsed. If the WRC bit is clear, any attempted write access is ignored. See “Register Access Timing” on page 269. Hibernation RTC Match 1 (HIBRTCM1) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RTCM1 Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RTCM1 Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 RTCM1 R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 Description 0xFFFF.FFFF RTC Match 1 A write loads the value into the RTC match register. A read returns the current match value. 280 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 4: Hibernation RTC Load (HIBRTCLD), offset 0x00C This register is used to load a 32-bit value loaded into the RTC counter. The load occurs immediately upon this register being written. Note: HIBRTCC, HIBRTCM0, HIBRTCM1, HIBRTCLD, HIBRTCT, and HIBDATA are on the Hibernation module clock domain and have special timing requirements. Software should make use of the WRC bit in the HIBCTL register to ensure that the required timing gap has elapsed. If the WRC bit is clear, any attempted write access is ignored. See “Register Access Timing” on page 269. Hibernation RTC Load (HIBRTCLD) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x00C Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RTCLD Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RTCLD Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 RTCLD R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 Description 0xFFFF.FFFF RTC Load A write loads the current value into the RTC counter (RTCC). A read returns the 32-bit load value. January 22, 2012 281 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Register 5: Hibernation Control (HIBCTL), offset 0x010 This register is the control register for the Hibernation module. This register must be written last before a hibernate event is issued. Writes to other registers after the HIBREQ bit is set are not guaranteed to complete before hibernation is entered. Hibernation Control (HIBCTL) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x010 Type R/W, reset 0x8000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 WRC Type Reset 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 HIBREQ RTCEN R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved reserved Type Reset 23 RO 0 VDD3ON VABORT CLK32EN LOWBATEN PINWEN RTCWEN CLKSEL Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31 WRC RO 1 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Write Complete/Capable Value Description 0 The interface is processing a prior write and is busy. Any write operation that is attempted while WRC is 0 results in undetermined behavior. 1 The interface is ready to accept a write. Software must poll this bit between write requests and defer writes until WRC=1 to ensure proper operation. The bit name WRC means "Write Complete," which is the normal use of the bit (between write accesses). However, because the bit is set out-of-reset, the name can also mean "Write Capable" which simply indicates that the interface may be written to by software. This difference may be exploited by software at reset time to detect which method of programming is appropriate: 0 = software delay loops required; 1 = WRC paced available. 30:9 reserved RO 0x000 8 VDD3ON R/W 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. VDD Powered Value Description 1 The internal switches control the power to the on-chip modules (VDD3ON mode). 0 The internal switches are not used. The HIB signal should be used to control an external switch or regulator. Note that regardless of the status of the VDD3ON bit, the HIB signal is asserted during Hibernate mode. Thus, when VDD3ON is set, the HIB signal should not be connected to the 3.3V regulator, and the 3.3V power source should remain connected. 282 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 7 VABORT R/W 0 6 CLK32EN R/W 0 Description Power Cut Abort Enable Value Description 1 When this bit is set, the battery voltage level is checked before entering hibernation. If VBAT is less than VLOWBAT, the microcontroller does not go into hibernation. 0 The microcontroller goes into hibernation regardless of the voltage level of the battery. Clocking Enable This bit must be enabled to use the Hibernation module. 5 4 3 2 LOWBATEN PINWEN RTCWEN CLKSEL R/W R/W R/W R/W 0 0 0 0 Value Description 1 The Hibernation module clock source is enabled. 0 The Hibernation module clock source is disabled. Low Battery Monitoring Enable Value Description 1 Low battery voltage detection is enabled. When this bit is set, the battery voltage level is checked before entering hibernation. If VBAT is less than VLOWBAT, the LOWBAT bit in the HIBRIS register is set. 0 Low battery monitoring is disabled. External WAKE Pin Enable Value Description 1 An assertion of the WAKE pin takes the microcontroller out of hibernation. 0 The status of the WAKE pin has no effect on hibernation. RTC Wake-up Enable Value Description 1 An RTC match event (the value the HIBRTCC register matches the value of the HIBRTCM0 or HIBRTCM1 register) takes the microcontroller out of hibernation. 0 An RTC match event has no effect on hibernation. Hibernation Module Clock Select Value Description 1 Use raw output. Use this value for a 32.768-kHz oscillator. 0 Use Divide-by-128 output. Use this value for a 4.194304-MHz crystal. January 22, 2012 283 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Bit/Field Name Type Reset 1 HIBREQ R/W 0 Description Hibernation Request Value Description 1 Set this bit to initiate hibernation. 0 No hibernation request. After a wake-up event, this bit is automatically cleared by hardware. A hibernation request is ignored if both the PINWEN and RTCWEN bits are clear. 0 RTCEN R/W 0 RTC Timer Enable Value Description 1 The Hibernation module RTC is enabled. 0 The Hibernation module RTC is disabled. 284 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 6: Hibernation Interrupt Mask (HIBIM), offset 0x014 This register is the interrupt mask register for the Hibernation module interrupt sources. Each bit in this register masks the corresponding bit in the Hibernation Raw Interrupt Status (HIBRIS) register. If a bit is unmasked, the interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller. If the bit is masked, the interrupt is not sent to the interrupt controller. Hibernation Interrupt Mask (HIBIM) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x014 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset EXTW Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:4 reserved RO 0x0000.000 3 EXTW R/W 0 R/W 0 LOWBAT RTCALT1 RTCALT0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. External Wake-Up Interrupt Mask Value Description 2 LOWBAT R/W 0 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the EXTW bit in the HIBRIS register is set. 0 The EXTW interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. Low Battery Voltage Interrupt Mask Value Description 1 RTCALT1 R/W 0 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the LOWBAT bit in the HIBRIS register is set. 0 The LOWBAT interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. RTC Alert 1 Interrupt Mask Value Description 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the RTCALT1 bit in the HIBRIS register is set. 0 The RTCALT1 interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. January 22, 2012 285 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 RTCALT0 R/W 0 Description RTC Alert 0 Interrupt Mask Value Description 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the RTCALT0 bit in the HIBRIS register is set. 0 The RTCALT0 interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. 286 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 7: Hibernation Raw Interrupt Status (HIBRIS), offset 0x018 This register is the raw interrupt status for the Hibernation module interrupt sources. Each bit can be masked by clearing the corresponding bit in the HIBIM register. When a bit is masked, the interrupt is not sent to the interrupt controller. Bits in this register are cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit in the Hibernation Interrupt Clear (HIBIC) register or by entering hibernation. Hibernation Raw Interrupt Status (HIBRIS) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x018 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset EXTW Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:4 reserved RO 0x0000.000 3 EXTW RO 0 RO 0 LOWBAT RTCALT1 RTCALT0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. External Wake-Up Raw Interrupt Status Value Description 1 The WAKE pin has been asserted. 0 The WAKE pin has not been asserted. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the EXTW bit in the HIBIC register. 2 LOWBAT RO 0 Low Battery Voltage Raw Interrupt Status Value Description 1 The battery voltage dropped below VLOWBAT. 0 The battery voltage has not dropped below VLOWBAT. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the LOWBAT bit in the HIBIC register. 1 RTCALT1 RO 0 RTC Alert 1 Raw Interrupt Status Value Description 1 The value of the HIBRTCC register matches the value in the HIBRTCM1 register. 0 No match This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the RTCALT1 bit in the HIBIC register. January 22, 2012 287 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 RTCALT0 RO 0 Description RTC Alert 0 Raw Interrupt Status Value Description 1 The value of the HIBRTCC register matches the value in the HIBRTCM0 register. 0 No match This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the RTCALT0 bit in the HIBIC register. 288 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 8: Hibernation Masked Interrupt Status (HIBMIS), offset 0x01C This register is the masked interrupt status for the Hibernation module interrupt sources. Bits in this register are the AND of the corresponding bits in the HIBRIS and HIBIM registers. When both corresponding bits are set, the bit in this register is set, and the interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller. Hibernation Masked Interrupt Status (HIBMIS) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x01C Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset EXTW Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:4 reserved RO 0x0000.000 3 EXTW RO 0 RO 0 LOWBAT RTCALT1 RTCALT0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. External Wake-Up Masked Interrupt Status Value Description 1 An unmasked interrupt was signaled due to a WAKE pin assertion. 0 An external wake-up interrupt has not occurred or is masked. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the EXTW bit in the HIBIC register. 2 LOWBAT RO 0 Low Battery Voltage Masked Interrupt Status Value Description 1 An unmasked interrupt was signaled due to a low battery voltage condition. 0 A low battery voltage interrupt has not occurred or is masked. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the LOWBAT bit in the HIBIC register. 1 RTCALT1 RO 0 RTC Alert 1 Masked Interrupt Status Value Description 1 An unmasked interrupt was signaled due to an RTC match. 0 An RTC match interrupt has not occurred or is masked. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the RTCALT1 bit in the HIBIC register. January 22, 2012 289 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 RTCALT0 RO 0 Description RTC Alert 0 Masked Interrupt Status Value Description 1 An unmasked interrupt was signaled due to an RTC match. 0 An RTC match interrupt has not occurred or is masked. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the RTCALT0 bit in the HIBIC register. 290 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 9: Hibernation Interrupt Clear (HIBIC), offset 0x020 This register is the interrupt write-one-to-clear register for the Hibernation module interrupt sources. Writing a 1 to a bit clears the corresponding interrupt in the HIBRIS register. Hibernation Interrupt Clear (HIBIC) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x020 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W1C 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset EXTW Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:4 reserved RO 0x0000.000 3 EXTW R/W1C 0 LOWBAT RTCALT1 RTCALT0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. External Wake-Up Masked Interrupt Clear Writing a 1 to this bit clears the EXTW bit in the HIBRIS and HIBMIS registers. Reads return an indeterminate value. 2 LOWBAT R/W1C 0 Low Battery Voltage Masked Interrupt Clear Writing a 1 to this bit clears the LOWBAT bit in the HIBRIS and HIBMIS registers. Reads return an indeterminate value. 1 RTCALT1 R/W1C 0 RTC Alert1 Masked Interrupt Clear Writing a 1 to this bit clears the RTCALT1 bit in the HIBRIS and HIBMIS registers. Reads return an indeterminate value. 0 RTCALT0 R/W1C 0 RTC Alert0 Masked Interrupt Clear Writing a 1 to this bit clears the RTCALT0 bit in the HIBRIS and HIBMIS registers. Reads return an indeterminate value. January 22, 2012 291 Texas Instruments-Production Data Hibernation Module Register 10: Hibernation RTC Trim (HIBRTCT), offset 0x024 This register contains the value that is used to trim the RTC clock predivider. It represents the computed underflow value that is used during the trim cycle. It is represented as 0x7FFF ± N clock cycles, where N is the number of clock cycles to add or subtract every 63 seconds. Note: HIBRTCC, HIBRTCM0, HIBRTCM1, HIBRTCLD, HIBRTCT, and HIBDATA are on the Hibernation module clock domain and have special timing requirements. Software should make use of the WRC bit in the HIBCTL register to ensure that the required timing gap has elapsed. If the WRC bit is clear, any attempted write access is ignored. See “Register Access Timing” on page 269. Hibernation RTC Trim (HIBRTCT) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x024 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.7FFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 TRIM Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:16 reserved RO 0x0000 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 15:0 TRIM R/W 0x7FFF RTC Trim Value This value is loaded into the RTC predivider every 64 seconds. It is used to adjust the RTC rate to account for drift and inaccuracy in the clock source. Compensation can be adjusted by software by moving the default value of 0x7FFF up or down. Moving the value up slows down the RTC and moving the value down speeds up the RTC. 292 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 11: Hibernation Data (HIBDATA), offset 0x030-0x12C This address space is implemented as a 64x32-bit memory (256 bytes). It can be loaded by the system processor in order to store state information and does not lose power during a power cut operation as long as a battery is present. Note: HIBRTCC, HIBRTCM0, HIBRTCM1, HIBRTCLD, HIBRTCT, and HIBDATA are on the Hibernation module clock domain and have special timing requirements. Software should make use of the WRC bit in the HIBCTL register to ensure that the required timing gap has elapsed. If the WRC bit is clear, any attempted write access is ignored. See “Register Access Timing” on page 269. Hibernation Data (HIBDATA) Base 0x400F.C000 Offset 0x030-0x12C Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - RTD Type Reset R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RTD Type Reset R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 RTD R/W - R/W - Description Hibernation Module NV Data January 22, 2012 293 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory 7 Internal Memory The LM3S1G21 microcontroller comes with 64 KB of bit-banded SRAM, internal ROM,and 384 KB of Flash memory. The Flash memory controller provides a user-friendly interface, making Flash memory programming a simple task. Flash memory protection can be applied to the Flash memory on a 2-KB block basis. 7.1 Block Diagram Figure 7-1 on page 294 illustrates the internal memory blocks and control logic. The dashed boxes in the figure indicate registers residing in the System Control module. Figure 7-1. Internal Memory Block Diagram ROM Control ROM Array RMCTL Flash Control Icode Bus Cortex-M3 FMA FMD FMC FCRIS FCIM FCMISC Dcode Bus Flash Array System Bus Flash Write Buffer FMC2 FWBVAL FWBn 32 words Flash Protection Bridge FMPREn FMPRE FMPPEn FMPPE User Registers Flash Timing BOOTCFG USECRL USER_REG0 USER_REG1 USER_REG2 USER_REG3 SRAM Array 7.2 Functional Description This section describes the functionality of the SRAM, ROM, and Flash memories. Note: The μDMA controller can transfer data to and from the on-chip SRAM. However, because the Flash memory and ROM are located on a separate internal bus, it is not possible to transfer data from the Flash memory or ROM with the μDMA controller. 294 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 7.2.1 SRAM ® The internal SRAM of the Stellaris devices is located at address 0x2000.0000 of the device memory map. To reduce the number of time consuming read-modify-write (RMW) operations, ARM provides bit-banding technology in the processor. With a bit-band-enabled processor, certain regions in the memory map (SRAM and peripheral space) can use address aliases to access individual bits in a single, atomic operation. The bit-band base is located at address 0x2200.0000. The bit-band alias is calculated by using the formula: bit-band alias = bit-band base + (byte offset * 32) + (bit number * 4) For example, if bit 3 at address 0x2000.1000 is to be modified, the bit-band alias is calculated as: 0x2200.0000 + (0x1000 * 32) + (3 * 4) = 0x2202.000C With the alias address calculated, an instruction performing a read/write to address 0x2202.000C allows direct access to only bit 3 of the byte at address 0x2000.1000. For details about bit-banding, see “Bit-Banding” on page 77. Note: 7.2.2 The SRAM is implemented using two 32-bit wide SRAM banks (separate SRAM arrays). The banks are partitioned such that one bank contains all even words (the even bank) and the other contains all odd words (the odd bank). A write access that is followed immediately by a read access to the same bank incurs a stall of a single clock cycle. However, a write to one bank followed by a read of the other bank can occur in successive clock cycles without incurring any delay. ROM The internal ROM of the Stellaris device is located at address 0x0100.0000 of the device memory map. Detailed information on the ROM contents can be found in the Stellaris® ROM User’s Guide. The ROM contains the following components: ■ Stellaris Boot Loader and vector table ■ Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library (DriverLib) release for product-specific peripherals and interfaces ■ Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) cryptography tables ■ Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) error detection functionality The boot loader is used as an initial program loader (when the Flash memory is empty) as well as an application-initiated firmware upgrade mechanism (by calling back to the boot loader). The Peripheral Driver Library APIs in ROM can be called by applications, reducing Flash memory requirements and freeing the Flash memory to be used for other purposes (such as additional features in the application). Advance Encryption Standard (AES) is a publicly defined encryption standard used by the U.S. Government and Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) is a technique to validate a span of data has the same contents as when previously checked. 7.2.2.1 Boot Loader Overview The Stellaris Boot Loader is used to download code to the Flash memory of a device without the use of a debug interface. When the core is reset, the user has the opportunity to direct the core to execute the ROM Boot Loader or the application in Flash memory by using any GPIO signal in Ports A-H as configured in the Boot Configuration (BOOTCFG) register. January 22, 2012 295 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory At reset, the ROM is mapped over the Flash memory so that the ROM boot sequence is always executed. The boot sequence executed from ROM is as follows: 1. The BA bit (below) is cleared such that ROM is mapped to 0x01xx.xxxx and Flash memory is mapped to address 0x0. 2. The BOOTCFG register is read. If the EN bit is clear, the status of the specified GPIO pin is compared with the specified polarity. If the status matches the specified polarity, the ROM is mapped to address 0x0000.0000 and execution continues out of the ROM Boot Loader. 3. If the status doesn't match the specified polarity, the data at address 0x0000.0004 is read, and if the data at this address is 0xFFFF.FFFF, the ROM is mapped to address 0x0000.0000 and execution continues out of the ROM Boot Loader. 4. If there is data at address 0x0000.0004 that is not 0xFFFF.FFFF, the stack pointer (SP) is loaded from Flash memory at address 0x0000.0000 and the program counter (PC) is loaded from address 0x0000.0004. The user application begins executing. The boot loader uses a simple packet interface to provide synchronous communication with the device. The speed of the boot loader is determined by the internal oscillator (PIOSC) frequency as it does not enable the PLL. The following serial interfaces can be used: ■ UART0 ■ SSI0 ■ I2C0 For simplicity, both the data format and communication protocol are identical for all serial interfaces. See the Stellaris® Boot Loader User's Guide for information on the boot loader software. 7.2.2.2 Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library The Stellaris Peripheral Driver Library contains a file called driverlib/rom.h that assists with calling the peripheral driver library functions in the ROM. The detailed description of each function is available in the Stellaris® ROM User’s Guide. See the "Using the ROM" chapter of the Stellaris® Peripheral Driver Library User's Guide for more details on calling the ROM functions and using driverlib/rom.h. A table at the beginning of the ROM points to the entry points for the APIs that are provided in the ROM. Accessing the API through these tables provides scalability; while the API locations may change in future versions of the ROM, the API tables will not. The tables are split into two levels; the main table contains one pointer per peripheral which points to a secondary table that contains one pointer per API that is associated with that peripheral. The main table is located at 0x0100.0010, right after the Cortex-M3 vector table in the ROM. DriverLib functions are described in detail in the Stellaris® Peripheral Driver Library User's Guide. Additional APIs are available for graphics and USB functions, but are not preloaded into ROM. The Stellaris Graphics Library provides a set of graphics primitives and a widget set for creating graphical user interfaces on Stellaris microcontroller-based boards that have a graphical display (for more information, see the Stellaris® Graphics Library User's Guide). 296 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 7.2.2.3 Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) Cryptography Tables AES is a strong encryption method with reasonable performance and size. AES is fast in both hardware and software, is fairly easy to implement, and requires little memory. AES is ideal for applications that can use pre-arranged keys, such as setup during manufacturing or configuration. Four data tables used by the XySSL AES implementation are provided in the ROM. The first is the forward S-box substitution table, the second is the reverse S-box substitution table, the third is the forward polynomial table, and the final is the reverse polynomial table. See the Stellaris® ROM User’s Guide for more information on AES. 7.2.2.4 Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) Error Detection The CRC technique can be used to validate correct receipt of messages (nothing lost or modified in transit), to validate data after decompression, to validate that Flash memory contents have not been changed, and for other cases where the data needs to be validated. A CRC is preferred over a simple checksum (e.g. XOR all bits) because it catches changes more readily. See the Stellaris® ROM User’s Guide for more information on CRC. 7.2.3 Flash Memory At system clock speeds of 50 MHz and below, the Flash memory is read in a single cycle. The Flash memory is organized as a set of 1-KB blocks that can be individually erased. An individual 32-bit word can be programmed to change bits from 1 to 0. In addition, a write buffer provides the ability to concurrently program 32 continuous words in Flash memory. Erasing a block causes the entire contents of the block to be reset to all 1s. The 1-KB blocks are paired into sets of 2-KB blocks that can be individually protected. The protection allows blocks to be marked as read-only or execute-only, providing different levels of code protection. Read-only blocks cannot be erased or programmed, protecting the contents of those blocks from being modified. Execute-only blocks cannot be erased or programmed and can only be read by the controller instruction fetch mechanism, protecting the contents of those blocks from being read by either the controller or by a debugger. Caution – The Stellaris Flash memory array has ECC which uses a test port into the Flash memory to continually scan the array for ECC errors and to correct any that are detected. This operation is transparent to the microcontroller. The BIST must scan the entire memory array occasionally to ensure integrity, taking about five minutes to do so. In systems where the microcontroller is frequently powered for less than five minutes, power should be removed from the microcontroller in a controlled manner to ensure proper operation. This controlled manner can either be through entering Hibernate mode or software can request permission to power down the part using the USDREQ bit in the Flash Control (FCTL) register and wait to receive an acknowledge from the USDACK bit prior to removing power. If the microcontroller is powered down using this controlled method, the BIST engine keeps track of where it was in the memory array and it always scans the complete array after any aggregate of five minutes powered-on, regardless of the number of intervening power cycles. If the microcontroller is powered down before five minutes of being powered up, BIST starts again from wherever it left off before the last controlled power-down or from 0 if there never was a controlled power down. An occasional short power down is not a concern, but the microcontroller should not always be powered down frequently in an uncontrolled manner. The microcontroller can be power-cycled as frequently as necessary if it is powered-down in a controlled manner. 7.2.3.1 Prefetch Buffer The Flash memory controller has a prefetch buffer that is automatically used when the CPU frequency is greater than 50 MHz. In this mode, the Flash memory operates at half of the system clock. The prefetch buffer fetches two 32-bit words per clock allowing instructions to be fetched with no wait states while code is executing linearly. The fetch buffer includes a branch speculation mechanism January 22, 2012 297 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory that recognizes a branch and avoids extra wait states by not reading the next word pair. Also, short loop branches often stay in the buffer. As a result, some branches can be executed with no wait states. Other branches incur a single wait state. 7.2.3.2 Flash Memory Protection The user is provided two forms of Flash memory protection per 2-KB Flash memory block in six pairs of 32-bit wide registers. The policy for each protection form is controlled by individual bits (per policy per block) in the FMPPEn and FMPREn registers. ■ Flash Memory Protection Program Enable (FMPPEn): If a bit is set, the corresponding block may be programmed (written) or erased. If a bit is cleared, the corresponding block may not be changed. ■ Flash Memory Protection Read Enable (FMPREn): If a bit is set, the corresponding block may be executed or read by software or debuggers. If a bit is cleared, the corresponding block may only be executed, and contents of the memory block are prohibited from being read as data. The policies may be combined as shown in Table 7-1 on page 298. Table 7-1. Flash Memory Protection Policy Combinations FMPPEn FMPREn 0 0 Protection Execute-only protection. The block may only be executed and may not be written or erased. This mode is used to protect code. 1 0 The block may be written, erased or executed, but not read. This combination is unlikely to be used. 0 1 Read-only protection. The block may be read or executed but may not be written or erased. This mode is used to lock the block from further modification while allowing any read or execute access. 1 1 No protection. The block may be written, erased, executed or read. A Flash memory access that attempts to read a read-protected block (FMPREn bit is set) is prohibited and generates a bus fault. A Flash memory access that attempts to program or erase a program-protected block (FMPPEn bit is set) is prohibited and can optionally generate an interrupt (by setting the AMASK bit in the Flash Controller Interrupt Mask (FCIM) register) to alert software developers of poorly behaving software during the development and debug phases. Note that if a FMPREn bit is cleared, all read accesses to the Flash memory block are disallowed, including any data accesses. Care must be taken not to store required data in a Flash memory block that has the associated FMPREn bit cleared. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. These settings create a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by clearing the specific register bit. The changes are effective immediately, but are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing any type of reset sequence. The changes are committed using the Flash Memory Control (FMC) register. Details on programming these bits are discussed in “Non-Volatile Register Programming” on page 301. 7.2.3.3 Interrupts The Flash memory controller can generate interrupts when the following conditions are observed: ■ Programming Interrupt - signals when a program or erase action is complete. 298 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller ■ Access Interrupt - signals when a program or erase action has been attempted on a 2-kB block of memory that is protected by its corresponding FMPPEn bit. The interrupt events that can trigger a controller-level interrupt are defined in the Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status (FCMIS) register (see page 310) by setting the corresponding MASK bits. If interrupts are not used, the raw interrupt status is always visible via the Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status (FCRIS) register (see page 309). Interrupts are always cleared (for both the FCMIS and FCRIS registers) by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit in the Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (FCMISC) register (see page 311). 7.2.3.4 Flash Memory Programming The Stellaris devices provide a user-friendly interface for Flash memory programming. All erase/program operations are handled via three registers: Flash Memory Address (FMA), Flash Memory Data (FMD), and Flash Memory Control (FMC). Note that if the debug capabilities of the microcontroller have been deactivated, resulting in a "locked" state, a recovery sequence must be performed in order to reactivate the debug module. See “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. During a Flash memory operation (write, page erase, or mass erase) access to the Flash memory is inhibited. As a result, instruction and literal fetches are held off until the Flash memory operation is complete. If instruction execution is required during a Flash memory operation, the code that is executing must be placed in SRAM and executed from there while the flash operation is in progress. Caution – The Flash memory is divided into sectors of electrically separated address ranges of 4 KB each, aligned on 4 KB boundaries. Erase/program operations on a 1-KB page have an electrical effect on the other three 1-KB pages within the sector. A specific 1-KB page must be erased after 6 total erase/program cycles occur to the other pages within its 4-KB sector. The following sequence of operations on a 4-KB sector of Flash memory (Page 0..3) provides an example: ■ Page 3 is erase and programmed with values. ■ Page 0, Page 1, and Page 2 are erased and then programmed with values. At this point Page 3 has been affected by 3 erase/program cycles. ■ Page 0, Page 1, and Page 2 are again erased and then programmed with values. At this point Page 3 has been affected by 6 erase/program cycles. ■ If the contents of Page 3 must continue to be valid, Page 3 must be erased and reprogrammed before any other page in this sector has another erase or program operation. To program a 32-bit word 1. Write source data to the FMD register. 2. Write the target address to the FMA register. 3. Write the Flash memory write key and the WRITE bit (a value of 0xA442.0001) to the FMC register. 4. Poll the FMC register until the WRITE bit is cleared. January 22, 2012 299 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Important: To ensure proper operation, two writes to the same word must be separated by an ERASE. The following two sequences are allowed: ■ ERASE -> PROGRAM value -> PROGRAM 0x0000.0000 ■ ERASE -> PROGRAM value -> ERASE The following sequence is NOT allowed: ■ ERASE -> PROGRAM value -> PROGRAM value To perform an erase of a 1-KB page 1. Write the page address to the FMA register. 2. Write the Flash memory write key and the ERASE bit (a value of 0xA442.0002) to the FMC register. 3. Poll the FMC register until the ERASE bit is cleared or, alternatively, enable the programming interrupt using the PMASK bit in the FCIM register. To perform a mass erase of the Flash memory 1. Write the Flash memory write key and the MERASE bit (a value of 0xA442.0004) to the FMC register. 2. Poll the FMC register until the MERASE bit is cleared or, alternatively, enable the programming interrupt using the PMASK bit in the FCIM register. 7.2.3.5 32-Word Flash Memory Write Buffer A 32-word write buffer provides the capability to perform faster write accesses to the Flash memory by concurrently programing 32 words with a single buffered Flash memory write operation. The buffered Flash memory write operation takes the same amount of time as the single word write operation controlled by bit 0 in the FMC register. The data for the buffered write is written to the Flash Write Buffer (FWBn) registers. The registers are 32-word aligned with Flash memory, and therefore the register FWB0 corresponds with the address in FMA where bits [6:0] of FMA are all 0. FWB1 corresponds with the address in FMA + 0x4 and so on. Only the FWBn registers that have been updated since the previous buffered Flash memory write operation are written. The Flash Write Buffer Valid (FWBVAL) register shows which registers have been written since the last buffered Flash memory write operation. This register contains a bit for each of the 32 FWBn registers, where bit[n] of FWBVAL corresponds to FWBn. The FWBn register has been updated if the corresponding bit in the FWBVAL register is set. To program 32 words with a single buffered Flash memory write operation 1. Write the source data to the FWBn registers. 2. Write the target address to the FMA register. This must be a 32-word aligned address (that is, bits [6:0] in FMA must be 0s). 3. Write the Flash memory write key and the WRBUF bit (a value of 0xA442.0001) to the FMC2 register. 300 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 4. Poll the FMC2 register until the WRBUF bit is cleared or wait for the PMIS interrupt to be signaled. 7.2.3.6 Non-Volatile Register Programming This section discusses how to update the registers shown in Table 7-2 on page 302 that are resident within the Flash memory itself. These registers exist in a separate space from the main Flash memory array and are not affected by an ERASE or MASS ERASE operation. With the exception of the Boot Configuration (BOOTCFG) register, the settings in these registers can be written, their functions verified, and their values read back before they are committed, at which point they become non-volatile. If a value in one of these registers has not been committed, any type of reset restores the last committed value or the default value if the register has never been committed. Once the register contents are committed, the only way to restore the factory default values is to perform the sequence described in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. To write to a non-volatile register: ■ Bits can only be changed from 1 to 0. ■ For all registers except the BOOTCFG register, write the data to the register address provided in the register description. For the BOOTCFG register, write the data to the FMD register. ■ The registers can be read to verify their contents. To verify what is to be stored in the BOOTCFG register, read the FMD register. Reading the BOOTCFG register returns the previously committed value or the default value if the register has never been committed. ■ The new values are effectively immediately for all registers except BOOTCFG, as the new value for the register is not stored in the register until it has been committed. ■ Prior to committing the register value, any type of reset restores the last committed value or the default value if the register has never been committed. To commit a new value to a non-volatile register: ■ Write the data as described above. ■ Write to the FMA register the value shown in Table 7-2 on page 302. ■ Write the Flash memory write key and set the COMT bit in the FMC register. These values must be written to the FMC register at the same time. ■ Committing a non-volatile register has the same timing as a write to regular Flash memory, defined by TPROG, as shown in Table 21-19 on page 904. Software can poll the COMT bit in the FMC register to determine when the operation is complete, or an interrupt can be enabled by setting the PMASK bit in the FCIM register. ■ When committing the BOOTCFG register, the INVDRIS bit in the FCRIS register is set if a bit that has already been committed as a 0 is attempted to be committed as a 1. ■ Once the value has been committed, any type of reset has no effect on the register contents. ■ Changes to the BOOTCFG register are effective after the next reset. ■ The NW bit in the USER_REG0, USER_REG1, USER_REG2, USER_REG3, and BOOTCFG registers is cleared when the register is committed. Once this bit is cleared, additional changes to the register are not allowed. January 22, 2012 301 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Important: After being committed, these registers can only be restored to their factory default values by performing the sequence described in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. The mass erase of the main Flash memory array caused by the sequence is performed prior to restoring these registers. Table 7-2. User-Programmable Flash Memory Resident Registers Register to be Committed 7.3 FMA Value Data Source FMPRE0 0x0000.0000 FMPRE0 FMPRE1 0x0000.0002 FMPRE1 FMPRE2 0x0000.0004 FMPRE2 FMPRE3 0x0000.0006 FMPRE3 FMPRE4 0x0000.0008 FMPRE4 FMPRE5 0x0000.000A FMPRE5 FMPPE0 0x0000.0001 FMPPE0 FMPPE1 0x0000.0003 FMPPE1 FMPPE2 0x0000.0005 FMPPE2 FMPPE3 0x0000.0007 FMPPE3 FMPRE4 0x0000.0009 FMPRE4 FMPRE5 0x0000.000B FMPRE5 USER_REG0 0x8000.0000 USER_REG0 USER_REG1 0x8000.0001 USER_REG1 USER_REG2 0x8000.0002 USER_REG2 USER_REG3 0x8000.0003 USER_REG3 BOOTCFG 0x7510.0000 FMD Register Map Table 7-3 on page 302 lists the ROM Controller register and the Flash memory and control registers. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register's address. The Flash memory register offsets are relative to the Flash memory control base address of 0x400F.D000. The ROM and Flash memory protection register offsets are relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. Table 7-3. Flash Register Map Offset Name Type Reset See page Description Flash Memory Registers (Flash Control Offset) 0x000 FMA R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Address 304 0x004 FMD R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Data 305 0x008 FMC R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Control 306 0x00C FCRIS RO 0x0000.0000 Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status 309 0x010 FCIM R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Controller Interrupt Mask 310 0x014 FCMISC R/W1C 0x0000.0000 Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear 311 0x020 FMC2 R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Control 2 312 302 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 7-3. Flash Register Map (continued) Description See page Offset Name Type Reset 0x030 FWBVAL R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Write Buffer Valid 313 0x0F8 FCTL R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Control 314 0x100 0x17C FWBn R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Write Buffer n 315 ROM Control 316 Memory Registers (System Control Offset) 0x0F0 RMCTL R/W1C - 0x130 FMPRE0 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 0 317 0x200 FMPRE0 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 0 317 0x134 FMPPE0 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 0 318 0x400 FMPPE0 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 0 318 0x1D0 BOOTCFG R/W 0xFFFF.FFFE Boot Configuration 319 0x1E0 USER_REG0 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF User Register 0 321 0x1E4 USER_REG1 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF User Register 1 322 0x1E8 USER_REG2 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF User Register 2 323 0x1EC USER_REG3 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF User Register 3 324 0x204 FMPRE1 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 1 325 0x208 FMPRE2 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 2 326 0x20C FMPRE3 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 3 327 0x210 FMPRE4 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 4 328 0x214 FMPRE5 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 5 329 0x218 FMPRE6 R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 6 330 0x21C FMPRE7 R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 7 331 0x404 FMPPE1 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 1 332 0x408 FMPPE2 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 2 333 0x40C FMPPE3 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 3 334 0x410 FMPPE4 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 4 335 0x414 FMPPE5 R/W 0xFFFF.FFFF Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 5 336 0x418 FMPPE6 R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 6 337 0x41C FMPPE7 R/W 0x0000.0000 Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 7 338 7.4 Flash Memory Register Descriptions (Flash Control Offset) This section lists and describes the Flash Memory registers, in numerical order by address offset. Registers in this section are relative to the Flash control base address of 0x400F.D000. January 22, 2012 303 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 1: Flash Memory Address (FMA), offset 0x000 During a write operation, this register contains a 4-byte-aligned address and specifies where the data is written. During erase operations, this register contains a 1 KB-aligned CPU byte address and specifies which block is erased. Note that the alignment requirements must be met by software or the results of the operation are unpredictable. Flash Memory Address (FMA) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset 17 16 OFFSET OFFSET Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:19 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 18:0 OFFSET R/W 0x0 Address Offset Address offset in Flash memory where operation is performed, except for non-volatile registers (see “Non-Volatile Register Programming” on page 301 for details on values for this field). 304 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 2: Flash Memory Data (FMD), offset 0x004 This register contains the data to be written during the programming cycle or read during the read cycle. Note that the contents of this register are undefined for a read access of an execute-only block. This register is not used during erase cycles. Flash Memory Data (FMD) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x004 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 DATA Type Reset DATA Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 DATA R/W Reset Description 0x0000.0000 Data Value Data value for write operation. January 22, 2012 305 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 3: Flash Memory Control (FMC), offset 0x008 When this register is written, the Flash memory controller initiates the appropriate access cycle for the location specified by the Flash Memory Address (FMA) register (see page 304). If the access is a write access, the data contained in the Flash Memory Data (FMD) register (see page 305) is written to the specified address. This register must be the final register written and initiates the memory operation. The four control bits in the lower byte of this register are used to initiate memory operations. Care must be taken not to set multiple control bits as the results of such an operation are unpredictable. Caution – If any of bits [15:4] are written to 1, the device may become inoperable. These bits should always be written to 0. In all registers, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Flash Memory Control (FMC) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 COMT MERASE ERASE WRITE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 WRKEY Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:16 WRKEY WO 0x0000 Description Flash Memory Write Key This field contains a write key, which is used to minimize the incidence of accidental Flash memory writes. The value 0xA442 must be written into this field for a Flash memory write to occur. Writes to the FMC register without this WRKEY value are ignored. A read of this field returns the value 0. 15:4 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 306 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 3 COMT R/W 0 Description Commit Register Value This bit is used to commit writes to Flash-memory-resident registers and to monitor the progress of that process. Value Description 1 Set this bit to commit (write) the register value to a Flash-memory-resident register. When read, a 1 indicates that the previous commit access is not complete. 0 A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. When read, a 0 indicates that the previous commit access is complete. See “Non-Volatile Register Programming” on page 301 for more information on programming Flash-memory-resident registers. 2 MERASE R/W 0 Mass Erase Flash Memory This bit is used to mass erase the Flash main memory and to monitor the progress of that process. Value Description 1 Set this bit to erase the Flash main memory. When read, a 1 indicates that the previous mass erase access is not complete. 0 A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. When read, a 0 indicates that the previous mass erase access is complete. For information on erase time, see “Flash Memory” on page 904. 1 ERASE R/W 0 Erase a Page of Flash Memory This bit is used to erase a page of Flash memory and to monitor the progress of that process. Value Description 1 Set this bit to erase the Flash memory page specified by the contents of the FMA register. When read, a 1 indicates that the previous page erase access is not complete. 0 A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. When read, a 0 indicates that the previous page erase access is complete. For information on erase time, see “Flash Memory” on page 904. January 22, 2012 307 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 WRITE R/W 0 Description Write a Word into Flash Memory This bit is used to write a word into Flash memory and to monitor the progress of that process. Value Description 1 Set this bit to write the data stored in the FMD register into the Flash memory location specified by the contents of the FMA register. When read, a 1 indicates that the write update access is not complete. 0 A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. When read, a 0 indicates that the previous write update access is complete. For information on programming time, see “Flash Memory” on page 904. 308 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 4: Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status (FCRIS), offset 0x00C This register indicates that the Flash memory controller has an interrupt condition. An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller only if the corresponding FCIM register bit is set. Flash Controller Raw Interrupt Status (FCRIS) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x00C Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PRIS ARIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:2 reserved RO 0x0000.000 1 PRIS RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Programming Raw Interrupt Status This bit provides status on programming cycles which are write or erase actions generated through the FMC or FMC2 register bits (see page 306 and page 312). Value Description 1 The programming or erase cycle has completed. 0 The programming or erase cycle has not completed. This status is sent to the interrupt controller when the PMASK bit in the FCIM register is set. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the PMISC bit in the FCMISC register. 0 ARIS RO 0 Access Raw Interrupt Status Value Description 1 A program or erase action was attempted on a block of Flash memory that contradicts the protection policy for that block as set in the FMPPEn registers. 0 No access has tried to improperly program or erase the Flash memory. This status is sent to the interrupt controller when the AMASK bit in the FCIM register is set. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the AMISC bit in the FCMISC register. January 22, 2012 309 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 5: Flash Controller Interrupt Mask (FCIM), offset 0x010 This register controls whether the Flash memory controller generates interrupts to the controller. Flash Controller Interrupt Mask (FCIM) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x010 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PMASK AMASK RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:2 reserved RO 0x0000.000 1 PMASK R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Programming Interrupt Mask This bit controls the reporting of the programming raw interrupt status to the interrupt controller. Value Description 0 AMASK R/W 0 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the PRIS bit is set. 0 The PRIS interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. Access Interrupt Mask This bit controls the reporting of the access raw interrupt status to the interrupt controller. Value Description 1 An interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller when the ARIS bit is set. 0 The ARIS interrupt is suppressed and not sent to the interrupt controller. 310 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 6: Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (FCMISC), offset 0x014 This register provides two functions. First, it reports the cause of an interrupt by indicating which interrupt source or sources are signalling the interrupt. Second, it serves as the method to clear the interrupt reporting. Flash Controller Masked Interrupt Status and Clear (FCMISC) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x014 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:2 reserved RO 0x0000.000 1 PMISC R/W1C 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 1 0 PMISC AMISC R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Programming Masked Interrupt Status and Clear Value Description 1 When read, a 1 indicates that an unmasked interrupt was signaled because a programming cycle completed. Writing a 1 to this bit clears PMISC and also the PRIS bit in the FCRIS register (see page 309). 0 When read, a 0 indicates that a programming cycle complete interrupt has not occurred. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. 0 AMISC R/W1C 0 Access Masked Interrupt Status and Clear Value Description 1 When read, a 1 indicates that an unmasked interrupt was signaled because a program or erase action was attempted on a block of Flash memory that contradicts the protection policy for that block as set in the FMPPEn registers. Writing a 1 to this bit clears AMISC and also the ARIS bit in the FCRIS register (see page 309). 0 When read, a 0 indicates that no improper accesses have occurred. A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. January 22, 2012 311 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 7: Flash Memory Control 2 (FMC2), offset 0x020 When this register is written, the Flash memory controller initiates the appropriate access cycle for the location specified by the Flash Memory Address (FMA) register (see page 304). If the access is a write access, the data contained in the Flash Write Buffer (FWB) registers is written. This register must be the final register written as it initiates the memory operation. Flash Memory Control 2 (FMC2) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x020 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 WRKEY Type Reset WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 WO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:16 WRKEY WO 0x0000 RO 0 0 WRBUF RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 Description Flash Memory Write Key This field contains a write key, which is used to minimize the incidence of accidental Flash memory writes. The value 0xA442 must be written into this field for a write to occur. Writes to the FMC2 register without this WRKEY value are ignored. A read of this field returns the value 0. 15:1 reserved RO 0x000 0 WRBUF R/W 0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Buffered Flash Memory Write This bit is used to start a buffered write to Flash memory. Value Description 1 Set this bit to write the data stored in the FWBn registers to the location specified by the contents of the FMA register. When read, a 1 indicates that the previous buffered Flash memory write access is not complete. 0 A write of 0 has no effect on the state of this bit. When read, a 0 indicates that the previous buffered Flash memory write access is complete. For information on programming time, see “Flash Memory” on page 904. 312 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 8: Flash Write Buffer Valid (FWBVAL), offset 0x030 This register provides a bitwise status of which FWBn registers have been written by the processor since the last write of the Flash memory write buffer. The entries with a 1 are written on the next write of the Flash memory write buffer. This register is cleared after the write operation by hardware. A protection violation on the write operation also clears this status. Software can program the same 32 words to various Flash memory locations by setting the FWB[n] bits after they are cleared by the write operation. The next write operation then uses the same data as the previous one. In addition, if a FWBn register change should not be written to Flash memory, software can clear the corresponding FWB[n] bit to preserve the existing data when the next write operation occurs. Flash Write Buffer Valid (FWBVAL) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x030 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 FWB[n] Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 FWB[n] Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 FWB[n] R/W 0x0 R/W 0 Description Flash Memory Write Buffer Value Description 1 The corresponding FWBn register has been updated since the last buffer write operation and is ready to be written to Flash memory. 0 The corresponding FWBn register has no new data to be written. Bit 0 corresponds to FWB0, offset 0x100, and bit 31 corresponds to FWB31, offset 0x13C. January 22, 2012 313 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 9: Flash Control (FCTL), offset 0x0F8 This register is used to ensure that the microcontroller is powered down in a controlled fashion in systems where power is cycled more frequently than once every five minutes. The USDREQ bit should be set to indicate that power is going to be turned off. Software should poll the USDACK bit to determine when it is acceptable to power down. Note that this power-down process is not required if the microcontroller enters Hibernate mode prior to power being removed. Flash Control (FCTL) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x0F8 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 1 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:2 reserved RO 0x0000.000 1 USDACK RO 0 USDACK USDREQ RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. User Shut Down Acknowledge Value Description 1 The microcontroller can be powered down. 0 The microcontroller cannot yet be powered down. This bit should be set within 50 ms of setting the USDREQ bit. 0 USDREQ R/W 0 User Shut Down Request Value Description 1 Requests permission to power down the microcontroller. 0 No effect. 314 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 10: Flash Write Buffer n (FWBn), offset 0x100 - 0x17C These 32 registers hold the contents of the data to be written into the Flash memory on a buffered Flash memory write operation. The offset selects one of the 32-bit registers. Only FWBn registers that have been updated since the preceding buffered Flash memory write operation are written into the Flash memory, so it is not necessary to write the entire bank of registers in order to write 1 or 2 words. The FWBn registers are written into the Flash memory with the FWB0 register corresponding to the address contained in FMA. FWB1 is written to the address FMA+0x4 etc. Note that only data bits that are 0 result in the Flash memory being modified. A data bit that is 1 leaves the content of the Flash memory bit at its previous value. Flash Write Buffer n (FWBn) Base 0x400F.D000 Offset 0x100 - 0x17C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 DATA Type Reset DATA Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 DATA R/W Reset Description 0x0000.0000 Data Data to be written into the Flash memory. 7.5 Memory Register Descriptions (System Control Offset) The remainder of this section lists and describes the registers that reside in the System Control address space, in numerical order by address offset. Registers in this section are relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. January 22, 2012 315 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 11: ROM Control (RMCTL), offset 0x0F0 This register provides control of the ROM controller state. This register offset is relative to the System Control base address of 0x400F.E000. At reset, the ROM is mapped over the Flash memory so that the ROM boot sequence is always executed. The boot sequence executed from ROM is as follows: 1. The BA bit (below) is cleared such that ROM is mapped to 0x01xx.xxxx and Flash memory is mapped to address 0x0. 2. The BOOTCFG register is read. If the EN bit is clear, the status of the specified GPIO pin is compared with the specified polarity. If the status matches the specified polarity, the ROM is mapped to address 0x0000.0000 and execution continues out of the ROM Boot Loader. 3. If the status doesn't match the specified polarity, the data at address 0x0000.0004 is read, and if the data at this address is 0xFFFF.FFFF, the ROM is mapped to address 0x0000.0000 and execution continues out of the ROM Boot Loader. 4. If there is data at address 0x0000.0004 that is not 0xFFFF.FFFF, the stack pointer (SP) is loaded from Flash memory at address 0x0000.0000 and the program counter (PC) is loaded from address 0x0000.0004. The user application begins executing. ROM Control (RMCTL) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x0F0 Type R/W1C, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:1 reserved RO 0x0000.000 0 BA R/W1C 1 RO 0 0 BA RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 R/W1C 1 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Boot Alias Value Description 1 The microcontroller's ROM appears at address 0x0. 0 The Flash memory is at address 0x0. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to this bit position. 316 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 12: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 0 (FMPRE0), offset 0x130 and 0x200 Note: This register is aliased for backwards compatability. Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPPEn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPREn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 0 (FMPRE0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x130 and 0x200 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 READ_ENABLE R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Read Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be read or executed only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory up to the total of 64 KB. January 22, 2012 317 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 13: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 0 (FMPPE0), offset 0x134 and 0x400 Note: This register is aliased for backwards compatability. Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPREn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPPEn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 0 (FMPPE0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x134 and 0x400 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 PROG_ENABLE R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Programming Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be execute only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory up to the total of 64 KB. 318 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 14: Boot Configuration (BOOTCFG), offset 0x1D0 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register provides configuration of a GPIO pin to enable the ROM Boot Loader as well as a write-once mechanism to disable external debugger access to the device. Upon reset, the user has the opportunity to direct the core to execute the ROM Boot Loader or the application in Flash memory by using any GPIO signal from Ports A-H as configured by the bits in this register. If the EN bit is set or the specified pin does not have the required polarity, the system control module checks address 0x000.0004 to see if the Flash memory has a valid reset vector. If the data at address 0x0000.0004 is 0xFFFF.FFFF, then it is assumed that the Flash memory has not yet been programmed, and the core executes the ROM Boot Loader. The DBG0 bit (bit 0) is set to 0 from the factory and the DBG1 bit (bit 1) is set to 1, which enables external debuggers. Clearing the DBG1 bit disables any external debugger access to the device permanently, starting with the next power-up cycle of the device. The NW bit (bit 31) indicates that the register has not yet been committed and is controlled through hardware to ensure that the register is only committed once. Prior to being committed, bits can only be changed from 1 to 0. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. Boot Configuration (BOOTCFG) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x1D0 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFE 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 NW Type Reset R/W 1 15 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 14 13 12 PORT Type Reset R/W 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 1 RO 1 reserved R/W 1 RO 1 RO 1 11 10 PIN R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 9 8 POL EN R/W 1 R/W 1 reserved RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 NW R/W 1 Not Written RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 1 0 DBG1 DBG0 R/W 1 R/W 0 When set, this bit indicates that this 32-bit register has not been committed. When clear, this bit specifies that this register has been committed and may not be committed again. 30:16 reserved RO 0x7FFF Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 319 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Bit/Field Name Type Reset 15:13 PORT R/W 0x7 Description Boot GPIO Port This field selects the port of the GPIO port pin that enables the ROM boot loader at reset. Value Description 12:10 PIN R/W 0x7 0x0 Port A 0x1 Port B 0x2 Port C 0x3 Port D 0x4 Port E 0x5 Port F 0x6 Port G 0x7 Port H Boot GPIO Pin This field selects the pin number of the GPIO port pin that enables the ROM boot loader at reset. Value Description 9 POL R/W 0x1 0x0 Pin 0 0x1 Pin 1 0x2 Pin 2 0x3 Pin 3 0x4 Pin 4 0x5 Pin 5 0x6 Pin 6 0x7 Pin 7 Boot GPIO Polarity When set, this bit selects a high level for the GPIO port pin to enable the ROM boot loader at reset. When clear, this bit selects a low level for the GPIO port pin. 8 EN R/W 0x1 Boot GPIO Enable Clearing this bit enables the use of a GPIO pin to enable the ROM Boot Loader at reset. When this bit is set, the contents of address 0x0000.0004 are checked to see if the Flash memory has been programmed. If the contents are not 0xFFFF.FFFF, the core executes out of Flash memory. If the Flash has not been programmed, the core executes out of ROM. 7:2 reserved RO 0x3F 1 DBG1 R/W 1 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Debug Control 1 The DBG1 bit must be 1 and DBG0 must be 0 for debug to be available. 0 DBG0 R/W 0x0 Debug Control 0 The DBG1 bit must be 1 and DBG0 must be 0 for debug to be available. 320 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 15: User Register 0 (USER_REG0), offset 0x1E0 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register provides 31 bits of user-defined data that is non-volatile and can only be committed once. Bit 31 indicates that the register is available to be committed and is controlled through hardware to ensure that the register is only committed once. Prior to being committed, bits can only be changed from 1 to 0. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. The write-once characteristics of this register are useful for keeping static information like communication addresses that need to be unique per part and would otherwise require an external EEPROM or other non-volatile device. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. User Register 0 (USER_REG0) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x1E0 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 NW Type Reset 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 DATA R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 DATA Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 NW R/W 1 Not Written When set, this bit indicates that this 32-bit register has not been committed. When clear, this bit specifies that this register has been committed and may not be committed again. 30:0 DATA R/W 0x7FFFFFFF User Data Contains the user data value. This field is initialized to all 1s and can only be committed once. January 22, 2012 321 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 16: User Register 1 (USER_REG1), offset 0x1E4 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register provides 31 bits of user-defined data that is non-volatile and can only be written once. Bit 31 indicates that the register is available to be written and is controlled through hardware to ensure that the register is only written once. The write-once characteristics of this register are useful for keeping static information like communication addresses that need to be unique per part and would otherwise require an external EEPROM or other non-volatile device. User Register 1 (USER_REG1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x1E4 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 NW Type Reset 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 DATA R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 DATA Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 NW R/W 1 Not Written When set, this bit indicates that this 32-bit register has not been committed. When clear, this bit specifies that this register has been committed and may not be committed again. 30:0 DATA R/W 0x7FFFFFFF User Data Contains the user data value. This field is initialized to all 1s and can only be committed once. 322 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 17: User Register 2 (USER_REG2), offset 0x1E8 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register provides 31 bits of user-defined data that is non-volatile and can only be written once. Bit 31 indicates that the register is available to be written and is controlled through hardware to ensure that the register is only written once. The write-once characteristics of this register are useful for keeping static information like communication addresses that need to be unique per part and would otherwise require an external EEPROM or other non-volatile device. User Register 2 (USER_REG2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x1E8 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 NW Type Reset 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 DATA R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 DATA Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 NW R/W 1 Not Written When set, this bit indicates that this 32-bit register has not been committed. When clear, this bit specifies that this register has been committed and may not be committed again. 30:0 DATA R/W 0x7FFFFFFF User Data Contains the user data value. This field is initialized to all 1s and can only be committed once. January 22, 2012 323 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 18: User Register 3 (USER_REG3), offset 0x1EC Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register provides 31 bits of user-defined data that is non-volatile and can only be written once. Bit 31 indicates that the register is available to be written and is controlled through hardware to ensure that the register is only written once. The write-once characteristics of this register are useful for keeping static information like communication addresses that need to be unique per part and would otherwise require an external EEPROM or other non-volatile device. User Register 3 (USER_REG3) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x1EC Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 NW Type Reset 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 DATA R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 DATA Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31 NW R/W 1 Not Written When set, this bit indicates that this 32-bit register has not been committed. When clear, this bit specifies that this register has been committed and may not be committed again. 30:0 DATA R/W 0x7FFFFFFF User Data Contains the user data value. This field is initialized to all 1s and can only be committed once. 324 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 19: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 1 (FMPRE1), offset 0x204 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPPEn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPREn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 64 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 1 (FMPRE1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x204 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 READ_ENABLE R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Read Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be read or executed only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in memory range from 65 to 128 KB. January 22, 2012 325 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 20: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 2 (FMPRE2), offset 0x208 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPPEn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPREn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 128 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 2 (FMPRE2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x208 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 READ_ENABLE R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Read Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be read or executed only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 129 to 192 KB. 326 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 21: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 3 (FMPRE3), offset 0x20C Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPPEn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPREn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 3 (FMPRE3) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x20C Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 READ_ENABLE R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Read Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be read or executed only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 193 to 256 KB. January 22, 2012 327 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 22: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 4 (FMPRE4), offset 0x210 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPPEn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPREn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 4 (FMPRE4) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x210 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 READ_ENABLE R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Read Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be read or executed only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 257 to 320 KB. 328 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 23: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 5 (FMPRE5), offset 0x214 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPPEn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPREn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 5 (FMPRE5) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x214 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 READ_ENABLE R/W R/W 1 Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Read Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be read or executed only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 321 to 384 KB. January 22, 2012 329 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 24: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 6 (FMPRE6), offset 0x218 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPPEn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPREn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 6 (FMPRE6) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x218 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 READ_ENABLE R/W R/W 0 Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Description 0x00000000 Flash Read Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be read or executed only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0x00000000 Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 385 to 448 KB. 330 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 25: Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 7 (FMPRE7), offset 0x21C Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the read-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPPEn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPREn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Read Enable 7 (FMPRE7) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x21C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 READ_ENABLE Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 READ_ENABLE R/W R/W 0 Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Description 0x00000000 Flash Read Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be read or executed only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0x00000000 Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 449 to 512 KB. January 22, 2012 331 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 26: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 1 (FMPPE1), offset 0x404 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPREn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPPEn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 64 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 1 (FMPPE1) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x404 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset PROG_ENABLE Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 PROG_ENABLE R/W Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Programming Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be execute only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in memory range from 65 to 128 KB. 332 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 27: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 2 (FMPPE2), offset 0x408 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPREn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPPEn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 128 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 2 (FMPPE2) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x408 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset PROG_ENABLE Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 PROG_ENABLE R/W Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Programming Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be execute only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 129 to 192 KB. January 22, 2012 333 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 28: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 3 (FMPPE3), offset 0x40C Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPREn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPPEn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 3 (FMPPE3) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x40C Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset PROG_ENABLE Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 PROG_ENABLE R/W Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Programming Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be execute only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 193 to 256 KB. 334 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 29: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 4 (FMPPE4), offset 0x410 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPREn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPPEn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 4 (FMPPE4) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x410 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset PROG_ENABLE Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 PROG_ENABLE R/W Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Programming Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be execute only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 257 to 320 KB. January 22, 2012 335 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 30: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 5 (FMPPE5), offset 0x414 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPREn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPPEn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 5 (FMPPE5) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x414 Type R/W, reset 0xFFFF.FFFF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset PROG_ENABLE Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 PROG_ENABLE R/W Reset R/W 1 R/W 1 Description 0xFFFFFFFF Flash Programming Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be execute only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0xFFFFFFFF Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 321 to 384 KB. 336 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 31: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 6 (FMPPE6), offset 0x418 Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPREn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPPEn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 6 (FMPPE6) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x418 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset PROG_ENABLE Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 PROG_ENABLE R/W Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Description 0x00000000 Flash Programming Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be execute only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0x00000000 Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 385 to 448 KB. January 22, 2012 337 Texas Instruments-Production Data Internal Memory Register 32: Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 7 (FMPPE7), offset 0x41C Note: Offset is relative to System Control base address of 0x400FE000. This register stores the execute-only protection bits for each 2-KB flash block (FMPREn stores the execute-only bits). Flash memory up to a total of 64 KB is controlled by this register. Other FMPPEn registers (if any) provide protection for other 64K blocks. This register is loaded during the power-on reset sequence. The factory settings for the FMPREn and FMPPEn registers are a value of 1 for all implemented banks. This achieves a policy of open access and programmability. The register bits may be changed by writing the specific register bit. However, this register is R/W0; the user can only change the protection bit from a 1 to a 0 (and may NOT change a 0 to a 1). The changes are not permanent until the register is committed (saved), at which point the bit change is permanent. If a bit is changed from a 1 to a 0 and not committed, it may be restored by executing a power-on reset sequence. The reset value shown only applies to power-on reset; any other type of reset does not affect this register. Once committed, the only way to restore the factory default value of this register is to perform the sequence detailed in “Recovering a "Locked" Microcontroller” on page 167. If the Flash memory size on the device is less than 192 KB, this register usually reads as zeroes, but software should not rely on these bits to be zero. For additional information, see “Flash Memory Protection” on page 298. Flash Memory Protection Program Enable 7 (FMPPE7) Base 0x400F.E000 Offset 0x41C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 PROG_ENABLE Type Reset PROG_ENABLE Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 PROG_ENABLE R/W Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Description 0x00000000 Flash Programming Enable Configures 2-KB flash blocks to be execute only. The policies may be combined as shown in the table "Flash Protection Policy Combinations". Value Description 0x00000000 Bits [31:0] each enable protection on a 2-KB block of Flash memory in the range from 449 to 512 KB. 338 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 8 Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) The LM3S1G21 microcontroller includes a Direct Memory Access (DMA) controller, known as micro-DMA (μDMA). The μDMA controller provides a way to offload data transfer tasks from the Cortex™-M3 processor, allowing for more efficient use of the processor and the available bus bandwidth. The μDMA controller can perform transfers between memory and peripherals. It has dedicated channels for each supported on-chip module and can be programmed to automatically perform transfers between peripherals and memory as the peripheral is ready to transfer more data. The μDMA controller provides the following features: ® ® ■ ARM PrimeCell 32-channel configurable µDMA controller ■ Support for memory-to-memory, memory-to-peripheral, and peripheral-to-memory in multiple transfer modes – Basic for simple transfer scenarios – Ping-pong for continuous data flow – Scatter-gather for a programmable list of arbitrary transfers initiated from a single request ■ Highly flexible and configurable channel operation – Independently configured and operated channels – Dedicated channels for supported on-chip modules – Primary and secondary channel assignments – One channel each for receive and transmit path for bidirectional modules – Dedicated channel for software-initiated transfers – Per-channel configurable priority scheme – Optional software-initiated requests for any channel ■ Two levels of priority ■ Design optimizations for improved bus access performance between µDMA controller and the processor core – µDMA controller access is subordinate to core access – RAM striping – Peripheral bus segmentation ■ Data sizes of 8, 16, and 32 bits ■ Transfer size is programmable in binary steps from 1 to 1024 ■ Source and destination address increment size of byte, half-word, word, or no increment ■ Maskable peripheral requests January 22, 2012 339 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) ■ Interrupt on transfer completion, with a separate interrupt per channel 8.1 Block Diagram Figure 8-1. μDMA Block Diagram uDMA Controller DMA error System Memory CH Control Table Peripheral DMA Channel 0 • • • Peripheral DMA Channel N-1 Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) IRQ General Peripheral N Registers request done request done request done DMASTAT DMACFG DMACTLBASE DMAALTBASE DMAWAITSTAT DMASWREQ DMAUSEBURSTSET DMAUSEBURSTCLR DMAREQMASKSET DMAREQMASKCLR DMAENASET DMAENACLR DMAALTSET DMAALTCLR DMAPRIOSET DMAPRIOCLR DMAERRCLR DMACHASGN DMACHIS DMASRCENDP DMADSTENDP DMACHCTRL • • • DMASRCENDP DMADSTENDP DMACHCTRL Transfer Buffers Used by µDMA ARM Cortex-M3 8.2 Functional Description The μDMA controller is a flexible and highly configurable DMA controller designed to work efficiently with the microcontroller's Cortex-M3 processor core. It supports multiple data sizes and address increment schemes, multiple levels of priority among DMA channels, and several transfer modes to allow for sophisticated programmed data transfers. The μDMA controller's usage of the bus is always subordinate to the processor core, so it never holds up a bus transaction by the processor. Because the μDMA controller is only using otherwise-idle bus cycles, the data transfer bandwidth it provides is essentially free, with no impact on the rest of the system. The bus architecture has been optimized to greatly enhance the ability of the processor core and the μDMA controller to efficiently share the on-chip bus, thus improving performance. The optimizations include RAM striping and peripheral bus segmentation, which in many cases allow both the processor core and the μDMA controller to access the bus and perform simultaneous data transfers. The μDMA controller can transfer data to and from the on-chip SRAM. However, because the Flash memory and ROM are located on a separate internal bus, it is not possible to transfer data from the Flash memory or ROM with the μDMA controller. Each peripheral function that is supported has a dedicated channel on the μDMA controller that can be configured independently. The μDMA controller implements a unique configuration method using channel control structures that are maintained in system memory by the processor. While simple transfer modes are supported, it is also possible to build up sophisticated "task" lists in memory that allow the μDMA controller to perform arbitrary-sized transfers to and from arbitrary locations as part of a single transfer request. The μDMA controller also supports the use of ping-pong buffering to accommodate constant streaming of data to or from a peripheral. 340 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Each channel also has a configurable arbitration size. The arbitration size is the number of items that are transferred in a burst before the μDMA controller rearbitrates for channel priority. Using the arbitration size, it is possible to control exactly how many items are transferred to or from a peripheral each time it makes a μDMA service request. 8.2.1 Channel Assignments μDMA channels 0-31 are assigned to peripherals according to the following table. The DMA Channel Assignment (DMACHASGN) register (see page 388) can be used to specify the primary or secondary assignment. If the primary function is not available on this microcontroller, the secondary function becomes the primary function. If the secondary function is not available, the primary function is the only option. Note: Channels noted in the table as "Available for software" may be assigned to peripherals in the future. However, they are currently available for software use. Channel 30 is dedicated for software use. Because of the way the μDMA controller interacts with peripherals, the μDMA channel for the peripheral must be enabled in order for the μDMA controller to be able to read and write the peripheral registers, even if a different μDMA channel is used to perform the μDMA transfer. To minimize confusion and chance of software errors, it is best practice to use a peripheral's μDMA channel for performing all μDMA transfers for that peripheral, even if it is processor-triggered and using AUTO mode, which could be considered a software transfer. Note that if the software channel is used, interrupts occur on the dedicated μDMA interrupt vector. If the peripheral channel is used, then the interrupt occurs on the interrupt vector for the peripheral. Table 8-1. μDMA Channel Assignments μDMA Channel Primary Assignment Secondary Assignment 0 Available for software UART2 Receive 1 Available for software UART2 Transmit 2 Available for software General-Purpose Timer 3A 3 Available for software General-Purpose Timer 3B 4 Available for software General-Purpose Timer 2A 5 Available for software General-Purpose Timer 2B 6 Available for software General-Purpose Timer 2A 7 Available for software General-Purpose Timer 2B 8 UART0 Receive UART1 Receive 9 UART0 Transmit UART1 Transmit 10 SSI0 Receive SSI1 Receive 11 SSI0 Transmit SSI1 Transmit 12 Available for software UART2 Receive 13 Available for software UART2 Transmit 14 ADC0 Sample Sequencer 0 General-Purpose Timer 2A 15 ADC0 Sample Sequencer 1 General-Purpose Timer 2B 16 ADC0 Sample Sequencer 2 Available for software 17 ADC0 Sample Sequencer 3 Available for software 18 General-Purpose Timer 0A General-Purpose Timer 1A 19 General-Purpose Timer 0B General-Purpose Timer 1B January 22, 2012 341 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Table 8-1. μDMA Channel Assignments (continued) μDMA Channel 8.2.2 Primary Assignment Secondary Assignment 20 General-Purpose Timer 1A EPI0 NBRFIFO 21 General-Purpose Timer 1B EPI0 WFIFO 22 UART1 Receive Available for software 23 UART1 Transmit Available for software 24 SSI1 Receive Available for software 25 SSI1 Transmit Available for software 26 Available for software Available for software 27 Available for software Available for software 28 Available for software Available for software 29 Available for software Available for software 30 Dedicated for software use 31 Reserved Priority The μDMA controller assigns priority to each channel based on the channel number and the priority level bit for the channel. Channel number 0 has the highest priority and as the channel number increases, the priority of a channel decreases. Each channel has a priority level bit to provide two levels of priority: default priority and high priority. If the priority level bit is set, then that channel has higher priority than all other channels at default priority. If multiple channels are set for high priority, then the channel number is used to determine relative priority among all the high priority channels. The priority bit for a channel can be set using the DMA Channel Priority Set (DMAPRIOSET) register and cleared with the DMA Channel Priority Clear (DMAPRIOCLR) register. 8.2.3 Arbitration Size When a μDMA channel requests a transfer, the μDMA controller arbitrates among all the channels making a request and services the μDMA channel with the highest priority. Once a transfer begins, it continues for a selectable number of transfers before rearbitrating among the requesting channels again. The arbitration size can be configured for each channel, ranging from 1 to 1024 item transfers. After the μDMA controller transfers the number of items specified by the arbitration size, it then checks among all the channels making a request and services the channel with the highest priority. If a lower priority μDMA channel uses a large arbitration size, the latency for higher priority channels is increased because the μDMA controller completes the lower priority burst before checking for higher priority requests. Therefore, lower priority channels should not use a large arbitration size for best response on high priority channels. The arbitration size can also be thought of as a burst size. It is the maximum number of items that are transferred at any one time in a burst. Here, the term arbitration refers to determination of μDMA channel priority, not arbitration for the bus. When the μDMA controller arbitrates for the bus, the processor always takes priority. Furthermore, the μDMA controller is held off whenever the processor must perform a bus transaction on the same bus, even in the middle of a burst transfer. 8.2.4 Request Types The μDMA controller responds to two types of requests from a peripheral: single or burst. Each peripheral may support either or both types of requests. A single request means that the peripheral 342 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller is ready to transfer one item, while a burst request means that the peripheral is ready to transfer multiple items. The μDMA controller responds differently depending on whether the peripheral is making a single request or a burst request. If both are asserted, and the μDMA channel has been set up for a burst transfer, then the burst request takes precedence. See Table 8-2 on page 343, which shows how each peripheral supports the two request types. Table 8-2. Request Type Support 8.2.4.1 Peripheral Single Request Signal Burst Request Signal ADC None Sequencer IE bit EPI WFIFO None WFIFO Level (configurable) EPI NBRFIFO None NBRFIFO Level (configurable) General-Purpose Timer Raw interrupt pulse None SSI TX TX FIFO Not Full TX FIFO Level (fixed at 4) SSI RX RX FIFO Not Empty RX FIFO Level (fixed at 4) UART TX TX FIFO Not Full TX FIFO Level (configurable) UART RX RX FIFO Not Empty RX FIFO Level (configurable) Single Request When a single request is detected, and not a burst request, the μDMA controller transfers one item and then stops to wait for another request. 8.2.4.2 Burst Request When a burst request is detected, the μDMA controller transfers the number of items that is the lesser of the arbitration size or the number of items remaining in the transfer. Therefore, the arbitration size should be the same as the number of data items that the peripheral can accommodate when making a burst request. For example, the UART generates a burst request based on the FIFO trigger level. In this case, the arbitration size should be set to the amount of data that the FIFO can transfer when the trigger level is reached. A burst transfer runs to completion once it is started, and cannot be interrupted, even by a higher priority channel. Burst transfers complete in a shorter time than the same number of non-burst transfers. It may be desirable to use only burst transfers and not allow single transfers. For example, perhaps the nature of the data is such that it only makes sense when transferred together as a single unit rather than one piece at a time. The single request can be disabled by using the DMA Channel Useburst Set (DMAUSEBURSTSET) register. By setting the bit for a channel in this register, the μDMA controller only responds to burst requests for that channel. 8.2.5 Channel Configuration The μDMA controller uses an area of system memory to store a set of channel control structures in a table. The control table may have one or two entries for each μDMA channel. Each entry in the table structure contains source and destination pointers, transfer size, and transfer mode. The control table can be located anywhere in system memory, but it must be contiguous and aligned on a 1024-byte boundary. Table 8-3 on page 344 shows the layout in memory of the channel control table. Each channel may have one or two control structures in the control table: a primary control structure and an optional alternate control structure. The table is organized so that all of the primary entries are in the first half of the table, and all the alternate structures are in the second half of the table. The primary entry January 22, 2012 343 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) is used for simple transfer modes where transfers can be reconfigured and restarted after each transfer is complete. In this case, the alternate control structures are not used and therefore only the first half of the table must be allocated in memory; the second half of the control table is not necessary, and that memory can be used for something else. If a more complex transfer mode is used such as ping-pong or scatter-gather, then the alternate control structure is also used and memory space should be allocated for the entire table. Any unused memory in the control table may be used by the application. This includes the control structures for any channels that are unused by the application as well as the unused control word for each channel. Table 8-3. Control Structure Memory Map Offset Channel 0x0 0, Primary 0x10 1, Primary ... ... 0x1F0 31, Primary 0x200 0, Alternate 0x210 1, Alternate ... 0x3F0 ... 31, Alternate Table 8-4 shows an individual control structure entry in the control table. Each entry is aligned on a 16-byte boundary. The entry contains four long words: the source end pointer, the destination end pointer, the control word, and an unused entry. The end pointers point to the ending address of the transfer and are inclusive. If the source or destination is non-incrementing (as for a peripheral register), then the pointer should point to the transfer address. Table 8-4. Channel Control Structure Offset Description 0x000 Source End Pointer 0x004 Destination End Pointer 0x008 Control Word 0x00C Unused The control word contains the following fields: ■ Source and destination data sizes ■ Source and destination address increment size ■ Number of transfers before bus arbitration ■ Total number of items to transfer ■ Useburst flag ■ Transfer mode The control word and each field are described in detail in “μDMA Channel Control Structure” on page 362. The μDMA controller updates the transfer size and transfer mode fields as 344 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller the transfer is performed. At the end of a transfer, the transfer size indicates 0, and the transfer mode indicates "stopped." Because the control word is modified by the μDMA controller, it must be reconfigured before each new transfer. The source and destination end pointers are not modified, so they can be left unchanged if the source or destination addresses remain the same. Prior to starting a transfer, a μDMA channel must be enabled by setting the appropriate bit in the DMA Channel Enable Set (DMAENASET) register. A channel can be disabled by setting the channel bit in the DMA Channel Enable Clear (DMAENACLR) register. At the end of a complete μDMA transfer, the controller automatically disables the channel. 8.2.6 Transfer Modes The μDMA controller supports several transfer modes. Two of the modes support simple one-time transfers. Several complex modes support a continuous flow of data. 8.2.6.1 Stop Mode While Stop is not actually a transfer mode, it is a valid value for the mode field of the control word. When the mode field has this value, the μDMA controller does not perform any transfers and disables the channel if it is enabled. At the end of a transfer, the μDMA controller updates the control word to set the mode to Stop. 8.2.6.2 Basic Mode In Basic mode, the μDMA controller performs transfers as long as there are more items to transfer, and a transfer request is present. This mode is used with peripherals that assert a μDMA request signal whenever the peripheral is ready for a data transfer. Basic mode should not be used in any situation where the request is momentary even though the entire transfer should be completed. For example, a software-initiated transfer creates a momentary request, and in Basic mode, only the number of transfers specified by the ARBSIZE field in the DMA Channel Control Word (DMACHCTL) register is transferred on a software request, even if there is more data to transfer. When all of the items have been transferred using Basic mode, the μDMA controller sets the mode for that channel to Stop. 8.2.6.3 Auto Mode Auto mode is similar to Basic mode, except that once a transfer request is received, the transfer runs to completion, even if the μDMA request is removed. This mode is suitable for software-triggered transfers. Generally, Auto mode is not used with a peripheral. When all the items have been transferred using Auto mode, the μDMA controller sets the mode for that channel to Stop. 8.2.6.4 Ping-Pong Ping-Pong mode is used to support a continuous data flow to or from a peripheral. To use Ping-Pong mode, both the primary and alternate data structures must be implemented. Both structures are set up by the processor for data transfer between memory and a peripheral. The transfer is started using the primary control structure. When the transfer using the primary control structure is complete, the μDMA controller reads the alternate control structure for that channel to continue the transfer. Each time this happens, an interrupt is generated, and the processor can reload the control structure for the just-completed transfer. Data flow can continue indefinitely this way, using the primary and alternate control structures to switch back and forth between buffers as the data flows to or from the peripheral. Refer to Figure 8-2 on page 346 for an example showing operation in Ping-Pong mode. January 22, 2012 345 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Figure 8-2. Example of Ping-Pong μDMA Transaction µDMA Controller SOURCE DEST CONTROL Unused transfers using BUFFER A transfer continues using alternate Primary Structure Cortex-M3 Processor SOURCE DEST CONTROL Unused Pe rip he ral /µD M AI nte rru p t transfers using BUFFER B Time SOURCE DEST CONTROL Unused Pe Alternate Structure 8.2.6.5 SOURCE DEST CONTROL Unused rip he ral /µD M AI nte transfers using BUFFER A rru pt BUFFER A · Process data in BUFFER B · Reload alternate structure transfer continues using alternate Primary Structure BUFFER B · Process data in BUFFER A · Reload primary structure transfer continues using primary Alternate Structure BUFFER A Pe rip he ral /µD M AI nte transfers using BUFFER B rru pt BUFFER B · Process data in BUFFER B · Reload alternate structure Memory Scatter-Gather Memory Scatter-Gather mode is a complex mode used when data must be transferred to or from varied locations in memory instead of a set of contiguous locations in a memory buffer. For example, a gather μDMA operation could be used to selectively read the payload of several stored packets of a communication protocol and store them together in sequence in a memory buffer. 346 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller In Memory Scatter-Gather mode, the primary control structure is used to program the alternate control structure from a table in memory. The table is set up by the processor software and contains a list of control structures, each containing the source and destination end pointers, and the control word for a specific transfer. The mode of each control word must be set to Scatter-Gather mode. Each entry in the table is copied in turn to the alternate structure where it is then executed. The μDMA controller alternates between using the primary control structure to copy the next transfer instruction from the list and then executing the new transfer instruction. The end of the list is marked by programming the control word for the last entry to use Auto transfer mode. Once the last transfer is performed using Auto mode, the μDMA controller stops. A completion interrupt is generated only after the last transfer. It is possible to loop the list by having the last entry copy the primary control structure to point back to the beginning of the list (or to a new list). It is also possible to trigger a set of other channels to perform a transfer, either directly, by programming a write to the software trigger for another channel, or indirectly, by causing a peripheral action that results in a μDMA request. By programming the μDMA controller using this method, a set of arbitrary transfers can be performed based on a single μDMA request. Refer to Figure 8-3 on page 348 and Figure 8-4 on page 349, which show an example of operation in Memory Scatter-Gather mode. This example shows a gather operation, where data in three separate buffers in memory is copied together into one buffer. Figure 8-3 on page 348 shows how the application sets up a μDMA task list in memory that is used by the controller to perform three sets of copy operations from different locations in memory. The primary control structure for the channel that is used for the operation is configured to copy from the task list to the alternate control structure. Figure 8-4 on page 349 shows the sequence as the μDMA controller performs the three sets of copy operations. First, using the primary control structure, the μDMA controller loads the alternate control structure with task A. It then performs the copy operation specified by task A, copying the data from the source buffer A to the destination buffer. Next, the μDMA controller again uses the primary control structure to load task B into the alternate control structure, and then performs the B operation with the alternate control structure. The process is repeated for task C. January 22, 2012 347 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Figure 8-3. Memory Scatter-Gather, Setup and Configuration 1 2 3 Source and Destination Buffer in Memory Task List in Memory Channel Control Table in Memory 4 WORDS (SRC A) SRC A DST ITEMS=4 16 WORDS (SRC B) SRC Unused DST SRC ITEMS=12 DST B “TASK” A ITEMS=16 Channel Primary Control Structure “TASK” B Unused SRC DST ITEMS=1 “TASK” C Unused SRC DST Channel Alternate Control Structure ITEMS=n 1 WORD (SRC C) C 4 (DEST A) 16 (DEST B) 1 (DEST C) NOTES: 1. Application has a need to copy data items from three separate locations in memory into one combined buffer. 2. Application sets up µDMA “task list” in memory, which contains the pointers and control configuration for three µDMA copy “tasks.” 3. Application sets up the channel primary control structure to copy each task configuration, one at a time, to the alternate control structure, where it is executed by the µDMA controller. 4. The SRC and DST pointers in the task list must point to the last location in the corresponding buffer. 348 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 8-4. Memory Scatter-Gather, μDMA Copy Sequence Task List in Memory Buffers in Memory µDMA Control Table in Memory SRC A SRC SRC B PRI COPIED DST TASK A TASK B SRC SRC C ALT COPIED DST TASK C DEST A DEST B DEST C Then, using the channel’s alternate control structure, the µDMA controller copies data from the source buffer A to the destination buffer. Using the channel’s primary control structure, the µDMA controller copies task A configuration to the channel’s alternate control structure. Task List in Memory Buffers in Memory µDMA Control Table in Memory SRC A SRC B SRC PRI DST TASK A SRC TASK B TASK C SRC C COPIED ALT COPIED DST DEST A DEST B DEST C Then, using the channel’s alternate control structure, the µDMA controller copies data from the source buffer B to the destination buffer. Using the channel’s primary control structure, the µDMA controller copies task B configuration to the channel’s alternate control structure. Task List in Memory Buffers in Memory µDMA Control Table in Memory SRC A SRC SRC B PRI DST TASK A SRC TASK B TASK C SRC C ALT DST DEST A COPIED COPIED DEST B DEST C Using the channel’s primary control structure, the µDMA controller copies task C configuration to the channel’s alternate control structure. Then, using the channel’s alternate control structure, the µDMA controller copies data from the source buffer C to the destination buffer. January 22, 2012 349 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) 8.2.6.6 Peripheral Scatter-Gather Peripheral Scatter-Gather mode is very similar to Memory Scatter-Gather, except that the transfers are controlled by a peripheral making a μDMA request. Upon detecting a request from the peripheral, the μDMA controller uses the primary control structure to copy one entry from the list to the alternate control structure and then performs the transfer. At the end of this transfer, the next transfer is started only if the peripheral again asserts a μDMA request. The μDMA controller continues to perform transfers from the list only when the peripheral is making a request, until the last transfer is complete. A completion interrupt is generated only after the last transfer. By using this method, the μDMA controller can transfer data to or from a peripheral from a set of arbitrary locations whenever the peripheral is ready to transfer data. Refer to Figure 8-5 on page 351 and Figure 8-6 on page 352, which show an example of operation in Peripheral Scatter-Gather mode. This example shows a gather operation, where data from three separate buffers in memory is copied to a single peripheral data register. Figure 8-5 on page 351 shows how the application sets up a µDMA task list in memory that is used by the controller to perform three sets of copy operations from different locations in memory. The primary control structure for the channel that is used for the operation is configured to copy from the task list to the alternate control structure. Figure 8-6 on page 352 shows the sequence as the µDMA controller performs the three sets of copy operations. First, using the primary control structure, the µDMA controller loads the alternate control structure with task A. It then performs the copy operation specified by task A, copying the data from the source buffer A to the peripheral data register. Next, the µDMA controller again uses the primary control structure to load task B into the alternate control structure, and then performs the B operation with the alternate control structure. The process is repeated for task C. 350 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 8-5. Peripheral Scatter-Gather, Setup and Configuration 1 2 3 Source Buffer in Memory Task List in Memory Channel Control Table in Memory 4 WORDS (SRC A) SRC A DST ITEMS=4 16 WORDS (SRC B) SRC DST SRC ITEMS=12 DST B “TASK” A Unused ITEMS=16 Channel Primary Control Structure “TASK” B Unused SRC DST ITEMS=1 “TASK” C Unused SRC DST Channel Alternate Control Structure ITEMS=n 1 WORD (SRC C) C Peripheral Data Register DEST NOTES: 1. Application has a need to copy data items from three separate locations in memory into a peripheral data register. 2. Application sets up µDMA “task list” in memory, which contains the pointers and control configuration for three µDMA copy “tasks.” 3. Application sets up the channel primary control structure to copy each task configuration, one at a time, to the alternate control structure, where it is executed by the µDMA controller. January 22, 2012 351 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Figure 8-6. Peripheral Scatter-Gather, μDMA Copy Sequence Task List in Memory Buffers in Memory µDMA Control Table in Memory SRC A SRC SRC B PRI COPIED DST TASK A TASK B SRC SRC C ALT COPIED DST TASK C Then, using the channel’s alternate control structure, the µDMA controller copies data from the source buffer A to the peripheral data register. Using the channel’s primary control structure, the µDMA controller copies task A configuration to the channel’s alternate control structure. Task List in Memory Peripheral Data Register Buffers in Memory µDMA Control Table in Memory SRC A SRC SRC B PRI DST TASK A SRC TASK B TASK C SRC C COPIED ALT COPIED DST Then, using the channel’s alternate control structure, the µDMA controller copies data from the source buffer B to the peripheral data register. Using the channel’s primary control structure, the µDMA controller copies task B configuration to the channel’s alternate control structure. Task List in Memory Peripheral Data Register Buffers in Memory µDMA Control Table in Memory SRC A SRC SRC B PRI DST TASK A SRC TASK B TASK C SRC C ALT DST COPIED COPIED Peripheral Data Register Using the channel’s primary control structure, the µDMA controller copies task C configuration to the channel’s alternate control structure. Then, using the channel’s alternate control structure, the µDMA controller copies data from the source buffer C to the peripheral data register. 352 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 8.2.7 Transfer Size and Increment The μDMA controller supports transfer data sizes of 8, 16, or 32 bits. The source and destination data size must be the same for any given transfer. The source and destination address can be auto-incremented by bytes, half-words, or words, or can be set to no increment. The source and destination address increment values can be set independently, and it is not necessary for the address increment to match the data size as long as the increment is the same or larger than the data size. For example, it is possible to perform a transfer using 8-bit data size, but using an address increment of full words (4 bytes). The data to be transferred must be aligned in memory according to the data size (8, 16, or 32 bits). Table 8-5 shows the configuration to read from a peripheral that supplies 8-bit data. Table 8-5. μDMA Read Example: 8-Bit Peripheral 8.2.8 Field Configuration Source data size 8 bits Destination data size 8 bits Source address increment No increment Destination address increment Byte Source end pointer Peripheral read FIFO register Destination end pointer End of the data buffer in memory Peripheral Interface Each peripheral that supports μDMA has a single request and/or burst request signal that is asserted when the peripheral is ready to transfer data (see Table 8-2 on page 343). The request signal can be disabled or enabled using the DMA Channel Request Mask Set (DMAREQMASKSET) and DMA Channel Request Mask Clear (DMAREQMASKCLR) registers. The μDMA request signal is disabled, or masked, when the channel request mask bit is set. When the request is not masked, the μDMA channel is configured correctly and enabled, and the peripheral asserts the request signal, the μDMA controller begins the transfer. Note: When using μDMA to transfer data to and from a peripheral, the peripheral must disable all interrupts to the NVIC. When a μDMA transfer is complete, the μDMA controller generates an interrupt, see “Interrupts and Errors” on page 354 for more information. For more information on how a specific peripheral interacts with the μDMA controller, refer to the DMA Operation section in the chapter that discusses that peripheral. 8.2.9 Software Request One μDMA channel is dedicated to software-initiated transfers. This channel also has a dedicated interrupt to signal completion of a μDMA transfer. A transfer is initiated by software by first configuring and enabling the transfer, and then issuing a software request using the DMA Channel Software Request (DMASWREQ) register. For software-based transfers, the Auto transfer mode should be used. It is possible to initiate a transfer on any channel using the DMASWREQ register. If a request is initiated by software using a peripheral μDMA channel, then the completion interrupt occurs on the interrupt vector for the peripheral instead of the software interrupt vector. Any channel may be used for software requests as long as the corresponding peripheral is not using μDMA for data transfer. January 22, 2012 353 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) 8.2.10 Interrupts and Errors When a μDMA transfer is complete, the μDMA controller generates a completion interrupt on the interrupt vector of the peripheral. Therefore, if μDMA is used to transfer data for a peripheral and interrupts are used, then the interrupt handler for that peripheral must be designed to handle the μDMA transfer completion interrupt. If the transfer uses the software μDMA channel, then the completion interrupt occurs on the dedicated software μDMA interrupt vector (see Table 8-6 on page 354). When μDMA is enabled for a peripheral, the μDMA controller stops the normal transfer interrupts for a peripheral from reaching the interrupt controller (the interrupts are still reported in the peripheral's interrupt registers). Thus, when a large amount of data is transferred using μDMA, instead of receiving multiple interrupts from the peripheral as data flows, the interrupt controller receives only one interrupt when the transfer is complete. Unmasked peripheral error interrupts continue to be sent to the interrupt controller. When a μDMA channel generates a completion interrupt, the CHIS bit corresponding to the peripheral channel is set in the DMA Channel Interrupt Status (DMACHIS) register (see page 389). This register can be used by the peripheral interrupt handler code to determine if the interrupt was caused by the μDMA channel or an error event reported by the peripheral's interrupt registers. The completion interrupt request from the μDMA controller is automatically cleared when the interrupt handler is activated. If the μDMA controller encounters a bus or memory protection error as it attempts to perform a data transfer, it disables the μDMA channel that caused the error and generates an interrupt on the μDMA error interrupt vector. The processor can read the DMA Bus Error Clear (DMAERRCLR) register to determine if an error is pending. The ERRCLR bit is set if an error occurred. The error can be cleared by writing a 1 to the ERRCLR bit. Table 8-6 shows the dedicated interrupt assignments for the μDMA controller. Table 8-6. μDMA Interrupt Assignments Interrupt Assignment 46 μDMA Software Channel Transfer 47 μDMA Error 8.3 Initialization and Configuration 8.3.1 Module Initialization Before the μDMA controller can be used, it must be enabled in the System Control block and in the peripheral. The location of the channel control structure must also be programmed. The following steps should be performed one time during system initialization: 1. The μDMA peripheral must be enabled in the System Control block. To do this, set the UDMA bit of the System Control RCGC2 register (see page 254). 2. Enable the μDMA controller by setting the MASTEREN bit of the DMA Configuration (DMACFG) register. 3. Program the location of the channel control table by writing the base address of the table to the DMA Channel Control Base Pointer (DMACTLBASE) register. The base address must be aligned on a 1024-byte boundary. 354 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 8.3.2 Configuring a Memory-to-Memory Transfer μDMA channel 30 is dedicated for software-initiated transfers. However, any channel can be used for software-initiated, memory-to-memory transfer if the associated peripheral is not being used. 8.3.2.1 Configure the Channel Attributes First, configure the channel attributes: 1. Program bit 30 of the DMA Channel Priority Set (DMAPRIOSET) or DMA Channel Priority Clear (DMAPRIOCLR) registers to set the channel to High priority or Default priority. 2. Set bit 30 of the DMA Channel Primary Alternate Clear (DMAALTCLR) register to select the primary channel control structure for this transfer. 3. Set bit 30 of the DMA Channel Useburst Clear (DMAUSEBURSTCLR) register to allow the μDMA controller to respond to single and burst requests. 4. Set bit 30 of the DMA Channel Request Mask Clear (DMAREQMASKCLR) register to allow the μDMA controller to recognize requests for this channel. 8.3.2.2 Configure the Channel Control Structure Now the channel control structure must be configured. This example transfers 256 words from one memory buffer to another. Channel 30 is used for a software transfer, and the control structure for channel 30 is at offset 0x1E0 of the channel control table. The channel control structure for channel 30 is located at the offsets shown in Table 8-7. Table 8-7. Channel Control Structure Offsets for Channel 30 Offset Description Control Table Base + 0x1E0 Channel 30 Source End Pointer Control Table Base + 0x1E4 Channel 30 Destination End Pointer Control Table Base + 0x1E8 Channel 30 Control Word Configure the Source and Destination The source and destination end pointers must be set to the last address for the transfer (inclusive). 1. Program the source end pointer at offset 0x1E0 to the address of the source buffer + 0x3FC. 2. Program the destination end pointer at offset 0x1E4 to the address of the destination buffer + 0x3FC. The control word at offset 0x1E8 must be programmed according to Table 8-8. Table 8-8. Channel Control Word Configuration for Memory Transfer Example Field in DMACHCTL Bits Value DSTINC 31:30 2 32-bit destination address increment DSTSIZE 29:28 2 32-bit destination data size SRCINC 27:26 2 32-bit source address increment SRCSIZE 25:24 2 32-bit source data size reserved 23:18 0 Reserved January 22, 2012 Description 355 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Table 8-8. Channel Control Word Configuration for Memory Transfer Example (continued) Field in DMACHCTL Bits Description ARBSIZE 17:14 3 XFERSIZE 13:4 255 3 0 N/A for this transfer type 2:0 2 Use Auto-request transfer mode NXTUSEBURST XFERMODE 8.3.2.3 Value Arbitrates after 8 transfers Transfer 256 items Start the Transfer Now the channel is configured and is ready to start. 1. Enable the channel by setting bit 30 of the DMA Channel Enable Set (DMAENASET) register. 2. Issue a transfer request by setting bit 30 of the DMA Channel Software Request (DMASWREQ) register. The μDMA transfer begins. If the interrupt is enabled, then the processor is notified by interrupt when the transfer is complete. If needed, the status can be checked by reading bit 30 of the DMAENASET register. This bit is automatically cleared when the transfer is complete. The status can also be checked by reading the XFERMODE field of the channel control word at offset 0x1E8. This field is automatically cleared at the end of the transfer. 8.3.3 Configuring a Peripheral for Simple Transmit This example configures the μDMA controller to transmit a buffer of data to a peripheral. The peripheral has a transmit FIFO with a trigger level of 4. The example peripheral uses μDMA channel 7. 8.3.3.1 Configure the Channel Attributes First, configure the channel attributes: 1. Configure bit 7 of the DMA Channel Priority Set (DMAPRIOSET) or DMA Channel Priority Clear (DMAPRIOCLR) registers to set the channel to High priority or Default priority. 2. Set bit 7 of the DMA Channel Primary Alternate Clear (DMAALTCLR) register to select the primary channel control structure for this transfer. 3. Set bit 7 of the DMA Channel Useburst Clear (DMAUSEBURSTCLR) register to allow the μDMA controller to respond to single and burst requests. 4. Set bit 7 of the DMA Channel Request Mask Clear (DMAREQMASKCLR) register to allow the μDMA controller to recognize requests for this channel. 8.3.3.2 Configure the Channel Control Structure This example transfers 64 bytes from a memory buffer to the peripheral's transmit FIFO register using μDMA channel 7. The control structure for channel 7 is at offset 0x070 of the channel control table. The channel control structure for channel 7 is located at the offsets shown in Table 8-9. Table 8-9. Channel Control Structure Offsets for Channel 7 Offset Description Control Table Base + 0x070 Channel 7 Source End Pointer 356 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 8-9. Channel Control Structure Offsets for Channel 7 (continued) Offset Description Control Table Base + 0x074 Channel 7 Destination End Pointer Control Table Base + 0x078 Channel 7 Control Word Configure the Source and Destination The source and destination end pointers must be set to the last address for the transfer (inclusive). Because the peripheral pointer does not change, it simply points to the peripheral's data register. 1. Program the source end pointer at offset 0x070 to the address of the source buffer + 0x3F. 2. Program the destination end pointer at offset 0x074 to the address of the peripheral's transmit FIFO register. The control word at offset 0x078 must be programmed according to Table 8-10. Table 8-10. Channel Control Word Configuration for Peripheral Transmit Example Field in DMACHCTL Bits Value DSTINC 31:30 3 Destination address does not increment DSTSIZE 29:28 0 8-bit destination data size SRCINC 27:26 0 8-bit source address increment SRCSIZE 25:24 0 8-bit source data size reserved 23:18 0 Reserved ARBSIZE 17:14 2 Arbitrates after 4 transfers XFERSIZE 13:4 63 Transfer 64 items 3 0 N/A for this transfer type 2:0 1 Use Basic transfer mode NXTUSEBURST XFERMODE Note: 8.3.3.3 Description In this example, it is not important if the peripheral makes a single request or a burst request. Because the peripheral has a FIFO that triggers at a level of 4, the arbitration size is set to 4. If the peripheral does make a burst request, then 4 bytes are transferred, which is what the FIFO can accommodate. If the peripheral makes a single request (if there is any space in the FIFO), then one byte is transferred at a time. If it is important to the application that transfers only be made in bursts, then the Channel Useburst SET[7] bit should be set in the DMA Channel Useburst Set (DMAUSEBURSTSET) register. Start the Transfer Now the channel is configured and is ready to start. 1. Enable the channel by setting bit 7 of the DMA Channel Enable Set (DMAENASET) register. The μDMA controller is now configured for transfer on channel 7. The controller makes transfers to the peripheral whenever the peripheral asserts a μDMA request. The transfers continue until the entire buffer of 64 bytes has been transferred. When that happens, the μDMA controller disables the channel and sets the XFERMODE field of the channel control word to 0 (Stopped). The status of the transfer can be checked by reading bit 7 of the DMA Channel Enable Set (DMAENASET) register. This bit is automatically cleared when the transfer is complete. The status can also be checked by reading the XFERMODE field of the channel control word at offset 0x078. This field is automatically cleared at the end of the transfer. January 22, 2012 357 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) If peripheral interrupts are enabled, then the peripheral interrupt handler receives an interrupt when the entire transfer is complete. 8.3.4 Configuring a Peripheral for Ping-Pong Receive This example configures the μDMA controller to continuously receive 8-bit data from a peripheral into a pair of 64-byte buffers. The peripheral has a receive FIFO with a trigger level of 8. The example peripheral uses μDMA channel 8. 8.3.4.1 Configure the Channel Attributes First, configure the channel attributes: 1. Configure bit 8 of the DMA Channel Priority Set (DMAPRIOSET) or DMA Channel Priority Clear (DMAPRIOCLR) registers to set the channel to High priority or Default priority. 2. Set bit 8 of the DMA Channel Primary Alternate Clear (DMAALTCLR) register to select the primary channel control structure for this transfer. 3. Set bit 8 of the DMA Channel Useburst Clear (DMAUSEBURSTCLR) register to allow the μDMA controller to respond to single and burst requests. 4. Set bit 8 of the DMA Channel Request Mask Clear (DMAREQMASKCLR) register to allow the μDMA controller to recognize requests for this channel. 8.3.4.2 Configure the Channel Control Structure This example transfers bytes from the peripheral's receive FIFO register into two memory buffers of 64 bytes each. As data is received, when one buffer is full, the μDMA controller switches to use the other. To use Ping-Pong buffering, both primary and alternate channel control structures must be used. The primary control structure for channel 8 is at offset 0x080 of the channel control table, and the alternate channel control structure is at offset 0x280. The channel control structures for channel 8 are located at the offsets shown in Table 8-11. Table 8-11. Primary and Alternate Channel Control Structure Offsets for Channel 8 Offset Description Control Table Base + 0x080 Channel 8 Primary Source End Pointer Control Table Base + 0x084 Channel 8 Primary Destination End Pointer Control Table Base + 0x088 Channel 8 Primary Control Word Control Table Base + 0x280 Channel 8 Alternate Source End Pointer Control Table Base + 0x284 Channel 8 Alternate Destination End Pointer Control Table Base + 0x288 Channel 8 Alternate Control Word Configure the Source and Destination The source and destination end pointers must be set to the last address for the transfer (inclusive). Because the peripheral pointer does not change, it simply points to the peripheral's data register. Both the primary and alternate sets of pointers must be configured. 1. Program the primary source end pointer at offset 0x080 to the address of the peripheral's receive buffer. 358 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 2. Program the primary destination end pointer at offset 0x084 to the address of ping-pong buffer A + 0x3F. 3. Program the alternate source end pointer at offset 0x280 to the address of the peripheral's receive buffer. 4. Program the alternate destination end pointer at offset 0x284 to the address of ping-pong buffer B + 0x3F. The primary control word at offset 0x088 and the alternate control word at offset 0x288 are initially programmed the same way. 1. Program the primary channel control word at offset 0x088 according to Table 8-12. 2. Program the alternate channel control word at offset 0x288 according to Table 8-12. Table 8-12. Channel Control Word Configuration for Peripheral Ping-Pong Receive Example Field in DMACHCTL Bits Value DSTINC 31:30 0 8-bit destination address increment DSTSIZE 29:28 0 8-bit destination data size SRCINC 27:26 3 Source address does not increment SRCSIZE 25:24 0 8-bit source data size reserved 23:18 0 Reserved ARBSIZE 17:14 3 Arbitrates after 8 transfers XFERSIZE 13:4 63 Transfer 64 items 3 0 N/A for this transfer type 2:0 3 Use Ping-Pong transfer mode NXTUSEBURST XFERMODE Note: 8.3.4.3 Description In this example, it is not important if the peripheral makes a single request or a burst request. Because the peripheral has a FIFO that triggers at a level of 8, the arbitration size is set to 8. If the peripheral does make a burst request, then 8 bytes are transferred, which is what the FIFO can accommodate. If the peripheral makes a single request (if there is any data in the FIFO), then one byte is transferred at a time. If it is important to the application that transfers only be made in bursts, then the Channel Useburst SET[8] bit should be set in the DMA Channel Useburst Set (DMAUSEBURSTSET) register. Configure the Peripheral Interrupt An interrupt handler should be configured when using μDMA Ping-Pong mode, it is best to use an interrupt handler. However, the Ping-Pong mode can be configured without interrupts by polling. The interrupt handler is triggered after each buffer is complete. 1. Configure and enable an interrupt handler for the peripheral. 8.3.4.4 Enable the μDMA Channel Now the channel is configured and is ready to start. 1. Enable the channel by setting bit 8 of the DMA Channel Enable Set (DMAENASET) register. January 22, 2012 359 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) 8.3.4.5 Process Interrupts The μDMA controller is now configured and enabled for transfer on channel 8. When the peripheral asserts the μDMA request signal, the μDMA controller makes transfers into buffer A using the primary channel control structure. When the primary transfer to buffer A is complete, it switches to the alternate channel control structure and makes transfers into buffer B. At the same time, the primary channel control word mode field is configured to indicate Stopped, and an interrupt is When an interrupt is triggered, the interrupt handler must determine which buffer is complete and process the data or set a flag that the data must be processed by non-interrupt buffer processing code. Then the next buffer transfer must be set up. In the interrupt handler: 1. Read the primary channel control word at offset 0x088 and check the XFERMODE field. If the field is 0, this means buffer A is complete. If buffer A is complete, then: a. Process the newly received data in buffer A or signal the buffer processing code that buffer A has data available. b. Reprogram the primary channel control word at offset 0x88 according to Table 8-12 on page 359. 2. Read the alternate channel control word at offset 0x288 and check the XFERMODE field. If the field is 0, this means buffer B is complete. If buffer B is complete, then: a. Process the newly received data in buffer B or signal the buffer processing code that buffer B has data available. b. Reprogram the alternate channel control word at offset 0x288 according to Table 8-12 on page 359. 8.3.5 Configuring Channel Assignments Channel assignments for each μDMA channel can be changed using the DMACHASGN register. Each bit represents a μDMA channel. If the bit is set, then the secondary function is used for the channel. Refer to Table 8-1 on page 341 for channel assignments. For example, to use SSI1 Receive on channel 8 instead of UART0, set bit 8 of the DMACHASGN register. 8.4 Register Map Table 8-13 on page 361 lists the μDMA channel control structures and registers. The channel control structure shows the layout of one entry in the channel control table. The channel control table is located in system memory, and the location is determined by the application, that is, the base address is n/a (not applicable). In the table below, the offset for the channel control structures is the offset from the entry in the channel control table. See “Channel Configuration” on page 343 and Table 8-3 on page 344 for a description of how the entries in the channel control table are located in memory. The μDMA register addresses are given as a hexadecimal increment, relative to the μDMA base address of 0x400F.F000. Note that the μDMA module clock must be enabled before the registers can be programmed (see page 254). There must be a delay of 3 system clocks after the μDMA module clock is enabled before any μDMA module registers are accessed. 360 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 8-13. μDMA Register Map Offset Name Type Reset Description See page μDMA Channel Control Structure (Offset from Channel Control Table Base) 0x000 DMASRCENDP R/W - DMA Channel Source Address End Pointer 363 0x004 DMADSTENDP R/W - DMA Channel Destination Address End Pointer 364 0x008 DMACHCTL R/W - DMA Channel Control Word 365 DMA Status 370 DMA Configuration 372 μDMA Registers (Offset from μDMA Base Address) 0x000 DMASTAT RO 0x001F.0000 0x004 DMACFG WO - 0x008 DMACTLBASE R/W 0x0000.0000 DMA Channel Control Base Pointer 373 0x00C DMAALTBASE RO 0x0000.0200 DMA Alternate Channel Control Base Pointer 374 0x010 DMAWAITSTAT RO 0xFFFF.FFC0 DMA Channel Wait-on-Request Status 375 0x014 DMASWREQ WO - DMA Channel Software Request 376 0x018 DMAUSEBURSTSET R/W 0x0000.0000 DMA Channel Useburst Set 377 0x01C DMAUSEBURSTCLR WO - DMA Channel Useburst Clear 378 0x020 DMAREQMASKSET R/W 0x0000.0000 DMA Channel Request Mask Set 379 0x024 DMAREQMASKCLR WO - DMA Channel Request Mask Clear 380 0x028 DMAENASET R/W 0x0000.0000 DMA Channel Enable Set 381 0x02C DMAENACLR WO - DMA Channel Enable Clear 382 0x030 DMAALTSET R/W 0x0000.0000 DMA Channel Primary Alternate Set 383 0x034 DMAALTCLR WO - DMA Channel Primary Alternate Clear 384 0x038 DMAPRIOSET R/W 0x0000.0000 DMA Channel Priority Set 385 0x03C DMAPRIOCLR WO - DMA Channel Priority Clear 386 0x04C DMAERRCLR R/W 0x0000.0000 DMA Bus Error Clear 387 0x500 DMACHASGN R/W 0x0000.0000 DMA Channel Assignment 388 0x504 DMACHIS R/W1C 0x0000.0000 DMA Channel Interrupt Status 389 0xFD0 DMAPeriphID4 RO 0x0000.0004 DMA Peripheral Identification 4 394 0xFE0 DMAPeriphID0 RO 0x0000.0030 DMA Peripheral Identification 0 390 0xFE4 DMAPeriphID1 RO 0x0000.00B2 DMA Peripheral Identification 1 391 0xFE8 DMAPeriphID2 RO 0x0000.000B DMA Peripheral Identification 2 392 0xFEC DMAPeriphID3 RO 0x0000.0000 DMA Peripheral Identification 3 393 0xFF0 DMAPCellID0 RO 0x0000.000D DMA PrimeCell Identification 0 395 0xFF4 DMAPCellID1 RO 0x0000.00F0 DMA PrimeCell Identification 1 396 0xFF8 DMAPCellID2 RO 0x0000.0005 DMA PrimeCell Identification 2 397 January 22, 2012 361 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Table 8-13. μDMA Register Map (continued) Offset Name 0xFFC DMAPCellID3 8.5 Type Reset RO 0x0000.00B1 Description DMA PrimeCell Identification 3 See page 398 μDMA Channel Control Structure The μDMA Channel Control Structure holds the transfer settings for a μDMA channel. Each channel has two control structures, which are located in a table in system memory. Refer to “Channel Configuration” on page 343 for an explanation of the Channel Control Table and the Channel Control Structure. The channel control structure is one entry in the channel control table. Each channel has a primary and alternate structure. The primary control structures are located at offsets 0x0, 0x10, 0x20 and so on. The alternate control structures are located at offsets 0x200, 0x210, 0x220, and so on. 362 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 1: DMA Channel Source Address End Pointer (DMASRCENDP), offset 0x000 DMA Channel Source Address End Pointer (DMASRCENDP) is part of the Channel Control Structure and is used to specify the source address for a μDMA transfer. The μDMA controller can transfer data to and from the on-chip SRAM. However, because the Flash memory and ROM are located on a separate internal bus, it is not possible to transfer data from the Flash memory or ROM with the μDMA controller. Note: The offset specified is from the base address of the control structure in system memory, not the μDMA module base address. DMA Channel Source Address End Pointer (DMASRCENDP) Base n/a Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - ADDR Type Reset R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ADDR Type Reset R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 ADDR R/W - R/W - Description Source Address End Pointer This field points to the last address of the μDMA transfer source (inclusive). If the source address is not incrementing (the SRCINC field in the DMACHCTL register is 0x3), then this field points at the source location itself (such as a peripheral data register). January 22, 2012 363 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 2: DMA Channel Destination Address End Pointer (DMADSTENDP), offset 0x004 DMA Channel Destination Address End Pointer (DMADSTENDP) is part of the Channel Control Structure and is used to specify the destination address for a μDMA transfer. Note: The offset specified is from the base address of the control structure in system memory, not the μDMA module base address. DMA Channel Destination Address End Pointer (DMADSTENDP) Base n/a Offset 0x004 Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - ADDR Type Reset ADDR Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 ADDR R/W - Description Destination Address End Pointer This field points to the last address of the μDMA transfer destination (inclusive). If the destination address is not incrementing (the DSTINC field in the DMACHCTL register is 0x3), then this field points at the destination location itself (such as a peripheral data register). 364 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 3: DMA Channel Control Word (DMACHCTL), offset 0x008 DMA Channel Control Word (DMACHCTL) is part of the Channel Control Structure and is used to specify parameters of a μDMA transfer. Note: The offset specified is from the base address of the control structure in system memory, not the μDMA module base address. DMA Channel Control Word (DMACHCTL) Base n/a Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 31 30 DSTINC Type Reset 29 28 27 DSTSIZE 26 24 23 22 21 SRCSIZE 20 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 R/W - XFERSIZE R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:30 DSTINC R/W - 18 17 R/W - R/W - 3 2 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 1 0 XFERMODE NXTUSEBURST R/W - 16 ARBSIZE R/W - R/W - 19 reserved R/W - ARBSIZE Type Reset 25 SRCINC R/W - R/W - R/W - Description Destination Address Increment This field configures the destination address increment. The address increment value must be equal or greater than the value of the destination size (DSTSIZE). Value Description 0x0 Byte Increment by 8-bit locations 0x1 Half-word Increment by 16-bit locations 0x2 Word Increment by 32-bit locations 0x3 No increment Address remains set to the value of the Destination Address End Pointer (DMADSTENDP) for the channel 29:28 DSTSIZE R/W - Destination Data Size This field configures the destination item data size. Note: DSTSIZE must be the same as SRCSIZE. Value Description 0x0 Byte 8-bit data size 0x1 Half-word 16-bit data size 0x2 Word 32-bit data size 0x3 Reserved January 22, 2012 365 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Bit/Field Name Type Reset 27:26 SRCINC R/W - Description Source Address Increment This field configures the source address increment. The address increment value must be equal or greater than the value of the source size (SRCSIZE). Value Description 0x0 Byte Increment by 8-bit locations 0x1 Half-word Increment by 16-bit locations 0x2 Word Increment by 32-bit locations 0x3 No increment Address remains set to the value of the Source Address End Pointer (DMASRCENDP) for the channel 25:24 SRCSIZE R/W - Source Data Size This field configures the source item data size. Note: DSTSIZE must be the same as SRCSIZE. Value Description 0x0 Byte 8-bit data size. 0x1 Half-word 16-bit data size. 0x2 Word 32-bit data size. 0x3 23:18 reserved R/W - Reserved Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 366 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 17:14 ARBSIZE R/W - Description Arbitration Size This field configures the number of transfers that can occur before the μDMA controller re-arbitrates. The possible arbitration rate configurations represent powers of 2 and are shown below. Value Description 0x0 1 Transfer Arbitrates after each μDMA transfer 0x1 2 Transfers 0x2 4 Transfers 0x3 8 Transfers 0x4 16 Transfers 0x5 32 Transfers 0x6 64 Transfers 0x7 128 Transfers 0x8 256 Transfers 0x9 512 Transfers 0xA-0xF 1024 Transfers In this configuration, no arbitration occurs during the μDMA transfer because the maximum transfer size is 1024. 13:4 XFERSIZE R/W - Transfer Size (minus 1) This field configures the total number of items to transfer. The value of this field is 1 less than the number to transfer (value 0 means transfer 1 item). The maximum value for this 10-bit field is 1023 which represents a transfer size of 1024 items. The transfer size is the number of items, not the number of bytes. If the data size is 32 bits, then this value is the number of 32-bit words to transfer. The μDMA controller updates this field immediately prior to entering the arbitration process, so it contains the number of outstanding items that is necessary to complete the μDMA cycle. 3 NXTUSEBURST R/W - Next Useburst This field controls whether the Useburst SET[n] bit is automatically set for the last transfer of a peripheral scatter-gather operation. Normally, for the last transfer, if the number of remaining items to transfer is less than the arbitration size, the μDMA controller uses single transfers to complete the transaction. If this bit is set, then the controller uses a burst transfer to complete the last transfer. January 22, 2012 367 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Bit/Field Name Type Reset 2:0 XFERMODE R/W - Description μDMA Transfer Mode This field configures the operating mode of the μDMA cycle. Refer to “Transfer Modes” on page 345 for a detailed explanation of transfer modes. Because this register is in system RAM, it has no reset value. Therefore, this field should be initialized to 0 before the channel is enabled. Value Description 0x0 Stop 0x1 Basic 0x2 Auto-Request 0x3 Ping-Pong 0x4 Memory Scatter-Gather 0x5 Alternate Memory Scatter-Gather 0x6 Peripheral Scatter-Gather 0x7 Alternate Peripheral Scatter-Gather XFERMODE Bit Field Values. Stop Channel is stopped or configuration data is invalid. No more transfers can occur. Basic For each trigger (whether from a peripheral or a software request), the μDMA controller performs the number of transfers specified by the ARBSIZE field. Auto-Request The initial request (software- or peripheral-initiated) is sufficient to complete the entire transfer of XFERSIZE items without any further requests. Ping-Pong This mode uses both the primary and alternate control structures for this channel. When the number of transfers specified by the XFERSIZE field have completed for the current control structure (primary or alternate), the µDMA controller switches to the other one. These switches continue until one of the control structures is not set to ping-pong mode. At that point, the µDMA controller stops. An interrupt is generated on completion of the transfers configured by each control structure. See “Ping-Pong” on page 345. Memory Scatter-Gather When using this mode, the primary control structure for the channel is configured to allow a list of operations (tasks) to be performed. The source address pointer specifies the start of a table of tasks to be copied to the alternate control structure for this channel. The XFERMODE field for the alternate control structure should be configured to 0x5 (Alternate memory scatter-gather) to perform the task. When the task completes, the µDMA switches back to the primary channel control structure, which then copies the next task to the alternate control structure. This process continues until the table of tasks is empty. The last task must have an XFERMODE value other than 0x5. Note that for continuous operation, the last task can update the primary channel control structure back to the start of the list or to another list. See “Memory Scatter-Gather” on page 346. 368 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Alternate Memory Scatter-Gather This value must be used in the alternate channel control data structure when the μDMA controller operates in Memory Scatter-Gather mode. Peripheral Scatter-Gather This value must be used in the primary channel control data structure when the μDMA controller operates in Peripheral Scatter-Gather mode. In this mode, the μDMA controller operates exactly the same as in Memory Scatter-Gather mode, except that instead of performing the number of transfers specified by the XFERSIZE field in the alternate control structure at one time, the μDMA controller only performs the number of transfers specified by the ARBSIZE field per trigger; see Basic mode for details. See “Peripheral Scatter-Gather” on page 350. Alternate Peripheral Scatter-Gather This value must be used in the alternate channel control data structure when the μDMA controller operates in Peripheral Scatter-Gather mode. 8.6 μDMA Register Descriptions The register addresses given are relative to the μDMA base address of 0x400F.F000. January 22, 2012 369 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 4: DMA Status (DMASTAT), offset 0x000 The DMA Status (DMASTAT) register returns the status of the μDMA controller. You cannot read this register when the μDMA controller is in the reset state. DMA Status (DMASTAT) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x000 Type RO, reset 0x001F.0000 31 30 29 28 27 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset STATE RO 0 17 16 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 2 1 0 DMACHANS reserved Type Reset 18 reserved RO 0 MASTEN RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:21 reserved RO 0x000 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 20:16 DMACHANS RO 0x1F Available μDMA Channels Minus 1 This field contains a value equal to the number of μDMA channels the μDMA controller is configured to use, minus one. The value of 0x1F corresponds to 32 μDMA channels. 15:8 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 7:4 STATE RO 0x0 Control State Machine Status This field shows the current status of the control state machine. Status can be one of the following. Value Description 0x0 Idle 0x1 Reading channel controller data. 0x2 Reading source end pointer. 0x3 Reading destination end pointer. 0x4 Reading source data. 0x5 Writing destination data. 0x6 Waiting for µDMA request to clear. 0x7 Writing channel controller data. 0x8 Stalled 0x9 Done 0xA-0xF Undefined 3:1 reserved RO 0x0 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 370 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset 0 MASTEN RO 0 Description Master Enable Status Value Description 0 The μDMA controller is disabled. 1 The μDMA controller is enabled. January 22, 2012 371 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 5: DMA Configuration (DMACFG), offset 0x004 The DMACFG register controls the configuration of the μDMA controller. DMA Configuration (DMACFG) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x004 Type WO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset WO - MASTEN WO - Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:1 reserved WO - Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 0 MASTEN WO - Controller Master Enable Value Description 0 Disables the μDMA controller. 1 Enables μDMA controller. 372 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 6: DMA Channel Control Base Pointer (DMACTLBASE), offset 0x008 The DMACTLBASE register must be configured so that the base pointer points to a location in system memory. The amount of system memory that must be assigned to the μDMA controller depends on the number of μDMA channels used and whether the alternate channel control data structure is used. See “Channel Configuration” on page 343 for details about the Channel Control Table. The base address must be aligned on a 1024-byte boundary. This register cannot be read when the μDMA controller is in the reset state. DMA Channel Control Base Pointer (DMACTLBASE) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x008 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 ADDR Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 ADDR Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:10 ADDR R/W 0x0000.00 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Channel Control Base Address This field contains the pointer to the base address of the channel control table. The base address must be 1024-byte aligned. 9:0 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 373 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 7: DMA Alternate Channel Control Base Pointer (DMAALTBASE), offset 0x00C The DMAALTBASE register returns the base address of the alternate channel control data. This register removes the necessity for application software to calculate the base address of the alternate channel control structures. This register cannot be read when the μDMA controller is in the reset state. DMA Alternate Channel Control Base Pointer (DMAALTBASE) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x00C Type RO, reset 0x0000.0200 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 ADDR Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ADDR Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 ADDR RO RO 1 Reset RO 0 Description 0x0000.0200 Alternate Channel Address Pointer This field provides the base address of the alternate channel control structures. 374 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 8: DMA Channel Wait-on-Request Status (DMAWAITSTAT), offset 0x010 This read-only register indicates that the μDMA channel is waiting on a request. A peripheral can hold off the μDMA from performing a single request until the peripheral is ready for a burst request to enhance the μDMA performance. The use of this feature is dependent on the design of the peripheral and is not controllable by software in any way. This register cannot be read when the μDMA controller is in the reset state. DMA Channel Wait-on-Request Status (DMAWAITSTAT) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x010 Type RO, reset 0xFFFF.FFC0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WAITREQ[n] Type Reset RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 WAITREQ[n] Type Reset RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 WAITREQ[n] RO RO 1 Reset RO 1 RO 1 Description 0xFFFF.FFC0 Channel [n] Wait Status These bits provide the channel wait-on-request status. Bit 0 corresponds to channel 0. Value Description 1 The corresponding channel is waiting on a request. 0 The corresponding channel is not waiting on a request. January 22, 2012 375 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 9: DMA Channel Software Request (DMASWREQ), offset 0x014 Each bit of the DMASWREQ register represents the corresponding μDMA channel. Setting a bit generates a request for the specified μDMA channel. DMA Channel Software Request (DMASWREQ) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x014 Type WO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - SWREQ[n] Type Reset SWREQ[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 SWREQ[n] WO - WO - Description Channel [n] Software Request These bits generate software requests. Bit 0 corresponds to channel 0. Value Description 1 Generate a software request for the corresponding channel. 0 No request generated. These bits are automatically cleared when the software request has been completed. 376 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 10: DMA Channel Useburst Set (DMAUSEBURSTSET), offset 0x018 Each bit of the DMAUSEBURSTSET register represents the corresponding μDMA channel. Setting a bit disables the channel's single request input from generating requests, configuring the channel to only accept burst requests. Reading the register returns the status of USEBURST. If the amount of data to transfer is a multiple of the arbitration (burst) size, the corresponding SET[n] bit is cleared after completing the final transfer. If there are fewer items remaining to transfer than the arbitration (burst) size, the μDMA controller automatically clears the corresponding SET[n] bit, allowing the remaining items to transfer using single requests. In order to resume transfers using burst requests, the corresponding bit must be set again. A bit should not be set if the corresponding peripheral does not support the burst request model. Refer to “Request Types” on page 342 for more details about request types. DMA Channel Useburst Set (DMAUSEBURSTSET) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x018 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 SET[n] Type Reset SET[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 SET[n] R/W Reset Description 0x0000.0000 Channel [n] Useburst Set Value Description 0 μDMA channel [n] responds to single or burst requests. 1 μDMA channel [n] responds only to burst requests. Bit 0 corresponds to channel 0. This bit is automatically cleared as described above. A bit can also be manually cleared by setting the corresponding CLR[n] bit in the DMAUSEBURSTCLR register. January 22, 2012 377 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 11: DMA Channel Useburst Clear (DMAUSEBURSTCLR), offset 0x01C Each bit of the DMAUSEBURSTCLR register represents the corresponding μDMA channel. Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAUSEBURSTSET register. DMA Channel Useburst Clear (DMAUSEBURSTCLR) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x01C Type WO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - CLR[n] Type Reset CLR[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 CLR[n] WO - Description Channel [n] Useburst Clear Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAUSEBURSTSET register meaning that µDMA channel [n] responds to single and burst requests. 378 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 12: DMA Channel Request Mask Set (DMAREQMASKSET), offset 0x020 Each bit of the DMAREQMASKSET register represents the corresponding μDMA channel. Setting a bit disables μDMA requests for the channel. Reading the register returns the request mask status. When a μDMA channel's request is masked, that means the peripheral can no longer request μDMA transfers. The channel can then be used for software-initiated transfers. DMA Channel Request Mask Set (DMAREQMASKSET) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x020 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 SET[n] Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 SET[n] Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 SET[n] R/W R/W 0 Reset R/W 0 Description 0x0000.0000 Channel [n] Request Mask Set Value Description 0 The peripheral associated with channel [n] is enabled to request μDMA transfers. 1 The peripheral associated with channel [n] is not able to request μDMA transfers. Channel [n] may be used for software-initiated transfers. Bit 0 corresponds to channel 0. A bit can only be cleared by setting the corresponding CLR[n] bit in the DMAREQMASKCLR register. January 22, 2012 379 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 13: DMA Channel Request Mask Clear (DMAREQMASKCLR), offset 0x024 Each bit of the DMAREQMASKCLR register represents the corresponding μDMA channel. Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAREQMASKSET register. DMA Channel Request Mask Clear (DMAREQMASKCLR) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x024 Type WO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - CLR[n] Type Reset WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 CLR[n] Type Reset WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 CLR[n] WO - WO - Description Channel [n] Request Mask Clear Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAREQMASKSET register meaning that the peripheral associated with channel [n] is enabled to request μDMA transfers. 380 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 14: DMA Channel Enable Set (DMAENASET), offset 0x028 Each bit of the DMAENASET register represents the corresponding µDMA channel. Setting a bit enables the corresponding µDMA channel. Reading the register returns the enable status of the channels. If a channel is enabled but the request mask is set (DMAREQMASKSET), then the channel can be used for software-initiated transfers. DMA Channel Enable Set (DMAENASET) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x028 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 SET[n] Type Reset SET[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 SET[n] R/W Reset Description 0x0000.0000 Channel [n] Enable Set Value Description 0 µDMA Channel [n] is disabled. 1 µDMA Channel [n] is enabled. Bit 0 corresponds to channel 0. A bit can only be cleared by setting the corresponding CLR[n] bit in the DMAENACLR register. January 22, 2012 381 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 15: DMA Channel Enable Clear (DMAENACLR), offset 0x02C Each bit of the DMAENACLR register represents the corresponding µDMA channel. Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAENASET register. DMA Channel Enable Clear (DMAENACLR) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x02C Type WO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - CLR[n] Type Reset CLR[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 CLR[n] WO - Description Clear Channel [n] Enable Clear Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAENASET register meaning that channel [n] is disabled for μDMA transfers. Note: The controller disables a channel when it completes the μDMA cycle. 382 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 16: DMA Channel Primary Alternate Set (DMAALTSET), offset 0x030 Each bit of the DMAALTSET register represents the corresponding µDMA channel. Setting a bit configures the µDMA channel to use the alternate control data structure. Reading the register returns the status of which control data structure is in use for the corresponding µDMA channel. DMA Channel Primary Alternate Set (DMAALTSET) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x030 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 SET[n] Type Reset SET[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 SET[n] R/W Reset Description 0x0000.0000 Channel [n] Alternate Set Value Description 0 µDMA channel [n] is using the primary control structure. 1 µDMA channel [n] is using the alternate control structure. Bit 0 corresponds to channel 0. A bit can only be cleared by setting the corresponding CLR[n] bit in the DMAALTCLR register. Note: For Ping-Pong and Scatter-Gather cycle types, the µDMA controller automatically sets these bits to select the alternate channel control data structure. January 22, 2012 383 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 17: DMA Channel Primary Alternate Clear (DMAALTCLR), offset 0x034 Each bit of the DMAALTCLR register represents the corresponding μDMA channel. Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAALTSET register. DMA Channel Primary Alternate Clear (DMAALTCLR) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x034 Type WO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - CLR[n] Type Reset WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 CLR[n] Type Reset WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 CLR[n] WO - WO - Description Channel [n] Alternate Clear Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAALTSET register meaning that channel [n] is using the primary control structure. Note: For Ping-Pong and Scatter-Gather cycle types, the µDMA controller automatically sets these bits to select the alternate channel control data structure. 384 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 18: DMA Channel Priority Set (DMAPRIOSET), offset 0x038 Each bit of the DMAPRIOSET register represents the corresponding µDMA channel. Setting a bit configures the µDMA channel to have a high priority level. Reading the register returns the status of the channel priority mask. DMA Channel Priority Set (DMAPRIOSET) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x038 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 SET[n] Type Reset SET[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 SET[n] R/W Reset Description 0x0000.0000 Channel [n] Priority Set Value Description 0 µDMA channel [n] is using the default priority level. 1 µDMA channel [n] is using a high priority level. Bit 0 corresponds to channel 0. A bit can only be cleared by setting the corresponding CLR[n] bit in the DMAPRIOCLR register. January 22, 2012 385 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 19: DMA Channel Priority Clear (DMAPRIOCLR), offset 0x03C Each bit of the DMAPRIOCLR register represents the corresponding µDMA channel. Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAPRIOSET register. DMA Channel Priority Clear (DMAPRIOCLR) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x03C Type WO, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - WO - CLR[n] Type Reset CLR[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 CLR[n] WO - Description Channel [n] Priority Clear Value Description 0 No effect. 1 Setting a bit clears the corresponding SET[n] bit in the DMAPRIOSET register meaning that channel [n] is using the default priority level. 386 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 20: DMA Bus Error Clear (DMAERRCLR), offset 0x04C The DMAERRCLR register is used to read and clear the µDMA bus error status. The error status is set if the μDMA controller encountered a bus error while performing a transfer. If a bus error occurs on a channel, that channel is automatically disabled by the μDMA controller. The other channels are unaffected. DMA Bus Error Clear (DMAERRCLR) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x04C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:1 reserved RO 0x0000.000 0 ERRCLR R/W1C 0 RO 0 ERRCLR R/W1C 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. μDMA Bus Error Status Value Description 0 No bus error is pending. 1 A bus error is pending. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. January 22, 2012 387 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 21: DMA Channel Assignment (DMACHASGN), offset 0x500 Each bit of the DMACHASGN register represents the corresponding µDMA channel. Setting a bit selects the secondary channel assignment as specified in Table 8-1 on page 341. DMA Channel Assignment (DMACHASGN) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x500 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - CHASGN[n] Type Reset CHASGN[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:0 CHASGN[n] R/W - R/W - Description Channel [n] Assignment Select Value Description 0 Use the primary channel assignment. 1 Use the secondary channel assignment. 388 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 22: DMA Channel Interrupt Status (DMACHIS), offset 0x504 Each bit of the DMACHIS register represents the corresponding µDMA channel. A bit is set when that μDMA channel causes a completion interrupt. The bits are cleared by a writing a 1. DMA Channel Interrupt Status (DMACHIS) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0x504 Type R/W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 R/W1C 0 CHIS[n] Type Reset CHIS[n] Type Reset Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 CHIS[n] R/W1C Reset Description 0x0000.0000 Channel [n] Interrupt Status Value Description 1 The corresponding μDMA channel caused an interrupt. 0 The corresponding μDMA channel has not caused an interrupt. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it. January 22, 2012 389 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 23: DMA Peripheral Identification 0 (DMAPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 The DMAPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded, and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA Peripheral Identification 0 (DMAPeriphID0) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFE0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0030 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset PID0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID0 RO 0x30 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. μDMA Peripheral ID Register [7:0] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 390 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 24: DMA Peripheral Identification 1 (DMAPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 The DMAPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded, and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA Peripheral Identification 1 (DMAPeriphID1) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFE4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.00B2 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset PID1 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID1 RO 0xB2 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. μDMA Peripheral ID Register [15:8] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. January 22, 2012 391 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 25: DMA Peripheral Identification 2 (DMAPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 The DMAPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded, and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA Peripheral Identification 2 (DMAPeriphID2) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFE8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.000B 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset PID2 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID2 RO 0x0B Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. μDMA Peripheral ID Register [23:16] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 392 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 26: DMA Peripheral Identification 3 (DMAPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC The DMAPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA Peripheral Identification 3 (DMAPeriphID3) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFEC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset PID3 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID3 RO 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. μDMA Peripheral ID Register [31:24] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. January 22, 2012 393 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 27: DMA Peripheral Identification 4 (DMAPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 The DMAPeriphIDn registers are hard-coded, and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA Peripheral Identification 4 (DMAPeriphID4) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFD0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0004 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset PID4 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID4 RO 0x04 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. μDMA Peripheral ID Register Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 394 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 28: DMA PrimeCell Identification 0 (DMAPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 The DMAPCellIDn registers are hard-coded, and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA PrimeCell Identification 0 (DMAPCellID0) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFF0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.000D 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset CID0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 CID0 RO 0x0D Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. μDMA PrimeCell ID Register [7:0] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. January 22, 2012 395 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 29: DMA PrimeCell Identification 1 (DMAPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 The DMAPCellIDn registers are hard-coded, and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA PrimeCell Identification 1 (DMAPCellID1) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFF4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.00F0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset CID1 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 CID1 RO 0xF0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. μDMA PrimeCell ID Register [15:8] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 396 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 30: DMA PrimeCell Identification 2 (DMAPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 The DMAPCellIDn registers are hard-coded, and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA PrimeCell Identification 2 (DMAPCellID2) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFF8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0005 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset CID2 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:8 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 7:0 CID2 RO 0x05 μDMA PrimeCell ID Register [23:16] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. January 22, 2012 397 Texas Instruments-Production Data Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA) Register 31: DMA PrimeCell Identification 3 (DMAPCellID3), offset 0xFFC The DMAPCellIDn registers are hard-coded, and the fields within the registers determine the reset values. DMA PrimeCell Identification 3 (DMAPCellID3) Base 0x400F.F000 Offset 0xFFC Type RO, reset 0x0000.00B1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset CID3 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 31:8 reserved RO 0x00 Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 7:0 CID3 RO 0xB1 μDMA PrimeCell ID Register [31:24] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 398 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 9 General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) The GPIO module is composed of nine physical GPIO blocks, each corresponding to an individual GPIO port (Port A, Port B, Port C, Port D, Port E, Port F, Port G, Port H, Port J). The GPIO module supports up to 67 programmable input/output pins, depending on the peripherals being used. The GPIO module has the following features: ■ Up to 67 GPIOs, depending on configuration ■ Highly flexible pin muxing allows use as GPIO or one of several peripheral functions ■ 5-V-tolerant in input configuration ■ Two means of port access: either Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB) with better back-to-back access performance, or the legacy Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB) for backwards-compatibility with existing code ■ Fast toggle capable of a change every clock cycle for ports on AHB, every two clock cycles for ports on APB ■ Programmable control for GPIO interrupts – Interrupt generation masking – Edge-triggered on rising, falling, or both – Level-sensitive on High or Low values ■ Bit masking in both read and write operations through address lines ■ Can be used to initiate an ADC sample sequence ■ Pins configured as digital inputs are Schmitt-triggered ■ Programmable control for GPIO pad configuration – Weak pull-up or pull-down resistors – 2-mA, 4-mA, and 8-mA pad drive for digital communication; up to four pads can sink 18-mA for high-current applications – Slew rate control for the 8-mA drive – Open drain enables – Digital input enables 9.1 Signal Description GPIO signals have alternate hardware functions. The following table lists the GPIO pins and their analog and digital alternate functions. The AINx and VREFA analog signals are not 5-V tolerant and go through an isolation circuit before reaching their circuitry. These signals are configured by clearing the corresponding DEN bit in the GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register and setting the corresponding AMSEL bit in the GPIO Analog Mode Select (GPIOAMSEL) register. Other analog January 22, 2012 399 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) signals are 5-V tolerant and are connected directly to their circuitry (C0-, C0+, C1-, C1+). These signals are configured by clearing the DEN bit in the GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register. All GPIO signals are 5-V tolerant when configured as inputs except for PB0 and PB1, which are limited to 3.6 V. The digital alternate hardware functions are enabled by setting the appropriate bit in the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) and GPIODEN registers and configuring the PMCx bit field in the GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL) register to the numeric encoding shown in the table below. Note that each pin must be programmed individually; no type of grouping is implied by the columns in the table. Table entries that are shaded gray are the default values for the corresponding GPIO pin. Important: All GPIO pins are configured as GPIOs and tri-stated by default (GPIOAFSEL=0, GPIODEN=0, GPIOPDR=0, GPIOPUR=0, and GPIOPCTL=0, with the exception of the pins shown in the table below. A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting RST puts the pins back to their default state. Table 9-1. GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values GPIO Pins Default State PA[1:0] UART0 GPIOAFSEL GPIODEN GPIOPDR GPIOPUR 0 0 0 GPIOPCTL 0 0x1 PA[5:2] SSI0 0 0 0 0 0x2 PB[3:2] I2C0 0 0 0 0 0x3 PC[3:0] JTAG/SWD 1 1 0 1 0x1 Table 9-2. GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions (100LQFP) IO Pin Analog Function a Digital Function (GPIOPCTL PMCx Bit Field Encoding) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 PA0 26 - U0Rx - - - - - - I2C1SCL U1Rx - - PA1 27 - U0Tx - - - - - - I2C1SDA U1Tx - - PA2 28 - SSI0Clk - - - - - - - - - - PA3 29 - SSI0Fss - - - - - - - - - - PA4 30 - SSI0Rx - - - - - - - - - - PA5 31 - SSI0Tx - - - - - - - - - - PA6 34 - I2C1SCL CCP1 - - - - - - U1CTS - - PA7 35 - I2C1SDA CCP4 - - - - CCP3 - U1DCD - - PB0 66 - CCP0 - - - U1Rx - - - - - - PB1 67 - CCP2 - - CCP1 U1Tx - - - - - - PB2 72 - I2C0SCL - - CCP3 CCP0 - - - - - - PB3 65 - I2C0SDA - - - - - - - - - - PB4 92 C0- - - - U2Rx - - U1Rx EPI0S23 - - - PB5 91 C1- C0o CCP5 CCP6 CCP0 - CCP2 U1Tx EPI0S22 - - - PB6 90 VREFA C0+ CCP1 CCP7 C0o - - CCP5 - - - - - PB7 89 - - - - NMI - - - - - - - PC0 80 - - - TCK SWCLK - - - - - - - - PC1 79 - - - TMS SWDIO - - - - - - - - 400 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 9-2. GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions (100LQFP) (continued) a Digital Function (GPIOPCTL PMCx Bit Field Encoding) IO Pin Analog Function 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 PC2 78 - - - TDI - - - - - - - - PC3 77 - - - TDO SWO - - - - - - - - PC4 25 - CCP5 - - - CCP2 CCP4 - EPI0S2 CCP1 - - PC5 24 C1+ CCP1 C1o C0o - CCP3 - - EPI0S3 - - - PC6 23 - CCP3 - - - U1Rx CCP0 - EPI0S4 - - - PC7 22 - CCP4 - - CCP0 U1Tx - C1o EPI0S5 - - - PD0 10 - - - - U2Rx U1Rx CCP6 - - U1CTS - - PD1 11 - - - - U2Tx U1Tx CCP7 - - U1DCD CCP2 - PD2 12 - U1Rx CCP6 - CCP5 - - - EPI0S20 - - - PD3 13 - U1Tx CCP7 - CCP0 - - - EPI0S21 - - - PD4 97 AIN7 CCP0 CCP3 - - - - - - U1RI EPI0S19 - PD5 98 AIN6 CCP2 CCP4 - - - - - - U2Rx EPI0S28 - PD6 99 AIN5 - - - - - - - - U2Tx EPI0S29 - PD7 100 AIN4 - C0o CCP1 - - - - - U1DTR EPI0S30 - PE0 74 - - SSI1Clk CCP3 - - - - EPI0S8 - - - PE1 75 - - SSI1Fss - CCP2 CCP6 - - EPI0S9 - - - PE2 95 - CCP4 SSI1Rx - - CCP2 - - EPI0S24 - - - PE3 96 - CCP1 SSI1Tx - - CCP7 - - EPI0S25 - - - PE4 6 AIN3 CCP3 - - - U2Tx CCP2 - - - - - PE5 5 AIN2 CCP5 - - - - - - - - - - PE6 2 AIN1 - C1o - - - - - - U1CTS - - PE7 1 AIN0 - - - - - - - - U1DCD - - PF0 47 - - - - - - - - - U1DSR - - PF1 61 - - - - - - - - - U1RTS CCP3 - PF2 60 - - - - - - - - - SSI1Clk - - PF3 59 - - - - - - - - - SSI1Fss - - PF4 58 - CCP0 C0o - - - - - EPI0S12 SSI1Rx - - PF5 46 - CCP2 C1o - - - - - EPI0S15 SSI1Tx - - PF6 43 - CCP1 - - - - - - U1RTS - - - PF7 42 - CCP4 - - - - - - EPI0S12 - - - PG0 19 - U2Rx - I2C1SCL - - - - EPI0S13 - - - PG1 18 - U2Tx - I2C1SDA - - - - EPI0S14 - - - PG2 17 - - - - - - - - - - - - PG3 16 - - - - - - - - - - - - PG4 41 - CCP3 - - - - - - EPI0S15 - U1RI - PG5 40 - CCP5 - - - - - - - - U1DTR - PG6 37 - - - - - - - - - - U1RI - PG7 36 - - - - - - - - CCP5 EPI0S31 - - PH0 86 - CCP6 - - - - - - EPI0S6 - - - January 22, 2012 401 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Table 9-2. GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions (100LQFP) (continued) a Digital Function (GPIOPCTL PMCx Bit Field Encoding) IO Pin Analog Function 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 PH1 85 - CCP7 - - - - - - EPI0S7 - - - PH2 84 - - C1o - - - - - EPI0S1 - - - PH3 83 - - - - - - - - EPI0S0 - - - PH4 76 - - - - - - - - EPI0S10 - - SSI1Clk PH5 63 - - - - - - - - EPI0S11 - - SSI1Fss PH6 62 - - - - - - - - EPI0S26 - - SSI1Rx PH7 15 - - - - - - - - EPI0S27 - - SSI1Tx PJ0 14 - - - - - - - - EPI0S16 - - I2C1SCL PJ1 87 - - - - - - - - EPI0S17 - - I2C1SDA PJ2 39 - - - - - - - - EPI0S18 CCP0 - - a. The digital signals that are shaded gray are the power-on default values for the corresponding GPIO pin. Table 9-3. GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions (108BGA) a Digital Function (GPIOPCTL PMCx Bit Field Encoding) IO Pin Analog Function 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 PA0 L3 - U0Rx - - - - - - I2C1SCL U1Rx - - PA1 M3 - U0Tx - - - - - - I2C1SDA U1Tx - - PA2 M4 - SSI0Clk - - - - - - - - - - PA3 L4 - SSI0Fss - - - - - - - - - - PA4 L5 - SSI0Rx - - - - - - - - - - PA5 M5 - SSI0Tx - - - - - - - - - - PA6 L6 - I2C1SCL CCP1 - - - - - - U1CTS - - PA7 M6 - I2C1SDA CCP4 - - - - CCP3 - U1DCD - - PB0 E12 - CCP0 - - - U1Rx - - - - - - PB1 D12 - CCP2 - - CCP1 U1Tx - - - - - - PB2 A11 - I2C0SCL - - CCP3 CCP0 - - - - - - PB3 E11 - I2C0SDA - - - - - - - - - - PB4 A6 C0- - - - U2Rx - - U1Rx EPI0S23 - - - PB5 B7 C1- C0o CCP5 CCP6 CCP0 - CCP2 U1Tx EPI0S22 - - - PB6 A7 VREFA C0+ CCP1 CCP7 C0o - - CCP5 - - - - - PB7 A8 - - - - NMI - - - - - - - PC0 A9 - - - TCK SWCLK - - - - - - - - PC1 B9 - - - TMS SWDIO - - - - - - - - PC2 B8 - - - TDI - - - - - - - - PC3 A10 - - - TDO SWO - - - - - - - - PC4 L1 - CCP5 - - - CCP2 CCP4 - EPI0S2 CCP1 - - PC5 M1 C1+ CCP1 C1o C0o - CCP3 - - EPI0S3 - - - 402 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 9-3. GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions (108BGA) (continued) a Digital Function (GPIOPCTL PMCx Bit Field Encoding) IO Pin Analog Function 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 PC6 M2 - CCP3 - - - U1Rx CCP0 - EPI0S4 - - - PC7 L2 - CCP4 - - CCP0 U1Tx - C1o EPI0S5 - - - PD0 G1 - - - - U2Rx U1Rx CCP6 - - U1CTS - - PD1 G2 - - - - U2Tx U1Tx CCP7 - - U1DCD CCP2 - PD2 H2 - U1Rx CCP6 - CCP5 - - - EPI0S20 - - - PD3 H1 - U1Tx CCP7 - CCP0 - - - EPI0S21 - - - PD4 B5 AIN7 CCP0 CCP3 - - - - - - U1RI EPI0S19 - PD5 C6 AIN6 CCP2 CCP4 - - - - - - U2Rx EPI0S28 - PD6 A3 AIN5 - - - - - - - - U2Tx EPI0S29 - PD7 A2 AIN4 - C0o CCP1 - - - - - U1DTR EPI0S30 - PE0 B11 - - SSI1Clk CCP3 - - - - EPI0S8 - - - PE1 A12 - - SSI1Fss - CCP2 CCP6 - - EPI0S9 - - - PE2 A4 - CCP4 SSI1Rx - - CCP2 - - EPI0S24 - - - PE3 B4 - CCP1 SSI1Tx - - CCP7 - - EPI0S25 - - - PE4 B2 AIN3 CCP3 - - - U2Tx CCP2 - - - - - PE5 B3 AIN2 CCP5 - - - - - - - - - - PE6 A1 AIN1 - C1o - - - - - - U1CTS - - PE7 B1 AIN0 - - - - - - - - U1DCD - - PF0 M9 - - - - - - - - - U1DSR - - PF1 H12 - - - - - - - - - U1RTS CCP3 - PF2 J11 - - - - - - - - - SSI1Clk - - PF3 J12 - - - - - - - - - SSI1Fss - - PF4 L9 - CCP0 C0o - - - - - EPI0S12 SSI1Rx - - PF5 L8 - CCP2 C1o - - - - - EPI0S15 SSI1Tx - - PF6 M8 - CCP1 - - - - - - U1RTS - - - PF7 K4 - CCP4 - - - - - - EPI0S12 - - - PG0 K1 - U2Rx - I2C1SCL - - - - EPI0S13 - - - PG1 K2 - U2Tx - I2C1SDA - - - - EPI0S14 - - - PG2 J1 - - - - - - - - - - - - PG3 J2 - - - - - - - - - - - - PG4 K3 - CCP3 - - - - - - EPI0S15 - U1RI - PG5 M7 - CCP5 - - - - - - - - U1DTR - PG6 L7 - - - - - - - - - - U1RI - PG7 C10 - - - - - - - - CCP5 EPI0S31 - - PH0 C9 - CCP6 - - - - - - EPI0S6 - - - PH1 C8 - CCP7 - - - - - - EPI0S7 - - - PH2 D11 - - C1o - - - - - EPI0S1 - - - PH3 D10 - - - - - - - - EPI0S0 - - - PH4 B10 - - - - - - - - EPI0S10 - - SSI1Clk PH5 F10 - - - - - - - - EPI0S11 - - SSI1Fss January 22, 2012 403 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Table 9-3. GPIO Pins and Alternate Functions (108BGA) (continued) a Digital Function (GPIOPCTL PMCx Bit Field Encoding) IO Pin Analog Function 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 PH6 G3 - - - - - - - - EPI0S26 - - SSI1Rx PH7 H3 - - - - - - - - EPI0S27 - - SSI1Tx PJ0 F3 - - - - - - - - EPI0S16 - - I2C1SCL PJ1 B6 - - - - - - - - EPI0S17 - - I2C1SDA PJ2 K6 - - - - - - - - EPI0S18 CCP0 - - a. The digital signals that are shaded gray are the power-on default values for the corresponding GPIO pin. 9.2 Functional Description Each GPIO port is a separate hardware instantiation of the same physical block (see Figure 9-1 on page 404 and Figure 9-2 on page 405). The LM3S1G21 microcontroller contains nine ports and thus nine of these physical GPIO blocks. Note that not all pins may be implemented on every block. Some GPIO pins can function as I/O signals for the on-chip peripheral modules. For information on which GPIO pins are used for alternate hardware functions, refer to Table 19-5 on page 859. Figure 9-1. Digital I/O Pads Commit Control GPIOLOCK GPIOCR Port Control GPIOPCTL Mode Control GPIOAFSEL Periph 1 DEMUX Alternate Input Alternate Output Alternate Output Enable MUX Periph 0 Pad Input Periph n GPIO Output GPIO Output Enable Interrupt Control Pad Control GPIOIS GPIOIBE GPIOIEV GPIOIM GPIORIS GPIOMIS GPIOICR GPIODR2R GPIODR4R GPIODR8R GPIOSLR GPIOPUR GPIOPDR GPIOODR GPIODEN MUX GPIODATA GPIODIR Interrupt MUX GPIO Input Data Control Pad Output Digital I/O Pad Package I/O Pin Pad Output Enable Identification Registers GPIOPeriphID0 GPIOPeriphID1 GPIOPeriphID2 GPIOPeriphID3 GPIOPeriphID4 GPIOPeriphID5 GPIOPeriphID6 GPIOPeriphID7 GPIOPCellID0 GPIOPCellID1 GPIOPCellID2 GPIOPCellID3 404 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 9-2. Analog/Digital I/O Pads Commit Control GPIOLOCK GPIOCR Port Control GPIOPCTL Mode Control GPIOAFSEL Periph 1 DEMUX Alternate Input Alternate Output Alternate Output Enable MUX Periph 0 Pad Input Periph n MUX MUX Data Control Pad Output Pad Output Enable Analog/Digital I/O Pad Package I/O Pin GPIO Input GPIO Output GPIODATA GPIODIR Interrupt GPIO Output Enable Interrupt Control GPIOIS GPIOIBE GPIOIEV GPIOIM GPIORIS GPIOMIS GPIOICR Pad Control GPIODR2R GPIODR4R GPIODR8R GPIOSLR GPIOPUR GPIOPDR GPIOODR GPIODEN GPIOAMSEL Analog Circuitry Identification Registers GPIOPeriphID0 GPIOPeriphID1 GPIOPeriphID2 GPIOPeriphID3 9.2.1 GPIOPeriphID4 GPIOPeriphID5 GPIOPeriphID6 GPIOPeriphID7 GPIOPCellID0 GPIOPCellID1 GPIOPCellID2 GPIOPCellID3 ADC (for GPIO pins that connect to the ADC input MUX) Isolation Circuit Data Control The data control registers allow software to configure the operational modes of the GPIOs. The data direction register configures the GPIO as an input or an output while the data register either captures incoming data or drives it out to the pads. Caution – It is possible to create a software sequence that prevents the debugger from connecting to the Stellaris® microcontroller. If the program code loaded into flash immediately changes the JTAG pins to their GPIO functionality, the debugger may not have enough time to connect and halt the controller before the JTAG pin functionality switches. As a result, the debugger may be locked out of the part. This issue can be avoided with a software routine that restores JTAG functionality based on an external or software trigger. 9.2.1.1 Data Direction Operation The GPIO Direction (GPIODIR) register (see page 414) is used to configure each individual pin as an input or output. When the data direction bit is cleared, the GPIO is configured as an input, and the corresponding data register bit captures and stores the value on the GPIO port. When the data direction bit is set, the GPIO is configured as an output, and the corresponding data register bit is driven out on the GPIO port. January 22, 2012 405 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) 9.2.1.2 Data Register Operation To aid in the efficiency of software, the GPIO ports allow for the modification of individual bits in the GPIO Data (GPIODATA) register (see page 413) by using bits [9:2] of the address bus as a mask. In this manner, software drivers can modify individual GPIO pins in a single instruction without affecting the state of the other pins. This method is more efficient than the conventional method of performing a read-modify-write operation to set or clear an individual GPIO pin. To implement this feature, the GPIODATA register covers 256 locations in the memory map. During a write, if the address bit associated with that data bit is set, the value of the GPIODATA register is altered. If the address bit is cleared, the data bit is left unchanged. For example, writing a value of 0xEB to the address GPIODATA + 0x098 has the results shown in Figure 9-3, where u indicates that data is unchanged by the write. Figure 9-3. GPIODATA Write Example ADDR[9:2] 0x098 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0xEB 1 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 GPIODATA u u 1 u u 0 1 u 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 During a read, if the address bit associated with the data bit is set, the value is read. If the address bit associated with the data bit is cleared, the data bit is read as a zero, regardless of its actual value. For example, reading address GPIODATA + 0x0C4 yields as shown in Figure 9-4. Figure 9-4. GPIODATA Read Example 9.2.2 ADDR[9:2] 0x0C4 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 GPIODATA 1 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 Returned Value 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Interrupt Control The interrupt capabilities of each GPIO port are controlled by a set of seven registers. These registers are used to select the source of the interrupt, its polarity, and the edge properties. When one or more GPIO inputs cause an interrupt, a single interrupt output is sent to the interrupt controller for the entire GPIO port. For edge-triggered interrupts, software must clear the interrupt to enable any further interrupts. For a level-sensitive interrupt, the external source must hold the level constant for the interrupt to be recognized by the controller. Three registers define the edge or sense that causes interrupts: ■ GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS) register (see page 415) 406 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller ■ GPIO Interrupt Both Edges (GPIOIBE) register (see page 416) ■ GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV) register (see page 417) Interrupts are enabled/disabled via the GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM) register (see page 418). When an interrupt condition occurs, the state of the interrupt signal can be viewed in two locations: the GPIO Raw Interrupt Status (GPIORIS) and GPIO Masked Interrupt Status (GPIOMIS) registers (see page 419 and page 420). As the name implies, the GPIOMIS register only shows interrupt conditions that are allowed to be passed to the interrupt controller. The GPIORIS register indicates that a GPIO pin meets the conditions for an interrupt, but has not necessarily been sent to the interrupt controller. Interrupts are cleared by writing a 1 to the appropriate bit of the GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR) register (see page 422). When programming the interrupt control registers (GPIOIS, GPIOIBE, or GPIOIEV), the interrupts should be masked (GPIOIM cleared). Writing any value to an interrupt control register can generate a spurious interrupt if the corresponding bits are enabled. 9.2.2.1 ADC Trigger Source In addition to providing GPIO functionality, PB4 can also be used as an external trigger for the ADC. If PB4 is configured as a non-masked interrupt pin (the appropriate bit of GPIOIM is set), an interrupt for Port B is generated, and an external trigger signal is sent to the ADC. If the ADC Event Multiplexer Select (ADCEMUX) register is configured to use the external trigger, an ADC conversion is initiated. See page 633. If no other Port B pins are being used to generate interrupts, the Interrupt 0-31 Set Enable (EN0) register can disable the Port B interrupts, and the ADC interrupt can be used to read back the converted data. Otherwise, the Port B interrupt handler must ignore and clear interrupts on PB4 and wait for the ADC interrupt, or the ADC interrupt must be disabled in the EN0 register and the Port B interrupt handler must poll the ADC registers until the conversion is completed. See page 110 for more information. 9.2.3 Mode Control The GPIO pins can be controlled by either software or hardware. Software control is the default for most signals and corresponds to the GPIO mode, where the GPIODATA register is used to read or write the corresponding pins. When hardware control is enabled via the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (see page 423), the pin state is controlled by its alternate function (that is, the peripheral). Further pin muxing options are provided through the GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL) register which selects one of several peripheral functions for each GPIO. For information on the configuration options, refer to Table 19-5 on page 859. Note: 9.2.4 If any pin is to be used as an ADC input, the appropriate bit in the GPIOAMSEL register must be set to disable the analog isolation circuit. Commit Control The GPIO commit control registers provide a layer of protection against accidental programming of critical hardware peripherals. Protection is provided for the NMI pin (PB7) and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PC[3:0]). Writes to protected bits of the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (see page 423), GPIO Pull Up Select (GPIOPUR) register (see page 429), GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register (see page 431), and GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register (see January 22, 2012 407 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) page 434) are not committed to storage unless the GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK) register (see page 436) has been unlocked and the appropriate bits of the GPIO Commit (GPIOCR) register (see page 437) have been set. 9.2.5 Pad Control The pad control registers allow software to configure the GPIO pads based on the application requirements. The pad control registers include the GPIODR2R, GPIODR4R, GPIODR8R, GPIOODR, GPIOPUR, GPIOPDR, GPIOSLR, and GPIODEN registers. These registers control drive strength, open-drain configuration, pull-up and pull-down resistors, slew-rate control and digital input enable for each GPIO. For special high-current applications, the GPIO output buffers may be used with the following restrictions. With the GPIO pins configured as 8-mA output drivers, a total of four GPIO outputs may be used to sink current loads up to 18 mA each. At 18-mA sink current loading, the VOL value is specified as 1.2 V. The high-current GPIO package pins must be selected such that there are only a maximum of two per side of the physical package or BGA pin group with the total number of high-current GPIO outputs not exceeding four for the entire package. 9.2.6 Identification The identification registers configured at reset allow software to detect and identify the module as a GPIO block. The identification registers include the GPIOPeriphID0-GPIOPeriphID7 registers as well as the GPIOPCellID0-GPIOPCellID3 registers. 9.3 Initialization and Configuration The GPIO modules may be accessed via two different memory apertures. The legacy aperture, the Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB), is backwards-compatible with previous Stellaris parts. The other aperture, the Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB), offers the same register map but provides better back-to-back access performance than the APB bus. These apertures are mutually exclusive. The aperture enabled for a given GPIO port is controlled by the appropriate bit in the GPIOHBCTL register (see page 208). To use the pins in a particular GPIO port, the clock for the port must be enabled by setting the appropriate GPIO Port bit field (GPIOn) in the RCGC2 register (see page 254). When the internal POR signal is asserted and until otherwise configured, all GPIO pins are configured to be undriven (tristate): GPIOAFSEL=0, GPIODEN=0, GPIOPDR=0, and GPIOPUR=0, except for the pins shown in Table 9-1 on page 400. Table 9-4 on page 408 shows all possible configurations of the GPIO pads and the control register settings required to achieve them. Table 9-5 on page 409 shows how a rising edge interrupt is configured for pin 2 of a GPIO port. Table 9-4. GPIO Pad Configuration Examples a Configuration Digital Input (GPIO) GPIO Register Bit Value AFSEL 0 DIR ODR 0 0 DEN 1 PUR ? PDR ? DR2R DR4R DR8R X X X SLR X Digital Output (GPIO) 0 1 0 1 ? ? ? ? ? ? Open Drain Output (GPIO) 0 1 1 1 X X ? ? ? ? Open Drain Input/Output (I2C) 1 X 1 1 X X ? ? ? ? Digital Input (Timer CCP) 1 X 0 1 ? ? X X X X 408 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 9-4. GPIO Pad Configuration Examples (continued) a GPIO Register Bit Value Configuration DR2R DR4R DR8R Digital Output (Timer PWM) AFSEL 1 DIR X ODR 0 DEN 1 PUR ? PDR ? ? ? ? SLR ? Digital Input/Output (SSI) 1 X 0 1 ? ? ? ? ? ? Digital Input/Output (UART) 1 X 0 1 ? ? ? ? ? ? Analog Input (Comparator) 0 0 0 0 0 0 X X X X Digital Output (Comparator) 1 X 0 1 ? ? ? ? ? ? a. X=Ignored (don’t care bit) ?=Can be either 0 or 1, depending on the configuration Table 9-5. GPIO Interrupt Configuration Example Desired Interrupt Event Trigger Register GPIOIS 0=edge a Pin 2 Bit Value 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 X X X X X 0 X X X X X X X 0 X X X X X X X 1 X X 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1=level GPIOIBE 0=single edge 1=both edges GPIOIEV 0=Low level, or falling edge 1=High level, or rising edge GPIOIM 0=masked 1=not masked a. X=Ignored (don’t care bit) 9.4 Register Map Table 9-7 on page 410 lists the GPIO registers. Each GPIO port can be accessed through one of two bus apertures. The legacy aperture, the Advanced Peripheral Bus (APB), is backwards-compatible with previous Stellaris parts. The other aperture, the Advanced High-Performance Bus (AHB), offers the same register map but provides better back-to-back access performance than the APB bus. Important: The GPIO registers in this chapter are duplicated in each GPIO block; however, depending on the block, all eight bits may not be connected to a GPIO pad. In those cases, writing to unconnected bits has no effect, and reading unconnected bits returns no meaningful data. The offset listed is a hexadecimal increment to the register’s address, relative to that GPIO port’s base address: ■ ■ ■ ■ GPIO Port A (APB): 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB): 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB): 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB): 0x4005.9000 January 22, 2012 409 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ GPIO Port C (APB): 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB): 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB): 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB): 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB): 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB): 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB): 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB): 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB): 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB): 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB): 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB): 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB): 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB): 0x4006.0000 Note that each GPIO module clock must be enabled before the registers can be programmed (see page 254). There must be a delay of 3 system clocks after the GPIO module clock is enabled before any GPIO module registers are accessed. Important: All GPIO pins are configured as GPIOs and tri-stated by default (GPIOAFSEL=0, GPIODEN=0, GPIOPDR=0, GPIOPUR=0, and GPIOPCTL=0, with the exception of the pins shown in the table below. A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting RST puts the pins back to their default state. Table 9-6. GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values GPIO Pins Default State GPIOAFSEL GPIODEN GPIOPDR GPIOPUR GPIOPCTL PA[1:0] UART0 0 0 0 0 0x1 PA[5:2] SSI0 0 0 0 0 0x2 PB[3:2] I2C0 0 0 0 0 0x3 PC[3:0] JTAG/SWD 1 1 0 1 0x1 The default register type for the GPIOCR register is RO for all GPIO pins with the exception of the NMI pin and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]). These five pins are the only GPIOs that are protected by the GPIOCR register. Because of this, the register type for GPIO Port B7 and GPIO Port C[3:0] is R/W. The default reset value for the GPIOCR register is 0x0000.00FF for all GPIO pins, with the exception of the NMI pin and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]). To ensure that the JTAG port is not accidentally programmed as GPIO pins, the PC[3:0] pins default to non-committable. Similarly, to ensure that the NMI pin is not accidentally programmed as a GPIO pin, the PB7 pin defaults to non-committable. Because of this, the default reset value of GPIOCR for GPIO Port B is 0x0000.007F while the default reset value of GPIOCR for Port C is 0x0000.00F0. Table 9-7. GPIO Register Map Description See page Offset Name Type Reset 0x000 GPIODATA R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Data 413 0x400 GPIODIR R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Direction 414 0x404 GPIOIS R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Interrupt Sense 415 410 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 9-7. GPIO Register Map (continued) Description See page Offset Name Type Reset 0x408 GPIOIBE R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Interrupt Both Edges 416 0x40C GPIOIEV R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Interrupt Event 417 0x410 GPIOIM R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Interrupt Mask 418 0x414 GPIORIS RO 0x0000.0000 GPIO Raw Interrupt Status 419 0x418 GPIOMIS RO 0x0000.0000 GPIO Masked Interrupt Status 420 0x41C GPIOICR W1C 0x0000.0000 GPIO Interrupt Clear 422 0x420 GPIOAFSEL R/W - GPIO Alternate Function Select 423 0x500 GPIODR2R R/W 0x0000.00FF GPIO 2-mA Drive Select 425 0x504 GPIODR4R R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO 4-mA Drive Select 426 0x508 GPIODR8R R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO 8-mA Drive Select 427 0x50C GPIOODR R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Open Drain Select 428 0x510 GPIOPUR R/W - GPIO Pull-Up Select 429 0x514 GPIOPDR R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Pull-Down Select 431 0x518 GPIOSLR R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Slew Rate Control Select 433 0x51C GPIODEN R/W - GPIO Digital Enable 434 0x520 GPIOLOCK R/W 0x0000.0001 GPIO Lock 436 0x524 GPIOCR - - GPIO Commit 437 0x528 GPIOAMSEL R/W 0x0000.0000 GPIO Analog Mode Select 439 0x52C GPIOPCTL R/W - GPIO Port Control 441 0xFD0 GPIOPeriphID4 RO 0x0000.0000 GPIO Peripheral Identification 4 443 0xFD4 GPIOPeriphID5 RO 0x0000.0000 GPIO Peripheral Identification 5 444 0xFD8 GPIOPeriphID6 RO 0x0000.0000 GPIO Peripheral Identification 6 445 0xFDC GPIOPeriphID7 RO 0x0000.0000 GPIO Peripheral Identification 7 446 0xFE0 GPIOPeriphID0 RO 0x0000.0061 GPIO Peripheral Identification 0 447 0xFE4 GPIOPeriphID1 RO 0x0000.0000 GPIO Peripheral Identification 1 448 0xFE8 GPIOPeriphID2 RO 0x0000.0018 GPIO Peripheral Identification 2 449 0xFEC GPIOPeriphID3 RO 0x0000.0001 GPIO Peripheral Identification 3 450 0xFF0 GPIOPCellID0 RO 0x0000.000D GPIO PrimeCell Identification 0 451 0xFF4 GPIOPCellID1 RO 0x0000.00F0 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 1 452 0xFF8 GPIOPCellID2 RO 0x0000.0005 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 2 453 0xFFC GPIOPCellID3 RO 0x0000.00B1 GPIO PrimeCell Identification 3 454 January 22, 2012 411 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) 9.5 Register Descriptions The remainder of this section lists and describes the GPIO registers, in numerical order by address offset. 412 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 1: GPIO Data (GPIODATA), offset 0x000 The GPIODATA register is the data register. In software control mode, values written in the GPIODATA register are transferred onto the GPIO port pins if the respective pins have been configured as outputs through the GPIO Direction (GPIODIR) register (see page 414). In order to write to GPIODATA, the corresponding bits in the mask, resulting from the address bus bits [9:2], must be set. Otherwise, the bit values remain unchanged by the write. Similarly, the values read from this register are determined for each bit by the mask bit derived from the address used to access the data register, bits [9:2]. Bits that are set in the address mask cause the corresponding bits in GPIODATA to be read, and bits that are clear in the address mask cause the corresponding bits in GPIODATA to be read as 0, regardless of their value. A read from GPIODATA returns the last bit value written if the respective pins are configured as outputs, or it returns the value on the corresponding input pin when these are configured as inputs. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Data (GPIODATA) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x000 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset DATA RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 DATA R/W 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Data This register is virtually mapped to 256 locations in the address space. To facilitate the reading and writing of data to these registers by independent drivers, the data read from and written to the registers are masked by the eight address lines [9:2]. Reads from this register return its current state. Writes to this register only affect bits that are not masked by ADDR[9:2] and are configured as outputs. See “Data Register Operation” on page 406 for examples of reads and writes. January 22, 2012 413 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 2: GPIO Direction (GPIODIR), offset 0x400 The GPIODIR register is the data direction register. Setting a bit in the GPIODIR register configures the corresponding pin to be an output, while clearing a bit configures the corresponding pin to be an input. All bits are cleared by a reset, meaning all GPIO pins are inputs by default. GPIO Direction (GPIODIR) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x400 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 DIR RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 DIR R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Data Direction Value Description 0 Corresponding pin is an input. 1 Corresponding pins is an output. 414 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 3: GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS), offset 0x404 The GPIOIS register is the interrupt sense register. Setting a bit in the GPIOIS register configures the corresponding pin to detect levels, while clearing a bit configures the corresponding pin to detect edges. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x404 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 IS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 IS R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Sense Value Description 0 The edge on the corresponding pin is detected (edge-sensitive). 1 The level on the corresponding pin is detected (level-sensitive). January 22, 2012 415 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 4: GPIO Interrupt Both Edges (GPIOIBE), offset 0x408 The GPIOIBE register allows both edges to cause interrupts. When the corresponding bit in the GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS) register (see page 415) is set to detect edges, setting a bit in the GPIOIBE register configures the corresponding pin to detect both rising and falling edges, regardless of the corresponding bit in the GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV) register (see page 417). Clearing a bit configures the pin to be controlled by the GPIOIEV register. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Interrupt Both Edges (GPIOIBE) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x408 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 IBE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 IBE R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Both Edges Value Description 0 Interrupt generation is controlled by the GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV) register (see page 417). 1 Both edges on the corresponding pin trigger an interrupt. 416 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 5: GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV), offset 0x40C The GPIOIEV register is the interrupt event register. Setting a bit in the GPIOIEV register configures the corresponding pin to detect rising edges or high levels, depending on the corresponding bit value in the GPIO Interrupt Sense (GPIOIS) register (see page 415). Clearing a bit configures the pin to detect falling edges or low levels, depending on the corresponding bit value in the GPIOIS register. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Interrupt Event (GPIOIEV) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x40C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 IEV RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 IEV R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Event Value Description 0 A falling edge or a Low level on the corresponding pin triggers an interrupt. 1 A rising edge or a High level on the corresponding pin triggers an interrupt. January 22, 2012 417 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 6: GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM), offset 0x410 The GPIOIM register is the interrupt mask register. Setting a bit in the GPIOIM register allows interrupts that are generated by the corresponding pin to be sent to the interrupt controller on the combined interrupt signal. Clearing a bit prevents an interrupt on the corresponding pin from being sent to the interrupt controller. All bits are cleared by a reset. GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x410 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 IME RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0 7:0 IME R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Mask Enable Value Description 0 The interrupt from the corresponding pin is masked. 1 The interrupt from the corresponding pin is sent to the interrupt controller. 418 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 7: GPIO Raw Interrupt Status (GPIORIS), offset 0x414 The GPIORIS register is the raw interrupt status register. A bit in this register is set when an interrupt condition occurs on the corresponding GPIO pin. If the corresponding bit in the GPIO Interrupt Mask (GPIOIM) register (see page 418) is set, the interrupt is sent to the interrupt controller. Bits read as zero indicate that corresponding input pins have not initiated an interrupt. A bit in this register can be cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit in the GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR) register. GPIO Raw Interrupt Status (GPIORIS) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x414 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0 7:0 RIS RO 0x00 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Raw Status Value Description 1 An interrupt condition has occurred on the corresponding pin. 0 An interrupt condition has not occurred on the corresponding pin. A bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit in the GPIOICR register. January 22, 2012 419 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 8: GPIO Masked Interrupt Status (GPIOMIS), offset 0x418 The GPIOMIS register is the masked interrupt status register. If a bit is set in this register, the corresponding interrupt has triggered an interrupt to the interrupt controller. If a bit is clear, either no interrupt has been generated, or the interrupt is masked. In addition to providing GPIO functionality, PB4 can also be used as an external trigger for the ADC. If PB4 is configured as a non-masked interrupt pin (the appropriate bit of GPIOIM is set), an interrupt for Port B is generated, and an external trigger signal is sent to the ADC. If the ADC Event Multiplexer Select (ADCEMUX) register is configured to use the external trigger, an ADC conversion is initiated. See page 633. If no other Port B pins are being used to generate interrupts, the Interrupt 0-31 Set Enable (EN0) register can disable the Port B interrupts, and the ADC interrupt can be used to read back the converted data. Otherwise, the Port B interrupt handler must ignore and clear interrupts on PB4 and wait for the ADC interrupt, or the ADC interrupt must be disabled in the EN0 register and the Port B interrupt handler must poll the ADC registers until the conversion is completed. See page 110 for more information. GPIOMIS is the state of the interrupt after masking. GPIO Masked Interrupt Status (GPIOMIS) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x418 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 MIS RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. 420 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 7:0 MIS RO 0x00 GPIO Masked Interrupt Status Value Description 1 An interrupt condition on the corresponding pin has triggered an interrupt to the interrupt controller. 0 An interrupt condition on the corresponding pin is masked or has not occurred. A bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding bit in the GPIOICR register. January 22, 2012 421 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 9: GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR), offset 0x41C The GPIOICR register is the interrupt clear register. Writing a 1 to a bit in this register clears the corresponding interrupt bit in the GPIORIS and GPIOMIS registers. Writing a 0 has no effect. GPIO Interrupt Clear (GPIOICR) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x41C Type W1C, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 IC RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0 7:0 IC W1C 0x00 RO 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 W1C 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Interrupt Clear Value Description 1 The corresponding interrupt is cleared. 0 The corresponding interrupt is unaffected. 422 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 10: GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL), offset 0x420 The GPIOAFSEL register is the mode control select register. If a bit is clear, the pin is used as a GPIO and is controlled by the GPIO registers. Setting a bit in this register configures the corresponding GPIO line to be controlled by an associated peripheral. Several possible peripheral functions are multiplexed on each GPIO. The GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL) register is used to select one of the possible functions. Table 19-5 on page 859 details which functions are muxed on each GPIO pin. The reset value for this register is 0x0000.0000 for GPIO ports that are not listed in the table below. Important: All GPIO pins are configured as GPIOs and tri-stated by default (GPIOAFSEL=0, GPIODEN=0, GPIOPDR=0, GPIOPUR=0, and GPIOPCTL=0, with the exception of the pins shown in the table below. A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting RST puts the pins back to their default state. Table 9-8. GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values GPIO Pins Default State PA[1:0] UART0 GPIOAFSEL GPIODEN GPIOPDR GPIOPUR 0 0 0 0 GPIOPCTL 0x1 PA[5:2] SSI0 0 0 0 0 0x2 PB[3:2] I2C0 0 0 0 0 0x3 PC[3:0] JTAG/SWD 1 1 0 1 0x1 Caution – It is possible to create a software sequence that prevents the debugger from connecting to the Stellaris microcontroller. If the program code loaded into flash immediately changes the JTAG pins to their GPIO functionality, the debugger may not have enough time to connect and halt the controller before the JTAG pin functionality switches. As a result, the debugger may be locked out of the part. This issue can be avoided with a software routine that restores JTAG functionality based on an external or software trigger. The GPIO commit control registers provide a layer of protection against accidental programming of critical hardware peripherals. Protection is provided for the NMI pin (PB7) and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PC[3:0]). Writes to protected bits of the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (see page 423), GPIO Pull Up Select (GPIOPUR) register (see page 429), GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register (see page 431), and GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register (see page 434) are not committed to storage unless the GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK) register (see page 436) has been unlocked and the appropriate bits of the GPIO Commit (GPIOCR) register (see page 437) have been set. When using the I2C module, in addition to setting the GPIOAFSEL register bits for the I2C clock and data pins, the data pins should be set to open drain using the GPIO Open Drain Select (GPIOODR) register (see examples in “Initialization and Configuration” on page 408). January 22, 2012 423 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x420 Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 AFSEL RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 AFSEL R/W - RO 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Alternate Function Select Value Description 0 The associated pin functions as a GPIO and is controlled by the GPIO registers. 1 The associated pin functions as a peripheral signal and is controlled by the alternate hardware function. The reset value for this register is 0x0000.0000 for GPIO ports that are not listed in Table 9-1 on page 400. 424 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 11: GPIO 2-mA Drive Select (GPIODR2R), offset 0x500 The GPIODR2R register is the 2-mA drive control register. Each GPIO signal in the port can be individually configured without affecting the other pads. When setting the DRV2 bit for a GPIO signal, the corresponding DRV4 bit in the GPIODR4R register and DRV8 bit in the GPIODR8R register are automatically cleared by hardware. By default, all GPIO pins have 2-mA drive. GPIO 2-mA Drive Select (GPIODR2R) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x500 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.00FF 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 DRV2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 DRV2 R/W 0xFF RO 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Output Pad 2-mA Drive Enable Value Description 1 The corresponding GPIO pin has 2-mA drive. 0 The drive for the corresponding GPIO pin is controlled by the GPIODR4R or GPIODR8R register. Setting a bit in either the GPIODR4 register or the GPIODR8 register clears the corresponding 2-mA enable bit. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write if accessing GPIO via the APB memory aperture. If using AHB access, the change is effective on the next clock cycle. January 22, 2012 425 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 12: GPIO 4-mA Drive Select (GPIODR4R), offset 0x504 The GPIODR4R register is the 4-mA drive control register. Each GPIO signal in the port can be individually configured without affecting the other pads. When setting the DRV4 bit for a GPIO signal, the corresponding DRV2 bit in the GPIODR2R register and DRV8 bit in the GPIODR8R register are automatically cleared by hardware. GPIO 4-mA Drive Select (GPIODR4R) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x504 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 DRV4 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 DRV4 R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Output Pad 4-mA Drive Enable Value Description 1 The corresponding GPIO pin has 4-mA drive. 0 The drive for the corresponding GPIO pin is controlled by the GPIODR2R or GPIODR8R register. Setting a bit in either the GPIODR2 register or the GPIODR8 register clears the corresponding 4-mA enable bit. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write if accessing GPIO via the APB memory aperture. If using AHB access, the change is effective on the next clock cycle. 426 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 13: GPIO 8-mA Drive Select (GPIODR8R), offset 0x508 The GPIODR8R register is the 8-mA drive control register. Each GPIO signal in the port can be individually configured without affecting the other pads. When setting the DRV8 bit for a GPIO signal, the corresponding DRV2 bit in the GPIODR2R register and DRV4 bit in the GPIODR4R register are automatically cleared by hardware. The 8-mA setting is also used for high-current operation. Note: There is no configuration difference between 8-mA and high-current operation. The additional current capacity results from a shift in the VOH/VOL levels. See “Recommended Operating Conditions” on page 894 for further information. GPIO 8-mA Drive Select (GPIODR8R) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x508 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 DRV8 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 DRV8 R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Output Pad 8-mA Drive Enable Value Description 1 The corresponding GPIO pin has 8-mA drive. 0 The drive for the corresponding GPIO pin is controlled by the GPIODR2R or GPIODR4R register. Setting a bit in either the GPIODR2 register or the GPIODR4 register clears the corresponding 8-mA enable bit. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write if accessing GPIO via the APB memory aperture. If using AHB access, the change is effective on the next clock cycle. January 22, 2012 427 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 14: GPIO Open Drain Select (GPIOODR), offset 0x50C The GPIOODR register is the open drain control register. Setting a bit in this register enables the open-drain configuration of the corresponding GPIO pad. When open-drain mode is enabled, the corresponding bit should also be set in the GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register (see page 434). Corresponding bits in the drive strength and slew rate control registers (GPIODR2R, GPIODR4R, GPIODR8R, and GPIOSLR) can be set to achieve the desired rise and fall times. The GPIO acts as an input if the corresponding bit in the GPIODIR register is cleared. If open drain is selected while the GPIO is configured as an input, the GPIO will remain an input and the open-drain selection has no effect until the GPIO is changed to an output. When using the I2C module, in addition to configuring the pin to open drain, the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register bits for the I2C clock and data pins should be set (see examples in “Initialization and Configuration” on page 408). GPIO Open Drain Select (GPIOODR) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x50C Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 ODE RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 ODE R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Output Pad Open Drain Enable Value Description 1 The corresponding pin is configured as open drain. 0 The corresponding pin is not configured as open drain. 428 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 15: GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR), offset 0x510 The GPIOPUR register is the pull-up control register. When a bit is set, a weak pull-up resistor on the corresponding GPIO signal is enabled. Setting a bit in GPIOPUR automatically clears the corresponding bit in the GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register (see page 431). Write access to this register is protected with the GPIOCR register. Bits in GPIOCR that are cleared prevent writes to the equivalent bit in this register. Important: All GPIO pins are configured as GPIOs and tri-stated by default (GPIOAFSEL=0, GPIODEN=0, GPIOPDR=0, GPIOPUR=0, and GPIOPCTL=0, with the exception of the pins shown in the table below. A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting RST puts the pins back to their default state. Table 9-9. GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values Note: GPIO Pins Default State PA[1:0] UART0 GPIOAFSEL GPIODEN GPIOPDR GPIOPUR 0 0 0 GPIOPCTL 0 0x1 PA[5:2] SSI0 0 0 0 0 0x2 PB[3:2] I2C0 0 0 0 0 0x3 PC[3:0] JTAG/SWD 1 1 0 1 0x1 The GPIO commit control registers provide a layer of protection against accidental programming of critical hardware peripherals. Protection is provided for the NMI pin (PB7) and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PC[3:0]). Writes to protected bits of the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (see page 423), GPIO Pull Up Select (GPIOPUR) register (see page 429), GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register (see page 431), and GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register (see page 434) are not committed to storage unless the GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK) register (see page 436) has been unlocked and the appropriate bits of the GPIO Commit (GPIOCR) register (see page 437) have been set. GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x510 Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 PUE January 22, 2012 429 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PUE R/W - Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Pad Weak Pull-Up Enable Value Description 1 The corresponding pin has a weak pull-up resistor. 0 The corresponding pin is not affected. Setting a bit in the GPIOPDR register clears the corresponding bit in the GPIOPUR register. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write if accessing GPIO via the APB memory aperture. If using AHB access, the change is effective on the next clock cycle. The reset value for this register is 0x0000.0000 for GPIO ports that are not listed in Table 9-1 on page 400. 430 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 16: GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR), offset 0x514 The GPIOPDR register is the pull-down control register. When a bit is set, a weak pull-down resistor on the corresponding GPIO signal is enabled. Setting a bit in GPIOPDR automatically clears the corresponding bit in the GPIO Pull-Up Select (GPIOPUR) register (see page 429). Important: All GPIO pins are configured as GPIOs and tri-stated by default (GPIOAFSEL=0, GPIODEN=0, GPIOPDR=0, GPIOPUR=0, and GPIOPCTL=0, with the exception of the pins shown in the table below. A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting RST puts the pins back to their default state. Table 9-10. GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values Note: GPIO Pins Default State PA[1:0] UART0 GPIOAFSEL GPIODEN GPIOPDR GPIOPUR 0 0 0 GPIOPCTL 0 0x1 PA[5:2] SSI0 0 0 0 0 0x2 PB[3:2] I2C0 0 0 0 0 0x3 PC[3:0] JTAG/SWD 1 1 0 1 0x1 The GPIO commit control registers provide a layer of protection against accidental programming of critical hardware peripherals. Protection is provided for the NMI pin (PB7) and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PC[3:0]). Writes to protected bits of the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (see page 423), GPIO Pull Up Select (GPIOPUR) register (see page 429), GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register (see page 431), and GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register (see page 434) are not committed to storage unless the GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK) register (see page 436) has been unlocked and the appropriate bits of the GPIO Commit (GPIOCR) register (see page 437) have been set. GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x514 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 PDE January 22, 2012 431 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PDE R/W 0x00 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Pad Weak Pull-Down Enable Value Description 1 The corresponding pin has a weak pull-down resistor. 0 The corresponding pin is not affected. Setting a bit in the GPIOPUR register clears the corresponding bit in the GPIOPDR register. The change is effective on the second clock cycle after the write if accessing GPIO via the APB memory aperture. If using AHB access, the change is effective on the next clock cycle. 432 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 17: GPIO Slew Rate Control Select (GPIOSLR), offset 0x518 The GPIOSLR register is the slew rate control register. Slew rate control is only available when using the 8-mA drive strength option via the GPIO 8-mA Drive Select (GPIODR8R) register (see page 427). GPIO Slew Rate Control Select (GPIOSLR) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x518 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 SRL RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 SRL R/W 0x00 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Slew Rate Limit Enable (8-mA drive only) Value Description 1 Slew rate control is enabled for the corresponding pin. 0 Slew rate control is disabled for the corresponding pin. January 22, 2012 433 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 18: GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN), offset 0x51C Note: Pins configured as digital inputs are Schmitt-triggered. The GPIODEN register is the digital enable register. By default, all GPIO signals except those listed below are configured out of reset to be undriven (tristate). Their digital function is disabled; they do not drive a logic value on the pin and they do not allow the pin voltage into the GPIO receiver. To use the pin as a digital input or output (either GPIO or alternate function), the corresponding GPIODEN bit must be set. Important: All GPIO pins are configured as GPIOs and tri-stated by default (GPIOAFSEL=0, GPIODEN=0, GPIOPDR=0, GPIOPUR=0, and GPIOPCTL=0, with the exception of the pins shown in the table below. A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting RST puts the pins back to their default state. Table 9-11. GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values Note: GPIO Pins Default State GPIOAFSEL GPIODEN GPIOPDR GPIOPUR GPIOPCTL PA[1:0] UART0 0 0 0 0 0x1 PA[5:2] SSI0 0 0 0 0 0x2 PB[3:2] I2C0 0 0 0 0 0x3 PC[3:0] JTAG/SWD 1 1 0 1 0x1 The GPIO commit control registers provide a layer of protection against accidental programming of critical hardware peripherals. Protection is provided for the NMI pin (PB7) and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PC[3:0]). Writes to protected bits of the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (see page 423), GPIO Pull Up Select (GPIOPUR) register (see page 429), GPIO Pull-Down Select (GPIOPDR) register (see page 431), and GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) register (see page 434) are not committed to storage unless the GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK) register (see page 436) has been unlocked and the appropriate bits of the GPIO Commit (GPIOCR) register (see page 437) have been set. 434 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller GPIO Digital Enable (GPIODEN) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x51C Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 DEN RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 DEN R/W - RO 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. Digital Enable Value Description 0 The digital functions for the corresponding pin are disabled. 1 The digital functions for the corresponding pin are enabled. The reset value for this register is 0x0000.0000 for GPIO ports that are not listed in Table 9-1 on page 400. January 22, 2012 435 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 19: GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK), offset 0x520 The GPIOLOCK register enables write access to the GPIOCR register (see page 437). Writing 0x4C4F.434B to the GPIOLOCK register unlocks the GPIOCR register. Writing any other value to the GPIOLOCK register re-enables the locked state. Reading the GPIOLOCK register returns the lock status rather than the 32-bit value that was previously written. Therefore, when write accesses are disabled, or locked, reading the GPIOLOCK register returns 0x0000.0001. When write accesses are enabled, or unlocked, reading the GPIOLOCK register returns 0x0000.0000. GPIO Lock (GPIOLOCK) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x520 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0001 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 LOCK Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 LOCK Type Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit/Field Name Type 31:0 LOCK R/W R/W 0 Reset R/W 0 Description 0x0000.0001 GPIO Lock A write of the value 0x4C4F.434B unlocks the GPIO Commit (GPIOCR) register for write access.A write of any other value or a write to the GPIOCR register reapplies the lock, preventing any register updates. A read of this register returns the following values: Value Description 0x1 The GPIOCR register is locked and may not be modified. 0x0 The GPIOCR register is unlocked and may be modified. 436 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 20: GPIO Commit (GPIOCR), offset 0x524 The GPIOCR register is the commit register. The value of the GPIOCR register determines which bits of the GPIOAFSEL, GPIOPUR, GPIOPDR, and GPIODEN registers are committed when a write to these registers is performed. If a bit in the GPIOCR register is cleared, the data being written to the corresponding bit in the GPIOAFSEL, GPIOPUR, GPIOPDR, or GPIODEN registers cannot be committed and retains its previous value. If a bit in the GPIOCR register is set, the data being written to the corresponding bit of the GPIOAFSEL, GPIOPUR, GPIOPDR, or GPIODEN registers is committed to the register and reflects the new value. The contents of the GPIOCR register can only be modified if the status in the GPIOLOCK register is unlocked. Writes to the GPIOCR register are ignored if the status in the GPIOLOCK register is locked. Important: This register is designed to prevent accidental programming of the registers that control connectivity to the NMI and JTAG/SWD debug hardware. By initializing the bits of the GPIOCR register to 0 for PB7 and PC[3:0], the NMI and JTAG/SWD debug port can only be converted to GPIOs through a deliberate set of writes to the GPIOLOCK, GPIOCR, and the corresponding registers. Because this protection is currently only implemented on the NMI and JTAG/SWD pins on PB7 and PC[3:0], all of the other bits in the GPIOCR registers cannot be written with 0x0. These bits are hardwired to 0x1, ensuring that it is always possible to commit new values to the GPIOAFSEL, GPIOPUR, GPIOPDR, or GPIODEN register bits of these other pins. GPIO Commit (GPIOCR) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x524 Type -, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 - - - - - - - - reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset RO 0 CR January 22, 2012 437 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 CR - - Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Commit Value Description 1 The corresponding GPIOAFSEL, GPIOPUR, GPIOPDR, or GPIODEN bits can be written. 0 The corresponding GPIOAFSEL, GPIOPUR, GPIOPDR, or GPIODEN bits cannot be written. Note: The default register type for the GPIOCR register is RO for all GPIO pins with the exception of the NMI pin and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]). These five pins are the only GPIOs that are protected by the GPIOCR register. Because of this, the register type for GPIO Port B7 and GPIO Port C[3:0] is R/W. The default reset value for the GPIOCR register is 0x0000.00FF for all GPIO pins, with the exception of the NMI pin and the four JTAG/SWD pins (PB7 and PC[3:0]). To ensure that the JTAG port is not accidentally programmed as GPIO pins, the PC[3:0] pins default to non-committable. Similarly, to ensure that the NMI pin is not accidentally programmed as a GPIO pin, the PB7 pin defaults to non-committable. Because of this, the default reset value of GPIOCR for GPIO Port B is 0x0000.007F while the default reset value of GPIOCR for Port C is 0x0000.00F0. 438 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 21: GPIO Analog Mode Select (GPIOAMSEL), offset 0x528 Important: This register is only valid for ports D and E; the corresponding base addresses for the remaining ports are not valid. If any pin is to be used as an ADC input, the appropriate bit in GPIOAMSEL must be set to disable the analog isolation circuit. The GPIOAMSEL register controls isolation circuits to the analog side of a unified I/O pad. Because the GPIOs may be driven by a 5-V source and affect analog operation, analog circuitry requires isolation from the pins when they are not used in their analog function. Each bit of this register controls the isolation circuitry for the corresponding GPIO signal. For information on which GPIO pins can be used for ADC functions, refer to Table 19-5 on page 859. GPIO Analog Mode Select (GPIOAMSEL) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x528 Type R/W, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RO 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 reserved Type Reset reserved Type Reset GPIOAMSEL RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 R/W 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. January 22, 2012 439 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Bit/Field Name Type Reset Description 7:0 GPIOAMSEL R/W 0x00 GPIO Analog Mode Select Value Description 1 The analog function of the pin is enabled, the isolation is disabled, and the pin is capable of analog functions. 0 The analog function of the pin is disabled, the isolation is enabled, and the pin is capable of digital functions as specified by the other GPIO configuration registers. Note: This register and bits are only valid for GPIO signals that share analog function through a unified I/O pad. The reset state of this register is 0 for all signals. 440 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 22: GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL), offset 0x52C The GPIOPCTL register is used in conjunction with the GPIOAFSEL register and selects the specific peripheral signal for each GPIO pin when using the alternate function mode. Most bits in the GPIOAFSEL register are cleared on reset, therefore most GPIO pins are configured as GPIOs by default. When a bit is set in the GPIOAFSEL register, the corresponding GPIO signal is controlled by an associated peripheral. The GPIOPCTL register selects one out of a set of peripheral functions for each GPIO, providing additional flexibility in signal definition. For information on the defined encodings for the bit fields in this register, refer to Table 19-5 on page 859. The reset value for this register is 0x0000.0000 for GPIO ports that are not listed in the table below. Note: If the same signal is assigned to two different GPIO port pins, the signal is assigned to the port with the lowest letter and the assignment to the higher letter port is ignored. Important: All GPIO pins are configured as GPIOs and tri-stated by default (GPIOAFSEL=0, GPIODEN=0, GPIOPDR=0, GPIOPUR=0, and GPIOPCTL=0, with the exception of the pins shown in the table below. A Power-On-Reset (POR) or asserting RST puts the pins back to their default state. Table 9-12. GPIO Pins With Non-Zero Reset Values GPIO Pins Default State GPIOAFSEL GPIODEN GPIOPDR GPIOPUR GPIOPCTL PA[1:0] UART0 0 0 0 0 0x1 PA[5:2] SSI0 0 0 0 0 0x2 PB[3:2] I2C0 0 0 0 0 0x3 PC[3:0] JTAG/SWD 1 1 0 1 0x1 GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0x52C Type R/W, reset 31 30 29 28 27 26 R/W - 25 24 23 22 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - PMC7 Type Reset 20 19 18 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - 7 6 5 4 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - PMC6 PMC3 Type Reset 21 17 16 R/W - R/W - R/W - 3 2 1 0 R/W - R/W - R/W - R/W - PMC5 PMC2 PMC4 PMC1 PMC0 January 22, 2012 441 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:28 PMC7 R/W - Description Port Mux Control 7 This field controls the configuration for GPIO pin 7. 27:24 PMC6 R/W - Port Mux Control 6 This field controls the configuration for GPIO pin 6. 23:20 PMC5 R/W - Port Mux Control 5 This field controls the configuration for GPIO pin 5. 19:16 PMC4 R/W - Port Mux Control 4 This field controls the configuration for GPIO pin 4. 15:12 PMC3 R/W - Port Mux Control 3 This field controls the configuration for GPIO pin 3. 11:8 PMC2 R/W - Port Mux Control 2 This field controls the configuration for GPIO pin 2. 7:4 PMC1 R/W - Port Mux Control 1 This field controls the configuration for GPIO pin 1. 3:0 PMC0 R/W - Port Mux Control 0 This field controls the configuration for GPIO pin 0. 442 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 23: GPIO Peripheral Identification 4 (GPIOPeriphID4), offset 0xFD0 The GPIOPeriphID4, GPIOPeriphID5, GPIOPeriphID6, and GPIOPeriphID7 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 4 (GPIOPeriphID4) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFD0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PID4 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID4 RO 0x00 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register [7:0] January 22, 2012 443 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 24: GPIO Peripheral Identification 5 (GPIOPeriphID5), offset 0xFD4 The GPIOPeriphID4, GPIOPeriphID5, GPIOPeriphID6, and GPIOPeriphID7 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 5 (GPIOPeriphID5) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFD4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PID5 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID5 RO 0x00 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register [15:8] 444 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 25: GPIO Peripheral Identification 6 (GPIOPeriphID6), offset 0xFD8 The GPIOPeriphID4, GPIOPeriphID5, GPIOPeriphID6, and GPIOPeriphID7 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 6 (GPIOPeriphID6) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFD8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PID6 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID6 RO 0x00 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register [23:16] January 22, 2012 445 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 26: GPIO Peripheral Identification 7 (GPIOPeriphID7), offset 0xFDC The GPIOPeriphID4, GPIOPeriphID5, GPIOPeriphID6, and GPIOPeriphID7 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 7 (GPIOPeriphID7) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFDC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PID7 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID7 RO 0x00 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register [31:24] 446 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 27: GPIO Peripheral Identification 0 (GPIOPeriphID0), offset 0xFE0 The GPIOPeriphID0, GPIOPeriphID1, GPIOPeriphID2, and GPIOPeriphID3 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 0 (GPIOPeriphID0) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFE0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0061 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID0 RO 0x61 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register [7:0] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. January 22, 2012 447 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 28: GPIO Peripheral Identification 1 (GPIOPeriphID1), offset 0xFE4 The GPIOPeriphID0, GPIOPeriphID1, GPIOPeriphID2, and GPIOPeriphID3 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 1 (GPIOPeriphID1) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFE4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0000 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID1 RO 0x00 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register [15:8] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 448 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 29: GPIO Peripheral Identification 2 (GPIOPeriphID2), offset 0xFE8 The GPIOPeriphID0, GPIOPeriphID1, GPIOPeriphID2, and GPIOPeriphID3 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 2 (GPIOPeriphID2) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFE8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0018 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID2 RO 0x18 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register [23:16] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. January 22, 2012 449 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 30: GPIO Peripheral Identification 3 (GPIOPeriphID3), offset 0xFEC The GPIOPeriphID0, GPIOPeriphID1, GPIOPeriphID2, and GPIOPeriphID3 registers can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register; each register contains eight bits of the 32-bit register, used by software to identify the peripheral. GPIO Peripheral Identification 3 (GPIOPeriphID3) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFEC Type RO, reset 0x0000.0001 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 PID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 PID3 RO 0x01 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO Peripheral ID Register [31:24] Can be used by software to identify the presence of this peripheral. 450 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 31: GPIO PrimeCell Identification 0 (GPIOPCellID0), offset 0xFF0 The GPIOPCellID0, GPIOPCellID1, GPIOPCellID2, and GPIOPCellID3 registers are four 8-bit wide registers, that can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register. The register is used as a standard cross-peripheral identification system. GPIO PrimeCell Identification 0 (GPIOPCellID0) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFF0 Type RO, reset 0x0000.000D 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 CID0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 CID0 RO 0x0D RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO PrimeCell ID Register [7:0] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. January 22, 2012 451 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 32: GPIO PrimeCell Identification 1 (GPIOPCellID1), offset 0xFF4 The GPIOPCellID0, GPIOPCellID1, GPIOPCellID2, and GPIOPCellID3 registers are four 8-bit wide registers, that can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register. The register is used as a standard cross-peripheral identification system. GPIO PrimeCell Identification 1 (GPIOPCellID1) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFF4 Type RO, reset 0x0000.00F0 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 CID1 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 CID1 RO 0xF0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 RO 1 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO PrimeCell ID Register [15:8] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 452 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Register 33: GPIO PrimeCell Identification 2 (GPIOPCellID2), offset 0xFF8 The GPIOPCellID0, GPIOPCellID1, GPIOPCellID2, and GPIOPCellID3 registers are four 8-bit wide registers, that can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register. The register is used as a standard cross-peripheral identification system. GPIO PrimeCell Identification 2 (GPIOPCellID2) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFF8 Type RO, reset 0x0000.0005 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 CID2 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 CID2 RO 0x05 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO PrimeCell ID Register [23:16] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. January 22, 2012 453 Texas Instruments-Production Data General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) Register 34: GPIO PrimeCell Identification 3 (GPIOPCellID3), offset 0xFFC The GPIOPCellID0, GPIOPCellID1, GPIOPCellID2, and GPIOPCellID3 registers are four 8-bit wide registers, that can conceptually be treated as one 32-bit register. The register is used as a standard cross-peripheral identification system. GPIO PrimeCell Identification 3 (GPIOPCellID3) GPIO Port A (APB) base: 0x4000.4000 GPIO Port A (AHB) base: 0x4005.8000 GPIO Port B (APB) base: 0x4000.5000 GPIO Port B (AHB) base: 0x4005.9000 GPIO Port C (APB) base: 0x4000.6000 GPIO Port C (AHB) base: 0x4005.A000 GPIO Port D (APB) base: 0x4000.7000 GPIO Port D (AHB) base: 0x4005.B000 GPIO Port E (APB) base: 0x4002.4000 GPIO Port E (AHB) base: 0x4005.C000 GPIO Port F (APB) base: 0x4002.5000 GPIO Port F (AHB) base: 0x4005.D000 GPIO Port G (APB) base: 0x4002.6000 GPIO Port G (AHB) base: 0x4005.E000 GPIO Port H (APB) base: 0x4002.7000 GPIO Port H (AHB) base: 0x4005.F000 GPIO Port J (APB) base: 0x4003.D000 GPIO Port J (AHB) base: 0x4006.0000 Offset 0xFFC Type RO, reset 0x0000.00B1 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 3 2 1 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 1 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 reserved Type Reset RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 CID3 RO 0 RO 0 RO 0 Bit/Field Name Type Reset 31:8 reserved RO 0x0000.00 7:0 CID3 RO 0xB1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 0 RO 1 RO 1 Description Software should not rely on the value of a reserved bit. To provide compatibility with future products, the value of a reserved bit should be preserved across a read-modify-write operation. GPIO PrimeCell ID Register [31:24] Provides software a standard cross-peripheral identification system. 454 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller 10 External Peripheral Interface (EPI) The External Peripheral Interface is a high-speed parallel bus for external peripherals or memory. It has several modes of operation to interface gluelessly to many types of external devices. The External Peripheral Interface is similar to a standard microprocessor address/data bus, except that it must typically be connected to just one type of external device. Enhanced capabilities include µDMA support, clocking control and support for external FIFO buffers. The EPI has the following features: ■ 8/16/32-bit dedicated parallel bus for external peripherals and memory ■ Memory interface supports contiguous memory access independent of data bus width, thus enabling code execution directly from SDRAM, SRAM and Flash memory ■ Blocking and non-blocking reads ■ Separates processor from timing details through use of an internal write FIFO ■ Efficient transfers using Micro Direct Memory Access Controller (µDMA) – Separate channels for read and write – Read channel request asserted by programmable levels on the internal non-blocking read FIFO (NBRFIFO) – Write channel request asserted by empty on the internal write FIFO (WFIFO) The EPI supports three primary functional modes: Synchronous Dynamic Random Access Memory (SDRAM) mode, Traditional Host-Bus mode, and General-Purpose mode. The EPI module also provides custom GPIOs; however, unlike regular GPIOs, the EPI module uses a FIFO in the same way as a communication mechanism and is speed-controlled using clocking. ■ Synchronous Dynamic Random Access Memory (SDRAM) mode – Supports x16 (single data rate) SDRAM at up to 50 MHz – Supports low-cost SDRAMs up to 64 MB (512 megabits) – Includes automatic refresh and access to all banks/rows – Includes a Sleep/Standby mode to keep contents active with minimal power draw – Multiplexed address/data interface for reduced pin count ■ Host-Bus mode – Traditional x8 and x16 MCU bus interface capabilities – Similar device compatibility options as PIC, ATmega, 8051, and others – Access to SRAM, NOR Flash memory, and other devices, with up to 1 MB of addressing in unmultiplexed mode and 256 MB in multiplexed mode (512 MB in Host-Bus 16 mode with no byte selects) January 22, 2012 455 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) – Support of both muxed and de-muxed address and data – Access to a range of devices supporting the non-address FIFO x8 and x16 interface variant, with support for external FIFO (XFIFO) EMPTY and FULL signals – Speed controlled, with read and write data wait-state counters – Chip select modes include ALE, CSn, Dual CSn and ALE with dual CSn – Manual chip-enable (or use extra address pins) ■ General-Purpose mode – Wide parallel interfaces for fast communications with CPLDs and FPGAs – Data widths up to 32 bits – Data rates up to 150 MB/second – Optional "address" sizes from 4 bits to 20 bits – Optional clock output, read/write strobes, framing (with counter-based size), and clock-enable input ■ General parallel GPIO – 1 to 32 bits, FIFOed with speed control – Useful for custom peripherals or for digital data acquisition and actuator controls 10.1 EPI Block Diagram ® Figure 10-1 on page 457 provides a block diagram of a Stellaris EPI module. 456 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 10-1. EPI Block Diagram General Parallel GPIO NBRFIFO 8 x 32 bits WFIFO SDRAM 4 x 32 bits AHB Bus Interface With DMA AHB EPI 31:0 Host Bus Baud Rate Control (Clock) Wide Parallel Interface 10.2 Signal Description The following table lists the external signals of the EPI controller and describes the function of each. The EPI controller signals are alternate functions for GPIO signals and default to be GPIO signals at reset. The column in the table below titled "Pin Mux/Pin Assignment" lists the GPIO pin placement for the EPI signals. The AFSEL bit in the GPIO Alternate Function Select (GPIOAFSEL) register (page 423) should be set to choose the EPI controller function. The number in parentheses is the encoding that must be programmed into the PMCn field in the GPIO Port Control (GPIOPCTL) register (page 441) to assign the EPI signals to the specified GPIO port pins. For more information on configuring GPIOs, see “General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs)” on page 399. Table 10-1. External Peripheral Interface Signals (100LQFP) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment Pin Type a Buffer Type Description EPI0S0 83 PH3 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 0. EPI0S1 84 PH2 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 1. EPI0S2 25 PC4 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 2. EPI0S3 24 PC5 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 3. EPI0S4 23 PC6 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 4. EPI0S5 22 PC7 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 5. EPI0S6 86 PH0 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 6. EPI0S7 85 PH1 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 7. EPI0S8 74 PE0 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 8. EPI0S9 75 PE1 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 9. EPI0S10 76 PH4 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 10. January 22, 2012 457 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) Table 10-1. External Peripheral Interface Signals (100LQFP) (continued) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment a Pin Type Buffer Type Description EPI0S11 63 PH5 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 11. EPI0S12 42 58 PF7 (8) PF4 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 12. EPI0S13 19 PG0 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 13. EPI0S14 18 PG1 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 14. EPI0S15 41 46 PG4 (8) PF5 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 15. EPI0S16 14 PJ0 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 16. EPI0S17 87 PJ1 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 17. EPI0S18 39 PJ2 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 18. EPI0S19 97 PD4 (10) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 19. EPI0S20 12 PD2 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 20. EPI0S21 13 PD3 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 21. EPI0S22 91 PB5 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 22. EPI0S23 92 PB4 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 23. EPI0S24 95 PE2 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 24. EPI0S25 96 PE3 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 25. EPI0S26 62 PH6 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 26. EPI0S27 15 PH7 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 27. EPI0S28 98 PD5 (10) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 28. EPI0S29 99 PD6 (10) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 29. EPI0S30 100 PD7 (10) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 30. EPI0S31 36 PG7 (9) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 31. a. The TTL designation indicates the pin has TTL-compatible voltage levels. Table 10-2. External Peripheral Interface Signals (108BGA) Pin Name Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment EPI0S0 D10 PH3 (8) a Pin Type Buffer Type I/O TTL Description EPI module 0 signal 0. EPI0S1 D11 PH2 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 1. EPI0S2 L1 PC4 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 2. EPI0S3 M1 PC5 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 3. EPI0S4 M2 PC6 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 4. EPI0S5 L2 PC7 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 5. EPI0S6 C9 PH0 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 6. EPI0S7 C8 PH1 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 7. EPI0S8 B11 PE0 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 8. EPI0S9 A12 PE1 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 9. EPI0S10 B10 PH4 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 10. EPI0S11 F10 PH5 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 11. EPI0S12 K4 L9 PF7 (8) PF4 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 12. 458 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 10-2. External Peripheral Interface Signals (108BGA) (continued) Pin Name EPI0S13 Pin Number Pin Mux / Pin Assignment K1 PG0 (8) a Pin Type Buffer Type I/O TTL Description EPI module 0 signal 13. EPI0S14 K2 PG1 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 14. EPI0S15 K3 L8 PG4 (8) PF5 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 15. EPI0S16 F3 PJ0 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 16. EPI0S17 B6 PJ1 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 17. EPI0S18 K6 PJ2 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 18. EPI0S19 B5 PD4 (10) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 19. EPI0S20 H2 PD2 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 20. EPI0S21 H1 PD3 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 21. EPI0S22 B7 PB5 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 22. EPI0S23 A6 PB4 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 23. EPI0S24 A4 PE2 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 24. EPI0S25 B4 PE3 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 25. EPI0S26 G3 PH6 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 26. EPI0S27 H3 PH7 (8) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 27. EPI0S28 C6 PD5 (10) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 28. EPI0S29 A3 PD6 (10) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 29. EPI0S30 A2 PD7 (10) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 30. EPI0S31 C10 PG7 (9) I/O TTL EPI module 0 signal 31. a. The TTL designation indicates the pin has TTL-compatible voltage levels. 10.3 Functional Description The EPI controller provides a glueless, programmable interface to a variety of common external peripherals such as SDRAM x 16, Host Bus x8 and x16 devices, RAM, NOR Flash memory, CPLDs and FPGAs. In addition, the EPI controller provides custom GPIO that can use a FIFO with speed control by using either the internal write FIFO (WFIFO) or the non-blocking read FIFO (NBRFIFO). The WFIFO can hold 4 words of data that are written to the external interface at the rate controlled by the EPI Main Baud Rate (EPIBAUD) register. The NBRFIFO can hold 8 words of data and samples at the rate controlled by the EPIBAUD register. The EPI controller provides predictable operation and thus has an advantage over regular GPIO which has more variable timing due to on-chip bus arbitration and delays across bus bridges. Blocking reads stall the CPU until the transaction completes. Non-blocking reads are performed in the background and allow the processor to continue operation. In addition, write data can also be stored in the WFIFO to allow multiple writes with no stalls. Note: Both the WTAV bit field in the EPIWFIFOCNT register and the WBUSY bit in the EPISTAT register must be polled to determine if there is a current write transaction from the WFIFO. If both of these bits are clear, then a new bus access may begin. Main read and write operations can be performed in subsets of the range 0x6000.0000 to 0xDFFF.FFFF. A read from an address mapped location uses the offset and size to control the address and size of the external operation. When performing a multi-value load, the read is done as a burst (when available) to maximize performance. A write to an address mapped location uses January 22, 2012 459 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) the offset and size to control the address and size of the external operation. When performing a multi-value store, the write is done as a burst (when available) to maximize performance. NAND Flash memory (x8) can be read natively. Automatic programming support is not provided; programming must be done by the user following the manufacturer's protocol. Automatic page ECC is also not supported, but can be performed in software. 10.3.1 Non-Blocking Reads The EPI Controller supports a special kind of read called a non-blocking read, also referred to as a posted read. Where a normal read stalls the processor or μDMA until the data is returned, a non-blocking read is performed in the background. A non-blocking read is configured by writing the start address into a EPIRADDRn register, the size per transaction into a EPIRSIZEn register, and then the count of operations into a EPIRPSTDn register. After each read is completed, the result is written into the NBRFIFO and the EPIRADDRn register is incremented by the size (1, 2, or 4). If the NBRFIFO is filled, then the reads pause until space is made available. The NBRFIFO can be configured to interrupt the processor or trigger the μDMA based on fullness using the EPIFIFOLVL register. By using the trigger/interrupt method, the μDMA (or processor) can keep space available in the NBRFIFO and allow the reads to continue unimpeded. When performing non-blocking reads, the SDRAM controller issues two additional read transactions after the burst request is terminated. The data for these additional transfers is discarded. This situation is transparent to the user other than the additional EPI bus activity and can safely be ignored. Two non-blocking read register sets are available to allow sequencing and ping-pong use. When one completes, the other then activates. So, for example, if 20 words are to be read from 0x100 and 10 words from 0x200, the EPIRPSTD0 register can be set up with the read from 0x100 (with a count of 20), and the EPIRPSTD1 register can be set up with the read from 0x200 (with a count of 10). When EPIRPSTD0 finishes (count goes to 0), the EPIRPSTD1 register then starts its operation. The NBRFIFO has then passed 30 values. When used with the μDMA, it may transfer 30 values (simple sequence), or the primary/alternate model may be used to handle the first 20 in one way and the second 10 in another. It is also possible to reload the EPIRPSTD0 register when it is finished (and the EPIRPSTD1 register is active); thereby, keeping the interface constantly busy. To cancel a non-blocking read, the EPIRPSTDn register is cleared. Care must be taken, however if the register set was active to drain away any values read into the NBRFIFO and ensure that any read in progress is allowed to complete. To ensure that the cancel is complete, the following algorithm is used (using the EPIRPSTD0 register for example): EPIRPSTD0 = 0; while ((EPISTAT & 0x11) == 0x10) ; // we are active and busy // if here, then other one is active or interface no longer busy cnt = (EPIRADDR0 – original_address) / EPIRSIZE0; // count of values read cnt -= values_read_so_far; // cnt is now number left in FIFO while (cnt--) 460 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller value = EPIREADFIFO; // drain The above algorithm can be optimized in code; however, the important point is to wait for the cancel to complete because the external interface could have been in the process of reading a value when the cancel came in, and it must be allowed to complete. 10.3.2 DMA Operation The µDMA can be used to achieve maximum transfer rates on the EPI through the NBRFIFO and the WFIFO. The µDMA has one channel for write and one for read. The write channel copies values to the WFIFO when the WFIFO is at the level specified by the EPI FIFO Level Selects (EPIFIFOLVL) register. The non-blocking read channel copies values from the NBRFIFO when the NBRFIFO is at the level specified by the EPIFIFOLVL register. For non-blocking reads, the start address, the size per transaction, and the count of elements must be programmed in the µDMA. Note that both non-blocking read register sets can be used, and they fill the NBRFIFO such that one runs to completion, then the next one starts (they do not interleave). Using the NBRFIFO provides the best possible transfer rate. For blocking reads, the µDMA software channel (or another unused channel) is used for memory-to-memory transfers (or memory to peripheral, where some other peripheral is used). In this situation, the µDMA stalls until the read is complete and is not able to service another channel until the read is done. As a result, the arbitration size should normally be programmed to one access at a time. The µDMA controller can also transfer from and to the NBRFIFO and the WFIFO using the µDMA software channel in memory mode, however, the µDMA is stalled once the NBRFIFO is empty or the WFIFO is full. Note that when the µDMA controller is stalled, the core continues operation. See “Micro Direct Memory Access (μDMA)” on page 339 for more information on configuring the µDMA. The size of the FIFOs must be taken into consideration when configuring the µDMA to transfer data to and from the EPI. The arbitration size should be 4 or less when writing to EPI address space and 8 or less when reading from EPI address space. 10.4 Initialization and Configuration To enable and initialize the EPI controller, the following steps are necessary: 1. Enable the EPI module using the RCGC1 register. See page 245. 2. Enable the clock to the appropriate GPIO module via the RCGC2 register. See page 254. To find out which GPIO port to enable, refer to “Signal Description” on page 457. 3. Set the GPIO AFSEL bits for the appropriate pins. See page 423. To determine which GPIOs to configure, see Table 19-4 on page 853. 4. Configure the GPIO current level and/or slew rate as specified for the mode selected. See page 425 and page 433. 5. Configure the PMCn fields in the GPIOPCTL register to assign the EPI signals to the appropriate pins. See page 441 and Table 19-5 on page 859. 6. Select the mode for the EPI block to SDRAM, HB8, HB16, or general parallel use, using the MODE field in the EPI Configuration (EPICFG) register. Set the mode-specific details (if needed) using the appropriate mode configuration EPI Host Bus Configuration (EPIHBnCFGn) registers for the desired chip-select configuration. Set the EPI Main Baud Rate (EPIBAUD) register if the baud rate must be slower than the system clock rate. January 22, 2012 461 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) 7. Configure the address mapping using the EPI Address Map (EPIADDRMAP) register. The selected start address and range is dependent on the type of external device and maximum address (as appropriate). For example, for a 512-megabit SDRAM, program the ERADR field to 0x1 for address 0x6000.0000 or 0x2 for address 0x8000.0000; and program the ERSZ field to 0x3 for 256 MB. If using General-Purpose mode and no address at all, program the EPADR field to 0x1 for address 0xA000.0000 or 0x2 for address 0xC000.0000; and program the EPSZ field to 0x0 for 256 bytes. 8. To read or write directly, use the mapped address area (configured with the EPIADDRMAP register). Up to 4 or 5 writes can be performed at once without blocking. Each read is blocked until the value is retrieved. 9. To perform a non-blocking read, see “Non-Blocking Reads” on page 460. The following sub-sections describe the initialization and configuration for each of the modes of operation. Care must be taken to initialize everything properly to ensure correct operation. Control of the GPIO states is also important, as changes may cause the external device to interpret pin states as actions or commands (see “Register Descriptions” on page 412). Normally, a pull-up or pull-down is needed on the board to at least control the chip-select or chip-enable as the Stellaris GPIOs come out of reset in tri-state. 10.4.1 SDRAM Mode When activating the SDRAM mode, it is important to consider a few points: 1. Generally, it takes over 100 μs from when the mode is activated to when the first operation is allowed. The SDRAM controller begins the SDRAM initialization sequence as soon as the mode is selected and enabled via the EPICFG register. It is important that the GPIOs are properly configured before the SDRAM mode is enabled, as the EPI controller is relying on the GPIO block's ability to drive the pins immediately. As part of the initialization sequence, the LOAD MODE REGISTER command is automatically sent to the SDRAM with a value of 0x27, which sets a CAS latency of 2 and a full page burst length. 2. The INITSEQ bit in the EPI Status (EPISTAT) register can be checked to determine when the initialization sequence is complete. 3. When using a frequency range and/or refresh value other than the default value, it is important to configure the FREQ and RFSH fields in the EPI SDRAM Configuration (EPISDRAMCFG) register shortly after activating the mode. After the 100-μs startup time, the EPI block must be configured properly to keep the SDRAM contents stable. 4. The SLEEP bit in the EPISDRAMCFG register may be configured to put the SDRAM into a low-power self-refreshing state. It is important to note that the SDRAM mode must not be disabled once enabled, or else the SDRAM is no longer clocked and the contents are lost. 5. Before entering SLEEP mode, make sure all non-blocking reads and normal reads and writes have completed. If the system is running at 30 to 50 MHz, wait 2 EPI clocks after clearing the SLEEP bit before executing non-blocking reads, or normal reads and writes. If the system is configured to greater than 50 MHz, wait 5 EPI clocks before read and write transactions. For all other configurations, wait 1 EPI clock. The SIZE field of the EPISDRAMCFG register must be configured correctly based on the amount of SDRAM in the system. 462 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller The FREQ field must be configured according to the value that represents the range being used. Based on the range selected, the number of external clocks used between certain operations (for example, PRECHARGE or ACTIVATE) is determined. If a higher frequency is given than is used, then the only downside is that the peripheral is slower (uses more cycles for these delays). If a lower frequency is given, incorrect operation occurs. See “External Peripheral Interface (EPI)” on page 905 for timing details for the SDRAM mode. 10.4.1.1 External Signal Connections Table 10-3 on page 463 defines how EPI module signals should be connected to SDRAMs. The table applies when using a SDRAM up to 512 megabits. Note that the EPI signals must use 8-mA drive when interfacing to SDRAM, see page 427. Any unused EPI controller signals can be used as GPIOs or another alternate function. Table 10-3. EPI SDRAM Signal Connections a EPI Signal SDRAM Signal EPI0S0 A0 D0 EPI0S1 A1 D1 EPI0S2 A2 D2 EPI0S3 A3 D3 EPI0S4 A4 D4 EPI0S5 A5 D5 EPI0S6 A6 D6 EPI0S7 A7 D7 EPI0S8 A8 D8 EPI0S9 A9 D9 EPI0S10 A10 D10 EPI0S11 A11 EPI0S12 A12 b D12 EPI0S13 BA0 D13 EPI0S14 BA1 EPI0S15 D11 D14 D15 EPI0S16 DQML EPI0S17 DQMH EPI0S18 CASn EPI0S19 RASn EPI0S20-EPI0S27 not used EPI0S28 WEn EPI0S29 CSn EPI0S30 CKE EPI0S31 CLK a. If 2 signals are listed, connect the EPI signal to both pins. b. Only for 256/512 megabit SDRAMs January 22, 2012 463 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) 10.4.1.2 Refresh Configuration The refresh count is based on the external clock speed and the number of rows per bank as well as the refresh period. The RFSH field represents how many external clock cycles remain before an AUTO-REFRESH is required. The normal formula is: RFSH = (tRefresh_us / number_rows) / ext_clock_period A refresh period is normally 64 ms, or 64000 μs. The number of rows is normally 4096 or 8192. The ext_clock_period is a value expressed in μsec and is derived by dividing 1000 by the clock speed expressed in MHz. So, 50 MHz is 1000/50=20 ns, or 0.02 μs. A typical SDRAM is 4096 rows per bank if the system clock is running at 50 MHz with an EPIBAUD register value of 0: RFSH = (64000/4096) / 0.02 = 15.625 μs / 0.02 μs = 781.25 The default value in the RFSH field is 750 decimal or 0x2EE to allow for a margin of safety and providing 15 μs per refresh. It is important to note that this number should always be smaller or equal to what is required by the above equation. For example, if running the external clock at 25 MHz (40 ns per clock period), 390 is the highest number that may be used. Note that the external clock may be 25 MHz when the system clock is 25 MHz or when the system clock is 50 MHz and configuring the COUNT0 field in the EPIBAUD register to 1 (divide by 2). If a number larger than allowed is used, the SDRAM is not refreshed often enough, and data is lost. 10.4.1.3 Bus Interface Speed The EPI Controller SDRAM interface can operate up to 50 MHz. The COUNT0 field in the EPIBAUD register configures the speed of the EPI clock. For system clock (SysClk) speeds up to 50 MHz, the COUNT0 field can be 0x0000, and the SDRAM interface can run at the same speed as SysClk. However, if SysClk is running at higher speeds, the bus interface can run only as fast as half speed, and the COUNT0 field must be configured to at least 0x0001. 10.4.1.4 Non-Blocking Read Cycle Figure 10-2 on page 465 shows a non-blocking read cycle of n halfwords; n can be any number greater than or equal to 1. The cycle begins with the Activate command and the row address on the EPI0S[15:0] signals. With the programmed CAS latency of 2, the Read command with the column address on the EPI0S[15:0] signals follows after 2 clock cycles. Following one more NOP cycle, data is read in on the EPI0S[15:0] signals on every rising clock edge. The Burst Terminate command is issued during the cycle when the next-to-last halfword is read in. The DQMH and DQML signals are deasserted after the last halfword of data is received; the CSn signal deasserts on the following clock cycle, signaling the end of the read cycle. At least one clock period of inactivity separates any two SDRAM cycles. 464 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 10-2. SDRAM Non-Blocking Read Cycle CLK (EPI0S31) CKE (EPI0S30) CSn (EPI0S29) WEn (EPI0S28) RASn (EPI0S19) CASn (EPI0S18) DQMH, DQML (EPI0S [17:16]) AD [15:0] (EPI0S [15:0]) Row Activate Column NOP NOP Data 0 Read Data 1 ... Data n Burst Term NOP AD [15:0] driven in AD [15:0] driven out 10.4.1.5 AD [15:0] driven out Normal Read Cycle Figure 10-3 on page 465 shows a normal read cycle of n halfwords; n can be 1 or 2. The cycle begins with the Activate command and the row address on the EPI0S[15:0] signals. With the programmed CAS latency of 2, the Read command with the column address on the EPI0S[15:0] signals follows after 2 clock cycles. Following one more NOP cycle, data is read in on the EPI0S[15:0] signals on every rising clock edge. The DQMH, DQML, and CSn signals are deasserted after the last halfword of data is received, signaling the end of the cycle. At least one clock period of inactivity separates any two SDRAM cycles. Figure 10-3. SDRAM Normal Read Cycle CLK (EPI0S31) CKE (EPI0S30) CSn (EPI0S29) WEn (EPI0S28) RASn (EPI0S19) CASn (EPI0S18) DQMH, DQML (EPI0S [17:16]) AD [15:0] (EPI0S [15:0]) Row Activate Column NOP NOP Read Data 0 Data 1 NOP AD [15:0] driven in AD [15:0] driven out AD [15:0] driven out January 22, 2012 465 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) 10.4.1.6 Write Cycle Figure 10-4 on page 466 shows a write cycle of n halfwords; n can be any number greater than or equal to 1. The cycle begins with the Activate command and the row address on the EPI0S[15:0] signals. With the programmed CAS latency of 2, the Write command with the column address on the EPI0S[15:0] signals follows after 2 clock cycles. When writing to SDRAMs, the Write command is presented with the first halfword of data. Because the address lines and the data lines are multiplexed, the column address is modified to be (programmed address -1). During the Write command, the DQMH and DQML signals are high, so no data is written to the SDRAM. On the next clock, the DQMH and DQML signals are asserted, and the data associated with the programmed address is written. The Burst Terminate command occurs during the clock cycle following the write of the last halfword of data. The WEn, DQMH, DQML, and CSn signals are deasserted after the last halfword of data is received, signaling the end of the access. At least one clock period of inactivity separates any two SDRAM cycles. Figure 10-4. SDRAM Write Cycle CLK (EPI0S31) CKE (EPI0S30) CSn (EPI0S29) WEn (EPI0S28) RASn (EPI0S19) CASn (EPI0S18) DQMH, DQML (EPI0S [17:16]) AD [15:0] (EPI0S [15:0]) Row Activate Column-1 NOP NOP Data 0 Data 1 ... Data n Burst Term Write AD [15:0] driven out AD [15:0] driven out 10.4.2 Host Bus Mode Host Bus supports the traditional 8-bit and 16-bit interfaces popularized by the 8051 devices and SRAM devices. This interface is asynchronous and uses strobe pins to control activity. Addressable memory can be doubled using Host Bus-16 mode as it performs half-word accesses. The EPI0S0 is the LSB of the address and is equivalent to the internal Cortex-M3 A1 address. EPI0S0 should be connected to A0 of 16-bit memories. 10.4.2.1 Control Pins The main three strobes are Address Latch Enable (ALE), Write (WRn), and Read (RDn, sometimes called OEn). Note that the timings are designed for older logic and so are hold-time vs. setup-time specific. The polarity of the read and write strobes can be active High or active Low by clearing or setting the RDHIGH and WRHIGH bits in the EPI Host-Bus n Configuration 2 (EPIHBnCFG2) register. The ALE can be changed to an active-low chip select signal, CSn, through the EPIHBnCFG2 register. The ALE is best used for Host-Bus muxed mode in which EPI address and data pins are shared. All Host-Bus accesses have an address phase followed by a data phase. The ALE indicates to an 466 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller external latch to capture the address then hold it until the data phase. CSn is best used for Host-Bus unmuxed mode in which EPI address and data pins are separate. The CSn indicates when the address and data phases of a read or write access are occurring. Both the ALE and the CSn modes can be enhanced to access external devices using settings in the EPIHBnCFG2 register. Wait states can be added to the data phase of the access using the WRWS and RDWS bits in the EPIHBnCFG2 register. For FIFO mode, the ALE is not used, and two input holds are optionally supported to gate input and output to what the XFIFO can handle. Host-Bus 8 and Host-Bus 16 modes are very configurable. The user has the ability to connect external devices to the EPI signals, as well as control whether byte select signals are provided in HB16 mode. These capabilities depend on the configuration of the MODE field in the EPIHBnCFG register and the CSCFG fieldin the EPIHBnCFG2 register, and the BSEL bit in the EPIHB16CFG register. The CSCFGEXT bit extends the chip select configuration possibilities by providing the most significant bit of the CSCFG field. If one of the Dual-Chip-Select modes is selected (CSCFG is 0x2 or 0x3 in the EPIHBnCFG2 register), both chip selects can share the peripheral or the memory space, or one chip select can use the peripheral space and the other can use the memory space. In the EPIADDRMAP register, if the EPADR field is not 0x0 and the ERADR field is 0x0, then the address specified by EPADR is used for both chip selects, with CS0n being asserted when the MSB of the address range is 0 and CS1n being asserted when the MSB of the address range is 1. If the ERADR field is not 0x0 and the EPADR field is 0x0, then the address specified by ERADR is used for both chip selects, with the MSB performing the same delineation. If both the EPADR and the ERADR are not 0x0, then CS0n is asserted for either address range defined by EPADR and CS1n is asserted for either address range defined by ERADR. If the CSBAUD bit in the EPIHBnCFG2 register is set in Dual-chip select mode, the 2 chip selects can use different clock frequencies, wait states and strobe polarity. If the CSBAUD bit is clear, both chip selects use the clock frequency, wait states, and strobe polarity defined for CS0n. When BSEL=1 in the EPIHB16CFG register, byte select signals are provided, so byte-sized data can be read and written at any address, however these signals reduce the available address width by 2 pins. The byte select signals are active Low. BSEL0n corresponds to the LSB of the halfword, and BSEL1n corresponds to the MSB of the halfword. When BSEL=0, byte reads and writes at odd addresses only act on the even byte, and byte writes at even addresses write invalid values into the odd byte. As a result, accesses should be made as half-words (16-bits) or words (32-bits). In C/C++, programmers should use only short int and long int for accesses. Also, because data accesses in HB16 mode with no byte selects are on 2-byte boundaries, the available address space is doubled. For example, 28 bits of address accesses 512 MB in this mode. Table 10-4 on page 467 shows the capabilities of the HB8 and HB16 modes as well as the available address bits with the possible combinations of these bits. Although the EPI0S31 signal can be configured for the EPI clock signal in Host-Bus mode, it is not required and should be configured as a GPIO to reduce EMI in the system. Table 10-4. Capabilities of Host Bus 8 and Host Bus 16 Modes Host Bus Type MODE CSCFG Max # of External Devices BSEL Byte Access Available Address Addressable Memory HB8 0x0 0x0, 0x1 1 N/A Always 28 bits 256 MB HB8 0x0 0x2 2 N/A Always 27 bits 128 MB HB8 0x0 0x3 2 N/A Always 26 bits 64 MB January 22, 2012 467 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) Table 10-4. Capabilities of Host Bus 8 and Host Bus 16 Modes (continued) Host Bus Type MODE CSCFG Max # of External Devices BSEL Byte Access Available Address Addressable Memory HB8 0x1 0x0, 0x1 1 N/A Always 20 bits 1 MB HB8 0x1 0x2 2 N/A Always 19 bits 512 kB HB8 0x1 0x3 2 N/A Always 18 bits 256 kB HB8 0x3 0x1 1 N/A Always none - HB8 0x3 0x3 2 N/A Always none HB16 0x0 0x0, 0x1 1 0 No 28 bits HB16 0x0 0x0, 0x1 1 1 Yes 26 bits HB16 0x0 0x2 2 0 No a 512 MB b 128 MB a 256 MB 27 bits b HB16 0x0 0x2 2 1 Yes 25 bits HB16 0x0 0x3 2 0 No 26 bites HB16 0x0 0x3 2 1 Yes 24 bits a b 32 MB a 8 kB b 2 kB a 4 kB HB16 0x1 0x0, 0x1 1 0 No 12 bits HB16 0x1 0x0, 0x1 1 1 Yes 10 bits HB16 0x1 0x2 2 0 64 MB 128 MB No 11 bits b HB16 0x1 0x2 2 1 Yes 9 bits HB16 0x1 0x3 2 0 No 10 bits Yes b 8 bits 512 B a 1 kB 2 kB HB16 0x1 0x3 2 1 HB16 0x3 0x1 1 0 No none - HB16 0x3 0x1 1 1 Yes none - HB16 0x3 0x3 2 0 No none - HB16 0x3 0x3 2 1 Yes none - a. If byte selects are not used, data accesses are on 2-byte boundaries. As a result, the available address space is doubled. b. Two EPI signals are used for byte selects, reducing the available address space by two bits. Table 10-5 on page 468 shows how the EPI[31:0] signals function while in Host-Bus 8 mode. Notice that the signal configuration changes based on the address/data mode selected by the MODE field in the EPIHB8CFG2 register and on the chip select configuration selected by the CSCFG field in the same register. Although the EPI0S31 signal can be configured for the EPI clock signal in Host-Bus mode, it is not required and should be configured as a GPIO to reduce EMI in the system. Any unused EPI controller signals can be used as GPIOs or another alternate function. Table 10-5. EPI Host-Bus 8 Signal Connections EPI Signal CSCFG HB8 Signal (MODE =ADMUX) HB8 Signal (MODE =ADNOMUX (Cont. Read)) HB8 Signal (MODE =XFIFO) EPI0S0 X a AD0 D0 D0 EPI0S1 X AD1 D1 D1 EPI0S2 X AD2 D2 D2 EPI0S3 X AD3 D3 D3 EPI0S4 X AD4 D4 D4 EPI0S5 X AD5 D5 D5 468 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 10-5. EPI Host-Bus 8 Signal Connections (continued) EPI Signal CSCFG HB8 Signal (MODE =ADMUX) HB8 Signal (MODE =ADNOMUX (Cont. Read)) HB8 Signal (MODE =XFIFO) EPI0S6 X AD6 D6 D6 EPI0S7 X AD7 D7 D7 EPI0S8 X A8 A0 - EPI0S9 X A9 A1 - EPI0S10 X A10 A2 - EPI0S11 X A11 A3 - EPI0S12 X A12 A4 - EPI0S13 X A13 A5 - EPI0S14 X A14 A6 - EPI0S15 X A15 A7 - EPI0S16 X A16 A8 - EPI0S17 X A17 A9 - EPI0S18 X A18 A10 - EPI0S19 X A19 A11 - EPI0S20 X A20 A12 - EPI0S21 X A21 A13 - EPI0S22 X A22 A14 - EPI0S23 X A23 A15 - X A24 A16 - EPI0S24 0x0 EPI0S25 0x1 0x2 b A25 A17 CS1n 0x3 - 0x0 EPI0S26 0x1 0x0 0x1 0x2 EPI0S29 EPI0S30 EPI0S31 CS0n CS0n A27 A19 FEMPTY FFULL CS1n CS1n X RDn/OEn RDn/OEn RDn X WRn WRn WRn 0x0 ALE ALE - 0x3 EPI0S28 A18 0x2 0x3 EPI0S27 A26 0x1 CSn CSn CSn 0x2 CS0n CS0n CS0n 0x3 ALE ALE - X c Clock c Clock c Clock a. "X" indicates the state of this field is a don't care. b. When an entry straddles several row, the signal configuration is the same for all rows. c. The clock signal is not required for this mode and has unspecified timing relationships to other signals. January 22, 2012 469 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) Table 10-6 on page 470 shows how the EPI[31:0] signals function while in Host-Bus 16 mode. Notice that the signal configuration changes based on the address/data mode selected by the MODE field in the EPIHB16CFG2 register, on the chip select configuration selected by the CSCFG field in the same register, and on whether byte selects are used as configured by the BSEL bit in the EPIHB16CFG register. Although the EPI0S31 signal can be configured for the EPI clock signal in Host-Bus mode, it is not required and should be configured as a GPIO to reduce EMI in the system. Any unused EPI controller signals can be used as GPIOs or another alternate function. Table 10-6. EPI Host-Bus 16 Signal Connections EPI Signal CSCFG BSEL HB16 Signal (MODE =ADMUX) HB16 Signal (MODE =ADNOMUX (Cont. Read)) HB16 Signal (MODE =XFIFO) EPI0S0 X a X AD0 b D0 D0 EPI0S1 X X AD1 D1 D1 EPI0S2 EPI0S3 X X AD2 D2 D2 X X AD3 D3 D3 EPI0S4 X X AD4 D4 D4 EPI0S5 X X AD5 D5 D5 EPI0S6 X X AD6 D6 D6 EPI0S7 X X AD7 D7 D7 EPI0S8 X X AD8 D8 D8 EPI0S9 X X AD9 D9 D9 EPI0S10 X X AD10 D10 D10 EPI0S11 X X AD11 D11 D11 EPI0S12 X X AD12 D12 D12 EPI0S13 X X AD13 D13 D13 EPI0S14 X X AD14 D14 D14 EPI0S15 X X AD15 D15 D15 b EPI0S16 X X A16 A0 - EPI0S17 X X A17 A1 - EPI0S18 X X A18 A2 - EPI0S19 X X A19 A3 - EPI0S20 X X A20 A4 - EPI0S21 X X A21 A5 - EPI0S22 X X A22 A6 - EPI0S23 X c 0 A23 A7 - 1 470 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Table 10-6. EPI Host-Bus 16 Signal Connections (continued) EPI Signal CSCFG 0x0 0x1 EPI0S24 0x2 0x3 0x0 0x1 EPI0S25 0x2 0x3 0x0 EPI0S26 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x0 EPI0S27 0x1 HB16 Signal (MODE =ADMUX) HB16 Signal (MODE =ADNOMUX (Cont. Read)) A24 A8 1 BSEL0n BSEL0n X A25 A9 0 A25 A9 1 BSEL0n BSEL0n 0 A25 A9 1 BSEL1n BSEL1n BSEL HB16 Signal (MODE =XFIFO) 0 1 0 1 - 0 1 0 - 0 A26 A10 1 BSEL0n BSEL0n 0 A26 A10 1 BSEL0n BSEL0n 0 A26 A10 1 BSEL1n BSEL1n X CS0n CS0n 0 A27 A11 1 BSEL1n BSEL1n 0 A27 A11 1 BSEL1n BSEL1n CS1n CS1n CS1n -- FEMPTY FFULL 0x2 X 0x3 X EPI0S28 X X RDn/OEn RDn/OEn RDn EPI0S29 X X WRn WRn WRn 0x0 X ALE ALE - 0x1 X CSn CSn CSn 0x2 X CS0n CS0n CS0n 0x3 X ALE X X Clock EPI0S30 EPI0S31 ALE d d Clock d Clock a. "X" indicates the state of this field is a don't care. b. In this mode, half-word accesses are used. A0 is the LSB of the address and is equivalent to the internal Cortex-M3 A1 address. This pin should be connected to A0 of 16-bit memories. c. When an entry straddles several row, the signal configuration is the same for all rows. d. The clock signal is not required for this mode and has unspecified timing relationships to other signals. January 22, 2012 471 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) 10.4.2.2 SRAM support Figure 10-5 on page 472 shows how to connect the EPI signals to a 16-bit SRAM and a 16-bit Flash memory with muxed address and memory using byte selects and dual chip selects with ALE. This schematic is just an example of how to connect the signals; timing and loading have not been analyzed. In addition, not all bypass capacitors are shown. Figure 10-5. Example Schematic for Muxed Host-Bus 16 Mode EPI_16_BUS A[0:15] U1 EPI0 EPI1 EPI2 EPI3 EPI4 EPI5 EPI6 EPI7 47 46 44 43 41 40 38 37 EPI8 EPI9 EPI10 EPI11 EPI12 EPI13 EPI14 EPI15 36 35 33 32 30 29 27 26 EPI30 25 2LE 48 1LE 1D1 1D2 1D3 1D4 1D5 1D6 1D7 1D8 1Q1 1Q2 1Q3 1Q4 1Q5 1Q6 1Q7 1Q8 2D1 2D2 2D3 2D4 2D5 2D6 2D7 2D8 2Q1 2Q2 2Q3 2Q4 2Q5 2Q6 2Q7 2Q8 GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND 1 1OE 24 2OE +3.3V 7 VCC 18 VCC 31 VCC 42 VCC GND 2 3 5 6 8 9 11 12 A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 13 14 16 17 19 20 22 23 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 4 10 15 21 28 34 39 45 GND 74X16373 EPI_16_BUS EPI_16_BUS EPI_16_BUS EPI_16_BUS A[0:15] A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 EPI16 EPI17 U2 5 4 3 2 1 44 43 42 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 A16 A17 I/O0 I/O1 I/O2 I/O3 I/O4 I/O5 I/O6 I/O7 I/O8 I/O9 I/O10 I/O11 I/O12 I/O13 I/O14 I/O15 NC +3.3V 11 VCC 33 VCC GND EPI0 EPI1 EPI2 EPI3 EPI4 EPI5 EPI6 EPI7 EPI8 EPI9 EPI10 EPI11 EPI12 EPI13 EPI14 EPI15 EPI16 EPI17 EPI18 28 17 EPI29 6 EPI26 41 EPI28 40 BHE 39 BLE EPI25 EPI24 WE CE OE 12 VSS 34 VSS 7 8 9 10 13 14 15 16 29 30 31 32 35 36 37 38 A[0:15] A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 U3 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 48 17 16 9 10 12 13 14 15 47 CY62147 A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 A16 A17 A18 NC NC NC NC NC NC NC 29 31 33 35 38 40 42 44 30 32 34 36 39 41 43 45 EPI0 EPI1 EPI2 EPI3 EPI4 EPI5 EPI6 EPI7 EPI8 EPI9 EPI10 EPI11 EPI12 EPI13 EPI14 EPI15 11 WE 28 OE 26 CE EPI29 EPI28 EPI27 DQ0 DQ1 DQ2 DQ3 DQ4 DQ5 DQ6 DQ7 DQ8 DQ9 DQ10 DQ11 DQ12 DQ13 DQ14 DQ15 +3.3V VDD 37 46 VSS 27 VSS SST39VF800A 10.4.2.3 GND Speed of Transactions The COUNT0 field in the EPIBAUD register must be configured to set the main transaction rate based on what the slave device can support (including wiring considerations). The main control DESIGNER REVISION DATE ??? ?REV? TEXAS INSTRUMENTS 1/6/2011 STELLARIS PROJECT 472 MICROCONTROLLERS 108 WILD BASIN ROAD, SUITE 350 AUSTIN 78746 January 22,TX,2012 ?PROJECT NAME? DESCRIPTION Texas Instruments-Production R Data www.ti.com/stellaris ?DESC1? ?DESC2? FILENAME epi16_example.sch PART NO. ?PART NUMBER? SHEET 1 OF 1 ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller transitions are normally ½ the baud rate (COUNT0 = 1) because the EPI block forces data vs. control to change on alternating clocks. When using dual chip selects, each chip select can access the bus using differing baud rates by setting the CSBAUD bit in the EPIHBnCFG2 register. In this case, the COUNT0 field controls the CS0n transactions, and the COUNT1 field controls the CS1n transactions. Additionally, the Host-Bus mode provides read and write wait states for the data portion to support different classes of device. These wait states stretch the data period (hold the rising edge of data strobe) and may be used in all four sub-modes. The wait states are set using the WRWS and RDWS bits in the EPI Host-Bus n Configuration (EPIHBnCFG) register. 10.4.2.4 Sub-Modes of Host Bus 8/16 The EPI controller supports four variants of the Host-Bus model using 8 or 16 bits of data in all four cases. The four sub-modes are selected using the MODE bits in the EPIHBnCFG register, and are: 1. Address and data are muxed. This scheme is used by many 8051 devices, some Microchip PIC parts, and some ATmega parts. When used for standard SRAMs, a latch must be used between the microcontroller and the SRAM. This sub-mode is provided for compatibility with existing devices that support data transfers without a latch (that is, CPLDs). In general, the de-muxed sub-mode should normally be used. The ALE configuration should be used in this mode, as all Host-Bus accesses have an address phase followed by a data phase. The ALE indicates to an external latch to capture the address then hold until the data phase. The ALE configuration is controlled by configuring the CSCFG field to be 0x0 in the EPIHBnCFG2 register. The ALE can be enhanced to access two external devices with two separate CSn signals. By configuring the CSCFG field to be 0x3 in the EPIHBnCFG2 register, EPI0S30 functions as ALE, EPI0S27 functions as CS1n, and EPI0S26 functions as CS0n. The CSn is best used for Host-Bus unmuxed mode, in which EPI address and data pins are separate. The CSn indicates when the address and data phases of a read or write access are occurring. 2. Address and data are separate with 8 or 16 bits of data and up to 20 bits of address (1 MB). This scheme is used by more modern 8051 devices, as well as some PIC and ATmega parts. This mode is generally used with real SRAMs, many EEPROMs, and many NOR Flash memory devices. Note that there is no hardware command write support for Flash memory devices; this mode should only be used for Flash memory devices programmed at manufacturing time. If a Flash memory device must be written and does not support a direct programming model, the command mechanism must be performed in software. The CSn configuration should be used in this mode. The CSn signal indicates when the address and data phases of a read or write access is occurring. The CSn configuration is controlled by configuring the CSCFG field to be 0x1 in the EPIHBnCFG2 register. 3. Continuous read mode where address and data are separate. This sub-mode is used for real SRAMs which can be read more quickly by only changing the address (and not using RDn/OEn strobing). In this sub-mode, reads are performed by keeping the read mode selected (output enable is asserted) and then changing the address pins. The data pins are changed by the SRAM after the address pins change. For example, to read data from address 0x100 and then 0x101, the EPI controller asserts the output-enable signal and then configures the address pins to 0x100; the EPI controller then captures what is on the data pins and increments A0 to 1 (so the address is now 0x101); the EPI controller then captures what is on the data pins. Note that this mode consumes higher power because the SRAM must continuously drive the data pins. This mode is not practical in HB16 mode for normal SRAMs because there are generally not enough address bits available. Writes are not permitted in this mode. 4. FIFO mode uses 8 or 16 bits of data, removes ALE and address pins and optionally adds external XFIFO FULL/EMPTY flag inputs. This scheme is used by many devices, such as radios, January 22, 2012 473 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) communication devices (including USB2 devices), and some FPGA configurations (FIFO through block RAM). This sub-mode provides the data side of the normal Host-Bus interface, but is paced by the FIFO control signals. It is important to consider that the XFIFO FULL/EMPTY control signals may stall the interface and could have an impact on blocking read latency from the processor or μDMA. The WORD bit in the EPIHBnCFG2 register can be set to use memory more efficiently. By default, the EPI controller uses data bits [7:0] for Host-Bus 8 accesses or bits [15:0] for Host-Bus 16 accesses. When the WORD bit is set, the EPI controller can automatically route bytes of data onto the correct byte lanes such that bytes or words of data can be transferred on the correct byte or half-word bits on the entire bus. For example, the most significant byte of data will be transferred on bits [31:28] in host-bus 8 mode and the most significant word of data will be transferred on bits [31:16] of Host-Bus 16 mode. In addition, for the three modes above (1, 2, 4) that the Host-Bus 16 mode supports, byte select signals can be optionally implemented by setting the BSEL bit in the EPIHB16CFG register. Note: Byte accesses should not be attempted if the BSEL bit has not been enabled in Host-Bus 16 Mode. See “External Peripheral Interface (EPI)” on page 905 for timing details for the Host-Bus mode. 10.4.2.5 Bus Operation Bus operation is the same in Host-Bus 8 and Host-Bus 16 modes and is asynchronous. Timing diagrams show both ALE and CSn operation, but only one signal or the other is used in all modes except for ALE with dual chip selects mode (CSCFG field is 0x3 in the EPIHBnCFG2 register). Address and data on write cycles are held after the CSn signal is deasserted. The optional HB16 byte select signals have the same timing as the address signals. If wait states are required in the bus access, they can be inserted during the data phase of the access using the WRWS and RDWS bits in the EPIHBnCFG2 register. Each wait state adds 2 EPI clock cycles to the duration of the WRn or RDn strobe. During idle cycles, the address and muxed address data signals maintain the state of the last cycle. Figure 10-6 on page 474 shows a basic Host-Bus read cycle. Figure 10-7 on page 475 shows a basic Host-Bus write cycle. Both of these figures show address and data signals in the non-multiplexed mode (MODE field ix 0x1 in the EPIHBnCFG register). Figure 10-6. Host-Bus Read Cycle, MODE = 0x1, WRHIGH = 0, RDHIGH = 0 ALE (EPI0S30) CSn (EPI0S30) WRn (EPI0S29) RDn/OEn (EPI0S28) BSEL0n/ BSEL1na Address Data a Data BSEL0n and BSEL1n are available in Host-Bus 16 mode only. 474 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 10-7. Host-Bus Write Cycle, MODE = 0x1, WRHIGH = 0, RDHIGH = 0 ALE (EPI0S30) CSn (EPI0S30) WRn (EPI0S29) RDn/OEn (EPI0S28) BSEL0n/ BSEL1na Address Data a Data BSEL0n and BSEL1n are available in Host-Bus 16 mode only. Figure 10-8 on page 475 shows a write cycle with the address and data signals multiplexed (MODE field is 0x0 in the EPIHBnCFG register). A read cycle would look similar, with the RDn strobe being asserted along with CSn and data being latched on the rising edge of RDn. Figure 10-8. Host-Bus Write Cycle with Multiplexed Address and Data, MODE = 0x0, WRHIGH = 0, RDHIGH =0 ALE (EPI0S30) CSn (EPI0S30) WRn (EPI0S29) RDn/OEn (EPI0S28) BSEL0n/ BSEL1na Address (high order, non muxed) Muxed Address/Data a Address Data BSEL0n and BSEL1n are available in Host-Bus 16 mode only. When using ALE with dual CSn configuration (CSCFG field is 0x3 in the EPIHBnCFG2 register), the appropriate CSn signal is asserted at the same time as ALE, as shown in Figure 10-9 on page 476. January 22, 2012 475 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) Figure 10-9. Host-Bus Write Cycle with Multiplexed Address and Data and ALE with Dual CSn ALE (EPI0S30) CS0n/CS1n (EPI0S26/EPI0S27) WRn (EPI0S29) RDn/OEn (EPI0S28) BSEL0n/ BSEL1na Address (high order, non muxed) Muxed Address/Data a Address Data BSEL0n and BSEL1n are available in Host-Bus 16 mode only. Figure 10-10 on page 476 shows continuous read mode accesses. In this mode, reads are performed by keeping the read mode selected (output enable is asserted) and then changing the address pins. The data pins are changed by the SRAM after the address pins change. Figure 10-10. Continuous Read Mode Accesses OEn Address Data Addr1 Data1 Addr2 Data2 Addr3 Data3 FIFO mode accesses are the same as normal read and write accesses, except that the ALE signal and address pins are not present. Two input signals can be used to indicate when the XFIFO is full or empty to gate transactions and avoid overruns and underruns. The FFULL and FEMPTY signals are synchronized and must be recognized as asserted by the microcontroller for 2 system clocks before they affect transaction status. The MAXWAIT field in the EPIHBnCFG register defines the maximum number of EPI clocks to wait while the FEMPTY or FFULL signal is holding off a transaction. Figure 10-11 on page 477 shows how the FEMPTY signal should respond to a write and read from the XFIFO. Figure 10-12 on page 477 shows how the FEMPTY and FFULL signals should respond to 2 writes and 1 read from an external FIFO that contains two entries. 476 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 10-11. Write Followed by Read to External FIFO FFULL (EPI0S27) FEMPTY (EPI0S26) CSn (EPI0S30) WRn (EPI0S29) RDn (EPI0S28) Data Data Data Figure 10-12. Two-Entry FIFO FFULL (EPI0S27) FEMPTY (EPI0S26) CSn (EPI0S30) WRn (EPI0S29) RDn (EPI0S28) Data 10.4.3 Data Data Data General-Purpose Mode The General-Purpose Mode Configuration (EPIGPCFG) register is used to configure the control, data, and address pins, if used. Any unused EPI controller signals can be used as GPIOs or another alternate function. The general-purpose configuration can be used for custom interfaces with FPGAs, CPLDs, and digital data acquisition and actuator control. Important: The RD2CYC bit in the EPIGPCFG register must be set at all times in General-Purpose mode to ensure proper operation. General-Purpose mode is designed for three general types of use: ■ Extremely high-speed clocked interfaces to FPGAs and CPLDs. Three sizes of data and optional address are supported. Framing and clock-enable functions permit more optimized interfaces. ■ General parallel GPIO. From 1 to 32 pins may be written or read, with the speed precisely controlled by the EPIBAUD register baud rate (when used with the WFIFO and/or the NBRFIFO) or by the rate of accesses from software or μDMA. Examples of this type of use include: – Reading 20 sensors at fixed time periods by configuring 20 pins to be inputs, configuring the COUNT0 field in the EPIBAUD register to some divider, and then using non-blocking reads. January 22, 2012 477 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) – Implementing a very wide ganged PWM/PCM with fixed frequency for driving actuators, LEDs, etc. – Implementing SDIO 4-bit mode where commands are driven or captured on 6 pins with fixed timing, fed by the µDMA. ■ General custom interfaces of any speed. The configuration allows for choice of an output clock (free-running or gated), a framing signal (with frame size), a ready input (to stretch transactions), a read and write strobe, an address (of varying sizes), and data (of varying sizes). Additionally, provisions are made for separating data and address phases. The interface has the following optional features: ■ Use of the EPI clock output is controlled by the CLKPIN bit in the EPIGPCFG register. Unclocked uses include general-purpose I/O and asynchronous interfaces (optionally using RD and WR strobes). Clocked interfaces allow for higher speeds and are much easier to connect to FPGAs and CPLDs (which usually include input clocks). ■ EPI clock, if used, may be free running or gated depending on the CLKGATE bit in the EPIGPCFG register. A free-running EPI clock requires another method for determining when data is live, such as the frame pin or RD/WR strobes. A gated clock approach uses a setup-time model in which the EPI clock controls when transactions are starting and stopping. The gated clock is held high until a new transaction is started and goes high at the end of the cycle where RD/WR/FRAME and address (and data if write) are emitted. ■ Use of the ready input (iRDY) from the external device is controlled by the RDYEN bit in the EPIGPCFG register. The iRDY signal uses EPI0S27 and may only be used with a free-running clock. iRDY gates transactions, no matter what state they are in. When iRDY is deasserted, the transaction is held off from completing. ■ Use of the frame output (FRAME) is controlled by the FRMPIN bit in the EPIGPCFG register. The frame pin may be used whether the clock is output or not, and whether the clock is free running or not. It may also be used along with the iRDY signal. The frame may be a pulse (one clock) or may be 50/50 split across the frame size (controlled by the FRM50 bit in the EPIGPCFG register). The frame count (the size of the frame as specified by the FRMCNT field in the EPIGPCFG register) may be between 1 and 15 clocks for pulsed and between 2 and 30 clocks for 50/50. The frame pin counts transactions and not clocks; a transaction is any clock where the RD or WR strobe is high (if used). So, if the FRMCNT bit is set, then the frame pin pulses every other transaction; if 2-cycle reads and writes are used, it pulses every other address phase. FRM50 must be used with this in mind as it may hold state for many clocks waiting for the next transaction. ■ Use of the RD and WR outputs is controlled by the RW bit in the EPIGPCFG register. For interfaces where the direction is known (in advance, related to frame size, or other means), these strobes are not needed. For most other interfaces, RD and WR are used so the external peripheral knows what transaction is taking place, and if any transaction is taking place. ■ Separation of address/request and data phases may be used on writes using the WR2CYC bit in the EPIGPCFG register. This configuration allows the external peripheral extra time to act. Address and data phases must be separated on reads, and the RD2CYC bit in the EPIGPCFG register must be set. When configured to use an address as specified by the ASIZE field in the EPIGPCFG register, the address is emitted on the with the RD strobe (first cycle) and data is 478 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller expected to be returned on the next cycle (when RD is not asserted). If no address is used, then RD is asserted on the first cycle and data is captured on the second cycle (when RD is not asserted), allowing more setup time for data. For writes, the output may be in one or two cycles. In the two-cycle case, the address (if any) is emitted on the first cycle with the WR strobe and the data is emitted on the second cycle (with WR not asserted). Although split address and write data phases are not normally needed for logic reasons, it may be useful to make read and write timings match. If 2-cycle reads or writes are used, the RW bit is automatically set. ■ Address may be emitted (controlled by the ASIZE field in the EPIGPCFG register). The address may be up to 4 bits (16 possible values), up to 12 bits (4096 possible values), or up to 20 bits (1 M possible values). Size of address limits size of data, for example, 4 bits of address support up to 24 bits data. 4-bit address uses EPI0S[27:24]; 12-bit address uses EPI0S[27:16]; 20-bit address uses EPI0S[27:8]. The address signals may be used by the external peripheral as an address, code (command), or for other unrelated uses (such as a chip enable). If the chosen address/data combination does not use all of the EPI signals, the unused pins can be used as GPIOs or for other functions. For example, when using a 4-bit address with an 8-bit data, the pins assigned to EPIS0[23:8] can be assigned to other functions. ■ Data may be 8 bits, 16 bits, 24 bits, or 32 bits (controlled by the DSIZE field in the EPIGPCFG register). 32-bit data cannot be used with address or EPI clock or any other signal. 24-bit data can only be used with 4-bit address or no address. 32-bit data requires that either the WR2CYC bit or the RD2CYC bit in the EPIGPCFG register is set. ■ Memory can be used more efficiently by using the Word Access Mode. By default, the EPI controller uses data bits [7:0] when the DSIZE field in the EPIGPCFG register is 0x0; data bits [15:0] when the DSIZE field is 0x1; data bits [23:0] when the DSIZE field is 0x2; and data bits [31:0] when the DSIZE field is 0x3. When the WORD bit in the EPIGPCFG2 register is set, the EPI controller automatically routes bytes of data onto the correct byte lanes such that data can be stored in bits [31:8] for DSIZE=0x0 and bits [31:16] for DSIZE=0x1. ■ When using the EPI controller as a GPIO interface, writes are FIFOed (up to 4 can be held at any time), and up to 32 pins are changed using the EPIBAUD clock rate specified by COUNT0. As a result, output pin control can be very precisely controlled as a function of time. By contrast, when writing to normal GPIOs, writes can only occur 8-bits at a time and take up to two clock cycles to complete. In addition, the write itself may be further delayed by the bus due to μDMA or draining of a previous write. With both GPIO and the EPI controller, reads may be performed directly, in which case the current pin states are read back. With the EPI controller, the non-blocking interface may also be used to perform reads based on a fixed time rule via the EPIBAUD clock rate. Table 10-7 on page 479 shows how the EPI0S[31:0] signals function while in General-Purpose mode. Notice that the address connections vary depending on the data-width restrictions of the external peripheral. Table 10-7. EPI General Purpose Signal Connections EPI Signal General-Purpose Signal (D8, A20) General- Purpose Signal (D16, A12) General- Purpose Signal (D24, A4) General- Purpose Signal (D32) EPI0S0 D0 D0 D0 D0 EPI0S1 D1 D1 D1 D1 EPI0S2 D2 D2 D2 D2 January 22, 2012 479 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) Table 10-7. EPI General Purpose Signal Connections (continued) EPI Signal General-Purpose Signal (D8, A20) General- Purpose Signal (D16, A12) General- Purpose Signal (D24, A4) General- Purpose Signal (D32) EPI0S3 D3 D3 D3 D3 EPI0S4 D4 D4 D4 D4 EPI0S5 D5 D5 D5 D5 EPI0S6 D6 D6 D6 D6 EPI0S7 D7 D7 D7 D7 EPI0S8 A0 D8 D8 D8 EPI0S9 A1 D9 D9 D9 EPI0S10 A2 D10 D10 D10 EPI0S11 A3 D11 D11 D11 EPI0S12 A4 D12 D12 D12 EPI0S13 A5 D13 D13 D13 EPI0S14 A6 D14 D14 D14 EPI0S15 A7 D15 D15 D15 EPI0S16 A8 A0 a D16 D16 EPI0S17 A9 A1 D17 D17 EPI0S18 A10 A2 D18 D18 EPI0S19 A11 A3 D19 D19 EPI0S20 A12 A4 D20 D20 EPI0S21 A13 A5 D21 D21 EPI0S22 A14 A6 D22 D22 EPI0S23 A15 A7 D23 D23 EPI0S24 A16 A8 A0 b D24 EPI0S25 A17 A9 A1 D25 EPI0S26 A18 A10 A2 D26 EPI0S27 A19/iRDY A11/iRDY A3/iRDY c c c D27 EPI0S28 WR WR WR D28 EPI0S29 RD RD RD D29 EPI0S30 Frame Frame Frame D30 EPI0S31 Clock Clock Clock D31 a. In this mode, half-word accesses are used. AO is the LSB of the address and is equivalent to the system A1 address. b. In this mode, word accesses are used. AO is the LSB of the address and is equivalent to the system A2 address. c. This signal is iRDY if the RDYEN bit in the EPIGPCFG register is set. 10.4.3.1 Bus Operation A basic access is 1 EPI clock for write cycles and 2 EPI clocks for read cycles. An additional EPI clock can be inserted into a write cycle by setting the WR2CYC bit in the EPIGPCFG register. Note that the RD2CYC bit must always be set in the EPIGPCFG register. 480 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 10-13. Single-Cycle Write Access, FRM50=0, FRMCNT=0, WRCYC=0 Clock (EPI0S31) Frame (EPI0S30) RD (EPI0S29) WR (EPI0S28) Address Data Data Figure 10-14. Two-Cycle Read, Write Accesses, FRM50=0, FRMCNT=0, RDCYC=1, WRCYC=1 CLOCK (EPI0S31) FRAME (EPI0S30) RD (EPI0S29) WR (EPI0S28) Address Data Data Read Data Write January 22, 2012 481 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI) Figure 10-15. Read Accesses, FRM50=0, FRMCNT=0, RDCYC=1 CLOCK (EPI0S31) FRAME (EPI0S30) RD (EPI0S29) WR (EPI0S28) Addr1 Address Addr2 Data1 Data Addr3 Data2 Data3 FRAME Signal Operation The operation of the FRAME signal is controlled by the FRMCNT and FRM50 bits. When FRM50 is clear, the FRAME signal is high whenever the WR or RD strobe is high. When FRMCNT is clear, the FRAME signal is simply the logical OR of the WR and RD strobes so the FRAME signal is high during every read or write access, see Figure 10-16 on page 482. Figure 10-16. FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=0 and FRMCNT=0 Clock (EPI0S31) WR (EPI0S28) RD (EPI0S29) Frame (EPI0S30) If the FRMCNT field is 0x1, then the FRAME signal pulses high during every other read or write access, see Figure 10-17 on page 482. Figure 10-17. FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=0 and FRMCNT=1 Clock (EPI0S31) WR (EPI0S28) RD (EPI0S29) Frame (EPI0S30) If the FRMCNT field is 0x2 and FRM50 is clear, then the FRAME signal pulses high during every third access, and so on for every value of FRMCNT, see Figure 10-18 on page 483. 482 January 22, 2012 Texas Instruments-Production Data ® Stellaris LM3S1G21 Microcontroller Figure 10-18. FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=0 and FRMCNT=2 Clock (EPI0S31) WR (EPI0S28) RD (EPI0S29) Frame (EPI0S30) When FRM50 is set, the FRAME signal transitions on the rising edge of either the WR or RD strobes. When FRMCNT=0, the FRAME signal transitions on the rising edge of WR or RD for every access, see Figure 10-19 on page 483. Figure 10-19. FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=1 and FRMCNT=0 Clock (EPI0S31) WR (EPI0S28) RD (EPI0S29) Frame (EPI0S30) When FRMCNT=1, the FRAME signal transitions on the rising edge of the WR or RD strobes for every other access, see Figure 10-20 on page 483. Figure 10-20. FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=1 and FRMCNT=1 Clock (EPI0S31) WR (EPI0S28) RD (EPI0S29) Frame (EPI0S30) When FRMCNT=2, the FRAME signal transitions the rising edge of the WR or RD strobes for every third access, and so on for every value of FRMCNT, see Figure 10-21 on page 483. Figure 10-21. FRAME Signal Operation, FRM50=1 and FRMCNT=2 CLOCK (EPI0S31) WR (EPI0S28) RD (EPI0S29) FRAME (EPI0S30) January 22, 2012 483 Texas Instruments-Production Data External Peripheral Interface (EPI)